You are on page 1of 328

OWNER’S

MANUAL
Leon
5F0012720BH
Inglés 5F0012720BH (05.17)

Leon Inglés
­­ (05.17)
SEAT recommends SEAT recommends
SEAT GENUINE OIL Castrol EDGE Professional
About this manual The equipment marked with an aster-
isk* is fitted as standard only in certain
For the sake of the environment

versions, and is only supplied as op- Texts preceded by this symbol contain rele-
This manual contains a description of the vant information concerning environmental
equipment supplied with the vehicle at the tional extras for some versions, or are
protection.
time this manual was published. Some of the only offered in certain countries.
units described herein will not be available ® All registered marks are indicated with
Note
until a later date or are only available in cer- ®. Although the copyright symbol does
tain markets. not appear, it is a copyrighted mark. Texts preceded by this symbol contain additio-
nal information.
Because this is a general manual for the LEON >> The section is continued on the follow-
range, some of the equipment and functions ing page.
that are described in this manual are not in- This manual is divided into six large parts,
cluded in all types or variants of the model; Important warnings on a given page which are:
they may vary or be modified depending on Detailed contents on a given page 1. The essentials
the technical requirements and on the mar- 2. Safety
ket; this is in no way deceptive advertising. General information on a given page
3. Emergencies
The illustrations are intended as a general Emergency information on a given page 4. Operation
guide and may vary from the equipment fitted
in your vehicle in some details. 5. Tips
WARNING
The steering indications (left, right, forward, 6. Technical data
Texts preceded by this symbol contain infor-
reverse) appearing in this manual refer to the mation on safety. They warn you about possi- At the end of this manual, there is a detailed SEAT S.A. is permanently concerned about continuous development of its types and models. For this reason we ask you to under-
normal driving movements of the vehicle ex- ble dangers of accident or injury. alphabetical index that will help you quickly stand, that at any given time, changes regarding shape, equipment and technique may take place on the car delivered. For this reason
cept when otherwise indicated. find the information you require. no right at all may derive based on the data, drawings and descriptions in this current handbook.
The audiovisual material only is intended to CAUTION All texts, illustrations and standards in this handbook are based on the status of information at the time of printing. Except for error
help users to understand certain car function- or omission, the information included in the current handbook is valid as of the date of closing print.
Texts with this symbol draw your attention to
alities better. It does not replace the instruc- Re-printing, copying or translating, whether total or partial is not allowed unless SEAT allows it in written form.
potential sources of damage to your vehicle.
tion manual. Please use the instruction manu-
SEAT reserves all rights in accordance with the “Copyright” Act.
al to obtain more comprehensive information
and indications. All rights on changes are reserved.

❀ This paper has been manufactured using bleached non-chlorine cellulose.


© SEAT S.A. - Reprint: 15.05.17
Foreword You can access the information in this man-
ual using:
Thank you for trusting in us.
This Instruction Manual and its correspond- ● Thematic table of contents that follows the
We wish you safe and enjoya-
ing supplements should be read carefully to manual’s general chapter structure. ble motoring.
familiarise yourself with your vehicle.
● Visual table of contents that uses graphics
Besides the regular care and maintenance of to indicate the pages containing “essential” SEAT, S.A.
the vehicle, its correct handling will help pre- information, which is detailed in the corre-
serve its value. sponding chapters.
For safety reasons, always note the informa- ● Alphabetical index with many terms and
tion concerning accessories, modifications synonyms to help you find information.
and part replacements.
WARNING
If selling the vehicle, give all of the on-board
documentation to the new owner, as it Read and always observe safety informa-
should be kept with the vehicle. tion concerning the passenger's front air-
bag ››› page 87, Important information
regarding the front passenger's airbag.
Related videos

››› page 201


Safety: Traffic jam assist, adaptive cruise control, city safety assist, front and rear parking sensors and rear view cam- ››› page 221
era. ››› page 232
››› page 238

››› page 119


Technology: Kessy keyless access and starting system, with My Beat function, navigation system, wireless charger ››› page 124
and Full Link technology. ››› page 176
››› Booklet Navigation system
Table of Contents

Table of Contents How to jump start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .


Changing the wiper blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
65
67
Instruments and warning/control lamps . . . . .
Instruments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
108
108
Control lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
The essentials . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Introduction to the Easy Connect system* . . . . 114
Exterior view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 Safe driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
System settings (CAR)* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Exterior view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Safety first! . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 Communications and multimedia . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Driver-side general instrument panel (left- Advice about driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 Steering wheel controls* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
hand drive) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 Correct position for passengers . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Multimedia . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Driver-side general instrument panel (right- Pedal area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 Opening and closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
hand drive) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 Seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Central locking system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Centre console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Why wear a seat belt? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 Anti-theft alarm system* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Passenger-side general instrument panel (left- How to properly adjust your seatbelt . . . . . . . . 78
hand drive) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Rear lid (luggage compartment) . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Seat belt tensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Passenger-side general instrument panel Electric windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Airbag system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
(right-hand drive) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Panoramic sliding sunroof* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
Brief introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 Lights and visibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Interior view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Airbag safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
How it works . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Deactivating airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Unlocking and locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Visibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Transporting children safely . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Before driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 Windscreen wiper and window wiper sys-
Safety for children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 tems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 Child seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Child seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
Event Data Recorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89 Seats and head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
Starting the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Description and operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Lights and visibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Adjusting the seats and headrests . . . . . . . . . . 147
Easy Connect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Seat functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
Driver information system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 Self-help . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Transport and practical equipment . . . . . . . . . 152
Status display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Vehicle tool kit, anti-puncture kit* . . . . . . . . . . 90 Storage compartments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Tyre repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Storing objects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
Warning lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 Manual unlocking/locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92 Roof carrier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
Gearbox lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Changing the windscreen wiper blades . . . . . . 92 Air conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Air conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 Towing and tow-starting the vehicle . . . . . . . . . 93 Heating, ventilation and cooling . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Fluid Level control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 Fuses and bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 Ignition lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Changing bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 Braking and parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 Change the front bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 Braking and stability systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Action in the event of a puncture . . . . . . . . . . . 59 Changing incandescent rear light bulbs . . . . . . 102 Manual gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Changing a wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 Automatic gearbox/DSG automatic gear-
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 box* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Snow chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
Controls and displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 Run-in and economical driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
Emergency towing of the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . 64
General instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
3
Table of Contents

Engine management and exhaust gas purifica- Engine compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268


tion system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194 Engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
Driving tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195 Cooling system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
Driver assistance systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196 Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
Start-Stop System* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196 Windscreen washer reservoir . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
Auto Hold Function* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199 Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275
Cruise control system (CCS)* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
Adaptive Cruise Control ACC* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201 Wheels and tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
Area monitoring system (Front Assist) includ- Tyre monitoring systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
ing City emergency braking and pedestrian Temporary spare wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
monitoring* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212 Winter service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
Lane Assist system* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
Traffic Jam Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221 Technical data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
Emergency Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 Technical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
SEAT Drive Profile* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224 Important . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
Traffic sign detection system* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228 Vehicle identification data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
Fatigue detection (break recommendation)* . . 231 Information on fuel consumption . . . . . . . . . . . 288
Parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232 Trailer mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
Rear Assist “Rear View Camera”* . . . . . . . . . . . 238 Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
Towing bracket device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 Engine data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
Towing bracket device* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311
Trailer towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246 Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313
Advice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251
Care and maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251
Accessories and modifications to the vehi-
cle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251
Care and cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
Vehicle exterior care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
Caring for the vehicle interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
Intelligent technology . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
Electromechanical steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
Progressive steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
Four-wheel drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
Power Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
Checking and refilling levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
Filling the tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264
4
The essentials

Exterior view

1 ››› page 14 5 ››› page 64


2 ››› page 53 6 ››› page 15
3 ››› page 13 7 ››› page 59
4 ››› page 53
5
The essentials

Exterior view

1 ››› page 55 5 ››› page 54 9 ››› page 61


2 ››› page 54 6 ››› page 56 10 ››› page 60
3 ››› page 56 7 ››› page 56 11 ›››  page 158
4 ››› page 58 8 ›››  page 161
6
The essentials

Driver-side general instrument panel (left-hand drive)

1 ››› page 28 5 ››› page 18 8 ››› page 43 11 ››› page 27


2 ››› page 42 6 ››› page 16 9 ››› page 29 12 ››› page 19
3 ››› page 13 7 ››› page 15 10 ››› page 33 13 ››› page 58
4 ››› page 27

7
The essentials

Driver-side general instrument panel (right-hand drive)

1 ››› page 29 5 ››› page 18 8 ››› page 43 11 ››› page 19


2 ››› page 33 6 ››› page 16 9 ››› page 28 12 ››› page 27
3 ››› page 13 7 ››› page 15 10 ››› page 42 13 ››› page 58
4 ››› page 27

8
The essentials

Centre console

1 ››› page 46 3 ››› page 30 5 ››› page 48


2 ›››  page 174 4 ››› page 28
The layout in right-hand drive vehicles is symmetrical.

9
The essentials

Passenger-side general instrument panel (left-hand drive)

1 ››› page 19
2 ››› page 16
3 ›››  page 153

10
The essentials

Passenger-side general instrument panel (right-hand drive)

1 ››› page 19
2 ››› page 16
3 ›››  page 153

11
The essentials

Interior view

1 ››› page 17 5 ››› page 24


2 ››› page 18 6 ›››  page 160
3 ››› page 16 7 ››› page 17
4 ›››  page 145 8 ››› page 20
12
The essentials

How it works Locking and unlocking the vehicle using the


key
Unlocking and locking the driver door

● Locking: press the  ››› Fig. 1 button.


Unlocking and locking
● Locking the vehicle without activating the
Doors anti-theft system: Press the  ››› Fig. 1 button
for a second time within 2 seconds.
● Unlocking: press the  ››› Fig. 1 button.
● Unlocking the rear lid: Hold down the 
››› Fig. 1 button for at least 1 second.

Locking and unlocking with the central lock-


ing switch Fig. 3 Driver door lever: hidden lock cylinder.
● Locking: press the  ››› Fig. 2 button. None
of the doors can be opened from the outside. If the central locking system should fail to op-
The doors can be opened from the inside by erate, the driver door can still be locked and
pulling the inside door handle. unlocked by turning the key in the lock.
Fig. 1 Remote control key: buttons.
● Unlocking: press the  ››› Fig. 2 button. As a general rule, when the driver door is
locked manually all other doors are locked.
When it is unlocked manually, only the driver
 ››› in Description on page 120 door opens. Please observe the instructions
relating to the anti-theft alarm system
 ››› page 120 ›››  page 120.
● Unfold the vehicle key blade
 ››› page 13, ››› page 14 ›››  page 121.
● Insert the key shaft into the lower opening
in the cover on the driver door handle
››› Fig. 3 (arrow) then remove the cover up-
Fig. 2 Driver door: central locking switch. wards.
● Insert the key blade into the lock cylinder
to unlock or lock the vehicle. »

13
The essentials

Special Characteristics If the central locking system should fail to The rear lid opening system operates electri-
● The anti-theft alarm will remain active when work at any time, doors with no lock cylinder cally. It is activated by using the handle on
vehicles are unlocked. However, the alarm will have to be locked separately. the boot lid.
will not be triggered ›››  page 120. A mechanical locking device (only visible To lock/unlock, press the button  or button
● After the driver door is opened, you have when the door is open) is provided on the  ››› Fig. 1 on the remote control key.
15 seconds to switch on the ignition. Once front passenger door.
A warning appears on the instrument panel
this time has elapsed, the alarm is triggered. display if the rear lid is open or not properly
● Pull the cap out of the opening.
● Switch the ignition on. The electronic im- closed.* An audible warning is also given if it
● Insert the key in the inside slot and turn it
mobilizer recognises a valid vehicle key and is opened while the vehicle is moving faster
to the right as far as it will go (if the door is
deactivates the anti-theft alarm system. than 6 km/h (4 mph)*.
on the right side) or to the left (if the door is
on the left side).
Note Opening and closing
The anti-theft alarm is not activated when the Once the door has been closed it can no lon- ● Opening the rear lid: pull on the release
vehicle is locked manually using the key ger be opened from the outside. Pull the inte- lever and lift it up ››› Fig. 5. The rear lid opens
shaft ›››  page 120. rior door handle once to unlock and open the automatically.
door. ● Closing the rear lid: Hold it by one of the
handles on the interior lining and close it by
Manual locking of the doors with no pushing gently.
lock cylinder Rear lid
›››
 in Tailgate automatic lock on
page 130

 ››› page 130

 ››› page 15, ››› page 15

Fig. 4 Locking the door manually. Fig. 5 Rear lid: opening from the outside.

14
The essentials

Manual release of the rear lid Manual release of the rear lid Bonnet
3 Applies to the model: LEON/LEON SC 3 Applies to the model: LEON ST

Fig. 8 Release lever in the driver's footwell


Fig. 6 Luggage compartment: access to man- area.
ual release.

The rear lid can be unlocked manually from


inside in the event of an emergency.
● Insert the key in the opening in the lining
of the tail gate 1 and move the key in the di-
rection of the arrow until the lock is released.

Fig. 7 Luggage compartment: access to man-


ual release.
Fig. 9 Cam under the bonnet
The rear lid can be unlocked manually from
inside in the event of an emergency. ● Opening the bonnet: Pull the lever under
● Remove the cover by inserting a screwdriv- the dashboard ››› Fig. 8 1 .
er in groove ››› Fig. 7 A. ● Lift up the bonnet. Press the release catch
● Insert the key into the opening and turn it under the bonnet upwards ››› Fig. 9 2 . The
in the direction of the arrow until the latch arrester hook under the bonnet is released. »
››› Fig. 7 B has been released.
15
The essentials

● The bonnet can be opened. Release the Buttons on the driver door
bonnet stay and secure it in the fixture de- 1 Window on the front left door
signed for this in the bonnet.
2 Window on the front right door
››› Window on the rear left door (only 5-door
 in Work in the engine compartment
on page 268
3
vehicles)
4 Window on the right rear door (only 5-
 ››› page 268 door vehicles)
5 Safety switch for deactivating the electric
window buttons on the rear doors (only 5-
door vehicles) Fig. 12 On the interior roof lining: press the
Electric windows* button and pull on it to raise and lower the
sunroof.
›››
 in Opening and closing of the elec-
tric windows* on page 131
● Opening: Turn the switch to position
››› Fig. 11
 ››› page 131
3 .
● Convenience position: Turn the switch to
position ››› Fig. 11 2 .
● Closing: Turn the switch to position
Panoramic roof* ››› Fig. 11 1 .
● To tilt open: Push the switch to position
››› Fig. 124 . For an intermediate position,
hold down the switch until you reach the de-
sired position.
● Lowering: Pull the switch to position
Fig. 10 Detail of the driver door: controls for ››› Fig. 125 . For an intermediate position,
the windows. hold down the switch until you reach the de-
sired position.
● Opening the window: Press the  button.
● Closing the window: Pull the  button.
Fig. 11 On the interior roof lining: use the ro-
tary button for opening and closing

16
The essentials

››› 3 Tilting the backrest: turn the hand wheel. cushion, press the rear of the button
 in Opening or closing the panoramic
sliding sunroof on page 133 4 Lumbar support: Press the button in the
corresponding position.
up/down.
Seat forwards/backwards: press the but-
 ››› page 133 5 Folding down the backrest (only 3-door
vehicles): pull the lever and push the C
ton forwards/backwards.
Backrest further upright/further reclined:
backrest forward. press the button forwards/backwards.

Before driving ››› ›››


 in Manual adjustment of seats on
page 147  in Electric driver's seat adjustment*
on page 148
Manually adjusting the front seats

Electric adjustment of the driver's Adjusting the head restraints


seat*

Fig. 15 Front seat: adjustment of the head re-


Fig. 14 Driver's seat: electric seat adjust- straint.
ment.
● Grab the sides of the head restraints with
A Adjusting the lumbar support: press the both hands and push upwards to the desired
Fig. 13 Front seats: manual seat adjustment. button according to the desired position. position. To lower it, repeat the same action,
B Seat up/down: Press the button pressing the 1 button on the side. »
1 Forward/back: pull the lever and move
up/down. To adjust the front of the seat
the seat forwards or backwards.
cushion, press the front of the button
2 Raising/lowering: pull/push the lever. up/down. To adjust the rear of the seat
17
The essentials

››› Seat belt tensioners


 in Correct adjustment of front head
restraints on page 73
During a collision, the seat belts on the front

 ››› page 73, ››› page 148 seats are retracted automatically.
The tensioner can be triggered only once.

›››
Adjustment of the seat belt  in Service and disposal of belt ten-
sioners on page 80

Fig. 17 Correct seat belt and head restraint


 ››› page 79

positions, viewed from front and the side.

To adjust the seat belt around your should- Adjusting the exterior mirrors
ers, adjust the height of the seats.
The shoulder part of the seat belt should be
well centred over it, never over the neck. The
seat belt lies flat and fits comfortably on the
upper part of the body.
The lap part of the seat belt lies across the
pelvis, never across the stomach. The seat
belt lies flat and fits comfortably on the pel-
vis.

 ››› page 76 Fig. 18 Detail of the driver door: control for


the exterior mirror.

Fig. 16 Positioning and removing the seat  ››› page 78 Adjusting the exterior mirrors: Turn the knob
to the corresponding position:
belt buckle.
L/R Turning the knob to the desired posi-
tion, adjust the mirrors on the driver

18
The essentials

side (L, left) and the passenger side (R, ›››


right) to the direction desired.
Depending on the equipment fitted on
 in Adjusting the steering wheel po-
sition on page 71

the vehicle, the mirrors may be heated


according to the outside temperature.
 Folding in mirrors. Airbags

››› Front airbags


 in Adjusting the exterior rear view
mirrors on page 147

 ››› page 146

Adjusting the steering wheel

Fig. 21 Front passenger airbag located in


dash panel.

The front airbag for the driver is located in


the steering wheel ››› Fig. 20 and the airbag
for the front passenger is located in the dash
panel ››› Fig. 21. Airbags are identified by the
word “AIRBAG”.
Fig. 19 Lever in the lower left side of the
When the driver and front passenger airbags
steering column.
Fig. 20 Driver airbag located in steering are deployed, the covers remain attached to
wheel. the steering wheel and dashboard, respec-
● Adjusting the position of the steering
tively ››› Fig. 20 ››› Fig. 21.
wheel: Pull the ››› Fig. 19 lever down,
1
move the steering wheel to the desired posi- In conjunction with the seat belts, the front
tion and lift the lever back up until it locks. airbag system gives the front occupants ad-
ditional protection for the head and chest in »
19
The essentials

the event of a severe frontal collision ››› in ● Insert the key blade into the slot provided
Front airbags on page 82. in the deactivation switch.
Their special design allows the controlled es- ● Approximately ¾ of the length of the key
cape of the propellant gas when an occupant blade remains inserted (the maximum).
puts pressure on the bag. Thus, the head and ● Turn the key blade, changing its position to
chest are protected by the airbag. After the . Do not force it. If you have difficulty, en-
collision, the airbag deflates sufficiently to sure that you have inserted the key as far as
allow visibility. it will go.
● Finally, check the control lamp on the in-

 ››› page 82 strument panel where it shows  


   the following should appear .
Fig. 24 On the driver side: radius of action of
the knee airbag.

›››
Deactivating the front passenger front  in Front passenger front airbag
switch on page 86
The knee airbag is located on the driver side
below the dash panel ››› Fig. 23. Airbags are
airbag identified by the word “AIRBAG”.
 ››› page 85
The area framed in red (deployment area)
››› Fig. 24 is covered by the knee airbag when
it is deployed. Objects should never be
Knee airbag* placed or mounted in this area.

 ››› page 82

Fig. 22 Front passenger front airbag switch.

To deactivate the front passenger front air-


bag:
● Open the glove compartment on the front
Fig. 23 On the driver side: location of the
passenger side. knee airbag
20
The essentials

Side airbags* In conjunction with the seat belts, the side The head-protection airbags are located on
airbag system provides additional protection both sides in the interior above the doors
for the upper body in the event of a severe ››› Fig. 27 and are identified with the text
side collision ››› in Side airbags* on “AIRBAG”.
page 82.
In conjunction with the seat belts, the head-
In a side collision, the side airbags reduce protection airbag system gives the vehicle
the risk of injury to passengers to the areas occupants additional protection for the head
of the body facing the impact. In addition to and upper body in the event of a severe side
their normal function of protecting the occu- collision ››› in Curtain airbags* on
pants in a collision, the front and rear outer page 83.
seat belts also hold the passengers in the
event of a side collision; this is how these air-
Fig. 25 Side airbag in driver's seat. bags provide maximum protection.  ››› in Curtain airbags* on page 83

 ››› page 82

Head-protection airbags*

Fig. 26 Illustration of completely inflated side


airbags on the left side of the vehicle.

The side airbags are located in the backrest


cushions of the driver seat ››› Fig. 25 and the
front passenger seat as well as in the back-
rest of the side rear seats*. The locations are
Fig. 27 Location of head-protection airbags.
identified by the text “AIRBAG” in the upper
region of the backrests.

21
The essentials

Child seats ›››


 in Important information regarding
the front passenger's airbag on page 87
Important information regarding the
front passenger's airbag  ››› page 86

Fig. 29 Airbag stickers - version 2: on the


passenger-side sun blind  and on the rear
frame of the front passenger's door .

A sticker with important information about


the passenger airbag is located on the pas-
Fig. 28 Airbag stickers - version 1: on the senger's sun visor and/or on the passenger
passenger-side sun blind  and on the rear side door frame.
frame of the front passenger's door .

22
The essentials

Securing child seats with the seat belt

Fig. 30 On the rear seats: Possible installations


for the child seat.

Figure ››› Fig. 30 A shows the basic child re- is no contact with the child seat in the back
straint system mounting using lower retain- in the case that it goes opposite to the direc-
ing rings and the upper retaining strap. Fig- tion of the car. In the case of front facing re-
ure ››› Fig. 30 B shows the child restraint straint systems, the front backrest must be
system mounting using the vehicle seat belt. adjusted so that there is no contact with the
child's feet.
The seat belt may be used to secure univer-
sal type child seats to the vehicle seats To adjust the passenger seat to accommo-
marked with a U in the table below. date a child's seat and get the seat belt in a
perfect position, adjust the passenger back-
If the front passenger seat lacks a height ad-
rest as far forward as possible1).
justment, child seats cannot be mounted is
this location1). Starting with Group 0+ child seats should not
be mounted facing backwards in the passen-
To correctly use a child seat in the back, the
ger seat given that due to the size of some of
front backrest must be adjusted so that there
them, they can be difficult to install.1). »

1) Compliance with current national legislation and

the manufacturer's instructions is required when us-


ing or installing child seats.
23
The essentials

Seating position U: Suitable for universal restraint systems


for use in this weight group.
Weight Front pas- Rear Rear
group *: Only compatible for models with adjust-
senger side central able seat height. Place the seat in the
seata) seat seat backmost and highest position possi-
Group 0 U* U U ble.
to 10 kg
The systems include the child restraint sys-
Group 0+ U* U U tem mounting with an upper retaining strap
to 13 kg (Top Tether) and lower anchoring points on
the seat.
Group I U* U U
9 to 18 kg

Group II
15 to 25 kg
U* U U  ››› in Safety instructions on page 88

Group III U* U U
22 to 36 kg
a) Compliance with current national legislation and the manu-
facturer's instructions is required when using or installing child
seats.

“ISOFIX” and Top Tether child seat mounting system*


Child seats can be secured quickly, easily FIX” rings are located between the rear seat To understand the compatibility of the "ISO-
and safely on the rear outer seats with the backrest and the seat cushioning. The Top FIX" systems in the vehicle, consult the table
“ISOFIX” and Top Tether* system. Tether* rings are located at the rear of the below.
backrests of the rear seats (behind the seat
Two “ISOFIX” retaining rings are fitted on The body weight permitted and information
backrest or in the boot).
each rear seat. In some vehicles, the rings regarding sizes A to F is indicated on the la-
are secured to the seat frame and, in others, bel on child seats with “universal” or “semi-
they are secured to the rear floor. The “ISO- universal” certification.

24
The essentials

Vehicle Isofix positions


Weight group Size class Electrical equipment Mounting direction
Rear side seats
F ISO/L1 Backward-facing X
Baby carrier
G ISO/L2 Backward-facing X

Group 0 to 10 kg E ISO/R1 Backward-facing IU

E ISO/R1 Backward-facing IU

Group 0+ to 13 kg D ISO/R2 Backward-facing IU

C ISO/R3 Backward-facing IU

D ISO/R2 Backward-facing IU

C ISO/R3 Backward-facing IU

Group I 9 to 18 kg B ISO/F2 Forward-facing IU

B1 ISO/F2X Forward-facing IU

A ISO/F3 Forward-facing IU

Group II 15 to 25 kg --- --- Forward-facing ---

Group III 22 to 36 kg --- --- Forward-facing ---

IU: Suitable for ISOFIX universal child re-


straint systems approved for use in this
weight group.
X: ISOFIX position not suitable for ISOFIX
child restraint systems for this weight
group or size class.

 ››› in Safety instructions on page 88

25
The essentials

Attaching the child seat with the Attachment of the child seat with the Securing the Top Tether* to the an-
“ISOFIX system” Top Tether* retainer straps chorage point

Fig. 31 ISOFIX securing rings. Fig. 32 Position of the Top Tether rings on the Fig. 33 Retainer strap: correct adjustment
back of the rear seat. and fitting.
You are obliged to follow the seat manufac-
turer's instructions. Child seats with the Top Tether system come Securing the retainer strap
with a strap for securing the seat to the vehi- ● Follow the manufacturer's instructions to
● Remove the protective caps of the “ISOFIX” cle anchor point, located at the back of the deploy the child seat Top Tether retainer
rings by placing a finger in the hole and pull- rear seat backrest and provide greater re- strap.
ing up ››› Fig. 31. straint.
● Guide the strap under the rear seat head re-
● Press the child seat onto the “ISOFIX” re-
The objective of this strap is to reduce for- straint ››› Fig. 33 (lift the head restraint where
taining rings until the child seat can be heard ward movements of the child seat in a crash, necessary).
to engage securely. If the child seat is equip- to reduce the risk of injuries to the head from
ped with Top Tether* anchor points, secure it ● Slide the strap and secure it properly with
hitting the inside of the vehicle.
to the correspondent ring ››› Fig. 32. Observe the anchorage of the backrest ››› Fig. 32.
the manufacturer's instructions. ● Firmly tighten the strap following the manu-
Using the Top Tether in rear-facing mounted
● Pull on both sides of the child seat to en- seats facturer's instructions.
sure that it is properly anchored.
Currently, there are very few rear-facing child Releasing the retaining strap
Child seats with the “ISOFIX” and Top Tether* safety seats that have Top Tether. Please
carefully read and follow the seat manufac- ● Loosen the strap following the manufactur-
attachment system are available from Techni-
turer instructions to learn the proper way to er's instructions.
cal Services.
install the Top Tether strap.
26
The essentials

● Push the lock and release it from the an- position. If necessary, press the locking key Start-Stop System*
choring support. on the selector lever and release it again. When you stop and release the clutch pedal,
● Unlocking the steering wheel: Put the key the Start-Stop system* turns off the engine.
 ››› in Safety instructions on page 88 into the ignition and turn it at the same time
as the steering wheel in the direction indica-
The ignition remains switched on.

ted by the arrow. If it is not possible to turn ››› in Switching the ignition on and
the steering wheel, it may be because it is
locked.
 starting the engine with the key on
page 172
Starting the vehicle
Ignition lock
Turning on/switching off the ignition, glow
plugs reheating
 ››› page 171

● Switch ignition on: Turn the key to the 2


position.
● Switch ignition off. Turn the key to the 1
Lights and visibility
position.
Light switch
● Diesel vehicles : The glow plugs reheat
when the ignition is switched on.

Starting the engine


● Manual gearbox: press the clutch pedal all
the way down and move the gearbox lever in-
Fig. 34 Ignition key positions.
to neutral.
Switch ignition on: Place the key in the igni- ● Automatic gearbox: Press the brake pedal
tion and start the engine. and move the selector lever to the P position
or into N.
Locking and unlocking the steering wheel ● Turn the key to the 3 position. The key au-
Fig. 35 Dash panel: light control.
● Engaging the steering wheel lock: Remove tomatically returns to the 2 position. Do not
the key from the ignition and turn the wheel press the accelerator. ● Turn the switch to the required position
until it locks. Depending on the country, in ››› Fig. 35. »
vehicles with an automatic gearbox, to re-
move the key the gear lever must be in the P

27
The essentials

Sym- Ignition switched Ignition is Turn signal and main beam lever Hazard warning lights
bol off switched on
Fog lights, dipped
Light off or daytime
 beam and side lights
driving light on.
off.

The “Coming home” Automatic control of


and “Leaving home” dipped beam and
 guide lights may be daytime running
switched on. light.

 Side light on.

Dipped beam head- Dipped beam Fig. 37 Dash panel: switch for hazard warn-
 light off switched on.
Fig. 36 Turn signal and main beam lever.
ing lights.
More the lever to the required position:
 Front fog lights: move the switch to the
Switched on, for example:
first position, from positions ,  or . 1 Right turn signal: Right-hand parking
light (ignition switched off). ● When approaching a traffic jam
 Rear fog light: move the switch completely
from positions ,  or . 2 Left turn signal: Left-hand parking light ● In an emergency
(ignition switched off). ● The vehicle has broken down
● Switching off fog lights: Push the switch or
turn it to the  position. 3 Main beam switched on: Control lamp  ● When towing or being towed
lit up on the instrument panel.
›››
 ››› in Side light and dipped beam head-
light on page 135
4 Headlight flasher: lit up when the lever is
pushed. Control lamp  lit up.  in Hazard warning lights  on
page 140

 ››› page 135 Lever all the way down to switch it off.
 ››› page 140

›››
 in Turn signal and main beam lever
on page 136

 ››› page 136

28
The essentials

Interior lights Knob Function More the lever to the required position:

 Turning the reading light on and off Windscreen wipers interval wipe.
Using the control ››› Fig. 39 A adjust the
a) Depending on version.
1  interval (vehicles without rain sensor), or
the sensitivity of the rain sensor.

 ››› page 142 2  Slow wipe.

3  Continuous wipe.

Short wipe. Brief press, short clean. Hold


Windscreen wipers and window wiper 4  the lever down for more time to increase
blade the wipe frequency.
Fig. 38 Detail of headliner: front interior light- Automatic wipe. The windscreen washer
ing. function is activated by pushing the lever
5  forwards, and simultaneously the wind-
Knob Function screen wipers start.

Interval wipe for rear window. The wiper


 Switches interior lights off.
6  will wipe the window approximately every
six seconds.
 Switches interior lights on.
The rear window wash function is activa-
Door contact switch-on.
The interior lights come on automati-
7  ted by pressing the lever, and the rear
wiper starts simultaneously.
cally when the vehicle is unlocked, a
Central position
door is opened or the key is removed
or Fig. 39 Operating the windscreen wiper and

 a)
from the ignition.
The light goes off a few seconds af-
ter all the doors are closed, the vehi-
rear wiper.
 ››› page 143

cle is locked or the ignition is switch-


ed on.
More the lever to the required position:
 ››› page 67
0  Windscreen wiper off.

29
The essentials

Easy Connect
CAR menu settings

Fig. 40 Easy Connect: Main menu. Fig. 41 Easy Connect: CAR menu.

To select the settings menus, depending on ● If the Infotainment System is off, switch it ● To select a function in the menu, press the
the version, either press the Easy Connect on. desired button.
 button and the SETTINGS function button, ● Press the system's  button, then the
OR press the  button, then Vehicle and When you press the menu button, the last se-
system's Vehicle function button ››› Fig. 40 or lected menu will always be displayed.
then the SETTINGS function button. the system’s  button to go to the Vehi-
The actual number of menus available and cle menu ››› Fig. 41. When the function button check box is activa-
the name of the various options will depend ● Press the SETTINGS function button to open ted , the function is active.
on the vehicle’s electronics and equipment. the menu Vehicle settings menu Any changes made using the settings menus
››› Fig. 41. are automatically saved on closing the
● Switch the ignition on.
BACK  menus.

Menu Submenu Possible setting Description


ESC system – Activation of the Electronic Stability Programme (ESC) ››› page 181
Tyre pressure monitoring Tyre pressure storing (Calibration) ››› page 281
Tyres
Winter tyres Activation and deactivation of the speed warning. Setting the speed warning value ››› page 285
30
The essentials

Menu Submenu Possible setting Description


Activation/deactivation: Gear programme, temporary distance from the vehicle in front (dis-
ACC (adaptive cruise control) ››› page 201
tance level)

Front Assist (ambient traffic


monitoring system)
Activation/deactivation: monitoring system, advance warning, distance warning display ››› page 212

City emergency braking func-


tion
Activation/deactivation of the City emergency braking function. ››› page 216
Driver assistance
Lane Assist (system warning
you if you leave the lane)
Activation/deactivation: Lane Assist, Adaptive Lane Guidance ››› page 218

The following functions can be activated and deactivated:


Detection of traffic signs – Display of traffic signs on the multi-function display ››› page 228
– Trailer recognition (display of traffic signs for vehicles with trailer)

Fatigue detection Activation/deactivation ››› page 231


Parking and ma- Automatically activate, front volume, front sound settings, rear volume, rear sound settings,
noeuvring
ParkPilot
adjust volume
››› page 232

Vehicle interior lighting Instrument and switch lighting, footrest lighting ››› page 142
Coming home/Leaving home ››› page 138
Start time for “Coming home” function, start time for “Leaving home” function
Vehicle lights
function ››› page 139
Motorway light Activation/deactivation ››› page 141
Headlamp height adjustment Adjusting headlight height and range depending on vehicle load ››› page 141
››› page 18,
Mirrors Synchronised regulation, lower the rear-view mirror when reversing, fold in after parking
Mirrors/wind‐ ››› page 146
screen wipers
Windscreen wipers Automatic windscreen wipers, wipe when reversing ››› page 29

Opening and clos-


Radio-operated remote control Convenience open function ››› page 132
ing
Central locking system Unlocking doors, automatic locking/unlocking, audible confirmation ››› page 120 »

31
The essentials

Menu Submenu Possible setting Description


Current consumption, average consumption, volume to fill up, convenience consumers,
Multifunction ECOAdvice, travelling time, distance travelled, digital speed display, average speed, speed-
– ››› page 33
display ing warning, oil temperature, coolant temperature, restore data “from start”, restore data
“total calculation”

Time source, set the time, automatic summer time (DST) setting, select time zone, time for-
Date and time – –
mat, set the date, date format

Measurement units – Distance, speed, temperature, volume, consumption –

Service – Chassis number, date of next SEAT service inspection, date of next oil change service ››› page 41
All settings can be reset: driver assistance, parking and manoeuvring, lights, rear view mir-
Factory settings – –
rors and windscreen wipers, opening and closing, multi-function display

 ››› in CAR menu on page 114

 ››› page 114

32
The essentials

Driver information system ■ MFD from refuelling Using the menus on the instrument
■ MFD total calculation panel
Introduction Assist systems ››› page 37

With the ignition switched on, it is possible Navigation ››› Booklet Navigation system
to read the different functions of the display Audio ››› Booklet Radio or ››› Booklet Naviga-
by scrolling through the menus. tion system
In vehicles with multifunction steering wheel, Telephone ››› Booklet Radio or ››› Book-
the multifunction display can only be operat- let Navigation system
ed with the steering wheel buttons.
Vehicle status ››› page 30
The number of menus displayed on the in-
strument panel will vary according to the ve- WARNING
hicle electronics and equipment. Fig. 42 Windscreen wiper lever: control but-
Any distraction may lead to an accident, with
A specialised workshop will be able to pro- tons.
the risk of injury.
gramme or modify additional functions, ac- ● Do not operate the instrument panel con-
cording to the vehicle equipment. SEAT rec- trols when driving.
ommends visiting a SEAT Official Service.
Some menu options can only be read when
the vehicle is at a standstill.
As long as a priority 1 warning is displayed, it
will not be possible to read the menus
››› page 38. Some warning messages can
be confirmed and made to disappear with the
windscreen wiper lever button or the multi-
function steering wheel button. Fig. 43 Right side of multifunction steering
wheel: control buttons.
The information system also provides the fol-
lowing information and displays (depending The driver information system is controlled
on the vehicle's equipment): with the multifunction steering wheel buttons
Driving data ››› page 35
››› Fig. 43 or with the windscreen wiper lever
››› Fig. 42 (if the vehicle is not equipped with
■ MFD from departure
multifunction steering wheel). »
33
The essentials

Enabling the main menu Making changes according to the menu in the Assist systems menu
● Switch the ignition on. ● With the rocker switch on the windscreen ›››  page 196.
● If a message or vehicle pictogram appears, wiper lever or the thumbwheel of the multi-
function steering wheel, make the desired Activate or deactivate a driver assistance
press button ››› Fig. 42 1 on the windscreen system
wiper lever or button  on the multifunction changes. To increase or decrease the values
steering wheel ››› Fig. 43. more quickly, turn the thumbwheel faster. ● Briefly press the button ››› Fig. 44 in the di-
● Mark or confirm the selection with button rection of the arrow to open the menu As-
● If managed from the windscreen wiper lev-
››› Fig. 42 1on the windscreen wiper lever sist systems.
er: to display the main screen ››› page 34 or
to return to the main menu from another or button  on the multifunction steering ● Select the driver assistance system and ac-
menu hold down the rocker button ››› Fig. 42 wheel ››› Fig. 43. tivate or deactivate it ››› page 33. A mark indi-
2 . cates that driver assistance system is switch-
ed on.
● If managed from the multifunction steering
wheel: the main menu list is not displayed. Button for the driver assistance sys-
To go from point to point in the main menu, tems*
press button   or   several times Selection menu
››› Fig. 43.
Menu Function
Select a submenu
Information and possible configura-
Driving
● Press the rocker switch ››› Fig. 42 2 on the tions of the multifunction display (MFD)
data
windscreen wiper lever up or down or turn ››› page 35, ››› page 114.
the thumbwheel of the multifunction steering Information and possible configura-
wheel ››› Fig. 43 until the desired option ap- Assist
tions of the driver assistance systems
systems
pears marked on the menu. ››› page 37.
● The selected option is displayed between
two horizontal lines. In addition, a triangle is Fig. 44 On the turn signal and main beam
displayed on the right:  headlight lever: button for the driver assis-
● To consult the submenu option, press but- tance systems
ton ››› Fig. 42 1 on the windscreen wiper
lever or button  on the multifunction steer- With the turn signal and main beam head-
ing wheel ››› Fig. 43. light lever button, you can activate or deacti-
vate the driver assistance systems displayed

34
The essentials

Menu Function Driving data Menu Function


Information instructions from the acti- The MFD (multifunction display) shows differ- Display and storage of the values for
vated navigation system: when a route ent values for the journey and the consump- the journey and the consumption from
guidance is activated, the turning ar- tion. when the ignition is switched on to
rows and proximity bars are displayed. when it is switched off.
The appearance is similar to the Easy If the journey is continued in less than
Changing between display modes on the MFD from
Navigation Connect system. 2 hours after the ignition is switched
departure
If route guidance is not activated, the MFD off, the new data is added to the data
direction of travel (compass) and the already stored in the memory. The
● In vehicles without multifunction steering
name of the street along which you are memory will automatically be deleted if
driving are shown ››› Booklet Naviga- wheel: Press the rocker switch  on the the journey is interrupted for more than
tion system. windscreen wiper lever ››› Fig. 42. 2 hours.
● Vehicles with a multifunction steering
Station display on the radio. Display and storage of the values for
Track name on the CD. wheel: turn the thumbwheel ››› Fig. 43. MFD from the journey and the consumption. By
Audio Track name in Media mode ››› Book- refuelling refuelling, the memory will be erased
let Radio or ››› Booklet Navigation sys- Multifunction display memory automatically.
tem.
The multifunction display is equipped with The memory records the values for a
Information and possible configura- three memories that work automatically: MFD specific number of partial trips, up to a
tions of the mobile phone preinstalla- from departure, MFD from refuelling and MFD total of 19 hours and 59 minutes or 99
Telephone
tion ››› Booklet Radio or ››› Booklet Nav- MFD total hours and 59 minutes, or 1999.9 km or
total calculation. On the screen display, you
igation system. calcula- 9999 km, depending on the model of
can read which memory is currently dis- tion instrument panel. On reaching either of
In a racing circuit, measurement and played. these limitsa), the memory is automati-
memorisation of lap times by the vehi- cally erased and starts to count from 0
Lap timer
cle and comparison with previously again.
● Toggle between memories with the ignition
measured best times ››› page 37.
on and the memory displayed: Press the a) It varies according to the instrument panel version.
Display of the current warning or infor-  button on the windscreen wiper lever
Vehicle mation texts and other system compo- or the  button of the multifunction steering
status nents, depending on the equipment
Erasing a memory manually
wheel.
››› page 114. ● Select the memory that you wish to erase.
● Hold the  button of the multifunction
steering wheel or the  button of the multi-
function wheel pressed down for about 2 sec-
onds. »
35
The essentials

Personalising the displays Menu Function Menu Function


In the Easy Connect system you can adjust
Distance Distance covered in km (m) after Coolant tem-
which of the possible displays of the MFD can Digital display of the current temper-
covered switching on the ignition. perature
be shown on the instrument panel display ature of the liquid coolant.
gauge
with the  button and the SETTINGS function Whenever you refuel the quality of
button ›››  page 114. the natural gas is automatically veri- a) In vehicles with a natural gas engine, range and average con-

fied and is displayed when the igni- sumption refer only to data or natural gas consumption. If you
tion is switched on. The display is are in “petrol mode”, the information of both data only appears
Data summary CNG quality
made in a percentage of between on the dash panel and not on the multifunction screen.
70% and 100%. The greater the per-
Menu Function centage displayed the lower the con- Storing a speed with the speed warning
sumption may be.
The current fuel consumption dis- ● Select the display Speed warning at
play operates throughout the jour-
Current fuel The average speed will be shown af- --- km/h (--- mph)
ney, in litres/100 km; and with the ter a distance of about 100 metres
consumption ● Press the button  on the windscreen
engine running and the vehicle Average has been travelled. Otherwise hori-
stopped, in litres/hour. speed zontal lines are displayed. The value wiper lever or the button  on the multifunc-
shown is updated approximately ev- tion steering wheel to store the current speed
After turning on the ignition, aver-
age fuel consumption in li-
ery 5 seconds. and activate the warning.
tres/100 km will be displayed after Digital dis- ● To switch system on: adjust to the desired
travelling about 100 metres. Other- Current speed displayed in digital
Average fuel play of speed within 5 seconds using the rocker
wise horizontal lines are displayed. format.
consumptiona) speed switch  on the windscreen wiper lever or
The value shown is updated approxi-
mately every 5 seconds. by turning the thumbwheel on the multifunc-
Speed warn- If the stored speed is exceeded (be-
ACT®*: Depending on the equip- ing at --- tween 30 - 250 km/h, or 19 - tion steering wheel. Next, press the button
ment, number of active cylinders. km/h or Speed 155 mph), an audible warning is  or  again or wait several seconds.
warning at given together with a visual warn- The speed is stored and the warning activa-
Approximate distance in km that can --- mph ing.
still be travelled with the fuel re-
ted.
Operating maining in the tank, assuming the Detection of ● To switch system off: press the but-
rangea) same style of driving is maintained. The traffic signs detected are dis-
traffic
played.
ton  or  . The stored speed is de-
This is calculated using the current signs leted.
fuel consumption.
Oil tempera- Updated engine oil temperature dig-
This indicates the hours (h) and mi- ture ital display
Travelling
nutes (min) since the ignition was
time
switched on.

36
The essentials

Assist systems menu Change from one menu to another Menu “Pause”
● Vehicles without multifunction steering
Continue The interrupted timer continues.
Menu Function wheel: press the rocker switch  in the
windscreen wiper lever. A new timer starts. The halted lap ends
Display of Adaptive Cruise Control New lap
ACC ● Vehicles with multifunction steering wheel: and is included in the statistics.
(ACC) ››› page 201.
press  or  . The timer of the current lap ends and is
Switching the monitoring system Interr.
Front Assist cancelled. It is not included in the statis-
on and off ››› page 212. lap
Menu “Stop” tics.
Switching the Lane Assist system
Lane Assist* The timer starts. The current timer ends. The lap is inclu-
on or off ››› page 220. End
If there are existing laps and they are in- ded in the statistics.
Detection of Display of traffic signs cluded in the statistics, it will begin with
traffic signs ››› page 228: Start the number of laps in question.
Menu “Partial time”
It is only possible to begin with a new
Switching the fatigue detection first lap if the statistics have been reset Partial For about 5 seconds a partial time is dis-
Fatigue detec-
on or off (pause recommenda- first in the Statistics menu. time played. The timer continues in parallel.
tion*
tion) ››› page 231.
The timer begins when the vehicle sets The timer of the current lap stops and a
Since off. new lap starts immediately. The time for
start If the vehicle is already moving, the timer New lap
the lap you have just completed is inclu-
Timer* begins once the vehicle has stopped. ded in the statistics.
Statis- The Statistics menu is displayed on The current lap timer will be interrupted.
You can access the timer via the selection tics the screen.
menu ››› page 34. Stop The lap does not end. The Pause menu
is displayed. »
It allows you to manually time lap times on a Menu “Lap”
racing circuit, memorise them and compare
them to the vehicle's previous best times. The timer of the current lap stops and a
new lap starts immediately. The time for
New lap
The following menus can be displayed: the lap you have just completed is inclu-
ded in the statistics.
● Stop
Partial For about 5 seconds a partial time is dis-
● Lap time played. The timer continues in parallel.
● Pause
The current lap timer will be interrupted.
● Partial time Stop The lap does not end. The Pause menu
● Statistics is displayed.
37
The essentials

Menu “Statistics” Status display Illustra-


Key to ››› Fig. 45
tion
View of the latest lap times:
– total time Bonnet, rear lid and doors open  Do not continue driving!
– best lap time A The bonnet is open or is not properly
– worst lap time closed ››› page 268.
– average lap duration
A maximum of 10 laps is possible, and a  Do not continue driving!
total duration of 99 hours, 59 minutes B The rear lid is open or is not properly
and 59 seconds. closed ››› page 130.
If one of the 2 limits is reached, you will
have to reset the statistics in order to be-  Do not continue driving!
gin a new timer. C, D A vehicle door is open or is not properly
closed ››› page 120.
Back This returns to the previous menu.

Resetting
to zero
All the memorised statistical data are re-
set.  ››› page 109

WARNING
Do your best to avoid handling the timer Warning and information messages
while driving.
● Only set the timer or consult statistics
The system runs a check on certain compo-
when the vehicle is stationary. nents and functions when the ignition is
switched on and while the vehicle is moving.
● While driving, do not handle the timer in
Faults in the operation are displayed on the
complicated driving situations.
screen using red and yellow symbols and
Fig. 45 A: bonnet open; B: rear lid open; C: messages on the instrument panel display
front left door open; D: rear right door open (›››  page 113) and, in some cases, with
(5-door vehicles only). audible warnings. The display may vary ac-
cording to the type of instrument panel fitted.
When the ignition is switched on or when
driving, the bonnet, rear lid or doors that are
open will be indicated on the instrument pan-
el display, and, as applicable, this will be in-
dicated audibly. The display may vary accord-
ing to the type of instrument panel fitted.
38
The essentials

Priority 1 warning (red symbols) Gear-change indicator Vehicles with an automatic gearbox*
The display is only visible in tiptronic mode
Symbol flashing or lit; partly combined with audible
warnings.
›››  page 187.
 Stop the vehicle! It is dangerous ››› in Warning The following display symbols mean:
and control lamps on page 113!
Check the function that is faulty and repair it. If necessa- ●  Shifting up a gear
ry, request assistance from specialised personnel.
●  Shifting down a gear

Priority 2 warning (yellow symbols) CAUTION


Symbol flashing or lit; partly combined with audible The gear-change indicator is intended to help
warnings. save fuel, but it is not intended to recom-
A faulty function, or fluids which are below the correct mend the right gear for all driving situations.
levels may cause damage to the vehicle! ››› in Warn- Fig. 46 Instrument panel: gear-change indica-
tor (manual gearbox). In certain situations, only the driver can
ing and control lamps on page 113
choose the correct gear (for instance when
Check the faulty function as soon as possible. If neces-
overtaking, driving up a steep gradient or
sary, request assistance from specialised personnel. A gear change will be recommended if the
towing a trailer).
gear you are in is not the most economical
Informative text choice. If no gear-change is recommended, it
means that you are already in the most eco- Note
Information relating to different vehicle processes. nomical gear. The display disappears from the instrument
panel when you press the clutch pedal.
Vehicles with a manual gearbox
The following display symbols ››› Fig. 46
mean: Outside temperature display
●  Change to a higher gear: the suggested
gear appears to the right of the current gear When the outside temperature is below +4°C
when a higher gear is recommended. (+39°F), the “ice crystal” symbol (warning of
risk of freezing) is also displayed. At first, this
●  Change to a lower gear: the suggested
symbol flashes and then it remains lit until
gear appears to the left of the current gear the outside temperature rises above +6°C
when a lower gear is recommended. (+43°F) ››› in Indications on the display on
The gear recommendation may occasionally page 110. »
skip a gear (2nd  4th).
39
The essentials

When the vehicle is at a standstill or when Additional electrical appliances Note


travelling at very low speeds, the tempera-
● Operation with the windscreen wiper lever*: ● If you hide a saving tip, it will reappear af-
ture displayed may be higher than the true
ter you switch the ignition on again.
outside temperature as a result of the heat Press the rocker switch ››› Fig. 42 2 until the
produced by the engine. main menu appears. Enter into the section ● The saving tips do not appear in all situa-
Driving data. With the rocker switch, tions, but rather with a large separation of
The temperatures measured range from time.
move to the display Convenience con-
-40°C to +50°C (-40°F to +122°F).
sumers.

● Operation with the multi-function steering


Speed warning device
Engine oil temperature display wheel*: Move with the buttons 1 or 2 to
Driving data and enter with OK. Turn the The speed warning device warns the driver
Vehicles without multifunction steering right thumbwheel until the Convenience when they have exceeded the pre-set speed
wheel consumers display appears. limit by 3 km/h (2 mph). An audible warning
● Press the rocker switch ››› Fig. 42 2 until signal sounds, and the warning lamp  and
In addition, a scale will inform you of the cur-
the main menu appears. Enter into Driving the driver message Speed limit excee-
rent sum of all the additional appliances.
data. With the button 2 move to the oil ded! will be displayed simultaneously on the
temperature gauge. instrument panel. The warning lamp 
switches off when reducing speed below the
Vehicles with multifunction steering wheel Saving tips stored maximum limit.
● Enter the submenu Driving data and Tips on how to save fuel will be displayed in Speed warning programming is recommen-
turn the thumbwheel until the oil tempera- conditions that increase fuel consumption. ded if you wish to be reminded of a maxi-
ture display appears. Follow them to reduce consumption. The indi- mum speed, such as when travelling in a
cations appear automatically only with the ef- country with different speed limits or for a
The engine reaches its operating temperature maximum speed for winter tyres.
ficiency programme. After a time, the tips will
when in normal driving conditions, the oil
disappear automatically.
temperature is between 80°C (180°F) and Setting speed limit warning
120°C (250°F). If the engine is required to If you wish to hide a saving tip immediately
work hard and the outside temperature is after it appears, press any button on the You can use the radio or the Easy Connect* to
high, the engine oil temperature can in- windscreen wiper lever*/multifunction steer- set, alter or cancel the speed limit warning.
crease. This does not present any problem as ing wheel*.
● Vehicles with radio: press the button SETUP
long as the warning lamps  ››› table on
> control button  Driver Assistant >
page 45 or  ››› table on page 45 do not
Speed warning.
appear on the display.
40
The essentials

● Vehicles with Easy Connect: press the but- technological progress, maintenance work Vehicles with text messages: Service in
ton Systems or else Vehicle systems > has been greatly reduced. Because of the --- km or --- days will be shown on the
Driver assistant > Speed warning. technology used by SEAT, with this service instrument panel display.
you only need to change the oil when the ve-
The warning limit can be set from 30 to hicle so requires. To calculate this change Service due
240 km/h (20 to 149 mph). The adjustment (max. 2 years), the vehicle's conditions of
is made at 10 km/h (5 mph) intervals. When the service date is due, an audible
use and individual driving styles are consid-
warning is given when the ignition is switch-
ered. The advance warning first appears 20
Note ed on and the spanner displayed on the
days before the date established for the cor-
screen flashes for a few seconds .
● Please bear in mind that, even with the responding service. The kilometres (miles)
speed warning function, it is still important remaining until the next service are always Vehicles with text messages: Service now
to keep an eye on the vehicle speed with the rounded up to the nearest 100 km (miles) will be shown on the instrument panel dis-
speedometer and to observe the legal speed and the time is given in complete days. The play.
limits. current service message cannot be viewed
● The speed limit warning function in the ver- until 500 km after the last service. Prior to Reading a service notification
sion for some countries warns you at a speed this, only lines are visible on the display. With the ignition switched on, the engine off
of 120 km/h (75 mph). This is a factory-set
and the vehicle at a standstill, the current
speed limit. Inspection reminder service notification can be read:
When the Service date is approaching, when Press and hold the button ›››  Fig. 120 4
the ignition is switched on a Service remind- for more than 5 seconds to consult the serv-
Service intervals er is displayed. ice message.
The service interval indication appears on the Vehicles without text messages: a span- When the service date has passed, a minus
instrument panel display ›››  Fig. 120 3 . ner  will be displayed on the instrument sign is displayed in front of the number of kil-
panel plus an indication in km. ometres or days.
SEAT distinguishes between services with en-
gine oil change (e.g. Oil change service) and The kilometres indicated are the maximum Vehicles with text messages: the following
services without engine oil change (e.g. In- number of kilometres that can be travelled message is displayed: Service --- km
spection). until the next service. After a few seconds, (miles) or --- days ago.
the display mode changes. A clock symbol
In vehicles with Services established by time appears and the number of days until the The time can also be set via the  button
or mileage, the service intervals are already next service is due. and the SETTINGS function button in the Easy
pre-defined. Connect system ›››  page 114. »
In vehicles with LongLife Service, the inter-
vals are determined individually. Thanks to
41
The essentials

Resetting service interval display Cruise control Operation of the turn signal lever
If the service was not carried out by a SEAT ● Switching on the CCS: Move switch
dealership, the display can be reset as fol- Operating the cruise control system ››› Fig. 471 to . The system is on. If no
lows: (CCS)* speed has been programmed, the system will
not control it.
● Switch off the ignition, press and hold but-
● Activating the CCS: Press button ››› Fig. 47
ton ›››  Fig. 120 4 .
2 in the  area. The current speed is
● Switch ignition back on. memorised and controlled.
● Release the 4 ›››  Fig. 120 button and ● Temporarily switching off the CCS: Move
press it again for the next 20 seconds. switch ››› Fig. 47 1 to  or push the
brake. The cruise control system is switched
Note off temporarily.
● The service message disappears after a few ● Reactivating the CCS: Press button
seconds, when the engine is started or when ››› Fig. 472 in . The memorised speed
OK/RESET is pressed on the windscreen wiper
is saved and controlled again.
lever, or OK on the multifunction steering Fig. 47 On the left of the steering column:
wheel. switches and controls for operating the CCS ● Increasing stored speed during CCS regula-
● In vehicles with the LongLife system in tion: press button 2 in . The vehicle ac-
which the battery has been disconnected for celerates until the new stored speed.
a long period of time, it is not possible to cal- ● Reducing stored speed during CCS regula-
culate the date of the next service. Therefore tion: press button 2 in  to lower the
the service interval display may not be cor- speed by 1 km/h (1 mph). Speed is reduced
rect. In this case, bear in mind the maximum until reaching the new stored speed.
service intervals permitted in the ››› Book-
● Switching off the CCS: Move switch
let Maintenance Programme.
● If you reset the display manually, the next
››› Fig. 47
1 to . The system is disconnec-
ted and the memorised speed is deleted.
service interval will be indicated as in vehi-
cles with fixed service intervals. For this rea-
son we recommend that the service interval Operation using the third lever
display be reset by a SEAT authorised Dealer. Fig. 48 On the left of the steering column:
● Switching on the CCS: move the third lever
third lever to operate the CCS.
to  ››› Fig. 48. The system switches on but it
does not control the speed as no speed has
been programmed.

42
The essentials

● Activating the CCS: press the  ››› Fig. 48 ● Reactivating the CCS: move the lever to
button. It memorises and maintains the cur-
rent speed.
 ››› Fig. 48 and release it. The memo-
rised speed is saved and controlled again.
 ››› in Operation on page 201

● Temporarily switching off the CCS: move


the lever to  ››› Fig. 48 and release it or
● Switching off the CCS: move the third lever
to position  ››› Fig. 48. The system is dis-
 ››› page 200

press the brake pedal. The cruise control sys- connected and the memorised speed is de-
tem is switched off temporarily. leted.

Warning lamps
On the instrument panel

Fig. 49 Instrument panel, on dash panel. »


43
The essentials

Red warning lamps ››› page it lights up: Press the foot brake!
 Rear fog light switched on. ››› page
Central warning lamp: additional
135  flashes: the selector lever locking
185
button has not engaged.
 information on the instrument pan- – lights up or flashes: fault in the ››› page
el display  emission control system. 194 it lights up: cruise control activated
or speed limiter switched on and
 Parking brake on. ››› page it lights up: pre-heating of diesel active. ››› page
177 engine. ››› page
 200
 Do not continue driving!
››› page  195 flashes: the speed set by the
 The brake fluid level is too low or
179 flashes: fault in the diesel engine speed limiter has been exceeded.
there is a fault in the brake system. management.
green warning lamp: Lane Assist is ››› page
Lit up or flashing:
››› page fault in the petrol engine manage- ››› page  switched on and active. 218
  Do not continue driving!
259
 ment. 195
Fault in the steering. ››› page
lights up or flashes: fault in the ››› page  Main beam on or flasher on.
135
Driver or passenger has not fas- ››› page  steering system. 259
 tened seat belt. 75 ››› page
Tyre pressure too low, or fault in
››› page
 Natural gas operating mode
112
 Use the foot brake!  the tyre pressure monitoring sys-
281
tem.
Yellow warning lamps ››› page
 Fuel tank almost empty.
108
Central warning lamp: additional
 information on the instrument pan- –
 Fault in airbag system and seat ››› page
el display belt tensioners. 80

 Front brake pads worn.


 Lane Assist is switched on, but not ››› page
active. 218
it lights up: Fault in the ESC, or dis-
connection caused by the system.
 Other warning lamps
flashes: ESC or ASR activated. ››› page
181 ››› page
ASR manually deactivated. Left or right turn signal.
135
 
ESC in Sport mode or OFF
Hazard warning lights on.
››› page
140
 ABS faulty or does not work.
››› page
 Trailer turn signals
241
44
The essentials

On the instrument panel display  Do not continue driving! Mobile telephone is connected ››› Book-
Engine oil pressure too low. If  via Bluetooth to the original tele- let Radio
the warning lamp flashes, stop ››› page phone device. or
 driving, even if the oil level is 270 ››› Book-
correct. Do not even run the en- Mobile telephone battery charge let Navi-
gine at idle speed!  meter. Available only for devices gation
pre-installed in factory. system
››› page
 Fault in the battery.
275 Freezing warning. The outside
››› page
Driving light totally or partially ››› page
 temperature is lower than +4°C
39
(+39°F).
faulty. 98
  Start-Stop system activated.
››› page
Fault in the cornering light sys- ››› page
tem. 135 196
 Start-Stop system unavailable.
››› page ››› page
 Diesel particulate filter blocked
194  Low consumption driving status
109
Level of windscreen washer fluid ››› page
 too low. 143
Fig. 50 On the instrument panel display: door
Flashing: Fault in the oil level de- On the instrument panel
open.
tection. Control manually. ››› page
 270
››› page Ignition: Insufficient engine oil.
 Do not continue driving! 120
With the corresponding indica- ››› page ››› page
 tion: door(s), rear lid or bonnet 130
 Fault in the gearbox.
191
open or not properly closed. ››› page
268 ››› page
 Light Assist on.
137
Ignition:  Do not carry on driv-
ing! Engine coolant level too low, ››› page
coolant temperature too high ››› page
 Immobiliser active.
126
 272
››› page
Flashing: Fault in the engine
coolant system.
 Service interval display
41 Fig. 51 Warning lamp for disabling the front
passenger airbag. »

45
The essentials

Front passenger front airbag is ● Press the clutch pedal and keep your foot Automatic gearbox*
››› page right down.
  disabled (  
80
 ). ● Move the gearbox lever to the required po-
sition.
The front passenger front airbag ››› page
  is activated (   80 ● Release the clutch.
 ).
Selecting reverse gear
›››
 in Warning and control lamps on
page 113
● Press the clutch pedal and keep your foot
right down.

 ››› page 113 ● With the gearbox lever in neutral, push it


downwards, move it to the left as far as it will
go and then forwards to select reverse Fig. 53 Automatic gearbox: selector lever po-
››› Fig. 52 R . sitions.
● Release the clutch.
Gearbox lever P Parking lock
R Reverse gear
Manual gearbox  ››› in Changing gear on page 184
N Neutral (idling)

 ››› page 184 D/S Drive (forward)


+/– Tiptronic mode: pull the lever forwards
(+) to go up a gear or backwards (–) to
go down a gear.

›››
 in Selector lever positions on
page 185

 ››› page 185

Fig. 52 Gear shift pattern of a 5 or 6-speed


manual gearbox.  ››› page 47

The position of the gears is indicated on the


gearbox lever ››› Fig. 52.
46
The essentials

Manual release of the selector lever ● Unlocking: use the flat part of a screwdriver ● After carrying out the manual release, at-
blade. tach the selector lever boot on the gearbox
console again.
Removing the cover from the selector lever
If the power supply should ever fail (e.g. dis-
● Apply the handbrake  ››› to ensure that charged battery) and the vehicle has to be
the car does not move. pushed or towed, the selector lever must first
● Carefully pull the corners of the selector be moved to position N, after operating the
lever boot and twist it upwards above the lev- manual release mechanism.
er handle.
WARNING
Releasing the selector lever The selector lever may be moved out of posi-
● Using a screwdriver, press and hold the yel- tion P only when the handbrake is firmly ap-
Fig. 54 Selector lever: manual release from
low unlocking tab sideways ››› Fig. 54. plied. If this does not work, secure the vehi-
position P.
cle with the brake pedal. On a slope the vehi-
● Now press the interlock button on the se-
cle could otherwise start to move inadver-
Should the power supply be interrupted, lector lever A and move the selector lever to tently after shifting the selector lever out of
there is a manual unlocking device located position N. position P - accident risk!
under the console of the selector lever, on
the right. Releasing the selector lever re-
quires a certain degree of practical skill.

47
The essentials

Air conditioning
How does Climatronic* work?

Fig. 55 In the centre console: Climatronic con-


trols

To switch a specific function on, press the ap- The LED on each control lights up to indicate
propriate button. Press the button again to that the respective function of a control has
switch off the function. been switched on.

1
The left and right sides can be adjusted separately: Turn the control to adjust the temperature
Temperature

2
The power of the fan is automatically adjusted. The fan is also adjusted manually by turning the control.
Fan

3
The airflow adjusts automatically for comfort. You can also switch it on manually using the buttons 3 .
Air distribution

4 Indications on the temperature display screen selected for the right and left sides.

48
The essentials

 The air drawn in from outside the vehicle is directed at the windscreen and air recirculation is automatically switched off. To defrost the wind-
Defrost function screen more quickly, the air is dehumidified at temperatures over approximately +3°C (+38°F) and the fan runs at maximum output.

 The air is directed at the chest of driver and passengers by the dash panel air vents.

 Air distribution towards the footwell.

 Upward air distribution.

 Heated rear window: this only works when the engine is running and switches off automatically after a maximum of 10 minutes.

 Air recirculation

 Seat heating buttons

 Press the button to switch on or off the cooling system.

Press the button to make maximum cooling capacity available. The recirculation of air and the cooling system turn on automatically and air distri-
  bution adjusts automatically to the position .

When the warning light for button  lights up, the settings on the driver side also apply to the passenger side. Press the button or the temper-
 ature control on the passenger side

 Automatic adjustment of temperature, fan, and air distribution. Press the button: the warning lamp on the button will light up .

 Press the configuration button : the air conditioning operation menu will be displayed on the Easy Connect system screen.

Switching off Turn the blower control to the  position or press the  button.

 ››› in Introduction on page 167

 ››› page 167

49
The essentials

How does the manual air conditioning work*?

Fig. 56 In the centre console: Manual air condi-


tioning controls.

To switch a specific function on, press the ap- The LED on each control lights up to indicate
propriate button. Press the button again to that the respective function of a control has
switch off the function. been switched on.

1
Turn the control to adjust the temperature
Temperature

2 Setting 0: blower and manual air conditioning switched off


Fan Level 6: maximum fan level.

3
Rotate the continuous control to direct the airflow to the desired area.
Air distribution

 The airflow is directed at the windscreen. Air recirculation is automatically switched off or is not switched on. Increase the fan power to clear the
Defrost function windscreen of condensation as soon as possible. To dehumidify the air, the cooling system will automatically switch on.

 The air is directed at the chest of driver and passengers by the dash panel air vents.

 Distribution of air towards the chest and the footwell area.


50
The essentials

 Air distribution towards the footwell.

 Air distribution towards the windscreen and the footwell.

 Heated rear window: this only works when the engine is running and switches off automatically after a maximum of 10 minutes.

 Air recirculation

 Seat heating buttons

Maximum cooling power. The recirculation of air and the cooling system turn on automatically and air distribution adjusts automatically to the
  position 

 ››› in Introduction on page 167

 ››› page 167

How does the heating and the fresh air system work?

Fig. 57 In the centre console: heating system and


fresh air controls. »
51
The essentials

To switch a specific function on, press the ap- The LED on each control lights up to indicate
propriate button. Press the button again to that the respective function of a control has
switch off the function. been switched on.

1 Turn the control to adjust the temperature. The temperature cannot be lower than that of the exterior air temperature, as this system cannot cool
Temperature or dehumidify the air

2 Setting 0: blower, heating and fresh air systems switched off


Fan Level 6: maximum fan level

3
Rotate the continuous control to direct the airflow to the desired area.
Air distribution

 The airflow is directed at the windscreen.


Defrost function

 The air is directed at the chest of driver and passengers by the dash panel air vents.

 Distribution of air towards the chest and the footwell area.

 Air distribution towards the footwell.

 Air distribution towards the windscreen and the footwell.

 Heated rear window: this only works when the engine is running and switches off automatically after a maximum of 10 minutes

 Air recirculation ››› page 170

 Seat heating buttons

 ››› in Introduction on page 167

 ››› page 167

52
The essentials

Fluid Level control Fuel ● Place it in the space on the hinge of the
open flap ››› Fig. 58.
Filling capacities
Closing the fuel tank cap
● Unscrew the cap by turning it to the right as
Tank level far as it will go.
50 l, of which, approx. 7 l reserve ● Close the lid.
Petrol and diesel Vehicles with all-wheel-drive:
engines 55 l, of which, approx. 8.5 l re-

Natural gas en-


serve
 ››› in Filling up on page 263

approx. 15 kg
ginea)
a) The capacity depends on the efficacy and characteristics of
Fig. 58 Fuel tank flap with tank cap attached.  ››› page 262

the natural gas pumps. The capacity indicated is based on a


minimum loading pressure of 200 bar. The flap that covers the tank cap is unlocked
and locked automatically using the central
Capacity of the windscreen washer fluid container locking.
Versions without
headlight washer approx. 3 litres Opening the fuel tank cap
system
● Open the fuel tank flap by pressing on the
Versions with left side.
headlight washer approx. 5 litres ● Unscrew the cap by turning it to the left.
system

53
The essentials

Oil

Fig. 59 Engine oil dipstick. Fig. 60 In the engine compartment: Engine


oil filler cap.

The level is measured using the dipstick loca- ● Zone C : Add oil up to zone B . ● When the oil level reaches at least zone B ,
ted in the engine compartment unscrew the engine oil filler cap carefully.
›››  page 268. Topping up engine oil
● Unscrew cap from oil filler opening. Engine oil additives
The oil should leave a mark between zones
A and C . It should never exceed zone A . ● Add oil slowly. No type of additive should be mixed with the
engine oil. The deterioration caused by these
● Zone A : Do not add oil. ● At the same time, check the level to ensure
additives is not covered by the warranty.
● Zone B : You can add oil but keep the level
you do not add too much.
in that zone.

54
The essentials

Engine oil specifications

Service interval Engine type Specification


1.4l CNG / 1.4l 110kW without ACT VW 502 00
Petrol engines with Set Service Intervals (dependent on
1.0l / 1.2l / 1.4l 92kW / 1.4l 110kW with ACT / 1.8l / 2.0l VW 504 00
time/distance travelled)
1.2l / 1.4l 110kW without ACT / 1.6l / 1.8l / 2.0l VW 502 00a)

1.0l / 1.2l / 1.4l VW 508 00 / VW 504 00 b)


Petrol engines with Flexible Service Intervals (LongLife)
1.8l / 2.0l VW 504 00

Diesel engines with Set Service and Flexible Service In-


With particulate filter (DPF) VW 507 00
tervalsc)

Diesel engines with Set Service Intervals Without particulate filter (DPF) VW 505 01a) / VW 506 01a)
a) If the quality of the fuel available in the country does not fulfil the EN 228 (for petrol) and EN 590 (for diesel) standards.
b) Use of engine oil compliant with the VW 504 00 specification instead of VW 508 00 may have a slight negative effect on the vehicle’s exhaust gas values.
c) Only use recommended oils, otherwise you may damage the engine.

Coolant The coolant tank is located in the engine


 ››› in Changing engine oil on page 272 compartment ›››  page 268.
When the engine is cold, replace the coolant
 ››› page 270 when the level is below .

Coolant specifications
The engine cooling system is supplied from
the factory with a specially treated mixture of
water and at least 40 % of the additive G13
(TL-VW 774 J), purple. This mixture gives the
necessary frost protection down to -25°C
(-13°F) and protects the light alloy parts of
Fig. 61 Engine compartment: coolant expan-
the engine cooling system against corrosion.
sion tank cap.
It also prevents scaling and considerably rai-
ses the boiling point of the coolant. »
55
The essentials

To protect the cooling system, the percentage Brake fluid Windscreen washer
of additive must always be at least 40 %,
even in warm climates where anti-freeze pro-
tection is not required.
If for weather reasons further protection is
necessary, the proportion of additive may be
increased, but only up to 60 %; otherwise an-
tifreeze protection will diminish and this will
worsen cooling.
When the coolant is topped up, use a mixture
of distilled water and at least 40 % of the
G13 or G12 plus-plus (TL-VW 774 G) additive
Fig. 62 Engine compartment: brake fluid res- Fig. 63 In the engine compartment: wind-
(both are purple) to obtain an optimum anti- ervoir cap. screen washer reservoir top.
corrosion protection ››› in Topping up cool-
ant on page 273. The mixture of G13 with The brake fluid reservoir is located in the en- The windscreen washer reservoir is located in
G12 plus (TL-VW 774 F), G12 (red) or G11 gine compartment ›››  page 268. the engine compartment ›››  page 268.
(green-blue) engine coolants will significant-
ly reduce anti-corrosion protection and The level should be between the  and  To top up, mix water with a product recom-
should therefore be avoided ››› in Topping marks. If it is below , please visit a Techni- mended by SEAT.
up coolant on page 273. cal Service.
In cold temperatures, add anti-freeze.
›››
 ››› in Topping up coolant on page 273  in Topping up brake fluid on
page 274

››› in Checking and topping up the
windscreen washer reservoir on
page 274

 ››› page 272  ››› page 273


 ››› page 274

Battery
The battery is located in the engine compart-
ment ›››  page 268. It does not require

56
The essentials

maintenance. It is checked as part of the In-


spection Service.

›››
 in Important safety warnings for
handling a vehicle battery on page 276

 ››› page 275

57
The essentials

Emergencies Underneath the instrument panel Replacing a blown fuse


The fuse box is located behind the storage
compartment ››› Fig. 64.
Fuses
In the engine compartment
Fuse location
Press the locking tabs to release the fuse box
cover ››› Fig. 65.

Identifying fuses situated below the dash


panel by colours

Colour Amp rating


Fig. 66 Image of a blown fuse.
Black 1
Preparation
Purple 3
● Switch off the ignition, lights and all elec-
Light brown 5
trical equipment.
Fig. 64 On the driver-side dash panel: fuse
Brown 7.5 ● Open the corresponding fuse box
box cover.
Red 10
›››  page 97.
Blue 15 Identifying a blown fuse
Yellow 20 A fuse is blown if its metal strip is ruptured
››› Fig. 66.
White or transparent 25
● Point a lamp at the fuse to see if it has
Green 30
blown.
Orange 40
To replace a fuse

Fig. 65 In the engine compartment: fuse box


cover.
 ››› in Introduction on page 96
● Remove the fuse.
● Replace the blown fuse by one with an

 ››› page 96 identical amperage rating (same colour and


markings) and identical size.
58
The essentials

● Replace the cover again or close the fuse ● Have the vehicle tool kit ›››  page 90
Rear lights Type
box lid. and the spare wheel* ready
Retro fog light H21W ›››  page 284.
Reverse lights P21W LL ● Observe the applicable legislation for each
Bulbs country (reflective vest, warning triangles,
LED rear lights Type etc.).
Bulbs (12 V) ● All occupants should leave the vehicle and
Reverse lights W16W wait in a safe place (for instance behind the
The remaining functions work with LEDs roadside crash barrier).
Light source used for each function
Halogen headlights. Type WARNING

Daytime running light/side


P21W SLL
 ››› page 98 ● Always observe the above steps and pro-
tect yourself and other road users.
light
● If you change the wheel on a slope, block
Dipped beam headlights H7 LL the wheel on the opposite side of the car with
Main beam headlights H7 LL
Action in the event of a punc- a stone or similar to prevent the vehicle from
moving.
Turn signal PY21W LL
ture
What to do first
Full-LED main headlights Type
No bulbs may be replaced. All functions are with LEDs ● Park the vehicle on a horizontal surface
and in a safe place as far away from traffic as
possible.
Front fog light Type
● Apply the handbrake.
Fog/cornering lights* H8
● Switch on the hazard warning lights.
● Manual gearbox: select the 1st gear.
Rear lights Type
● Automatic gearbox: Move the selector lever
Brake light/tail light P21W LL to position P.
Side lights 2x W5W LL ● If you are towing a trailer, unhitch it from
your vehicle.
Turn signal PY21W LL

59
The essentials

Repairing a tyre with the anti-punc- ● Remove the lid from the filling tube ● Screw the compressor tyre inflator into the
ture kit ››› Fig. 67 and screw the open end of the
3 valve.
tube into the tyre valve. ● Repeat the inflation process.
● With the tyre sealant bottle upside down, ● If the indicated pressure still cannot be
fill the tyre with the contents of the sealant reached, the tyre is too badly damaged. Stop
bottle. and request assistance from an authorised
● Remove the bottle from the valve. technician.
● Place the insert back into the tyre valve us- ● Disconnect the air compressor. Unscrew
ing the tool ››› Fig. 67 1 . the tyre inflator tube from the tyre valve.
● When the tyre pressure is between 2.5 and
Inflating the tyre 2.0 bars, continue driving without exceeding
● Screw the compressor tyre inflator tube 80 km/h (50 mph).
››› Fig. 67 5 into the tyre valve. ● Check the pressure again after 10 minutes
● Check that the air bleed screw is closed ›››  page 92.
Fig. 67 Standard representation: contents of ››› Fig. 67 7 .
›››
the anti-puncture kit. ● Start the engine and leave it running.
● Insert the connector ››› Fig. 67 9 into the
 in TMS (Tyre Mobility System)* on
page 90
The anti-puncture kit is located under the
floor panel in the luggage compartment.
vehicle's 12-volt socket ›››  page 154.
● Turn the air compressor on with the ON/OFF
 ››› page 90

Sealing the tyre switch ››› Fig. 67 8 .


● Unscrew the tyre valve cap and insert. Use ● Keep the air compressor running until it
the ››› Fig. 67 1 tool to remove the insert. reaches 2.0 to 2.5 bar
Place it on a clean surface. (29-36 psi/200-250 kPa). A maximum of 8
minutes.
● Shake the tyre sealant bottle vigorously
● Disconnect the air compressor.
››› Fig. 67 10 .

● Screw the inflator tube ››› Fig. 67 3 into ● If it does not reach the pressure indicated,
the sealant bottle. The bottle's seal will break unscrew the tyre inflator tube from the valve.
automatically. ● Move the vehicle 10m so that the sealant is
distributed throughout the tyre.

60
The essentials

Changing a wheel Wheel covers* Wheel bolt caps*

Vehicle tool kit

Fig. 69 Remove the wheel cover. Fig. 70 Wheel: wheel bolts with caps.

The wheel covers must be removed for access Removal


Fig. 68 Underneath the floor panel of the lug-
gage compartment: vehicle tool kit. to the wheel bolts. ● Fit the plastic clip (vehicle tools) over the
cap until it clicks into place ››› Fig. 70.
1 An adapter for the anti-theft wheel bolts* Removing
● Remove the cap with the plastic clip.
2 Towline anchorage ● Remove the wheel cover using the wire
hook ››› Fig. 69.
3 Box spanner for wheel bolts*
● Hook this into one of the cut-outs of the
4 Crank handle for jack
wheel cover.
5 Jack*
6 Wire hook for pulling off the wheel cov- Fitting
ers*/wheel bolt cap clip. ● Fit the wheel cover onto the wheel rim by
pressing it firmly.
 ››› in What to do first on page 59 ● Put pressure on the point of the cut-out for
the valve.

 ››› page 90 ● Next fit the rest of the wheel cover.

61
The essentials

Anti-theft wheel bolts Loosening the wheel bolts Lifting the vehicle

Fig. 71 Anti-theft wheel bolt with cap and Fig. 72 Wheel: loosen the wheel bolts. Fig. 73 Crossbar: marks.
adapter.
● Insert the box spanner (vehicle tools) onto
● Remove the wheel cover* or the cap*. the wheel bolt as far as it will go. An adapter
● Insert the special adapter (vehicle tools) is required to unscrew or tighten the anti-
onto the anti-theft wheel bolt and push it on theft wheel bolts ››› page 62.
as far as it will go. ● Turn the wheel bolt approximately one turn
● Insert the wheel brace (vehicle tools) onto to the left ››› Fig. 72 (arrow). To apply the re-
the adapter as far as it will go. quired torque, hold the wheel brace at the
end. If it is not possible to loosen a wheel
● Remove the wheel bolt ››› page 62.
bolt, carefully apply pressure with one foot
on the end of the box spanner. Hold on to the
Note
vehicle for support and take care not to slip. Fig. 74 Strut: mounting the jack on the vehi-
Make a note of the code number of the anti- cle.
theft wheel bolt and keep it in a safe place, WARNING
but not in your vehicle. If you need a new ● Place the jack* (vehicle tools) on firm
adapter, you can obtain it from the SEAT Offi- Slightly loosen the wheel bolts (one turn) be-
fore raising the vehicle with the jack*. If not, ground. If necessary use a large, strong
cial Service, indicating the code number.
an accident may occur. board or similar support. If the surface is slip-
pery (for example tiles) place the jack on a
rubber mat or similar to prevent it from slip-
ping ››› .

62
The essentials

● Find the support point on the strut (sunken CAUTION ces. These surfaces must be clean before fit-
area) closest to the wheel to be changed ting the wheel.
››› Fig. 73. The vehicle must not be raised on the cross-
bar. Only place the jack* on the points de-
● Turn the jack*, located below the strut sup- signed for this purpose on the strut. Other-
port point, to raise it until tab 1 ››› Fig. 74 is wise, the vehicle may be damaged. Tyres with compulsory direction of ro-
below the housing provided. tation
● Align the jack* so that tab 1 “grips” onto
the housing provided on the strut and the A directional tread pattern can be identified
Removing and fitting a wheel by the arrows on the sidewall that point in
mobile base 2 is resting on the ground. The
base plate 2 should fall vertically with re- the direction of rotation. Always observe the
Change the wheel after loosening the wheel
spect to the support point 1 . direction of rotation indicated when fitting
bolts and raising the vehicle with the jack.
the wheel to guarantee optimum properties
● Continue turning the jack* until the wheel
of this type of tyres with regard to grip,
is slightly lifted off the ground. Taking off the wheel
noises, wear and aquaplaning.
● Unscrew the wheel bolts using the box
WARNING spanner and place them on a clean surface. If it is absolutely necessary to fit the spare
tyre* against the direction of rotation, drive
● Make sure that the jack* remains stable. If ● Take off the wheel.
with care as this means the tyre does not of-
the surface is slippery or soft, the jack* could
slip or sink, respectively, with the resultant fer optimum driving properties. This is of par-
Putting on the spare wheel ticular importance when the road surface is
risk of injury.
When fitting tyres with a compulsory rotation wet.
● Only raise the vehicle with the jack* sup-
plied by the manufacturer. Other vehicles direction, observe the instructions in To return to directional tread tires, replace
could slip, with the consequent risk of injury. ››› page 63. the punctured tyre as soon as possible and
● Only mount the jack* on the support points ● Mount the wheel. restore the obligatory direction of rotation of
designed for this purpose on the strut, and all tyres.
● Screw on the wheel bolts in position and
always align the jack correctly. If you do not,
the jack* could slip as it does not have an ad- tighten them loosely with a box spanner.
equate grip on the vehicle: risk of injury! ● Carefully lower the vehicle using the jack*.
Subsequent work
● The height of the parked vehicle can ● Tighten the wheel bolts in diagonal pairs
change as a result of variations in tempera- using the wheel brace. ● Alloy wheels: replace the wheel bolt caps.
ture and loading.
The wheel bolts should be clean and turn ● Plate wheels: replace the wheel hubcap
easily. Before fitting the spare wheel, inspect ››› page 61. »
the wheel condition and hub mounting surfa-
63
The essentials

● Return all tools to their proper storing loca- If there is a danger of being trapped despite Emergency towing of the vehi-
tion. having mounted the chains, it is best to disa-
● If the replaced wheel does not fit in the ble the driving wheels (ASR) in the ESC cle
spare wheel housing, store it safely in the ›››  page 182, Switching on/off the ESC
luggage compartment ›››  page 155. and ASR. Towing
● Check the tyre pressure of the newly moun- Snow chains will improve braking ability as
ted tyre as soon as possible. well as traction in winter conditions.
● In vehicles fitted with a tyre pressure indi- For technical reasons snow chains may only
cator, adjust the pressure and store the read- be used with the following wheel rim/tyre
ing in the radio/Easy Connect system* combination.
›››  page 281.
● Have the tightening torque of the wheel 195/65 R15 Chains with links of maximum 15 mm
bolts checked as soon as possible with a tor- 205/55 R16 Chains with links of maximum 15 mm
que wrench (it should be 120 Nm). Mean-
while, drive carefully. 225/45 R17 Chains with links of maximum 9 mm
● Have the flat tyre replaced as quickly as 225/40 R18 Chains with links of maximum 9 mm Fig. 75 Right side of the front bumper: tow-
possible. line anchorage screwed in.
Remove wheel covers and any integral trim
ring before fitting snow chains.

Snow chains Remove the chains when roads are free of


snow. Driving characteristics worsen, and the
Use wheels become damaged quickly and may
even be rendered unusable.
Snow chains should only be used on the
front wheels.
Check that they are correctly seated after
driving for a few yards; correct the position if
necessary, in accordance with the manufac- Fig. 76 Right side of the rear bumper: towline
turer's fitting instructions. Keep your speed anchorage screwed in.
below 50 km/h (30 mph).

64
The essentials

Towline anchorages Do not pull too hard with the towing vehicle Tow-starting
Attach the bar or rope to the towline ancho- and take care to avoid jerking the tow rope.
rages. When towing on an unpaved road, there is al- If the engine will not start, first try starting it
ways a risk of overloading and damaging the using the battery of another vehicle
The towline anchorages are located under anchorage points. ››› page 65. You should only attempt to tow-
the floor panel in the luggage compartment, start a vehicle if charging the battery does
next to the vehicle tools ›››  page 90. Switch on the ignition so that the turn sig-
not work. This is done by leveraging wheel
nals, windscreen wipers and windscreen
Screw the towline anchorage into the screw movement.
washer can work. Ensure that the steering
connection ››› Fig. 75 o ››› Fig. 76 and tighten wheel is unlocked and moves freely. When tow-starting a vehicle with a petrol en-
it with the wheel brace. gine, do not tow it more than a short dis-
Place the gear lever in neutral on vehicles
tance, otherwise unburned fuel can enter the
Tow rope or tow bar with a manual gearbox. With an automatic
catalytic converter.
gearbox, place the lever in N.
The tow bar offers increased safety and a ● Engage 2nd or 3rd gear before moving off.
lower risk of damage. To brake, press the brake pedal firmly. The
brake servo does not work when the engine ● Press the clutch and hold the pedal down.
The tow rope is recommended when there is is switched off. ● Switch the ignition on.
no tow bar. It must be elastic so that it does
not damage the vehicle. The power steering only works when the igni- ● Once both vehicles are moving, release the
tion is switched on and the vehicle is moving, clutch.
Notes for the driver of the towing vehicle provided that the battery is sufficiently charg- ● As soon as the engine has started, press
ed. Otherwise, it will need more force.
● The tow rope must be taut before you drive the clutch and move the gear lever to neutral.
off. Ensure that the tow rope remains taut at all
times.
● Release the clutch very carefully when start-
ing the vehicle (manual gearbox), or acceler- How to jump start
ate gently (automatic gearbox).  ››› in General information on page 93
Jump leads
Driving style
Towing requires some experience, especially
 ››› page 93
The jump lead must have a sufficient wire
when using a tow rope. Both drivers should cross section.
realise how difficult it is to tow a vehicle. In- If the engine fails to start because of a dis-
experienced drivers should not attempt to charged battery, the battery can be connec-
tow. ted to the battery of another vehicle to start
the engine. »
65
The essentials

Jump leads must comply with standard DIN 5. Connect the other end of the black jump
72553 (see cable manufacturer's instruc- lead X to a solid metal component bolted
tions). The wire cross section must be at least to the engine block or to the engine block
25 mm2 for petrol engines and at least itself of the vehicle with the flat battery.
35 mm2 for diesel engines. Do not connect it to a point near the bat-
tery A .
Note
6. Position the leads in such a way that they
● The vehicles must not touch each other, cannot come into contact with any moving
otherwise electricity could flow as soon as parts in the engine compartment.
the positive terminals are connected.
● The discharged battery must be properly Fig. 78 Diagram of connections for vehicles Starting
connected to the on-board network. with Start Stop system
7. Start the engine of the vehicle with the
Jump lead terminal connections boosting battery and let it run at idling
speed.
How to jump start: description 1. Switch off the ignition of both vehicles
››› . 8. Start the engine of the vehicle with the flat
battery and wait for 2 or 3 minutes until
2. Connect one end of the red jump lead to the engine is running.
the positive + terminal of the vehicle
with the flat battery A ››› Fig. 77. Removing the jump leads
3. Connect the other end of the red jump 9. Before you remove the jump leads, switch
lead to the positive terminal + in the ve- off the dipped beam headlights if they are
hicle providing assistance B . switched on.
4. For vehicles without Start-Stop system: 10.Turn on the heater blower and heated rear
connect one end of the black jump lead to window in the vehicle with the flat battery.
the negative terminal – of the vehicle This helps minimise voltage peaks which
Fig. 77 Diagram of connections for vehicles providing the current B ››› Fig. 77. are generated when the leads are discon-
without Start Stop system nected.
– For vehicles with Start-Stop system: con-
nect one end of the black jump lead X to a 11.When the engine is running, disconnect
suitable ground terminal, to a solid piece of the leads in reverse order to the details
metal in the engine block, or to the engine given above.
block itself ››› Fig. 78.

66
The essentials

Make sure the battery clamps have sufficient ● Never attach the negative cable to fuel sys- Changing the wiper blades
metal-to-metal contact with the battery termi- tem components or the brake lines in the oth-
nals. er vehicle. Windscreen wipers service position
If the engine fails to start after about 10 sec- ● The non-insulated parts of the battery
onds, switch off the starter and try again after clamps must not be allowed to touch. The
about 1 minute. jump lead attached to the positive battery
terminal must not touch metal parts of the ve-
hicle, this can cause a short circuit.
WARNING
● Position the leads in such a way that they
● Please note the safety warnings referring to
cannot come into contact with any moving
working in the engine compartment
parts in the engine compartment.
›››  page 268.
● Do not lean on the batteries. This could re-
● The battery providing assistance must have
sult in chemical burns.
the same voltage as the flat battery (12V) and
approximately the same capacity (see imprint
on battery). Failure to comply could result in Note Fig. 79 Wipers in service position.
an explosion.
The vehicles must not touch each other, oth-
● Never use jump leads when one of the bat- erwise electricity could flow as soon as the The wiper arms can be raised when the wip-
teries is frozen. Danger of explosion! Even af- positive terminals are connected. ers are in service position ››› Fig. 79.
ter the battery has thawed, battery acid could
leak and cause chemical burns. If a battery ● Close the bonnet ›››  page 268.
freezes, it should be replaced. ● Switch the ignition on and off.
● Keep sparks, flames and lighted cigarettes ● Press the windscreen wiper lever down-
away from batteries, danger of explosion. wards briefly 4 ››› page 29.
Failure to comply could result in an explo-
sion. Before driving, always lower the wiper arms.
● Observe the instructions provided by the Using the windscreen wiper lever, the wind-
manufacturer of the jump leads. screen wiper arms return to their initial posi-
● Do not connect the negative cable from the tion.
other vehicle directly to the negative terminal
of the flat battery. The gas emitted from the
battery could be ignited by sparks. Danger of
explosion.
 ››› page 92

67
The essentials

Changing the windscreen and rear Cleaning windscreen wiper blades ● Replace the wiper arm on the rear window.
window wiper blades ● Raise the wiper arms.
›››
● Use a soft cloth to remove dust and dirt
from the windscreen wiper blades.
 in Changing the windscreen and
rear window wiper blades on page 93

● If the blades are very dirty, a sponge or


damp cloth may be used ››› in Changing
 ››› page 92

the windscreen and rear window wiper


blades on page 93.

Changing the windscreen wiper blades


● Lift and unfold the wiper arms.
● Press and hold release button ››› Fig. 80 1
Fig. 80 Changing the windscreen wiper and pull gently on the wiper blade in the di-
blades rection of the arrow.
● Fit a new wiper blade of the same length
and design on to the wiper arm and hook it
into place.
● Rest the wiper arms back onto the wind-
screen.

Changing the rear wiper blade


● Raising/lowering the wiper arm.
● Turn the blade slightly ››› Fig. 81 (arrow
A ).
Fig. 81 Changing the rear wiper blade
● Hold down the release button 1 while
Raising and lowering windscreen wiper arms gently pulling the blade in the direction of ar-
row B .
● Place the windscreen wipers in the service
● Insert a new blade of the same length and
position ››› page 67.
type in the rear wiper arm in the opposite di-
● Grip the wiper arms only by the blade's fas- rection to the arrow B and hook into place
tening point. button 1 .
68
Safe driving

Safety – Ensure that all windows provide a clear and cumstance, you endanger yourself as well as

Technical data
good view of the surroundings. others on the road ››› , for this reason:
– Make sure all luggage is secured – Always pay attention to traffic and do not
Safe driving ››› page 155. get distracted by passengers or telephone
calls.
– Make sure that no objects can interfere
Safety first!
with the pedals. – Never drive when your driving ability is im-
paired (e.g. by medication, alcohol, drugs).
WARNING – Adjust front seat, head restraint and mir-
rors properly according to your size. – Observe traffic laws and speed limits.

Advice
● This manual contains important informa-
tion about the operation of the vehicle, both – Ensure that the passengers in the rear – Always reduce your speed as appropriate
for the driver and the passengers. The other seats always have the head restraints in for road, traffic and weather conditions.
sections of the on-board documentation also the in-use position ››› page 73.
contain further information that you should – When travelling long distances, take
be aware of for your own safety and for the – Instruct passengers to adjust the head re- breaks regularly - at least every two hours.

Operation
safety of your passengers. straints according to their height.
– If possible, avoid driving when you are tired
● Ensure that the on-board documentation is – Protect children with appropriate child or stressed.
kept in the vehicle at all times. This is espe- seats and properly applied seat belts
cially important when lending or selling the ››› page 86. WARNING
vehicle to another person.
– Assume the correct sitting position. Instruct When driving safety is impaired during a trip,
the risk of injury and accidents increases.

Emergencies
your passengers also to assume a proper
sitting position ››› page 70.
Advice about driving – Fasten your seat belt securely. Instruct your
passengers also to fasten their seat belts Safety equipment
Before starting every trip properly ››› page 75.
Never put your safety or the safety of your
For your own safety and the safety of your passengers in danger. In the event of an acci-
passengers, always note the following points dent, the safety equipment may reduce the
What affects driving safety?

Safety
before every trip: risk of injury. The following list includes most
of the safety equipment in your SEAT:
– Make sure that the vehicle's lights and turn As a driver, you are responsible for yourself
signals are working properly. and your passengers. When your concentra- ● three-point seat belts,
– Check tyre pressure.
tion or driving safety is affected by any cir- ● belt tension limiters for the front and rear
side seats, »
69
Safety

● Belt tensioners for the front seats, Correct position for passengers mend the following adjustments for the driv-
● front airbags, er:
● knee airbags, Correct sitting position for driver – Adjust the steering wheel so that there is a
● side airbags in the front seat backrests, distance of at least 25 cm between the
steering wheel and the centre of your chest
● Side airbags in the rear seat backrests*, ››› Fig. 82.
● head-protection airbags,
– Move the driver's seat forwards or back-
● “ISOFIX” anchor points for child seats in wards so that you are able to press the ac-
the rear side seats with the “ISOFIX” system, celerator, brake and clutch pedals to the
● height-adjustable front head restraints, floor with your knees still slightly angled
● rear head restraints with in-use position ››› .
and non-use position, – Ensure that you can reach the highest point
● adjustable steering column. of the steering wheel.
Fig. 82 The proper distance between driver – Adjust the head restraint so that its upper
The safety equipment mentioned above and steering wheel. edge is at the same level as the top of your
works together to provide you and your pas-
head, or as close as possible to the same
sengers with the best possible protection in
level as the top of your head ››› Fig. 83.
the event of an accident. However, these
safety systems can only be effective if you – Move the seat backrest to an upright posi-
and your passengers are sitting in a correct tion so that your back rests completely
position and use this equipment properly. against it.
Safety is everyone's business! – Fasten your seat belt securely ››› page 75.
– Keep both feet in the footwell so that you
have the vehicle under control at all times.

Adjustment of the driver's seat ››› page 147.


Fig. 83 Correct head restraint position for the
driver. WARNING
● An incorrect sitting position of the driver
For your own safety and to reduce the risk of
can lead to severe injuries.
injury in the event of an accident, we recom-

70
Safe driving

● Adjust the driver's seat so that there is at Adjusting the steering wheel position – Move the seat backrest to an upright posi-

Technical data
least 25 cm distance between the centre of tion so that your back rests completely
the chest and the centre of the steering Read the additional information carefully against it.
wheel ››› Fig. 82. If you are sitting closer than ›››  page 19. – Adjust the head restraint so that its upper
25 cm, the airbag system cannot protect you
edge is at the same level as the top of your
properly. WARNING
head, or as close as possible to the same
● If your physical constitution prevents you ● Never adjust the position of the steering level as the top of your head ››› page 73.
from maintaining the minimum distance of 25 wheel when the vehicle is moving, as this
cm, contact a specialised workshop. The could cause an accident. – Always keep both feet in the footwell in

Advice
workshop will help you decide if special spe-
● Move the lever up firmly so the steering
front of the front passenger seat.
cific modifications are necessary.
wheel position does not accidentally change – Fasten your seat belt securely ››› page 75.
● When driving, always hold the steering during driving. risk of accident!
wheel with both hands on the outside of the It is possible to deactivate the front passen-
● Make sure you are capable of reaching and
ring at the 9 o'clock and 3 o'clock positions. ger airbag in exceptional circumstances
firmly holding the upper part of the steering
This reduces the risk of injury when the driver ››› page 84.

Operation
wheel: risk of accident!
airbag is triggered.
● Never hold the steering wheel at the 12
● If you adjust the steering wheel so that it Adjusting the front passenger seat
o'clock position, or in any other manner (e.g.
points towards your face, the driver airbag ››› page 147.
will not protect you properly in the event of
in the centre of the steering wheel). In such
an accident. Make sure that the steering WARNING
cases, if the airbag is triggered, you may sus-
wheel points towards your chest.
tain injuries to the arms, hands and head. ● An incorrect sitting position of the front

Emergencies
● To reduce the risk of injury to the driver passenger can lead to severe injuries.
during sudden braking manoeuvres or an ac- ● Adjust the front passenger seat so that
cident, never drive with the backrest tilted far Correct sitting position for front pas- there is at least 25 cm between your chest
back! The airbag system and seat belts can senger and the dash panel. If you are sitting closer
only provide optimal protection when the than 25 cm, the airbag system cannot protect
backrest is in an upright position and the For your own safety and to reduce the risk of you properly.
driver is wearing his or her seat belt correct- injury in the event of an accident, we recom- ● If your physical constitution prevents you
ly. mend the following adjustments for the front

Safety
from maintaining the minimum distance of 25
● Adjust the head restraint properly to ach- passenger: cm, contact a specialised workshop. The
ieve optimal protection. workshop will help you decide if special spe-
– Move the front passenger seat back as far
as possible ››› . cific modifications are necessary. »

71
Safety

● Always keep your feet in the footwell when – Always keep both feet in the footwell in – Never allow anyone to assume an incorrect
the vehicle is moving; never rest them on the front of the rear seat. sitting position in the vehicle while travel-
dash panel, out the window or on the seat. An ling ››› .
– Fasten your seat belt securely ››› page 75.
incorrect sitting position exposes you to an
increased risk of injury in case of a sudden – Use an appropriate child restraint system The following list contains examples of sit-
braking or an accident. If the airbag is trig- when you take children in the vehicle ting positions that could be dangerous for all
gered, you could sustain severe injuries due ››› page 86. vehicle occupants. The list is not complete,
to an incorrect sitting position. but we would like to make you aware of this
● To reduce the risk of injury to the front pas- WARNING issue.
senger in events such as sudden braking ma- ● If the passengers in the rear seats are not
noeuvres or an accident, never travel with the Therefore, whenever the vehicle is in motion:
sitting properly, they could sustain severe in-
backrest tilted far back! The airbag system juries. ● Never stand in the vehicle.
and seat belts can only provide optimal pro-
tection when the backrest is in an upright po- ● Adjust the head restraint correctly in order ● Never stand on the seats.
sition and the front passenger is wearing his to achieve maximum protection. ● Never kneel on the seats.
or her seat belt properly. The further the seat ● Seat belts can only provide optimal protec-
● Never tilt your seat backrest far to the rear.
backrests are tilted to the rear, the greater tion when seat backrests are in an upright
the risk of injury due to incorrect positioning position and the vehicle occupants are wear- ● Never lean against the dash panel.
of the belt web or to the incorrect sitting po- ing their seat belts correctly. If passengers In ● Never lie on the rear bench.
sition! the rear seats are not sitting in an upright po-
sition, the risk of injury due to incorrect posi- ● Never sit on the front edge of a seat.
● Adjust the head restraint correctly in order
to achieve maximum protection. tioning of the seat belt increases. ● Never sit sideways.
● Never lean out of a window.
● Never put your feet out of a window.
Correct sitting position for rear seat Examples of incorrect sitting posi-
● Never put your feet on the dash panel.
passengers tions
● Never put your feet on the surface of a seat.
To reduce the risk of injury in the event of a Seat belts can provide optimal protection on- ● Do not allow anyone to travel in the foot-
sudden braking manoeuvre or an accident, ly when the belt webs are properly posi- well.
passengers on the rear seat bench must con- tioned. Incorrect sitting positions substan- ● Never travel without wearing the seat belt.
sider the following: tially reduce the protective function of seat
belts and increase the risk of injury due to in- ● Do not allow anyone to travel in the lug-
– Sit up straight. correct seat belt position. As the driver, you gage compartment.
– Adjust the head restraint to the correct po- are responsible for all passengers, especially
sition ››› page 73. children.
72
Safe driving

WARNING Properly adjusted head restraints are an im- Correct adjustment of rear head re-

Technical data
portant part of passenger protection and can straints
● Any incorrect sitting position increases the
reduce the risk of injuries in most accident
risk of severe injuries. Sitting in an incorrect
situations.
position exposes the vehicle occupants to se-
vere injuries if airbags are triggered, by strik- ● Adjust the head restraint so that its upper
ing a vehicle occupant who has assumed an edge is, as far as possible, at the same level
incorrect sitting position.
as the top of your head, or at the very least,
● Before the vehicle moves, assume the prop- at eye level ››› Fig. 84.

Advice
er sitting position and maintain it throughout
the trip. Before every trip, instruct your pas- WARNING
sengers to sit properly and to stay in this po-
sition during the trip ››› page 70, Correct posi- ● Travelling with the head restraints removed
tion for passengers. or improperly adjusted increases the risk of
severe injuries. An improper adjustment of
the head restraints may cause death in an ac- Fig. 85 Head restraints in the correct posi-

Operation
cident and increase the risk of suffering inju- tion.
Correct adjustment of front head re- ries during abrupt braking actions or unex-
straints pected manoeuvres.
● The head restraints must always be adjus-
ted according to the height of the passenger.

Emergencies
Fig. 86 Head restraint position warning label.

Safety
Fig. 84 Correctly adjusted head restraint as Properly adjusted head restraints are an im-
viewed from the front and the side. portant part of the passenger protection and
can reduce the risk of injuries in most acci-
Read the additional information carefully dent situations »
›››  page 17.
73
Safety

Rear head restraints Pedal area ● Never lay or fit floor mats or other floor cov-
– The rear head restraints have 2 positions: erings over the original floor mats. This
use and non-use. Pedals would reduce the pedal area and could ob-
struct the pedals. Risk of accident.
– One position for use (head restraint raised)
– Ensure that you can always press the accel- ● Never place objects in the driver footwell.
››› Fig. 85. In this position, the head re- An object could move into the pedal area and
erator, brake and clutch pedals unimpaired
straints are used normally, protecting pas- impair pedal operation. In the event of a sud-
to the floor.
sengers along with the rear seat belts. den driving or braking manoeuvre, you will
– Ensure that the pedals can return unim- not be able to operate the brake, clutch or ac-
– And one position for non-use (head re-
paired to their initial positions. celerator pedal. Risk of accident!
straint lowered).
– Ensure that the floor mats are securely fas-
– To fit the head restraints in position for use,
tened during the trip and do not obstruct
pull on the edges with both hands in the
the pedals ››› .
direction of the arrow.
Only use floor mats which leave the pedals
WARNING clear and which are secured to prevent them
● Under no circumstances should the rear from slipping. You can obtain suitable floor
passengers travel while the head restraints mats from a specialised dealership. Fasten-
are in the non-use position. See the warning ers* for floor mats are fitted in the footwells.
label located on the rear side fixed window
››› Fig. 86. If a brake circuit fails, the brake pedal must
be pressed down thoroughly in order to stop
● Do not swap the centre rear head restraint
the vehicle.
with either of the outer seat rear head re-
straints. Risk of injury in case of an accident!
Wear suitable footwear

CAUTION Always wear shoes which support your feet


properly and give you a good feeling for the
Note the instructions on the adjustment of pedals.
the head restraints ››› page 148.
WARNING
● Restricting pedal operation can lead to crit-
ical situations while driving.

74
Seat belts

Seat belts Seat belt lamp*  of more than approximately 25 km/h

Technical data
(15 mph) or if the seat belts are unfastened
while the vehicle is in motion. The warning
Why wear a seat belt? light will also flash .
The  lamp goes out when the driver and
Number of seats
passenger seat belts are fastened with the ig-
Your vehicle has five seats, two in the front nition switched on.
and three in the rear. Each seat is equipped

Advice
with a three-point seat belt. Rear seat belts fastened display*
Depending on the model version, when the
In some versions, your vehicle is approved
ignition is switched on, the seat belt status
only for four seats. Two front seats and two
display ››› Fig. 87 on the instrument panel in-
rear seats. Fig. 87 Instrument panel: right rear seat oc-
cupied and corresponding seat belt fastened forms the driver whether the passengers in
display. the rear seats have fastened their seat belts.

Operation
WARNING
The  symbol indicates that the passenger in
● Never transport more than the permitted this seat has fastened “his or her” seat belt.
The control lamp illuminates to remind the
amount of people in your vehicle.
driver to fasten his seat belt. When a seat belt in the rear seats is fastened
● Every vehicle occupant must properly fas-
ten and wear the seat belt belonging to his or Before starting the vehicle: or unfastened, the seat belt status is dis-
her seat. Children must be protected with an played for approximately 30 seconds. The in-
– Fasten your seat belt securely.

Emergencies
appropriate child restraint system. dication can be hidden by pressing the
– Instruct your passengers to fasten their 0.0/SET button on the dash panel.
seat belts properly before driving off. The seat belt status flashes for a maximum of
– Protect children by using a child seat ac- 30 seconds when a seat belt in the rear seats
cording to the child's height and weight. is unfastened while the vehicle is in motion.
An audible warning will also be heard if the
When the ignition is switched on, the control vehicle is travelling at over 25 km/h
lamp  in the instrument panel lights up (de- (15 mph).

Safety
pending on the model version) if the driver or
passenger have not fastened their seat belts.
An audible warning signal will sound for a
few seconds if the seat belts are not fastened
as the vehicle drives off and reaches a speed
75
Safety

The protective function of seat belts Ensure that your passengers wear their seat WARNING
belts as well. Accident statistics have shown
● If seat belts are worn incorrectly or not at
that wearing seat belts is an effective means
all, the risk of severe injuries increases. The
of substantially reducing the risk of injury
optimal protection from seat belts can be
and improving the chances of survival when
achieved only if you use them properly.
involved in a serious accident. Furthermore,
● Fasten your seat belt before every trip -
properly worn seat belts improve the protec-
even when driving in town. Other vehicle oc-
tion provided by airbags in the event of an
cupants must also wear the seat belts at all
accident. For this reason, wearing a seat belt
times, otherwise they run the risk of being in-
is required by law in most countries. jured.
Although your vehicle is equipped with air- ● The seat belt cannot offer its full protection
bags, the seat belts must be fastened and if the seat belt is not positioned correctly.
Fig. 88 Drivers with properly worn seat belts worn. The front airbags, for example, are only ● Never allow two passengers (even children)
will not be thrown forward in the event of sud- triggered in some cases of head-on collision. to share the same seat belt.
den braking. The front airbags will not be triggered during ● Always keep both feet in the footwell in
minor frontal or side collisions, rear-end colli- front of your seat as long as the vehicle is in
Properly worn seat belts hold the occupants sions, rollovers or accidents in which the air- motion.
in the proper position. They also help prevent bag trigger threshold value in the control unit
uncontrolled movements that may result in ● Never unbuckle a seat belt while the vehi-
is not exceeded.
serious injury and reduce the risk of being cle is in motion. Risk of fatal injury.
thrown out of the vehicle in case of an acci- Therefore, you should always wear your seat ● The seat belt must never be twisted while it
dent. belt and ensure that all vehicle occupants is being worn.
have fastened their seat belts properly before ● The seat belt should never lie on hard or
Vehicle occupants wearing their seat belts you drive off! fragile objects (such as glasses or pens, etc.)
correctly benefit greatly from the ability of the
because this can cause injuries.
belts to absorb kinetic energy. In addition,
the front part of your vehicle and other pas- ● Do not allow the seat belt to be damaged or
sive safety features (such as the airbag sys-
Safety instructions on using seat jammed, or to rub on any sharp edges.
tem) are designed to absorb the kinetic ener- belts ● Never wear the seat belt under the arm or
gy released in a collision. Taken together, all in any other incorrect position.
– Always wear the seat belt as described in
these features reduce the releasing kinetic ● Loose, bulky clothing (such as an overcoat
energy and consequently, the risk of injury. this section. over a jacket) impairs the proper fit and func-
This is why it is so important to fasten seat – Ensure that the seat belts can be fastened tion of the seat belts, reducing their capacity
belts before every trip, even when "just driv- at all times and are not damaged. to protect.
ing around the corner".
76
Seat belts

● The slot in the seat belt buckle must not be Head-on collisions and the laws of called “kinetic energy” is created both in the

Technical data
blocked with paper or other objects, as this physics passengers and inside the vehicle.
can prevent the latch plate from engaging se- The amount of “kinetic energy” depends on
curely.
the speed of the vehicle and the weight of
● Never use seat belt clips, fastening rings or the vehicle and its passengers. The higher
similar items to alter the position of the belt they are, the more energy there is to be “ab-
webbing. sorbed” in the event of an accident.
● Frayed or torn seat belts or damage to the
connections, belt retractors or parts of the The most significant factor, however, is the

Advice
buckle could cause severe injuries in the speed of the vehicle. If the speed doubles
event of an accident. Therefore, you must from 25 km/h (15 mph) to 50 km/h
check the condition of all seat belts at regular (30 mph), for example, the corresponding ki-
intervals. netic energy is multiplied by four.
● Seat belts which have been worn in an acci- Given that the passengers of the vehicle in
Fig. 89 A driver not wearing a seat belt is
dent and stretched must be replaced by a

Operation
thrown forward violently. our example do not have their seat belts fas-
specialised workshop. Renewal may be nec- tened, in the event of a collision the entire
essary even if there is no apparent damage.
amount of the passengers' kinetic energy will
The belt anchorage should also be checked.
be only absorbed by the mentioned impact.
● Do not attempt to repair a damaged seat
belt yourself. The seat belts must not be re- Even at speeds of 30 km/h (19 mph) to
moved or modified in any way. 50 km/h (30 mph), the forces acting on bod-

Emergencies
● The belts must be kept clean, otherwise the ies in a collision can easily exceed one tonne
retractors may not work properly. (1000 kg). At greater speed these forces are
even higher.
Vehicle occupants not wearing seat belts are
not “attached” to the vehicle. In a head-on
Fig. 90 The unbelted passenger in the rear
collision, they will move forward at the same
seat is thrown forward violently, hitting the speed their vehicle was travelling just before

Safety
driver who is wearing a seat belt. the impact. This example applies not only to
head-on collisions, but to all accidents and
It is easy to explain how the laws of physics collisions.
work in the case of a head-on collision: when Even at low speeds the forces acting on the
a vehicle starts moving, a type of energy body in a collision are so great that it is not »
77
Safety

possible to brace oneself with one's hands. How to properly adjust your
In a frontal collision, unbelted passengers
are thrown forward and will make violent con- seatbelt
tact with the steering wheel, dash panel,
windscreen or whatever else is in the way Fastening and unfastening the seat
››› Fig. 89. belt
It is also important for rear passengers to
wear seat belts properly, as they could other-
wise be thrown forward violently through the
vehicle interior in an accident. Passengers in
the rear seats who do not use seat belts en-
danger not only themselves but also the front
Fig. 92 Position of seat belt during pregnan-
occupants ››› Fig. 90. cy.

Read the additional information carefully


›››  page 18.
Fasten your seat belt
The seat belt cannot offer its full protection if
the seat belt is not positioned correctly.
● Adjust the seat and head restraint correctly.
● To fasten the belt, take hold of the latch
plate and pull it slowly across your chest and
lap.
● Insert the latch plate into the buckle for the
Fig. 91 Positioning and removing the seat
belt buckle.
appropriate seat and push it down until it is
securely locked with an audible click
››› Fig. 91 A.
● Pull the belt to ensure that the latch plate is
securely engaged in the buckle.

78
Seat belts

The seat belts are equipped with an automat- ● Never unbuckle a seat belt while the vehi- overturns, or in accidents where no major

Technical data
ic retractor on the shoulder strap. Full free- cle is in motion. If you do, you increase the forces act on the vehicle.
dom of movement is permitted when the risk of sustaining severe or fatal injuries.
shoulder belt is pulled slowly. However, dur- ● An incorrectly worn seat belt can cause se- Note
ing sudden braking, during travel in steep vere injuries in the event of an accident. ● If the seat belt tensioners are triggered, a
areas or bends and during acceleration, the fine dust is produced. This is normal and it is
● For pregnant women, the lap part of the
automatic retractor on the shoulder belt is not an indication of fire in the vehicle.
seat belt must lie as low as possible over the
locked. pelvis, never across the stomach, and always ● The relevant safety requirements must be
lie flat so that no pressure is exerted on the observed when the vehicle or components of

Advice
The automatic belt retractors on the front
seats are fitted with seat belt tensioners abdomen ››› Fig. 92. the system are scrapped. Specialised work-
››› page 79. ● Always engage the retractor lock when you shops are familiar with these regulations,
are securing a child seat in group 0, 0+ or 1 which are also available to you.
Releasing the seat belt ››› page 86.
● Read and observe the warnings ››› page 76.
● Press the red button on the belt buckle

Operation
››› Fig. 91 B. The latch plate is released and Service and disposal of belt tension-
springs out ››› . ers
● Guide the belt back by hand so that it rolls Seat belt tensioners The belt tensioners are components of the
up easily and the trim is not damaged. seat belts that are installed in the seats of
How the seat belt tensioner works your vehicle. If you work on the belt tension-
Positioning seat belts

Emergencies
ers or remove and install parts of the system
Seat belts offer their maximum protection on- Read the additional information carefully when performing other repair work, the seat
ly when they are properly positioned. ›››  page 18. belt may be damaged. The consequence may
be that, in the event of an accident, the belt
The seat belts for the occupants in the front
WARNING tensioners function incorrectly or may not
seats are equipped with belt tensioners. Sen-
● The seat belts offer best protection only
function at all.
sors will trigger the belt tensioners only dur-
when the backrests are in an upright position ing severe head-on, lateral and rear-end colli- So that the effectiveness of the seat belt ten-
and the seat belts have been fastened prop-

Safety
sions and only if the seat belt is worn. This sioner is not reduced and that removed parts
erly. retracts and tightens the seat belts, reducing do not cause any injuries or environmental
● Never put the latch plate in the buckle of the forward motion of the occupants. pollution, regulations, which are known to
another seat. If you do this, the seat belt will the specialised workshops, must be ob-
not protect you properly and the risk of injury The belt tensioners will not be triggered in »
served.
is increased. the event of minor collisions, if the vehicle

79
Safety

WARNING Airbag system airbag. In this case, the inflating airbag may
inflict critical or fatal injuries on the occu-
● Improper use or repairs not carried out by
pant. This also applies to children.
qualified mechanics increase the risk of se- Brief introduction
vere or fatal injuries. The belt tensioners may Always maintain the greatest possible dis-
fail to trigger or may trigger in the wrong cir- tance between yourself and the front airbag.
cumstances. Why is it so important to wear a seat
This way, the front airbags can completely
● Never attempt to repair, adjust, remove or belt and to sit correctly? deploy when triggered, providing their maxi-
install parts of the belt tensioners or seat mum protection.
belts. For the inflating airbags to achieve the best
protection, the seat belt must always be worn The most important factors that will trigger
● The seat belt tensioner, seat belt and auto-
properly and the correct sitting position must an airbag are: the type of accident, the angle
matic retractor cannot be repaired.
be assumed. of collision and the speed of the vehicle.
● Any work on the belt tensioners and seat
belts, including the removal and refitting of The airbag system is not a substitute for seat Whether or not the airbags are triggered de-
system parts in conjunction with other repair belts, but it is an integral part of the vehicle's pends primarily on the vehicle deceleration
work, must be performed by a specialised overall passive safety system. Please bear in rate resulting from the collision and detected
workshop only. mind that the airbag system can only work ef- by the control unit. If the vehicle deceleration
● The belt tensioners will only provide pro- fectively when the vehicle occupants are occurring during the collision and measured
tection for one accident and must be changed wearing their seat belts correctly and have by the control unit remains below the speci-
if they have been activated. adjusted the head restraints properly. There- fied reference values, the front, side and/or
fore, it is most important to properly wear the curtain airbags will not be triggered. Take in-
seat belts at all times, not only because this to account that the visible damage in a vehi-
is required by law in most countries, but also cle involved in an accident, no matter how
for your safety ››› page 75, Why wear a seat serious, is not a determining factor for the
belt?. airbags to have been triggered.
The airbag inflates in a matter of seconds, so
WARNING
if you are not properly seated when the air-
bag is triggered, you may sustain fatal inju- ● Wearing the seat belt incorrectly or assum-
ries. Therefore, it is essential that all vehicle ing an incorrect sitting position can lead to
occupants assume a correct sitting position critical or fatal injuries.
while travelling. ● All vehicle occupants, including children,
who are not properly belted can sustain criti-
Sharp braking before an accident may cause cal or fatal injuries if the airbag is triggered.
a passenger not wearing a seat belt to be Children up to 12 years old should always
thrown forward into the area of the deploying
80
Airbag system

travel on the rear seat. Never transport ● Head airbag WARNING

Technical data
children in the vehicle if they are not restrain- ● Airbag control lamp  on the instrument ● The seat belts and airbags can only provide
ed or the restraint system is not appropriate panel maximum protection if the occupants are
for their age, size or weight.
● Key-operated switch for front passenger air- seated correctly ››› page 70, Correct position
● If you are not wearing a seat belt, or if you for passengers.
bag
lean forward or to the side while travelling or ● If a fault has occurred in the airbag system,
assume an incorrect sitting position, there is ● Control lamp to disconnect/connect the
front airbag. have the system checked immediately by a
a substantially increased risk of injury. This
specialised workshop. Otherwise there is a
increased risk of injury will be further in-

Advice
The airbag system operation is monitored danger that during a collision, the system
creased if you are struck by an inflating air-
electronically. The airbag control lamp will il- may fail to trigger, or not trigger correctly.
bag.
● To reduce the risk of injury from an inflating
luminate for a few seconds every time the ig-
airbag, always wear the seat belt properly
nition is switched on (self-diagnosis).
››› page 75. Airbag activation
There is a fault in the system if the control
● Always adjust the front seats properly.

Operation
lamp : The airbags deploy extremely rapidly, within
● does not light up when the ignition is thousandths of a second, to provide addi-
switched on, tional protection in the event of an accident.
Description of the airbag system A fine dust may develop when the airbag de-
● turns off after 4 seconds after the ignition ploys. This is normal and it is not an indica-
Read the additional information carefully is switched on, tion of fire in the vehicle.
›››  page 19.

Emergencies
● turns off and then lights up again after the
The airbag system is only ready to function
The airbag system is not a substitute for the ignition is switched on,
when the ignition is on.
seat belts. The airbag system offers addition- ● illuminates or flashes while the vehicle is
al protection for the driver and passenger in moving. In special accidents instances, several air-
combination with the seat belts. bags may activate at the same time.
The airbag system is not triggered if: In the event of minor head-on and side colli-
The airbag system comprises the following ● the ignition is switched off sions, rear-end collisions, overturning or roll-
modules (as per vehicle equipment):

Safety
over of the vehicle, airbags do not activate.
● there is a minor frontal collision
● Electronic control unit
● there is a minor side collision Activation factors
● Front airbags for driver and passenger
● there is a rear-end collision The conditions that lead to the airbag system
● Knee airbag for the driver
● the vehicle turns over. activating in each situation cannot be gener-
● Side airbags alised. Some factors play an important role, »
81
Safety

such as the properties of the object the vehi- In an accident with airbag activation: Knee airbag*
cle hits (hard/soft), angle of impact, vehicle ● the interior lights switch on (if the interior
speed, etc. light switch is in the courtesy light position); Read the additional information carefully
Deceleration trajectory is key for airbag acti-
›››  page 20.
● the hazard warning lights switch on;
vation. ● all doors are unlocked; WARNING
The control unit analyses the collision trajec- ● the fuel supply to the engine is cut. ● The knee airbag is deployed in front of the
tory and activates the respective restraint driver's knees. Always keep the deployment
system. areas of the knee airbags free.
If the deceleration rate is below the prede- ● Never not fix objects to the cover or in the
fined reference value in the control unit the
Airbag safety instructions deployment area of the knee airbag.
airbags will not be triggered, even though ● Adjust the driver's seat so that there is a
the accident may cause extensive damage to Front airbags distance of at least 10 cm (4 inches) between
the car. your knees and the location of the this air-
Read the additional information carefully bag. If your physical constitution prevents
The following airbags are triggered in seri-
›››  page 19. you from meeting these requirements, make
ous head-on collisions sure you contact a specialised workshop.
WARNING
● Driver airbag.
● The deployment space between the front
● Front passenger front airbag passengers and the airbags must not in any Side airbags*
● Knee airbag for the driver. case be occupied by other passenger, pets
and objects. Read the additional information carefully
The following airbags are triggered in seri- ● The airbags provide protection for just one ›››  page 21.
ous side-on collisions accident; replace them once they have de-
ployed. WARNING
● Front side airbag on the side of the acci-
● It is also important not to attach any ob-
dent. ● If you do not wear a seat belt, if you lean
jects such as cup holders or telephone
● Rear side airbag on the side of the acci- mountings to the surfaces covering the air- forward, or are not seated correctly while the
dent. bag units. vehicle is in motion, you are at a greater risk
of injury if the side airbag system is triggered
● Curtain (head) airbag on the side of the ac- ● Do not attempt to modify components of
in an accident.
cident. the airbag system in any way.
● In order for the side airbags to provide their
maximum protection, the prescribed sitting

82
Airbag system

position must always be maintained with ● Under no circumstances should protective scribed sitting position must always be main-

Technical data
seat belts fastened while travelling. covers be fitted over seats with side airbags tained with seat belts fastened while travel-
● In a side-on collision the side airbags will unless the covers have been approved for use ling.
not work if the sensors do not correctly meas- in your vehicle. Because the airbag deploys ● For safety reasons, the curtain airbag must
ure the pressure increase on the interior of from the side of the backrest, the use of con- be disabled in those vehicles fitted with a
the doors, due to air escaping through the ventional seat covers would obstruct the side screen dividing the interior of the vehicle.
areas with holes or openings in the door pan- airbag, seriously reducing the airbag's effec- See your technical service to make this ad-
el. tiveness. justment.
● Never drive if the interior door panels have ● Any damage to the original seat upholstery ● There must be no other persons, animals or

Advice
been removed or if the panels have not been or around the seams of the side airbag units objects between the occupants of the outer
correctly fitted. must be repaired immediately by a special- seats and the deployment space of the head-
ised workshop. protection airbags so that the head-protec-
● Never drive the vehicle if the loudspeakers
● The airbags provide protection for just one tion airbag can deploy completely without re-
in the door panels have been removed, un-
less the holes left by the loudspeakers have accident; replace them once they have de- striction and provide the greatest possible
been closed properly. ployed. protection. Therefore, sun blinds which have

Operation
● Any work on the side airbag system or re- not been expressly approved for use in your
● Always check that the openings are closed
moval and installation of the airbag compo- vehicle may not be attached to the side win-
or covered if loudspeakers or other equip- dows
ment are fitted inside the door panels. nents for other repairs (such as removal of
the front seat) should only be performed by a ● The built-in coat hooks should be used only
● Occupants of the outer seats must never
specialised workshop. Otherwise, faults may for lightweight clothing. Do not leave any
carry any objects or pets in the deployment occur during the airbag system operation. heavy or sharp-edged objects in the pockets.

Emergencies
space between them and the airbags, or al- Please, do not hang the clothes on coat hang-
● Do not attempt to modify components of
low children or other passengers to travel in ers.
this position. It is also important not to at- the airbag system in any way.
● The airbags provide protection for just one
tach any accessories (such as cup holders) to
the doors. This would impair the protection accident; replace them once they have de-
offered by the side airbags. ployed.
Curtain airbags*
● The built-in coat hooks should be used only ● Any work on the head-protection airbag
for lightweight clothing. Do not leave any Read the additional information carefully system or removal and installation of the air-
bag components for other repairs (such as re-

Safety
heavy or sharp-edged objects in the pockets. ›››  page 21.
moval of the roof lining) should only be per-
● Great forces, such as hard blows or kicks,
formed by a specialised workshop. Other-
must not be exerted upon the backrest bol- WARNING
wise, faults may occur during the airbag sys-
ster because the system may be damaged. In tem operation.
this case, the side airbags would not be trig- ● In order for the head-protection airbags to
provide their maximum protection, the pre- ● Do not attempt to modify components of
gered.
the airbag system in any way. »
83
Safety

● The side and head airbags are managed It lights up on the combi-in- The disabling of airbags is only carried out in
through sensors located in the interior of the  strument certain cases, i.e. if:
front doors. To ensure the correct operation of ● a child seat is required in the front passen-
the side and curtain airbags neither the Fault in airbag
Have the system checked immedi- ger seat with the child facing in the opposite
doors nor the door panels should be modified system and seat
ately by a specialised workshop. direction to the direction of travel (in some
in any way (e.g. fitting loudspeakers). If the belt tensioners.
countries, due to divergent legal require-
front door is damaged, the airbag system
may not work correctly. All work carried out
ments, facing in the direction of travel)
  It lights up on the dash panel
››› page 88;
on the front door must be done in a special-
ised workshop. Fault in the air- Have the system checked immedi- ● despite the driver's seat being in the cor-
bag system. ately by a specialised workshop. rect position, a minimum distance of 25 cm
Front passenger cannot be maintained between the centre of
Check whether the airbag should re- the steering wheel and the driver's torso,
front airbag dis-
Deactivating airbags abled.
main disabled.
● installation of special devices is required in
the steering wheel area due to a physical dis-
Deactivation of front airbag   It lights up on the dash panel ability,
● if you have special seats installed (e.g. an
The control lamp switches off about
Front passenger 60 seconds after the ignition is orthopaedic seat without side airbags).
front airbag ena- turned on or after enabling of the
bled. front passenger front airbag with the The front passenger front airbag can be disa-
key lock switch. bled using the switch ››› page 85.
We recommend that you contact an author-
Several warning and control lamps light up
ised SEAT dealer for the disabling of other air-
for a few seconds when the ignition is switch-
bags.
ed on, signalling that the function is being
verified. They will switch off after a few sec-
Airbag system control
onds.
Fig. 93 Control lamp for disabling the front The airbag system availability is controlled
passenger front airbag on the dash panel If the front passenger airbag is deactivated, electronically, regardless of whether an air-
the lamp      does not re- bag is disabled.
main lit, or if it is lit together with the control
lamp  on the dash panel, there may be a
fault in the airbag system ››› .

84
Airbag system

If an airbag was disabled using a diagnostics CAUTION

Technical data
system:
Always pay attention to any lit control lamps
● the airbag system warning lamp  illumi-
and to the corresponding descriptions and in-
nates after switching on the ignition for structions to avoid damage to the vehicle.
about 4 seconds, and then flashes for about
12 seconds.
Note
If the airbag has been disabled with the air- ● Follow the current legislation in your coun-
bag switch on the side of the dash panel: try regarding the disabling of airbags.

Advice
● the airbag control lamp  will illuminate ● At your authorised SEAT dealer you can find
for about 4 seconds after the ignition is information on which vehicle airbags can be Fig. 95 Warning lamp for disabling the front
switched on, disabled. passenger airbag.
● The airbag is disabled, signalled with the
warning lamp   which lights up with the Read the additional information carefully
›››  page 20.

Operation
word      placed in the cen- Front passenger front airbag switch
tre part of the dash panel ››› Fig. 94. The switch disables only the front passenger
front airbag.
WARNING
In the event of a fault in the airbag system, Switching on the airbag
the airbag may not trigger correctly, may fail – Switch the ignition off.

Emergencies
to trigger or may even trigger unexpectedly,
leading to severe or fatal injuries. – Open the glove compartment on the front
● Have the airbag system checked immedi- passenger side.
ately by a specialised workshop. – Insert the key into the slot of the switch for
● Never mount a child seat in the front pas- deactivating the front passenger airbag
senger seat or remove the mounted child ››› Fig. 94. About 3/4 of the key should en-
seat! The front passenger front airbag may Fig. 94 Front passenger front airbag switch. ter, as far as it will go.
deploy during an accident in spite of the

Safety
fault. – Then turn the key gently to the ON position.
Do not force it if you feel resistance, and
make sure you have inserted the key fully.
– Close the passenger side storage compart-
ment. »
85
Safety

– Check, with the ignition switched on, that


the control lamp   ››› Fig. 95 does not
the system immediately checked by an Offi- Transporting children safely
cial Service.
light up, with the word    
 in the centre part of the dash panel. Safety for children
– The warning lamp   is illuminated for
Introduction
60 seconds in the centre part of the dash
panel. For safety reasons, as we have learned from
Control lamp with the word    accident statistics, we recommend that chil-
  (front passenger airbag disabled) dren under 12 years of age travel in the rear
seats. Depending on their age, height and
If the front passenger front airbag is disa- weight, children travelling in rear seats must
bled, after switching on the ignition, the con- use a child seat or a seat belt. For safety rea-
trol lamp will light up for several seconds, sons, the child seat should be installed in the
then it will switch off for about 1 s and then rear seat, behind the front passenger seat or
switch on again. in the centre back seat.
If the control lamp is flashing, there is a fault The physical laws involved and the forces
in the disabling of the airbag system ››› . acting in a collision apply also to children
Please go immediately to an Official Service. ››› page 77. But unlike adults, children do not
have fully developed muscle and bone struc-
WARNING tures. This means that children are subject to
● The driver of the vehicle is responsible for a greater risk of injury.
disabling or switching on the airbag.
To reduce the risk of injuries, children must
● Always switch off the ignition before disa-
always use special child restraint systems
bling the front passenger airbag! Failure to do when travelling in the vehicle.
so could result in a fault in the airbag deacti-
vation system. We recommend the use of child safety prod-
● Never leave the key in the airbag disabling ucts from the SEAT Original Accessories Pro-
switch as it could get damaged or enable or gramme, which includes systems for all ages
disable the airbag during driving. made by “Peke” (not for all countries).
● If the   (airbag disabled) control lamp These systems have been especially de-
flashes, the front passenger front airbag will signed and approved, complying with the
not trigger in the event of an accident! Have ECE-R44. regulation.
86
Transporting children safely

Follow the manufacturer's instructions and bled with a key-operated switch ››› page 85. ● Never hold children or babies on your lap,

Technical data
observe any statutory requirements when in- When transporting children, use a child seat this can result in potentially fatal injuries to
stalling and using child seats. Always read suitable for the age and size of each child the child!
and note ››› page 87. ››› page 88. ● Never allow a child to be transported in a
We recommend you always carry the manu- vehicle without being properly secured, or to
WARNING stand up or kneel on a seat while travelling.
facturer's Child Seat Instruction Manual to-
gether with the on-board documentation. ● If a child seat is secured to the front pas- In an accident, the child could be flung
senger seat, the risk to the child of sustain- through the vehicle, causing possibly fatal in-
ing critical or fatal injuries in the event of an juries to themselves and to the other vehicle

Advice
accident increases. occupants.
Important information regarding the ● If children assume an improper sitting posi-
● An inflating front passenger airbag can
front passenger's airbag strike the rear-facing child seat and project it tion when the vehicle is moving, they expose
with great force against the door, the roof or themselves to greater risk of injury in the
Read the additional information carefully the backrest. event of a sudden braking manoeuvre or in an
›››  page 22. accident. This is particularly important if the

Operation
● Never install a child seat facing backwards
child is travelling on the front passenger seat
Read and always observe the safety informa- on the front passenger seat unless the front
and the airbag system is triggered in an acci-
tion included in the following chapters: passenger front airbag has been disabled.
dent; as this could cause serious injury or
Risk of potentially fatal injuries to the child!
even death.
● Safety distance with respect to the passen- However, if it is necessary, in exceptional ca-
● A suitable child seat can protect your child!
ger airbag ››› page 80. ses, to transport a child in the front passen-
ger seat, the front passenger front airbag ● Never leave a child alone in the child seat

Emergencies
● Objects between the passenger and the
must always be disabled ››› page 84. If the or inside the vehicle because depending on
passenger side airbag ››› in Front airbags passenger seat has a height adjustment op- the season, very high temperatures may be
on page 82. tion, move it to the highest, most upright po- reached inside a parked vehicle, which could
sition. If you have a fixed seat, do not install be fatal.
The passenger side front airbag, when ena- any child restraint system in this location.
bled, is a serious risk for a child that is facing ● Children who are less than 1.5 metres tall
● For those vehicles that do not include a key must not wear a normal seat belt without a
backward since the airbag can strike the seat
lock switch to deactivate the airbag, the vehi- child seat, as this could cause injuries to the
with such force that it can cause serious or
cle must be taken to a technical service. abdominal and neck areas during a sudden

Safety
fatal injuries. Children up to 12 years old
● All vehicle occupants, especially children, braking manoeuvre or in an accident.
should always travel on the rear seat.
must assume the proper sitting position and ● Do not allow the seat belt to become twis-
Therefore we strongly recommend you to be properly belted in while travelling. ted and the seat belt should be properly in
transport children on the rear seats. This is place ››› page 75.
the safest location in the vehicle. Alternative- ● Only one child may occupy a child seat
ly, the front passenger airbag can be disa- ››› page 88, Child seats. » 87
Safety

● When a child seat is mounted in the rear WARNING Group 3: From 22 to 36 kg (over around 7
seats, the door child-proof lock should be ac- years old)
An undue installation of the safety seat will
tivated ››› page 128.
increase the risk of injury in the event of a Child seats that have been tested and ap-
crash. proved under the ECE R44 standard bear the
● Never tie the retainer strap to a hook in the test mark on the seat (the letter E in a circle
Child seats luggage compartment. with the test number below it).
● Never secure or tie luggage or other items
Follow the manufacturer's instructions and
Safety instructions to the lower anchorages (ISOFIX) or the upper
observe any statutory requirements when in-
ones (Top Tether).
stalling and using child seats.
Read the additional information carefully
›››  page 22. We recommend you to always include the
manufacturer's Child Seat Instruction Manual
Categorisation of child seats into
WARNING together with the on-board documentation.
groups
When travelling, children must be secured in SEAT recommends you use child seats from
the vehicle with a restraint system suitable Use only child seats that are officially ap- the Original Accessories Catalogue. These
for age, weight and size. proved and suitable for the child. child seats have been designed and tested
● Read and always observe information and for use in SEAT vehicles. You can find the
Child seats are subject to the regulation ECE-
warnings concerning the use of child seats right child seat for your model and age group
R 44. ECE-R stands for: Economic Commis-
››› page 87. at SEAT dealers.
sion for Europe Regulation.
The child seats are grouped into 5 catego-
WARNING
ries:
The retaining rings are designed only for use
with “ISOFIX” and Top Tether* system child Group 0: Up to 10 kg (up to around 9
seats. months)
● Never secure other child seats that do not
Group 0+: Up to 13 kg (up to around 18
have the “ISOFIX” or Top Tether* system, or
months)
retaining belts or objects to the fastening
rings - this can result in potentially fatal inju- Group 1: from 9 to 18 kg (up to approx. 4
ries to the child.
years old)
● Ensure that the child seat is secured cor-
rectly using the “ISOFIX” and Top Tether* se- Group 2: from 15 to 25 kg (up to approx. 7
curing rings. years old)
88
Event Data Recorder

Event Data Recorder Depending on vehicle equipment, this in- tem quality. Any data used for the purposes

Technical data
cludes data from systems such as: of research will be treated anonymously (in
other words, no reference will be made to the
Description and operation ● Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) vehicle, their owner or the lessee/hirer).
● Front Assist.
Your vehicle has an event data recorder
(EDR). ● Park Pilot system
● Lane Assist
The EDR’s function is to record data in the
event of a mild or serious accident. These da- The EDR data are only recorded in specific ac-

Advice
ta are used to support the analysis of how cident situations. No data are recorded in
different vehicle systems behaved. normal driving conditions.
The EDR records, over a reduced time range No audio or video data inside or around the
(normally 10 seconds or less), dynamic driv- vehicle are recorded. Under no circumstances
ing data and data from the restraint systems, are personal data such as name, age, or gen-

Operation
such as: der recorded. Nevertheless, third parties
● How different vehicle systems worked. (such as criminal proceedings authorities)
may relate the contents of the EDR data to
● Whether the driver and the occupants were
other data sources and create a personal ref-
wearing their seatbelts. erence in the context of an accident investi-
● How hard the acceleration or brake pedal gation.

Emergencies
was pressed.
In order to read the EDR data it is necessary
● Vehicle speed. to access (if legally permitted to do so) the
vehicle's ODB (“On-Board-Diagnose”) inter-
These data will provide a better understand-
face while the vehicle is switched on.
ing of the circumstances of the accident.
SEAT will not have access to EDR data unless
Data from the driving assist systems are also
the owner (or, in “Leasing” cases, the lessee
recorded. This includes data such as whether
or hirer) gives their consent. There may be ex-

Safety
the systems were inactive or active and if
ceptions to this, depending on legal or con-
such action had an impact on the vehicle’s
tractual provisions.
dynamic behaviour, changing its path in the
aforementioned situations, accelerating or Due to legal requirements in safety-related
decelerating the vehicle. products, SEAT may use the EDR data for field
research and in order to improve vehicle sys-
89
Emergencies

Emergencies Note ● In the event of cuts or perforations in the


tyre greater than 4 mm.
The jack does not generally require any main-
tenance. If required, it should be greased us- ● If you have been driving with very low pres-
Self-help ing universal type grease. sure or a completely flat tyre.
● If the sealant bottle has passed its use by
Vehicle tool kit, anti-puncture kit* date.

The tools and anti-puncture kit* are stored Tyre repair WARNING
under the floor panel in the luggage compart-
ment. Using the tyre mobility system can be dan-
TMS (Tyre Mobility System)* gerous, especially when filling the tyre at the
To access the vehicle tools: roadside. Please observe the following rules
Read the additional information carefully to minimise the risk of injury:
– Lift up the floor surface by the plastic han- ›››  page 60
● Stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible.
dle until it is fastened to the tabs on both
sides. The Anti-puncture kit* (Tyre Mobility System) Park it at a safe distance from surrounding
will reliably seal punctures caused by the traffic to fill the tyre.
Depending on the vehicle equipment, the an- penetration of a foreign body of up to about ● Ensure the ground on which you park is flat
ti-puncture kit* is located under the floor 4 mm in diameter. Do not remove foreign ob- and solid.
panel in the luggage compartment. jects, e.g. screws or nails, from the tyre. ● All passengers and particularly children
The tool kit includes: After inserting the sealant residue in the tyre, must keep a safe distance from the work area.
you must again check the tyre pressure about ● Turn on the hazard warning lights to warn
● Jack* 10 minutes after starting the engine. other road users.
● Wire hook for pulling off the wheel cov- ● Use the tyre mobility system only if you are
You should only use the tyre mobility set if
er*/wheel bolt cap clip. the vehicle is parked in a safe place, you are familiar with the necessary procedures. Oth-
● Box spanner for wheel bolts* erwise, you should seek professional assis-
familiar with the procedure and you have the
tance.
● Towline anchorage necessary tyre mobility set! Otherwise, you
● The tyre mobility set is intended for tempo-
should seek professional assistance.
● Adapter for the anti-theft wheel bolts* rary emergency use only until you can reach
● Towing bracket device the nearest specialised workshop.
Do not use the tyre sealant in the following
cases: ● Replace the repaired tyre with the tyre mo-
Some of the items listed are only provided in bility set as soon as possible.
certain model versions, or are optional ex- ● If the wheel rim has been damaged.
tras. ● In outside temperatures below -20°C (-4°F).

90
Self-help

● The sealant is a health hazard and must be Note 4 Air compressor

Technical data
cleaned immediately if it comes into contact 5 Tube for inflating tyres
Take into account the separate instruction
with the skin.
manual of the tyre mobility set* manufactur- 6 Warning provided by tyre pressure moni-
● Always keep the tyre mobility set out of the er. toring system (it can also be integrated in
reach of small children. the compressor).
● Never use an equivalent jack, even if it has
7 Air bleed screw (in its place, the compres-
been approved for your vehicle.
Contents of the tyre mobility system* sor may have a button).
● Always stop the engine, apply the hand-
8 ON/OFF switch

Advice
brake lever firmly and engage gear if using a
manual gearbox, in order to reduce the risk of 9 12 volt connector
vehicle involuntary movement. 10 Bottle of sealant
11 Spare tyre valve
WARNING
A tyre filled with sealant does not have the The valve insert remover 1 has a gap at the

Operation
same performance properties as a conven- lower end for a valve insert. The valve insert
tional tyre. can only be screwed or unscrewed in this
● Never drive faster than 80 km/h (50 mph).
way. This also applies to its replacement part
11 .
● Avoid heavy acceleration, hard braking and
fast cornering. WARNING

Emergencies
● Drive for only 10 minutes at a maximum
Fig. 96 Standard representation: contents of
When inflating the wheel, the air compressor
speed of 80 km/h (50 mph) and then check
the anti-puncture kit. and the inflator tube may become hot.
the tyre.
● Protect hands and skin from hot parts.
The anti-puncture kit is located underneath ● Do not place the hot flexible inflator tube or
For the sake of the environment
the floor covering in the luggage compart- hot air compressor on flammable material.
Dispose of used or expired sealant observing ment. It includes the following components ● Allow them to cool before storing the de-
any legal requirements. ››› Fig. 96: vice.

Safety
1 Tyre valve remover ● If it is not possible to inflate the tyre to at
Note least 2.0 bars (29 psi / 200 kPa), the tyre is
2 Sticker indicating maximum speed “max. too badly damaged. The sealant is not in a
A new bottle of sealant can be purchased at
80 km/h” or “max. 50 mph” good condition to seal the tyre. Do not con-
SEAT dealerships.
3 Filler tube with cap tinue driving. Seek specialist assistance. »
91
Emergencies

CAUTION ● Seek specialist assistance. WARNING


Switch off the air compressor after a maxi- Getting in the way of the doors and the rear
mum of 8 operational minutes to avoid over- lid is dangerous and can lead to serious in-
heating! Before switching on the air compres- jury.
sor again, let it cool for several minutes. Manual unlocking/locking ● Open and close the doors and the rear lid
only when there is nobody in the way.
Introduction
Check after 10 minutes of driving Read the additional information carefully CAUTION
›››  page 14, ›››  page 15. When opening and closing in an emergency,
Screw the inflator tube ››› Fig. 96 again
5
and check the pressure on the gauge 6 . carefully disassemble components and then
The doors, rear lid and panoramic tilting sun- reassemble them carefully to avoid damage
roof can be locked manually and partially to the vehicle.
1.3 bar (19 psi / 130 kPa) and lower: opened, for example if the key or the central
● Stop the vehicle! The tyre cannot be sealed locking is damaged.
sufficiently with the tyre mobility set.
● You should obtain professional assistance
WARNING Changing the windscreen wiper
››› . Opening and closing doors carelessly can blades
cause serious injury.
1.4 bar (20 psi / 140 kPa) and higher: ● If the vehicle is locked from outside, the Changing the windscreen and rear
doors and windows cannot be opened from
● Set the tyre pressure to the correct value window wiper blades
the inside.
again.
● Never leave children or disabled people Read the additional information carefully
● Carefully resume your journey until you alone in the car. They could be trapped in the
reach the nearest specialised workshop with-
›››  page 68.
car in an emergency and will not be able to
out exceeding 80 km/h (50 mph). get themselves to safety. The windscreen wiper blades are supplied as
● Have the damaged tyre replaced. ● Depending on the time of the year, temper- standard with a layer of graphite. This layer is
atures inside a locked and closed vehicle can responsible for ensuring that the wipe is si-
WARNING be extremely high or extremely low resulting lent. If the graphite layer is damaged, the
in serious injuries and illness or even death, noise of the water as it is wiped across the
Driving with an unsealed tyre is dangerous
particularly for young children. windscreen will be louder.
and can cause accidents and serious injury.
● Do not continue driving if the tyre pressure Check the condition of the wiper blades regu-
is 1.3 bar (19 psi / 130 kPa) and lower. larly. If the wipers scrape across the glass,
92
Self-help

they should be changed if they are damaged, CAUTION the Keyless Access system, the steering

Technical data
or cleaned if they are dirty ››› . wheel could lock up.
● To prevent damage to the bonnet and the
Damaged wiper blades should be replaced wiper arms, only leave them in the service
WARNING
immediately. These are available from quali- position.
fied workshops. ● Before driving, always lower the wiper If the vehicle has no electrical power, the
arms. brake lights, turn signals and all other lights
WARNING will no longer function. Do not have the vehi-
cle towed away. Failure to follow this instruc-
Worn or dirty wiper blades reduce visibility tion could result in an accident.

Advice
and increase the risk of accident and serious
injury. Towing and tow-starting the ve-
WARNING
● Always replace damaged or worn blades or hicle
blades which do not clean the windscreen The risk of accidents is high when tow-start-
correctly. General information ing, for example, the towed vehicle can easily
be driven into the towing vehicle.

Operation
CAUTION Read the additional information carefully
● Damaged or dirty windscreen wipers could
›››  page 64. CAUTION
scratch the glass. Tow-starting means starting the engine of If there is no oil in the gearbox or no lubricant
● If products containing solvents, rough the vehicle while another pulls it. in the automatic transmission the car may
sponges or sharp objects are used to clean only be towed with the driven wheels lifted
Towing means one vehicle pulling another clear of the road, or transported on a special

Emergencies
the blades, the graphite layer will be dam-
that is not roadworthy. car transporter or trailer.
aged.
● Never use fuel, nail varnish remover, paint If the vehicle comes with the Keyless Access
thinner or similar products to clean the win- system, towing is only allowed with the igni- CAUTION
dows. tion on!
Do not tow a vehicle for more than 50 m in at-
● In icy conditions, always check that the The vehicle battery drains if the vehicle is tempt to start it. There is risk of damage to
wiper blades are not frozen to the glass be- towed with the engine switched off and the the catalytic converter.
fore using the wipers. In cold weather, it may ignition connected. Depending on the battery

Safety
help to leave the vehicle parked with the wip- charge status, the drop in voltage may be so Note
ers in service position ›››  page 67.
large, even after just a few minutes, that no
electrical device in the vehicle may work e.g.
● Please observe related legal requirements. »
the hazard warning lights. In vehicles with

93
Emergencies

● Switch on the hazard warning lights of both ● Keep the clutch pressed down. Anchoring the front tow line
vehicles. However, observe any regulations ● Switch on the ignition and the hazard warn-
to the contrary. ing lights.
● The tow rope must not be twisted. Other- ● Once both vehicles are moving, release the
wise the front tow line anchorage could be clutch.
pulled off the vehicle.
● Once the engine starts, press the clutch
and disengage the gear to avoid colliding
with the towing vehicle.
Indications for tow-starting
Note
Vehicle's should not generally be tow-star-
ted. The jump start should be used instead The vehicle can only be tow-started if the
›››  page 65. electronic parking brake and, if appropriate, Fig. 97 Right side of the front bumper: tow-
the electronic lock of the steering column are line anchorage screwed in.
For technical reasons, towing the following deactivated. If the vehicle has no power sup-
vehicles is not allowed: ply or there is an electric system fault, the The front towline anchorage is only mounted
engine must be tow-started to deactivate the if the vehicle has to be towed.
● Vehicles with an automatic gearbox. electronic parking brake and the electronic
● If the vehicle battery is discharged, be- lock of the steering column. There is a cover with an opening into which
cause in vehicles with the Keyless Access the towline anchorage is screwed on the right
locking and ignition system the steering re- part of the front bumper.
mains locked and the electronic parking – To open the cover, press the left side.
brake cannot be deactivated nor can the elec-
tronic lock of the steering column be re- – Take the towline anchorage out of the vehi-
leased if they are activated. cle tool kit ››› page 90.
● If the battery is flat, it is possible that the – Screw the towline anchorage into the screw
engine control units may not operate correct- connection as far as it will go ››› Fig. 97 and
ly. tighten with the wheel brace.

After use, unscrew the towline anchorage


However, if the vehicle must absolutely be
and fit the cover back on the bumper. Put the
tow-started (in the case of manual gearbox-
towline anchorage back in the vehicle tool
es):
kit. The towline anchorage should always be
● Engage the 2nd or 3rd gear. kept in the vehicle.
94
Self-help

Rear towline anchorage Vehicles with towline anchorage Towing vehicles with a manual gear-

Technical data
On the right of the rear bumper there is a cov- box
er which covers a threaded hole.
Towing is relatively straightforward.
– Take the towline anchorage out of the vehi-
cle tool set ››› page 90. Please observe the relevant instructions
››› page 93.
– To open the cover, press the top right side
››› Fig. 98. The vehicle can be towed using a tow bar or
tow rope in the normal way, with all four

Advice
– Screw the towline anchorage into the screw wheels on the road; it can also be towed with
connection as far as it will go ››› Fig. 99 and either the front or rear wheels lifted off the
tighten with the wheel brace. road. The maximum towing speed is 50 km/h
Fig. 98 Right side of the rear bumper: cover- (30 mph).
After use, unscrew the towline anchorage
cap. and put it back in the vehicle tool kit. Replace

Operation
the cover on the bumper. The towline anchor-
age should always be kept in the vehicle. Towing a vehicle equipped with auto-
matic gearbox
WARNING
Certain restrictions must be observed when
● If the towline anchorage is not screwed in
towing your vehicle.
as far as the stop, there is a risk of the screw

Emergencies
connection shearing off during towing (acci- Please observe the relevant instructions
dent risk). ››› page 93.
● If your car has a towing bracket, only use
The vehicle can be towed with a tow bar or
special towing ropes. Risk of accident!
tow rope in the normal way, with all four
wheels on the ground. When doing so,
Fig. 99 Right side of the rear bumper: towline
CAUTION please note the following points:
anchorage screwed in.
In vehicles fitted with a towing bracket, only

Safety
● Make sure the selector lever is in the N po-
The rear towline anchorage should only be use special tow bars to prevent damage to
the ball joint. These tow bars have been spe- sition.
mounted if you wish to tow another vehicle.
cially approved for use with towing brackets. ● The vehicle must not be towed faster than
50 km/h (30 mph).
● The vehicle must not be towed further than
50 km (30 miles). Reason: when the engine »
95
Emergencies

is not running, the gearbox oil pump does


not work and the gearbox is not adequately
Fuses and bulbs ● Never use a fuse with a higher value. Only
replace fuses with a fuse of the same amper-
lubricated for higher speeds or longer distan- age (same colour and markings) and size.
ces. Fuses ● Never repair a fuse.

If the vehicle has to be towed with a break- ● Never replace a fuse by a metal strip, staple
Introduction
down truck, it must only be suspended at the or similar.
front wheels. Reason: the drive shafts are lo- In general, a fuse can be assigned to various
cated on the front wheels. If the car is towed electrical components. Likewise, an electrical CAUTION
with the rear wheels lifted off the road (I.e. component can be protected by several ● To prevent damage to the vehicle's electric
travelling backwards), the drive shafts also fuses. system, before replacing a fuse always turn
turn backwards. The planetary gears in the off the ignition, the lights and all electrical
automatic gearbox then turn at such high Only replace fuses when the cause of the
problem has been solved. If a newly inserted elements and remove the key from the igni-
speeds that the gearbox will be severely tion.
damaged in a short time. fuse blows after a short time, you must have
the electrical system checked by a special- ● If you replace a fuse with higher-rating
ised workshop as soon as possible. fuse, you could cause damage to another part
Note of the electrical system.
● If it is not possible to tow the vehicle in the ● Protect the fuse boxes when open to pre-
WARNING
normal way, or if it has to be towed further vent the entry of dust or humidity as they can
than 50 km (30 miles), it must be transported The high voltages in the electrical system can
damage the electrical system.
on a special car transporter or trailer. give serious electrical shocks, causing burns
and even death!
● Should the power supply to the selector
● Never touch the electrical wiring of the igni- Note
lever be interrupted in position P, the selector
lever will be locked. Before the vehicle can be tion system. ● One component may have more than one
recovered/manoeuvred you must manually ● Take care not to cause short circuits in the fuse.
release the selector lever ›››  page 47. electrical system. ● Several components may run on a single
fuse.
WARNING
Using unsuitable fuses, repairing fuses or
bridging a current circuit without fuses can
cause a fire and serious injury.

96
Fuses and bulbs

Vehicle fuses Opening and closing the fuse box situated No. Consumers/Amps

Technical data
below the dash panel
12 Radio 20
● Opening: fold the cover down ››› Fig. 100.
● Closing: push back the cover it in until it 14 Air conditioner fan 40
clicks into place. 15 KESSY 10

To open the engine compartment fuse box 16 Connectivity Box. 7.5

● Open the bonnet  ››› page 268. 17 Instrument panel 5

Advice
● Press the locking tabs to release the fuse 18 Rear camera 7.5
box cover ››› Fig. 101.
19 KESSY 7.5
● Then lift the cover out.
Fig. 100 On the driver-side dash panel: fuse
● To fit the cover, place it on the fuse box. 21 4x4 Haldex Control Unit 15
box cover.
Push the locking tabs down until they click

Operation
22 Trailer 15
audibly into place.
23 Sunroof 30
Fuses in the vehicle interior
24 Right lights 40
No. Consumers/Amps
25 Left door 30
4 Taxis 3

Emergencies
26 Heated seats 20
5 Gateway 5
27 Interior light 30
6 Automatic gearbox lever 5
28 Trailer 25
Air conditioning and heating control
Fig. 101 In the engine compartment: fuse box 7 10 Parking aid control unit, front camera,
panel, heating the back window. 32 7.5
cover. radar
Diagnosis, handbrake switch, light
8 10 33 Airbag 5
switch, reverse light, interior lighting

Safety
Read the additional information carefully
›››  page 58 9 Steering column 5 34
Reverse switch, clima sensor, electro-
7.5
chromic mirror
Only replace fuses with a fuse of the same 10 Radio display 7.5
amperage (same colour and markings) and Diagnosis, headlight control unit,
»
35 10
size. 11 Left lights 40 headlight adjuster

97
Emergencies

No. Consumers/Amps No. Consumers/Amps CAUTION


● Always carefully remove the fuse box cov-
36 Right LED headlight 10 7 Engine power supply 5/10
ers and refit them correctly to avoid problems
37 Left LED headlight 10 8 Lambda probe 10/15 with your vehicle.
● Protect the fuse boxes when open to avoid
38 Trailer 25 9 Engine 5/10/20
the entry of dust or humidity. Dirt and humid-
39 Right door 30 10 Fuel pump control unit 10/15/20 ity inside fuse boxes can cause damage to
the electrical system.
40 12V socket 20 11 PTC 40

42 Central locking 40 12 PTC 40 Note


44 Trailer 15 13 Automatic gearbox control unit 15/30 ● In the vehicle, there are more fuses than
those indicated in this chapter. These should
45 Electric driver's seat 15 15 Horn 15 only be changed by a specialised workshop.
47 Rear window wiper 15 16 Fuel pump control unit 5/15/20 ● Positions not containing a fuse do not ap-
pear in the following tables.
49 Starter motor; clutch sensor 5 17 Engine control unit 7.5
● Some of the equipment listed in the tables
52 Driving mode. 15 18 Terminal 30 (positive reference) 5 below pertain only to certain versions of the
model or are optional extras.
53 Heated rear window 30 19 Front windscreen washer 30
● Please note that the above lists, while cor-
20 Alarm horn 10 rect at the time of printing, are subject to
Fuse arrangement in engine compartment
change.
22 Engine control unit 5
No. Consumers/Amps
23 Starter motor 30
1 ESP control unit 25

2 ESP control unit 40/60


24 PTC 40 Changing bulbs
31 Electronic differential CUPRA 15
Engine control unit (diesel/pet- Topic introduction
3 30/15
rol) 33 Automatic gearbox pump 30
4 Engine sensors 5/10 Read the additional information carefully
›››  page 59.
5 Engine sensors 7.5/10
Changing bulbs requires a certain degree of
6 Brake light sensor 5
practical skill.
98
Fuses and bulbs

If you choose to change the engine compart- WARNING ● Before changing a bulb, make sure you

Technical data
ment lamps yourself, remember that it is a have the correct new bulb.
● Take particular care when working on com-
dangerous area ››› in Work in the engine ● Do not touch the glass part of the bulb with
ponents in the engine compartment if the en-
compartment on page 268. your bare hands, use a cloth or paper towel
gine is warm. Risk of burns.
Always use identical bulbs with the same ● Bulbs are highly sensitive to pressure. The
instead, since the fingerprints left on the
designation. The name can be found on the glass will vaporise as a result of the heat gen-
glass can break when you touch the bulb,
base of the bulb holder. erated by the bulb, they will be deposited on
causing injury.
the reflector and will impair its surface.
Depending on how equipped the vehicle is, ● When changing bulbs, please take care not
● Depending on the level of equipment fitted

Advice
there are different sets of headlights and tail to injure yourself on sharp edges, in particu-
in the vehicle, LEDs may be used for part or
lights: lar on the headlight housing.
all of the interior and/or exterior lighting.
LEDs have an estimated life that exceeds than
● Halogen headlights.
CAUTION that of the car. If an LED light fails, go to an
● Full-LED main headlights* authorised workshop for its replacement.
● Remove the ignition key before working on
● Halogen headlights with LED daytime run-

Operation
the electric system. Otherwise, a short circuit
ning lights* could occur.
● Rear bulb light ● Switch off the lights and the parking light
● LED rear light*
before changing a bulb.
● Take good care to avoid damaging any com-
Full-LED headlight system* ponents.

Emergencies
Full-LED headlights handle all light functions
(daylight, side light, turn signal, dipped For the sake of the environment
beam and route light) with light emitting di- Please ask your specialist retailer how to dis-
odes (LEDs) as a light source. pose of used bulbs in the proper manner.

Full-LED headlights are designed to last the


lifetime of the car and light bulbs cannot be Note
replaced. In case of headlight failure, go to

Safety
● Please check at regular intervals that all
an authorised workshop to have it replaced. lighting (especially the exterior lighting) on
your vehicle is functioning properly. This is
not only in the interest of your own safety,
but also that of all other road users.

99
Emergencies

Change the front bulbs – Remove connector ››› Fig. 103 2 from the Turn signal bulb
bulb.
Dipped headlight bulb – Unclip the retainer spring ››› Fig. 103 3
pressing inwards to the right.
– Extract the bulb and fit the replacement so
that the lug on the base fits into the recess
on the reflector.

Day light bulb

Fig. 105 Turn signal bulb.

Fig. 102 Dipped beam headlights.

Fig. 104 Day light bulb.

– Raise the bonnet. Fig. 106 Turn signal bulb.


– Turn the bulb holder ››› Fig. 104 1 to the
left and pull. – Raise the bonnet.
Fig. 103 Dipped beam headlights.
– Remove the bulb by pressing on the bulb – Move the loop ››› Fig. 105 1 in the direc-
– Raise the bonnet. tion of the arrow and remove the cover.
holder and turning it anti-clockwise at the
– Move the loops ››› Fig. 102 1 in the direc- same time. – Turn the bulb holder ››› Fig. 106 2 anti-
tion of the arrow and remove the cover. – Installation involves all of the above steps clockwise and pull.
in reverse sequence.
100
Fuses and bulbs

– Remove the bulb by pressing on the bulb – Raise the bonnet. Fog light bulb*

Technical data
holder and turning it anti-clockwise at the
– Move the loop ››› Fig. 107 1 in the direc- 3 Valid only for versions with incandescent bulbs
same time.
tion of the arrow and remove the cover.
– Installation involves all of the above steps
– Slide connector ››› Fig. 108 2 to the left or
in reverse sequence.
right and pull.
– Remove the bulb by disconnecting the con-
Main beam headlight bulb nector.

Advice
– Installation involves all of the above steps
in reverse sequence.

Operation
Fig. 107 Main beam headlight bulb.

Emergencies
Fig. 109 Fog light: extracting the grille. »

Safety
Fig. 108 Main beam headlight bulb.

101
Emergencies

Note The table corresponds to a right-hand traffic


vehicle. The position of lights may vary ac-
● Due to the difficulty of accessing fog light cording to the country.
bulbs, have them replaced at a Technical
Service or specialised workshop.
● LED fog lights should only be replaced by
specialised personnel.

Changing incandescent rear


Fig. 110 Fog light: remove the bulb holder
light bulbs
Follow the steps indicated:
Rear lights summary
1. Remove the screw ››› Fig. 109 1  from
the fog light grille using a screwdriver Tail lights on side panel
and extract the grille.
Turn signal PY21W NA LL
2. Remove the 3 screws ››› Fig. 109 2 .
3. Remove the metal clip situated on the Side light and brake light P21W LL
upper part of the fog light by pulling
away from the vehicle 3  and extract Tail lights on the rear lid
the fog light.
Left side
4. Remove the connector ››› Fig. 110 1
from the bulb. Side lights 2x W5W LL

5. Turn the bulb holder 2 anti-clockwise Fog lights H21 W


and pull.
6. Remove the bulb by pressing on the Right side
bulb holder and turning it anticlockwise
Side lights 2x W5W LL
at the same time.
7. Installation involves all of the above Reverse light P21W LL
steps in reverse sequence.
8. Check that the bulb works properly.
102
Fuses and bulbs

Rear bulbs (in the side panel) CAUTION

Technical data
Take care when removing the rear light unit to
make sure there is no damage to the paint-
work or any of its components.

Note
Make sure you have a soft cloth ready to
place under the glass on the rear light unit, to

Advice
avoid any scratches.
Fig. 112 Retaining tabs on reverse side of tail
light.

– Check which of the bulbs is defective.

Operation
– Open the rear lid.
– Remove the cover by prying the flat side of
a screwdriver into the recess and remove
the cover from the opening ››› Fig. 111 1 .
– Carefully loosen the screw located behind

Emergencies
the cover with a screwdriver, turning it anti-
clockwise (arrows) ››› Fig. 111 2 .
Fig. 111 Luggage compartment: location of
the bolt securing the tail light unit. Remove – Tilt the light in the direction of the arrows
the rear light unit from side panel. until it comes out of its housing (positions
3 and 4 ) ››› Fig. 111.

– Remove the bulb holder ››› Fig. 112 unlock-


ing the retaining tabs 1 .

Safety
– Change the damaged bulb.
– To refit follow the steps in reverse order,
taking special care when fitting the bulb
holder. The securing tabs must click into
place.
103
Emergencies

Rear light bulbs (in the rear lid) – Reinstall the bulb holder, making sure that
locking clips A ››› Fig. 113  are properly
clipped on.
– Replace the cover of the rear lid lining.

Rear LED light bulb (in the rear lid)

Fig. 114 Position of the bulbs in the bulb


holder

The rear lid must be open to change the


bulbs.
– Remove the rear lid cover in the direction
indicated ››› Fig. 113 .
– Unlock the retaining tabs A of the bulb
holder, following the direction of arrows 1 Fig. 115 Remove the cover from the rear lid
and 2 ››› Fig. 113 .
– Remove the bulb holder, moving it in the
Fig. 113 Remove the cover from the boot lid direction of arrow 3 ››› Fig. 113 .
and detach the bulb holder.
– Lightly press the defective bulb into the
bulb holder 1 , then turn it to the left 2
and remove it ››› Fig. 114.
– Fit the new bulb, pressing it into the bulb
holder and turn it to the right as far as it
will go.
– Use a cloth to remove any fingerprints from Fig. 116 Remove the bulb holder.
the glass part of the bulb.
– Check that the new bulb works properly.
104
Fuses and bulbs

The rear lid must be open to change the Note

Technical data
bulbs.
Depending on how equipped the vehicle is,
– Remove the rear lid cover in the direction the number plate lights may be LEDs. LEDs
indicated ››› Fig. 115. have an estimated life that exceeds than that
of the car. If a light with LEDs fails, go to an
– Turn the reverse lights bulb holder anti-
authorised workshop for replacement.
clockwise in the direction of the arrow 1
››› Fig. 116.
– Remove the bulb holder from its housing

Advice
2 .
Fig. 118 Number plate light: Remove the bulb
– Change the defective bulb and reinstall the
holder.
bulb holder in its housing, following these
instructions in reverse order. Follow the steps indicated:

Operation
– Check that the new bulb works properly. 1. Press the number plate light in the direc-
tion of the arrow ››› Fig. 117.
2. Remove the number plate light.
Changing number plate light bulbs
3. Turn the connector lock ››› Fig. 118 in the
direction of arrow 1 and pull on the con-

Emergencies
nector.
4. Rotate the bulb holder in the direction of
arrow 2 and extract it with the bulb.
5. Replace the defective bulb with a new
bulb with the same features.
6. Insert the bulb holder in the number plate

Safety
light and turn in the opposite direction of
arrow 2 until it stops.
Fig. 117 In the rear bumper: number plate
light. 7. Plug the connector into the bulb holder.

105
Operation

Fig. 119 Instruments and controls.

106
Controls and displays

Operation 9 Control lever for: 18 Depending on the equipment:

Technical data
– Windscreen wipers and washer . . 143 – USB/AUX-IN input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
– Wipe and wash system . . . . . . . . . . 143 – Connectivity Box/Wireless Charg-
Controls and displays er* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
– On-board computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Depending on equipment fitted: ra- – Storage compartment
General instrument panel 10
dio or display for Easy Connect 19 Depending on equipment fitted,
1 Door release lever (navigation, radio, TV/video) . . . . . . 114 gear lever or selector lever for:

Advice
2 Central locking switch . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 11 Depending on the equipment, but- – Manual gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
3 Electric control to adjust exterior tons for: – Automatic gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 – SEAT driving modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224 20 Electronic parking brake switch . . . 177
4 Air outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 – Start-Stop system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196 21 Auto Hold switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
5 Control lever for: – Park assist system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232 22 Starter button (Keyless Access lock-

Operation
– Turn signals and main beam – Hazard warning lights . . . . . . . . . . 140 ing and ignition system) . . . . . . . . . . 174
headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 – Tyre pressure switch . . . . . . . . . . . . 283 23 Driver's seat heating control . . . . . . 149
– Lane Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218 – Airbag off display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85 24 Ignition lock (vehicles without Key-
– Main beam assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 12 Depending on the equipment, less Access) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
– Cruise control system (CCS) . . . . . 200 glove compartment with: . . . . . . . . . 153 25 Knee airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20

Emergencies
6 Depending on equipment fitted: – CD player* and/or SD card* 26 Adjustable steering column . . . . . . . 19
– Lever for cruise control . . . . . . . . . . 200 ››› Booklet Radio 27 Storage compartment
7 Steering wheel with horn and
13 Tyre pressure switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283 28 Bonnet lock release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
– Driver airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
14 Front passenger airbag switch . . . . 85 29 Headlight range control . . . . . . . . . . . 141
– On-board computer controls . . . . 33
15 Front passenger airbag . . . . . . . . . . . 19 30 Headlight switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
– Controls for radio, telephone,
16 Passenger seat heating control . . . . 149 31 Electric windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131

Safety
navigation and speech dialogue 17 Depending on the equipment, con-
system ››› Booklet Radio trols for: Note
– Paddle levers for tiptronic gear- – Heating and ventilation system or ● Some of the equipment listed in this sec-
shift (automatic gearbox) . . . . . . . 187 manual air conditioner . . . . . . . . . . 51, 50 tion is only fitted on certain models or are op-
8 Instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 – Automatic air conditioner . . . . . . . 48 tional extras. »
107
Operation

● A separate Instructions Manual is enclosed ● The arrangement of switches and controls ››› page 106. However, the symbols used to
if the vehicle is equipped with a factory-fitted on right-hand drive models* may be slightly identify the controls are the same.
radio, CD player, AUX IN connection or navi- different from the layout shown in
gation system.

Instruments and warning/control lamps


Instruments
View of instrument panel

Fig. 120 Instrument panel, on dash panel.

Details of the instruments ››› Fig. 120: 1 Revolution counter (with the engine run- The beginning of the red zone of the rev
ning, in hundreds of revolutions per mi- counter indicates the maximum speed in
nute). any gear after running-in and with the
108
Instruments and warning/control lamps

engine hot. However, it is advisable to For the sake of the environment ● Active cylinder management display

Technical data
change up a gear or move the selector (ACT®)* ››› page 193
lever to D (or lift your foot off the acceler- Changing up a gear in time reduces fuel con-
sumption and noise. ● Signs recognised by the traffic signal de-
ator) before the needle reaches the red tection system ››› page 228
zone ››› .
● Low consumption driving status (ECO)
2 Engine coolant temperature display ››› page 110
››› page 111 or the natural gas level indi- Indications on the display
● Identifying letters on engine (MKB).
cator in vehicles with natural gas engine
A variety of information can be viewed on the
(CNG) ››› page 112.

Advice
instrument panel display ››› Fig. 120 3 , de- Distance travelled
3 Displays on the screen ›››  page 38, pending on the vehicle equipment:
››› page 109. The odometer registers the total distance
● Bonnet, rear lid and doors open travelled by the car.
4 Adjuster button and display
››› page 111. ›››  page 38. The odometer (trip) shows the distance
5 Speedometer.
● Warning and information messages travelled since the last odometer reset. The

Operation
›››  page 38. last digit of the trip recorder indicates distan-
6 Fuel gauge ››› page 112. ces of 100 metres or one tenths of a mile.
● Distance travelled ››› page 111.
WARNING ● Time ››› page 109. ● Briefly press the button ››› Fig. 120 4 to re-
Any distraction may lead to an accident, with ● Navigation instructions. set the trip recorder to 0.
the risk of injury. ● Outside temperature ›››  page 39. ● Keep the button 4 pressed for about 3

Emergencies
● Do not operate the instrument panel con- seconds and the previous value will be dis-
● Compass ››› page 110.
trols when driving. played.
● Shift lever position ››› page 185.

CAUTION
● Recommended gear (manual gearbox) Time
›››  page 39. ● To set the time, keep the button ››› Fig. 120
● To prevent damage to the engine, the rev
● Multifunction display (MFD) and menus 4 pressed for more than 3 seconds to select
counter needle should only remain in the red
zone for a short period of time. with different setting options ›››  page 33. the hour or minute display.

Safety
● When the engine is cold, avoid high revs ● Service interval display ›››  page 41. ● To continue setting the time, press the up-
and heavy acceleration and do not make the ● Second speed display ›››  page 33. per or lower part of the button 4 . Hold but-
engine work hard. ton down to scroll through the numbers
● Speed warning function ›››  page 40.
quickly. »
● Start-Stop system status display
››› page 196.
109
Operation

● Press the button 4 again in order to finish The second speed display can be adjusted in letters of the vehicle engine (MKB). To do
setting the time. the Easy Connect system via the  button this, the ignition must be switched on and
and the SETTINGS function button the engine switched off.
The time can also be set via the  button ››› page 114.
and the SETTINGS function button in the Easy WARNING
Connect system ››› page 114. Speed warning Observe the safety warnings ››› in Warning
When the speed setting is exceeded, this will and control lamps on page 113.
Compass
be indicated on the instrument panel display.
With the ignition on and the navigation sys- This is very useful, for example when using WARNING
tem on, the cardinal point corresponding to winter tyres that are not designed for driving
the direction of travel of the vehicle is dis- Even though outside temperatures are above
at the maximum speed of the vehicle
played on the instrument panel. freezing, some roads and bridges may be icy.
›››  page 40.
● At outside temperatures above +4°C
Selector lever position The speed warning settings can be adjusted (+39°F), even when the “ice crystal symbol”
in the Easy Connect system via the  button is not visible, there may still be patches of ice
The selected gear is displayed on the side of and the SETTINGS function button on the road.
the selector lever and on the instrument pan- ››› page 114. ● Do not rely on the outside temperature in-
el display. In positions D and S, and with the
dicator!
Tiptronic, the corresponding gear is also dis- Start-Stop operating display
played.
Updated information relating to the status is Note
Recommended gear (manual gearbox) displayed on the instrument panel
● Different versions of the instrument panel
››› page 196. are available and therefore the versions and
The recommended gear in order to save fuel
is displayed on the instrument panel while instructions on the display may vary. In the
Low consumption driving status (ECO)* case of displays without warning or informa-
you are driving ›››  page 39.
Depending on the equipment, when driving, tion texts, faults are indicated exclusively by
the “ECO” display appears on the instrument the warning lamps.
Second speed display (mph or km/h)
panel when the vehicle is in low consump- ● Depending on the equipment, some set-
In addition to the speedometer, the speed tion status due to active cylinder manage- tings and instructions can also be carried out
can also be displayed in a different unit of ment (ACT®)* ››› page 193. in the Easy Connect system.
measurement (in miles or in km per hour). ● When several warnings are active at the
This option cannot be deactivated in models Identifying letters on engine (MKB) same time, the symbols are shown succes-
destined for countries in which the second sively for a few seconds and will stay on until
Hold the button ››› Fig. 120 4 down for more the fault is rectified.
speed must always be visible. than 15 seconds to display the identifying
110
Instruments and warning/control lamps

Revolution counter For the sake of the environment The trip recorder shows the distance that has

Technical data
been travelled since it was last reset. It is
The rev counter indicates the number of en- Changing up a gear early will help you to save used to measure short trips. The last digit of
fuel and minimise emissions and engine
gine revolutions per minute ››› Fig. 120 1 . the trip recorder indicates distances of 100
noise.
metres or tenths of a mile.
Together with the gear-change indicator, the
rev counter offers you the possibility of using The trip recorder can be set to zero by press-
the engine of your vehicle at a suitable Odometer ing 0.0/SET ››› Fig. 121.
speed.

Advice
The start of the red zone on the dial indicates Fault display
the maximum engine speed which may be If there is a fault in the instrument panel, the
used briefly when the engine is warm and af- letters DEF will appear in the trip recorder
ter it has been run in properly. Before reach- display. Have the fault repaired immediately,
ing this range, you should change to a higher as far as is possible.
gear for vehicles with a manual gearbox or for

Operation
automatic gearboxes put the selector lever in
“D” or take your foot off the accelerator ped- Coolant temperature gauge
al.
We recommend that you avoid high revs and For vehicles with no coolant temperature
that you follow the recommendations on the Fig. 121 Instrument panel: odometer and re- gauge, a control lamp  appears for high
set button. coolant temperatures ››› page 272. Please

Emergencies
gear-change indicator. Consult the additional
information in ›››  page 39, Gear-change note ››› .
indicator. The distance covered is displayed in “kilome-
The coolant temperature gauge 2
tres” or miles “m”. It is possible to change
the measurement units (kilometres
››› Fig. 120 only works when the ignition is
CAUTION switched on. In order to avoid engine dam-
“km”/miles “m”) in the radio/Easy Connect*.
Never allow the rev counter needle 1 age, please read the following notes for the
Please refer to the Easy Connect* Instructions
››› Fig. 120 to go into the red zone on the different temperature ranges.
Manual for more details.
scale for more than a very brief period, other-

Safety
wise there is a risk of engine damage. Engine cold
Odometer/trip recorder
If only the diodes in the lower part of the
The odometer shows the total distance cov-
scale light up, this indicates that the engine
ered by the vehicle.
has not yet reached operating temperature. »

111
Operation

Avoid high revs and heavy acceleration and and high engine loads, there is a risk of the The green warning lamp  lights up when the
do not make the engine work hard. engine overheating. vehicle is running in natural gas operating
● The front spoiler also ensures proper distri-
mode.
Normal temperature bution of the cooling air when the vehicle is The green warning lamp  switches off when
If in normal operations, the diodes light up moving. If the spoiler is damaged this can re- the natural gas is exhausted. The engine
until the central zone, it means that the en- duce the cooling effect, which could cause changes to operate with petrol.
gine has reached operating temperature. At the engine to overheat. Seek specialist assis-
tance. Problem: If the vehicle is left parked for a
high outside temperatures and when making
long time immediately after refuelling, the
the engine work hard, the diodes may contin-
natural gas level indicator may not accurately
ue lighting up and reach the upper zone. This
indicate the same level shown after refuelling
is no cause for concern, provided the control Fuel - Gas level
when the vehicle is started up again. This is
lamp  does not light up on the instrument
not due to a leak in the system, but to a drop
panel digital display.
in pressure in the gas tank for technical rea-
sons after a cooling phase just after refuel-
Heat range
ling.
When the diodes light up in the upper area of
the display and the control lamp appears 
on the instrument panel display, the coolant Fuel level - Petrol/Diesel
temperature is excessive ››› page 272.

CAUTION
● To ensure a long useful life for the engine,
Fig. 122 Fuel gauge.
avoid high revs, driving at high speed and
making the engine work hard for approxi-
mately the first 15 minutes when the engine Displays 2 and 6 ››› Fig. 120 only work
is cold. The phase until the engine is warm al- when the ignition is switched on. When the
so depends on the outside temperature. If display reaches the reserve mark, the lower
necessary, use the engine oil temperature* diode lights up in red and the control lamp 
›››  page 40 as a guide. appears ››› page 108. When the fuel level is
● Additional lights and other accessories in very low, the lower diode flashes in red.
Fig. 123 Fuel gauge.
front of the air inlet reduce the cooling effect The yellow control lamp  lights up when the
of the coolant. At high outside temperatures reserve level has been reached. The display 6 ››› Fig. 120 only works when
the ignition is switched on. When the display
112
Instruments and warning/control lamps

reaches the reserve mark, the lower diode Depending on the model, additional text ● In any vehicle, the engine compartment is a

Technical data
lights up in red and the control lamp  ap- messages may be viewed on the instrument hazardous area and could cause severe inju-
pears ››› page 108. When the fuel level is very panel display. These may be purely informa- ries ››› page 268.
low, the lower diode flashes in red. tive or they may be advising of the need for
action ››› page 108, Instruments.
The distance to empty fuel level is displayed CAUTION
on the instrument panel 3 ››› Fig. 120. Depending upon the equipment fitted in the Failure to heed the control lamps and text
vehicle, instead of a warning lamp, some- messages when they appear may result in
The capacity of the fuel tank of your vehicle is
times a symbol may be displayed on the in- faults in the vehicle.
given in the Technical data section

Advice
strument panel.
›››  page 53.
When certain control and warning lamps are
CAUTION lit, an audible warning is also heard.
Never run the fuel tank completely dry. An ir-
regular fuel supply could cause misfiring. In WARNING
this way the unburned fuel can reach the ex- If the warning lamps and messages are ignor-

Operation
haust system, which could cause the catalytic ed, the vehicle may stall in traffic, or may
converter to overheat resulting in damage. cause accidents and severe injuries.
● Never ignore the warning lamps or text
messages.
Control lamps ● Stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible.

Emergencies
● Park the vehicle away from traffic and en-
Warning and control lamps sure that there are no highly flammable ma-
terials under the vehicle that could come into
Read the additional information carefully contact with the exhaust system (e.g. dry
grass, fuel).
›››  page 43.
● A faulty vehicle represents a risk of acci-
The control and warning lamps are indicators dent for the driver and for other road users. If
of warnings, ››› , faults ››› or certain func- necessary, switch on the hazard warning

Safety
tions. Some control and warning lamps come lamps and put out the warning triangle to ad-
on when the ignition is switched on, and vise other drivers.
switch off when the engine starts running, or ● Before opening the bonnet, switch off the
while driving. engine and allow it to cool.

113
Operation

Introduction to the Easy Function buttons in the Page


vehicle settings
Connect system* menu
ESC system ››› page 181
System settings (CAR)*
Tyres ››› page 281
CAR menu Driver assistance ››› table on page 30
Read the additional information carefully Parking and manoeuvring ››› page 232
›››  page 30
Vehicle lights ››› table on page 30
To select the settings menus, depending on
the version, either press the Easy Connect Mirrors and windscreen wipers ››› table on page 30
 button and the SETTINGS function button,
Opening and closing ››› table on page 30
OR press the  button, then Vehicle and
then the SETTINGS function button. Multifunction display ››› table on page 30
The actual number of menus available and Date and time ››› table on page 30
the name of the various options in these me-
Units ››› table on page 30
nus will depend on the vehicle’s electronics
and equipment. Service ››› page 109
Pressing the menu button will always take Factory settings ››› table on page 30
you to the last menu used.
When the function button check box is activa- WARNING
ted , the function is active. Any distraction may lead to an accident, with
the risk of injury. Operating the Easy Connect
Pressing the menu button  will always take
system while driving could distract you from
you to the last menu used.
traffic.
Any changes made using the settings menus
are automatically saved on closing those me-
nus.

114
Communications and multimedia

Communications and multi-

Technical data
media
Steering wheel controls*
General information
The steering wheel includes a multifunction

Advice
module from where it is possible to control
the audio, telephone and radio/navigation
functions without needing to distract the
driver.
There are two versions of the multifunction

Operation
module:
● Audio system + telephone without voice
control version (MID): for controlling the au-
dio functions available (radio, audio CD,
MP3, iPod®1), USB1), SD1)) and Bluetooth sys-

Emergencies
tem from the steering wheel.
● Audio system + telephone with voice con-
trol version (HIGH): for controlling the audio
functions available (radio, audio CD, MP3,
iPod®1), USB1), SD1)) and Bluetooth system
from the steering wheel.

Safety
1) Depending on the vehicle equipment.
115
Operation

Operating the telephone and audio system without voice control (MID)

Fig. 124 Controls on the steering wheel.

Button Radio Media (except AUX) AUX Telephone Navigation


Turn: Turn volume up/down Turn: Turn volume up/down Turn: Turn volume up/down Turn: Turn volume up/down Turn: Turn volume up/down
A
Press: Mute Press: Mute Press: Mute Press: Mute Press: Mute

Short press: answer/hang up


calls, enable/open the tele-
Short press: access to the tele- Short press: access to the tele- Short press: access to the tele- Short press: access to the tele-
phone menu.
B phone menu in the instrument phone menu in the instrument phone menu in the instrument phone menu in the instrument
Hold down: reject an incoming
panela). panela). panela). panela).
call/switch to private mode/re-
diala).

Short press: switch to the previ-


C Search for last station ous song No function No function No function
Hold down: quick rewind

Short press: switch to the next


D Search for the next station song No function No function No function
Hold down: fast forward

Change menu on instrument Change menu on instrument Change menu on instrument Change menu on instrument Change menu on instrument
E , F
panela) panela) panela) panela) panela)

G MID: change source MID: change source MID: change source MID: change source MID: change source

116
Communications and multimedia

Button Radio Media (except AUX) AUX Telephone Navigation

Technical data
Turn: Changes menu or memory
Turn: Next/previous presetb) Turn: Next/previous songb) Turn: No function Turn: Acts on the MFD on instrument panel
H
Press: Acts on the MFD Press: Acts on the MFD Press: Acts on the MFD Press: Confirm Press: Operates on instrument
panel
a) According to the vehicle's equipment package.
b) Only if the dash panel is in audio menu.

Advice
Operating the telephone and audio system with voice control (HIGH)

Operation
Emergencies
Fig. 125 Controls on the steering wheel.

Button Radio Media (except AUX) AUX Telephonea) Navigationa)


Turn: Turn volume up/down Turn: Turn volume up/down Turn: Turn volume up/down Turn: Turn volume up/down Turn: Turn volume up/down
A
Press: Mute Press: Mute Press: Mute Press: Mute Press: Mute

Short press: answer/hang up

Safety
Short press: access to the tele- Short press: access to the tele- Short press: access to the tele- calls, enable/open the tele- Short press: access to the tele-
phone menu on the dash pan- phone menu on the dash pan- phone menu on the dash pan- phone menu. phone menu on the dash pan-
B
ela). ela). ela). Hold down: reject an incoming ela).
Hold down: rediala) Hold down: rediala) Hold down: rediala) call/switch to private/redial Hold down: rediala) »
mode

117
Operation

Button Radio Media (except AUX) AUX Telephonea) Navigationa)


Short press: switch to the previ-
Radio/media functionality (ex-
C Search for last station ous song No function No functionb)
cept AUX )
Hold down: quick rewind

Short press: switch to the next


Radio/media functionality (ex-
D Search for the next station song No function No functionb)
cept AUX )
Hold down: fast forward

Change menu on instrument Change menu on instrument Change menu on instrument Change menu on instrument Change menu on instrument
E , F
panel panel panel panel panel

G Enable/disable voice controla) Enable/disable voice controla) Enable/disable voice controla) No functionb) Enable/disable voice control

Turn: Acts upon the dash panel Turn: Acts upon the dash panel Turn: Acts upon the dash panel
Turn: Next/previous presetc) Turn: Next/previous songc) menu depending on where it is menu depending on where it is menu depending on where it is
Press: Acts on the MFD or con- Press: Acts on the MFD or con- located located located
H firms the menu option of the firms the menu option of the Press: Acts on the MFD or con- Press: Acts on the MFD or con- Press: Acts on the MFD or con-
dash panel depending on the dash panel depending on the firms the menu option of the firms the menu option of the firms the menu option of the
menu option menu option dash panel depending on the dash panel depending on the dash panel depending on the
menu option menu option menu option
a) According to the vehicle's equipment package.
b) When a call is being made, radio/media functionality (except AUX).
c) Only if the dash panel is in audio menu.

118
Communications and multimedia

Multimedia Connectivity Box* / Wireless Charger* With the Wireless Charger you only have the

Technical data
wireless charging function if your mobile de-
vice has Qi technology.
USB/AUX-INPort
The Connectivity Box/Wireless Charger is in
the storage compartment area of the centre
console ››› Fig. 128.
The operating description is located in the re-
Fig. 127 Related video spective Instruction Manuals of the audio

Advice
system or the navigation system.

Note
Your mobile device must support the Qi wire-
less inductive charging interface standard for
proper operation.

Operation
Fig. 126 Centre console: USB/AUX-IN input.

Depending on the special characteristics and


the country, the vehicle may have a
USB/AUX-IN port.
The USB/AUX-IN port can be found in the Fig. 128 Centre console: Connectivity Box.

Emergencies
storage compartment area of the centre con-
sole ››› Fig. 126. Depending on the features and the country,
the vehicle may have one of these two op-
The operating description is located in the re- tions: Connectivity Box or Wireless Charger.
spective Instruction Manuals of the audio
system or the navigation system. With the Connectivity Box you can charge
your mobile device wirelessly with Qi1) tech-
nology, while also reducing the radiation in

Safety
the vehicle and getting better reception.

1) Qi technology allows you to charge your mobile

phone wirelessly.
119
Operation

Opening and closing The vehicle is unlocked again when the igni-
tion key is removed. Alternatively, the vehicle
the alarm from being triggered accidentally
››› page 130.
can also be unlocked via the central locking
Central locking system switch or by pulling one of the inside door Turn signals
handles. The Auto Lock function can be
The turn signals will flash twice when the ve-
Description switched on and off on the sound system or
hicle is unlocked and once when the vehicle
on the Easy Connect* system ››› page 123.
is locked.
Read the additional information carefully
›››  page 13 In the event of an accident in which the air-
If it does not flash, this indicates that one of
bags inflate, the doors will be automatically
the doors, the rear lid or the bonnet is not
The vehicle can be locked and unlocked via unlocked to facilitate access and assistance.
closed correctly.
the central locking system. There are several
methods, depending on the vehicle equip- Anti-theft alarm system*
ment: Accidental lock-out
If the anti-theft alarm system senses interfer-
The central locking system prevents you from
● key with remote control ››› page 122, ence with the vehicle it triggers an audible
being locked out of the vehicle in the follow-
and visible alarm.
● lock on driver door (emergency opening ing situations:
›››  page 13) or The anti-theft alarm system is automatically
● If the driver door is open, the vehicle can-
● interior central locking switch ››› page 123. switched on when locking the vehicle. It
switches off when the vehicle is unlocked not be locked with the central locking switch
from a distance. ››› page 123.
Unlocking one side of the vehicle only
When you lock the vehicle with the key, the When the driver door is unlocked with the Lock the vehicle with the remote control key,
doors and the rear lid are locked. When you key, you should switch on the ignition within when all the doors and the rear lid have been
open the door, you can either unlock only the 15 seconds. Otherwise the alarm will be trig- closed. This prevents the accidental locking
driver door, or all the vehicle doors. To select gered. On some export versions, the alarm is of the vehicle.
the required option, use Easy Connect* triggered immediately when you open a door.
››› page 123. WARNING
To deactivate the alarm, press the button 
on the remote control key, or switch on the Do not leave anyone (especially children) in
Automatic locking (Auto Lock)* ignition. After a certain time, the alarm will the vehicle if it is locked from the outside and
automatically switch off. the anti-theft security system* is enabled, as
The Auto Lock function locks the doors and the doors and windows cannot then be
the rear lid when the vehicle exceeds a speed Switch off the vehicle interior monitoring and opened from the inside. Locked doors could
of about 15 km/h (9 mph). tow-away protection if you wish to prevent delay assistance in an emergency, potentially
putting lives at risk.

120
Opening and closing

Note a longer period the control lamp flashes sev-

Technical data
eral times, such as in convenience opening.
● Never leave any valuable items in the vehi-
cle unattended. Even a locked vehicle is not a If the vehicle key control lamp does not light
safe. up when the button is pressed, replace the
● If the diode on the driver door sill lights up key's battery ››› page 127.
for about 30 seconds when the vehicle is
locked, the central locking system or anti- Unfolding and folding the key shaft
theft alarm* is not working properly. You
Press button 1 ››› Fig. 129 or ››› Fig. 130 to

Advice
should have the fault repaired at a SEAT Offi-
unlock and unfold the key shaft.
cial Service or specialised workshop.
● The vehicle interior monitoring of the anti- Fig. 130 Vehicle key with alarm button. To fold the shaft away, press button 1 and
theft alarm* system will only function as in- fold the key shaft in until it locks in place.
tended if the windows and the sunroof* are Vehicle key
closed. With the vehicle key the vehicle may be Alarm button*

Operation
locked or unlocked remotely ››› page 120. Only press alarm button 2 in the event of an
The vehicle key includes an emitter and bat- emergency! When the alarm button is press-
Car key tery. The receiver is in the interior of the vehi- ed, the vehicle horn is heard and the turn sig-
cle. The range of the vehicle key with remote nals are switched on for a short time. When
control and new battery is several metres the alarm button is pressed again, the alarm
around the vehicle. is switched off.

Emergencies
If it is not possible to open or close the vehi- Spare key
cle using the remote control key, this should
be re-synchronised ››› page 127 or the bat- To obtain a spare key and other vehicle keys,
tery changed ››› page 127. the vehicle chassis number is required.

Different keys belonging to the vehicle may Each new key contains a microchip which
be used. must be coded with the data from the vehicle
electronic immobiliser. A vehicle key will not

Safety
Fig. 129 Vehicle key Control lamp on the vehicle key work if it does not contain a microchip or the
microchip has not been encoded. This is also
When a button on the vehicle key is pressed, true for keys which are specially cut for the
the control lamp flashes ››› Fig. 129 (arrow) vehicle. »
once briefly, but if the button is held down for

121
Operation

The vehicle keys or new spare keys can be against overloading. The vehicle is then un- ● Other functions of the remote control key
obtained from a SEAT Official Service, a spe- locked. Lock it if necessary. ››› page 132, Convenience opening/closing.
cialised workshop or an approved key service
qualified to create this kind of key.
New keys or spare keys must be synchron- Unlocking/Locking by remote control Selective unlocking system
ised before use ››› page 127.
Read the additional information carefully The selective unlocking system allows you to
CAUTION ›››  page 13 only unlock the driver door and the fuel tank
All of the vehicle keys contain electronic com- flap. All other doors and the rear lid remain
The vehicle will be locked again automatical-
ponents. Protect them from damage, impacts locked.
ly if you do not open one of the doors or the
and humidity. rear lid within 30 seconds after unlocking the
Unlocking the driver door and tank flap
car. This function prevents the vehicle from
Note remaining unlocked if the unlocking button is – Press button  on the remote control key
pressed by mistake. This does not apply if once, or turn the key once to open.
● Only use the key button when you require
the corresponding function. Pushing the but-
you press the button  for at least one sec-
ton unnecessarily could accidentally unlock ond. Unlocking all the doors, the rear lid and the
the vehicle or trigger the alarm. It is also pos- tank flap simultaneously.
In vehicles with a security central locking
sible even when you are outside the radius of feature (selective unlocking of side doors) – Within 5 seconds, press button  on the
action. ››› page 122, when the button  is pressed remote control key twice, or turn the key to
● Key operation can be greatly influenced by once, only the driver door and the fuel tank open twice within 5 seconds.
overlapping radio signals close to the vehicle flap are unlocked. When the button is press-
working in the same range of frequencies, for ed a second time, all the vehicle doors are The anti-theft security system* and the anti-
example, radio transmitters or mobile tele- unlocked. theft alarm* are immediately disabled if you
phones. unlock only the driver door, without unlock-
● Obstacles between the remote control and WARNING ing the other doors.
the vehicle, bad weather conditions and dis- In vehicles with Easy Connect*, you can pro-
charged batteries can considerably reduce Observe the safety warnings ››› in Descrip-
tion on page 120. gramme the security central locking system
the range of the remote control.
directly ››› page 123.
● If the buttons of the vehicle key are press-
ed ››› Fig. 129 or ››› Fig. 130 or one of the cen- Note
tral locking buttons ››› page 123 is pressed ● Do not use the remote control key until the
repeatedly in short succession, the central vehicle is visible.
locking briefly disconnects as protection
122
Opening and closing

Programming the central locking sys- when you unlock the vehicle. In all the op- ● You can open the doors individually from

Technical data
tem tions, the fuel tank flap is also unlocked. the inside by pulling the inside door handle.
With the Driver setting, when you press the ● In the event of an accident in which the air-
You can use Easy Connect* to select which  button on the remote control key only the bags inflate, doors locked from the inside will
doors are unlocked with the central locking door on the driver's side is unlocked. If that be automatically unlocked to facilitate access
system. Using the radio or the Easy Connect* button is pressed twice, the rest of the doors and assistance.
system, you can select whether the vehicle and the rear lid will be unlocked.
automatically closes with the “Auto Lock” WARNING
programme at speeds of more than 15 km/h In vehicles with a conventional key, turn the

Advice
● The central locking switch also operates
(9 mph). key in the door lock, in the direction of open-
ing, twice within 2 seconds. when the ignition is switched off and auto-
matically locks all the vehicle doors when the
Programming the unlocking of the doors (ve- If the button  is pressed, all the vehicle button  is pressed.
hicles with Easy Connect) doors are locked. At the same time, a confir- ● The central locking switch does not operate
– Select:  button > SETTINGS function mation signal* is heard. if the vehicle is locked from the outside and

Operation
button > Opening and closing > Cen- Auto Lock/Locking while driving. If the anti-theft security system is switched on.
tral locking > Unlocking doors. you select on, all the vehicle doors are ● Locked doors could delay assistance in an
locked at speeds above 15 km/h (9 mph). emergency, potentially putting lives at risk.
Programming the Auto Lock (vehicles with Do not leave anyone, especially children, in
Easy Connect) the vehicle.
– Select:  button > SETTINGS function Central locking switch

Emergencies
button > Opening and closing > Cen- Note
tral locking > Locking while Read the additional information carefully Your vehicle will lock automatically when it
driving. ›››  page 13 reaches a speed of about 15 km/h (9 mph)
(Auto Lock) ››› page 120. You can unlock the
Programming the Auto Lock (vehicles with Please note the following when using the vehicle again using button  on the central
radio) central locking switch to lock your vehicle: locking switch.
– Select: SETUP button > control button  ● It is not possible to open the doors or the

Safety
Central locking > Locking while rear lid from the outside (for safety reasons,
driving. e.g. when stopped at traffic lights).
● The LED in the central locking switch lights
Unlocking doors You can choose to un-
lock all the doors or only the driver door up when all the doors are closed and locked.

123
Operation

Related video Keyless Access Once the doors have been locked, they can-
not be opened again immediately. This will
enable you to check that the doors are prop-
erly closed.
If you wish, when unlocking, you can unlock
only the corresponding door or the entire ve-
hicle. The necessary adjustments can be per-
Fig. 131 Technology formed in vehicles with a driver information
system ›››  page 30.

Fig. 133 Keyless Access locking and ignition General information


Unlocking and locking the vehicle system: sensor surface A for unlocking in-
with Keyless Access* side the door handle and sensor surface B If a valid key is in the proximity of the car
for locking on the exterior of the handle. ››› Fig. 132, the Keyless Access locking and
starting system gives the key entry as soon
Depending on the equipment, the vehicle as one of the sensor surfaces on the front
may have the Keyless Access system. door handles is touched. The following fea-
tures are then available without having to
Keyless Access is a key-free locking and igni- use the vehicle key actively:
tion system to unlock and lock the vehicle
without actively using its key. To do this, all ● Keyless-Entry: unlocking the vehicle using
that is required is to have a valid vehicle key the handles of the front doors or the soft-
in the detection area where you are attempt- touch/handle on the rear lid.
ing to access the vehicle ››› Fig. 132 and to ● Keyless-Exit: locking the vehicle using the
touch one of the sensor surfaces on the door sensor of the driver or passenger door han-
Fig. 132 Keyless Access locking and ignition handles ››› Fig. 133 ››› . dle.
system: In the proximity of the car.
The vehicle can be unlocked and locked via ● Press & Drive: keyless starting of the en-
the front doors only. When doing so, the re- gine with the starter button ››› page 171.
mote control key must be no further than ap-
prox. 1.5 m from the door handle. The central locking and locking systems oper-
ate in the same way as a normal locking and
It does not matter where you carry the key, for unlocking system. Only the controls change.
instance whether it is in your jacket pocket or
in a briefcase.

124
Opening and closing

Unlocking the vehicle is confirmed with a ● Touch (once) the locking sensor surface B blocked for engine ignition ››› page 171. In

Technical data
double flash of the indicator lights; locking (arrow) on one of the front door handles. The order to enable engine ignition, the button
by a single flash. door that is used must be closed. on the key  inside the vehicle needs to be
pressed.
If the vehicle is locked and then all doors and
On vehicles with a “Safe” security system:
the rear lid are closed leaving the last key
shutting and locking doors (Keyless-Exit) Automatically disabling sensors
used inside the vehicle and none outside,
the vehicle will not lock immediately. All the ● Switch the ignition off. If the vehicle is not locked or unlocked for a
vehicle's indicator lights will flash four times. ● Close the driver's door. long period of time, the proximity sensors on
the passenger doors are automatically disa-

Advice
The vehicle will lock again after a few sec-
● Touch (once) the sensor surface B (arrow)
onds if you fail to open any door or the rear bled.
on one of the front door handles. The vehicle
lid.
locks with the “Safe” ››› page 126 system. If one of the sensor surfaces on the door han-
If you unlock the vehicle but fail to open any The door that is used must be closed. dles is often activated in an unusual manner
door or the rear lid, the vehicle will lock again ● Touch (twice) the sensor surface B (arrow) with the vehicle locked (e.g. by the branches
after a few seconds. of a bush rubbing against it), all proximity
of one of the front door handles to lock the

Operation
vehicle without activating the “Safe” security sensors are disabled for a certain period of
Unlocking and opening the doors (Keyless- time.
system ››› page 126.
Entry) Sensors will again be enabled:
● Grip one of the front door handles. In doing Unlocking and locking the rear lid
this, the sensor surface ››› Fig. 133 A (arrow) ● After a time.
When a locked vehicle is opened, the rear lid

Emergencies
on the handle is touched and the vehicle un- ● OR: if the vehicle is unlocked with the but-
automatically unlocks if there is a valid vehi-
locks. cle key in the proximity ››› Fig. 132. ton  on the key.
● Open the door. ● OR: if the rear lid is open.
Open or close the rear lid normally.
● OR: if the vehicle is unlocked manually with
On vehicles with selective opening or info- After closing, the rear lid locks automatically.
tainment system configuration, pulling the the key.
If the complete vehicle is unlocked, the rear
door handle twice will unlock all doors. lid will not lock automatically after closing it. Keyless Access temporary disconnection

Safety
On vehicles without a “Safe” security sys- function
What happens when locking the vehicle with
tem: shutting and locking doors (Keyless-Ex- a second key There is a sequence of actions to be followed
it) if you wish to temporarily deactivate Keyless
If there is a vehicle key inside the vehicle and Access. First of all, lock the vehicle with the
● Switch the ignition off.
it is locked from the outside with a second key. As of this moment, you have 5 seconds »
● Close the driver's door. vehicle key, the key inside the vehicle is
125
Operation

to perform the second locking action through (arrow) on one of the handles is activated ● If the sensors are very dirty, e.g. have a lay-
the door handle sensor. continuously, all windows will close. er of salt, the correct functioning of the sen-
If this second action is performed more than sors on the door handles may be affected. In
this case, clean the vehicle.
5 seconds after the vehicle is locked with the Note
key, it will not be possible to deactivate Key- ● If the vehicle is equipped with an automatic
● If the vehicle battery has little or no charge,
less Access. gearbox, it may only be locked in the gear
or the vehicle key battery is almost or entire- stick is in position P.
Once Keyless Access has been temporarily ly out of charge, you will probably not be able
deactivated, the vehicle can only be unlocked to lock or unlock the vehicle with the Keyless
using the key. The Keyless Access function Access system. The vehicle can be unlocked
will be reactivated once it has been unlocked. or locked manually ››› page 92. Anti-theft security system (Safelock)*
● To control the proper locking of the vehicle,
the release function is disabled for approx. 2 The following message is displayed on the in-
Convenience functions strument panel to remind the driver that
seconds.
To close all the electric windows and the sun- when the vehicle is closed from the outside,
● If the message Keyless access system
roof using the convenience function, keep a the anti-theft security system is switched on.
faulty is displayed on the screen of the
finger for a few seconds on the locking sen- dash panel, abnormalities may occur in the  Do not forget the Safelock.
sor surface ››› Fig. 133 B (arrow) of the door operation of the Keyless Access system. Con- Please see Instruction Manual. The
handle until the windows and roof have tact a specialised workshop. SEAT recom- vehicle cannot be opened from inside. This
closed. mends visiting a SEAT dealership for this. makes it more difficult for unauthorised per-
● Depending on the function set on the info- sons to break into the vehicle ››› in De-
The doors opened by touching the sensor
tainment system for the mirrors, the exterior scription on page 120.
surface of the door handle depend on the
settings that have been activated in the info- mirrors will unfold and the surround lighting The anti-theft security system can be switch-
tainment system with the  button and the will come on when unlocking the vehicle us- ed off each time the vehicle is locked:
SETTINGS and Opening and closing function but- ing the sensor surface on the driver and pas-
senger door handles ››› page 145. ● Turn the key a second time to the lock posi-
tons.
● If there is no valid key inside the vehicle or tion, in the door lock, within two seconds. If
CAUTION the system fails to detect one, a warning will necessary, remove the protective cover on
display on the dash panel screen. This could the driver door handle ›››  page 13 or
The sensor surfaces on the door handles happen if any other radio frequency signal in-
could engage if hit with a water jet or high ● Press  on the remote control key for a
terferes with the key signal (e.g. from a mo-
pressure steam if there is a valid vehicle key bile device accessory) or if the key is covered second time within 2 seconds.
in the proximity. If at least one of the electric by another object (e.g. an aluminium case).
windows is open and the sensor surface B The flashing frequency of the diode in the
door sill immediately confirms the process.
Initially, the diode flashes in a fast sequence
126
Opening and closing

for a brief period, then it stops for approxi- The battery is located to the rear of the vehi- For the sake of the environment

Technical data
mately 30 seconds and, lastly continues cle key, under a cover.
flashing slowly. Please dispose of your used batteries correct-
ly and with respect for the environment.
Changing the battery
● Unfold the vehicle key blade ››› page 121.
Replacing the battery ● Remove the cover from the back of the ve- Synchronising the vehicle key
hicle key ››› Fig. 134 in the direction of the ar-
row ››› . If the button  is pressed frequently outside

Advice
● Extract the battery from the compartment of the vehicle range, it is possible that the ve-
using a suitable thin object ››› Fig. 135. hicle can no longer be locked or unlocked us-
● Place the new battery in the compartment
ing the key. In this case, the key must be re-
synchronised as described below:
as shown ››› Fig. 135, pressing in the oppo-
site direction to that shown by the arrow ● Unfold the vehicle key blade ››› page 121.
››› .

Operation
● If necessary, remove the cover from the
● Fit the cover as shown ››› Fig. 134, pressing driver door lever ›››  page 13.
it onto the vehicle key casing in the opposite
● Press the button  on the vehicle key. For
Fig. 134 Vehicle key: opening the battery direction to that shown by the arrow until it
compartment. this, it must remain with the vehicle.
clicks into place.
● Open the vehicle within one minute using

Emergencies
CAUTION the key blade. The key has been synchron-
ised.
● If the battery is not changed correctly, the
vehicle key may be damaged. ● If necessary, fit the cap.
● Use of unsuitable batteries may damage
the vehicle key. For this reason, always re-
place the dead battery with another of the
same voltage, size and specifications.

Safety
● When fitting the battery, check that the po-
larity is correct.

Fig. 135 Vehicle key: removing the battery.

SEAT recommends you ask a specialised


workshop to replace the battery.
127
Operation

Childproof lock anti-clockwise for the right hand side ● The turn signal light will flash once on clos-
3 Applies to vehicles with 5 doors:
doors. ing and activating the alarm.

Deactivating the childproof lock When does the system trigger an alarm?
– Unlock the vehicle and open the door The anti-theft alarm siren will be triggered for
whose childproof lock you want to deacti- about 30 seconds accompanied by sound
vate. and optical (flashing) warning signals and
will be repeated about ten times when the
– With the door open, rotate the groove in
vehicle is locked and the following unauthor-
the door using the ignition key, anti-clock-
ised actions are attempted:
wise for the left hand side doors ››› Fig. 136
and clockwise for the right hand side ● Opening a door that is mechanically un-
doors. locked using the vehicle key without switch-
Fig. 136 Childproof lock on the left hand side ing on the ignition in the next 15 seconds (in
Once the childproof lock is activated, the
door. certain markets, such as the Netherlands,
door can only be opened from the outside.
there is no 15 second waiting time and the
The childproof lock can be activated or deac-
The childproof lock prevents the rear doors alarm is activated immediately on opening
tivated by inserting the key in the groove
from being opened from the inside. This sys- the door).
when the door is open, as described above.
tem prevents minors from opening a door ac- ● A door is opened.
cidentally while the vehicle is running. ● The bonnet is opened.
This function is independent of the vehicle
electronic opening and locking systems. It
Anti-theft alarm system* ● The rear lid is opened.
● When the ignition is switched on with a
only affects rear doors. It can only be activa-
Description non-authorised key.
ted and deactivated manually, as described
below: ● When the vehicle battery is disconnected.
The anti-theft alarm makes it more difficult to
● Movement inside the vehicle (in vehicles
break into the vehicle or steal it.
Activating the childproof lock with interior monitoring ››› page 130).
– Unlock the vehicle and open the door in The anti-theft alarm is automatically turned ● When the vehicle is towed (in vehicles with
which you wish to activate the childproof on when the vehicle is locked with the key. anti-tow system ››› page 130).
lock. ● The turn signal light will flash twice on ● When the vehicle is raised (in vehicles with
– With the door open, rotate the groove in opening and deactivating the alarm. anti-tow system ››› page 130).
the door using the ignition key, clockwise
for the left hand side doors ››› Fig. 136 and
128
Opening and closing

● When the vehicle is transported on a ferry ● If the vehicle battery is run down or flat – Press the button  on the remote control

Technical data
or by rail (vehicles with an anti-tow system or then the anti-theft alarm will not operate cor- twice. The volumetric sensor and tilt sen-
vehicle interior monitoring ››› page 130). rectly. sors will be deactivated. The alarm system
● When a trailer connected to the anti-theft ● Vehicle monitoring remains active even if remains activated.
alarm system is disconnected. the battery is disconnected or not working for
The vehicle interior monitoring and the anti-
any reason.
tow system are automatically switched on
How to turn OFF the alarm ● The alarm is triggered immediately if one of
again next time the vehicle is locked.
Unlock the vehicle with the unlocking button the battery cables is disconnected while the
alarm system is active. The vehicle interior monitoring and anti-tow

Advice
on the key or turn on the ignition with a valid
sensor (tilt sensor) are automatically switch-
key.
ed on when the anti-theft alarm is switched
on. In order to activate it, all the doors and
Note Vehicle interior monitoring and anti-
the rear lid must be closed.
● After 28 days, the indicator light will be tow system*
switched off to prevent the battery from ex- If you wish to switch off the vehicle interior

Operation
hausting if the vehicle has been left parked It is a monitoring or control function incorpo- monitoring and the anti-tow system, it must
for a long period of time. The alarm system rated in the anti-theft alarm* which detects be done each time that the vehicle is locked;
remains activated. unauthorised vehicle entry by means of ultra- if not, they will be automatically switched on.
● If, after the audible warning goes off, an- sound.
The vehicle interior monitoring and the anti-
other monitored area is accessed (e.g. the tow system should be switched off if animals
rear lid is opened after a door has been Activation are left inside the locked vehicle (otherwise,

Emergencies
opened), the alarm is triggered again. – It is automatically switched on when the their movements will trigger the alarm) or
● The anti-theft alarm is not activated when anti-theft alarm is activated. when, for example, the vehicle is transported
the vehicle is locked from within using the or has to be towed with only one axle on the
central locking button  . Deactivation ground.
● If the driver door is unlocked mechanically
– Open the vehicle with the key, either me- False alarms
with the key, only the driver door is unlocked,
the rest of the doors remain locked. Only
chanically or by pressing the  button on
Interior monitoring will only operate correctly
when the ignition has been turned on will the the remote control. The time period from

Safety
if the vehicle is completely closed. Please ob-
other doors be available - but not unlocked - when the door is opened until the key is in-
serve related legal requirements.
and the central locking button will be activa- serted in the contact should not exceed 15
ted. seconds, otherwise the alarm will be trig-
gered. The following cases may cause a false alarm:
● Open windows (partially or fully). »
129
Operation

● Panoramic/tilting sunroof open (partially or Deactivating the vehicle interior moni- Rear lid (luggage compart-
completely). toring and anti-tow systems*
● Movement of objects inside the vehicle,
ment)
such as loose papers, items hanging from When the vehicle is locked, the alarm will be
the rear vision mirror (air fresheners), etc. triggered if movements are detected in the Tailgate automatic lock
interior (e.g. by animals) or if the vehicle's in-
clination is changed (e.g. during transport). Where the vehicle has been locked by press-
Note
You can prevent the alarm from being trig- ing the  button on the remote control with
● If the vehicle is relocked and the alarm is the rear lid open, the rear lid will lock auto-
gered accidentally by switching off the vehi-
activated without the volumetric sensor func- matically when closed.
tion, relocking will activate the alarm with all cle interior monitoring and/or tow-away pro-
its functions, except the volumetric sensor. tection. The automatic tailgate locking time extension
This function is reactivated when the alarm is function can be activated. Where this func-
● To switch off the interior monitoring and
switched on again, unless it is deliberately tion is activated and once the rear lid has
switched off. tow-away protection, switch off the ignition
been unlocked by pressing the  button on
and, using the Infotainment system, select:
● If the alarm has been triggered by the volu- the remote control key ››› page 122, the rear
 button > SETTINGS function button > Open-
metric sensor, this will be indicated by a lid can be re-opened for a certain length of
ing and closing > Central locking > Switch off
flashing of the warning lamp on the driver time.
door when the vehicle is opened. The flash is
alarm.
different to the flash indicating the alarm is ● When the vehicle is locked now, the vehicle Where required, the automatic tailgate lock-
activated. interior monitoring and the tow-away protec- ing time extension function can be activated
tion are switched off until the next time the or deactivated at an Authorised SEAT Service,
● The vibration of a mobile phone left inside
door is opened. which will provide all the necessary informa-
the vehicle may cause the vehicle interior
tion.
monitoring alarm to trigger, as both sensors
react to movements and shakes inside the ve- If the anti-theft security system (Safelock)* Before the vehicle locks automatically, there
hicle. ››› page 126 is switched off, the vehicle interi- is a risk of intruders getting into the vehicle.
● If on activating the alarm, any door or the or monitoring and the tow-away protection Therefore, we recommend you always lock
rear lid is open, only the alarm will be activa- are automatically switched off. the vehicle by pressing the  button on the
ted. The vehicle interior monitoring and the remote control or by using the central locking
anti-tow system will only be activated once WARNING
button.
all the doors are closed (including the rear Observe the safety warnings ››› in Descrip-
lid). tion on page 120. WARNING
Observe the safety warnings ››› in Intro-
duction on page 92.

130
Opening and closing

● Always close the rear lid properly. Risk of Electric windows Safety switch * (only in 5-door vehicles)

Technical data
accident or injury. Safety switch 5 on the driver door can be
● The rear lid must not be opened when the Opening and closing of the electric used to disable the electric window buttons
reverse or rear fog lights are lit. This may windows* in the rear doors.
damage the tail lights.
Safety switch not pressed: buttons on rear
● Do not close the rear lid by pushing it down
doors are activated.
with your hand on the rear window. The glass
could smash. Risk of injury! Safety switch pressed: buttons on rear doors
are deactivated.

Advice
● Ensure the rear lid is locked after closing it.
If not, it may open unexpectedly while driv- The safety control symbol  lights up in yel-
ing. low if the buttons on the rear doors are
● Closing the rear lid without observing and switched off.
ensuring it is clear could cause serious injury
to you and to third parties. Make sure that no WARNING

Operation
one is in the path of the rear lid.
Observe the safety warnings ››› in Intro-
● Never drive with the rear lid open or half- Fig. 137 Detail of the driver door: controls for duction on page 92.
closed, exhaust gases may penetrate into the the windows (5-door vehicle with front and
interior of the vehicle. Danger of poisoning! ● Incorrect use of the electric windows can
rear electric windows).
result in injury.
● If you only open the rear lid, do not leave
the key inside. The vehicle cannot be opened Read the additional information carefully ● Never close the rear lid without observing

Emergencies
if the key is left inside. ›››  page 16 and ensuring it is clear, to do otherwise could
cause serious injury to you and third parties.
The front and rear electric windows can be Make sure that no one is in the path of a win-
operated by using the controls on the driver dow.
door. The other doors each have a switch for ● The engine may accidentally be started and
their own window. be out of control.
● If the ignition is switched on, the electric
Always close the windows fully if you park
equipment could be activated with risk of in-
the vehicle or leave it unattended ››› .

Safety
jury, for example, in the electric windows.
You can use the electric windows for approx. ● The doors can be locked using the remote
10 minutes after switching off the ignition if control key. This could become an obstacle
neither the driver door nor the front passen- for assistance in an emergency situation. »
ger door has been opened and the key has
not been removed from the ignition.
131
Operation

● Therefore always take the key with you ● If the window is still obstructed, the win- – First unlock the vehicle using button  on
when you leave the vehicle. dow will stop at this point. the remote control key and then keep the
● The electric windows will work until the ig- ● If there is no obvious reason why the win- key in the driver door lock until all the win-
nition has been switched off and one of the dow cannot be closed, try to close it again by dows and the sliding/tilting sunroof* have
front doors has been opened. pulling the tab within ten seconds. The win- reached the required position.
● If necessary, use the safety switch to disa- dow closes with maximum force. The roll-
ble the rear electric windows. Make sure that back function is now deactivated. Convenience close function
they have been disabled. ● If more than 10 seconds pass, the window – Press and hold button  on the remote
will open fully when you operate one of the control key until all the windows and the
Note buttons. One-touch closing is reactivated. sliding/tilting sunroof* are closed ››› , or
If the window is not able to close because it – Keep the key in the driver door in the "lock"
WARNING position until all the windows and the slid-
is stiff or because of an obstruction, the win-
dow will automatically open again Observe the safety warnings ››› in Opening ing/tilting sunroof* are closed.
››› page 132. If this happens, check why the and closing of the electric windows* on
window could not be closed before attempt- page 131. Programming convenience opening in the
ing to close it again. ● The roll-back function does not prevent fin- Easy Connect*
gers or other parts of the body getting – Select: function button CAR > control but-
pinched against the window frame. Risk of
ton Vehicle systems* > Vehicle set-
Roll-back function accident.
tings > Central locking > Open the
window by holding button down or
The roll-back function reduces the risk of in- else > Front window on/off or else
jury when the electric windows close. Convenience opening/closing Roof on/off*.
● If a window is obstructed when closing au-
Use the convenience opening/closing func- WARNING
tomatically, the window stops at this point tion to easily open/close all the windows and
and lowers immediately ››› . the sliding/tilting sunroof* from the outside.
● Take care when closing the sliding/tilting
● Next, check why the window does not close sunroof* and windows. There is a risk of suf-
fering injury.
before attempting it again. Convenience open function
● For safety reasons, you should only use the
● If you try within the following 10 seconds – Press and hold button  on the remote remote control open and close functions with-
and the window closes again with difficulty control key until all the windows and the in about 2 metres of the vehicle. To avoid in-
or there is an obstruction, the automatic clos- sliding/tilting sunroof* have reached the juries, always keep an eye on the windows
ing will stop working for 10 seconds. desired position, or

132
Opening and closing

and the sliding/tilting sunroof* when press- – Release the switch and then lift it again for ● Only open or close the panoramic sliding

Technical data
ing the button to close them. The windows 1 second. This will re-enable the automatic sunroof and the sun blind* when nobody is in
stop moving as soon as the button is re- function. the way.
leased. ● The panoramic sliding sunroof can be oper-
If you push (or pull) a button to the first
ated for up to about ten minutes after the ig-
stage, the window will open (or close) until
nition has been switched off, provided the
you release the button. If you push or lift the
One-touch opening and closing* driver door and the front passenger door are
button briefly to the second stage, the win- not opened.
dow will open (one-touch opening) or close
One-touch opening and closing means you

Advice
(one-touch closing) automatically. If you op-
do not have to hold down the button. erate the button while the window is opening CAUTION
Buttons ››› Fig. 137 1 , 2 , 3 and 4 have or closing, it stops at this position. Check that when the rear lid is open, it does
two positions for opening windows and two not touch loads carried on the roof. When a
for closing them. This makes it easier to open roof carrier is fitted, DO NOT open the panor-
and close windows to the desired position. amic roof*.
Panoramic sliding sunroof*

Operation
One-touch closing Note
Opening or closing the panoramic
– Pull up the window button briefly up to the ● Leaves and other loose objects that accu-
sliding sunroof
second position. The window closes fully. mulate on the sun roof rails should be regu-
larly cleaned away either by hand or with a
Read the additional information carefully
One-touch opening vacuum.

Emergencies
›››  page 16
● In case of a fault in the operation of the
– Push down the window button briefly up to
The panoramic sliding sunroof will only work panoramic sliding sunroof, the anti-trap func-
the second position. The window opens
with the ignition on. It can be opened or tion will not operate correctly. Contact a spe-
fully.
closed for a few minutes after the ignition cialised workshop.
has been switched off, provided the driver
Resetting one-touch opening and closing door and the front passenger door are not
The automatic open and close function will opened.

Safety
not work if the battery has been temporarily
disconnected. The function can be restored WARNING
as follows: Careless or uncontrolled use of the panoram-
– Close the window as far as it will go by lift- ic sliding sunroof can cause serious injuries.
ing and holding the electric window switch.

133
Operation

Opening and closing the sun blind* Convenience closing of the panoramic ● Check why the panoramic sliding sunroof
3 Valid for vehicles: with sun blinds sliding sunroof or the sun blind does not close.
● Try and close them again.
The panoramic sliding sunroof can be ● If the panoramic sliding sunroof or sun
opened or closed from outside the vehicle
blind is still obstructed, it will stop at the cor-
using the vehicle key:
responding position. Close it without the an-
● Keep the vehicle unlocking or locking but- ti-trap function.
ton pressed. The panoramic sliding sunroof
is adjusted or closes. Closing without the roll-back function
● Release the unlock or lock button to stop ● The switch should be in the “closed posi-
the function. tion” ›››  page 16 1 .
● Panoramic sliding sunroof: Within five sec-
During convenience closing, the windows
Fig. 138 On the interior roof lining: switches onds of triggering the anti-trap function, pull
and the panoramic sliding sunroof close at
for the sun blind. the control all the way back ›››  page 16
the same time.
(arrow 5 ) until the panoramic sliding sun-
Function Action roof closes fully.
Note
● Sun blind: Within five seconds of triggering
Opening com- The rotary button of the panoramic sliding
the anti-trap function, press button
pletely (automatic Press button ››› Fig. 138 1 briefly. sunroof remains in the last position selected
function) if the roof is closed using convenience clos-
››› Fig. 138 2 until the sun blind closes fully.

ing from outside the vehicle, and will have to ● The panoramic sliding sunroof and sun
Stop automatic Press button 1 or button 2
be re-positioned the next time you drive. blind close without the anti-trap function.
operation briefly.
● If the panoramic sliding sunroof still cannot
To set the inter- Press button 1 or button 2 until be closed, visit a specialised workshop.
mediate position the correct position is set.
Roll-back function of the panoramic
Closing complete- sliding sunroof and the sun blind* WARNING
ly (automatic Press the button 2 briefly.
Closing the panoramic sliding sunroof or sun
function) The anti-trap function reduces the risk of in- blind without the anti-trap function can cause
jury when opening and closing the panoram- serious injuries.
Once the ignition has been switched off, you ic sliding sunroof and sun blind ››› . When
can still open or close the sun blind for a few ● Always close the panoramic sliding sunroof
it encounters an obstacle while closing, it carefully.
minutes provided the driver door and the rolls back and opens again.
front passenger door are not opened.
134
Lights and visibility

● Nobody should be in the way of the panor- Lights and visibility WARNING

Technical data
amic sliding sunroof or sun blind, especially
If the headlights are set too high and not
when they are closed without the anti-trap
function. Lights used correctly, there is a risk of dazzling or
distracting other road users. This could result
● The anti-trap function does not prevent fin- in a serious accident.
gers or other parts of the body getting Side light and dipped beam headlight
● Always make sure that the headlights are
pinched against the window frame and caus-
Read the additional information carefully correctly adjusted.
ing injury.
›››  page 27

Advice
Note
Note The driver is personally responsible for the
correct use and adjustment of the lights in all The legal requirements regarding the use of
The anti-trap function is activated if the win-
situations. vehicle lights in each country must be ob-
dows and the panoramic sliding sunroof are
served.
closed from the outside of the vehicle using
the ignition key for convenience closing Audible warnings to advise the driver that

Operation
››› page 132. the lights have not been switched off
If the key is not in the ignition and the driver Daytime running lights
door is open, an audible warning signal is
heard in the following cases: this is a remind- The daytime running lights consist of individ-
er to turn off the lights. ual lights, integrated in the front headlights.
With the daylight driving lights on, only these

Emergencies
● When the parking light is on ››› page 136. lights switch on ››› .
● When the light switch is in position  or
The daytime running lights switch on every
.
time the ignition is switched on, if the switch
is in positions  or , according to the level
WARNING
of exterior lighting.
The side lights or daytime running lights are
not bright enough to illuminate the road When the light switch is in position , a
light sensor automatically switches dipped

Safety
ahead and to ensure that other road users are
able to see you. beam on and off (including the control and
● Always use your dipped beam head lights if
instrument lighting) or the daytime running
it is raining or if visibility is poor. lights depending on the level of exterior
lighting. »

135
Operation

WARNING In vehicles that do not have the correspond- ● If a trailer turn signal malfunctions, the
ing menu, this function can be deactivated in control lamp will stop flashing (trailer turn
● Never drive with daytime lights if the road
a specialised workshop. signals) and the vehicle turn signal will flash
is not well lit due to weather or lighting con-
at double speed.
ditions. Daytime lights do not provide
WARNING ● The main beam headlights can only be
enough light to illuminate the road properly
or be seen by other road users. Improper or lack of use of the turn signals, or switched on if the dipped beam headlights
● The rear lights do not come on with the forgetting to deactivate them can confuse are already on.
daytime driving light. A vehicle which does other road users. This could result in a seri- ● In cold or damp weather conditions, the
not have the rear lights on may not be visible ous accident. headlights, tail lights and turn signals may
to other drivers in the darkness, in the case ● Always give warning when you are going to mist up inside temporarily. This is normal and
of heavy rain or in conditions of poor visibili- change lane, overtake or when turning, acti- in no way effects the useful life of the vehicle
ty. vating the turn signal in good time. lighting system.
● As soon as you have finished changing
lane, overtaking or turning, switch the turn
Turn signal and main beam lever signal off. Automatic dipped beam control *

Read the additional information carefully WARNING The automatic dipped beam control is merely
›››  page 28 intended as an aid and is not able to recog-
Incorrect use of the headlights may cause ac-
Push the lever all the way down to turn off cidents and serious injury, as the main beam nise all driving situations.
the corresponding function. may distract or dazzle other drivers. When the light switch is in position , the
vehicle lights and the instrument panel and
Convenience turn signals Note switch lighting switch on and off automatical-
For the convenience turn signals, move the ● If the convenience turn signals are operat-
ly in the following situations ››› in Daytime
lever as far as possible upwards or down- ing (three flashes) and the other convenience running lights on page 136:
wards and release the lever. The turn signal turn signals are switched on, the active part
will flash three times. stops flashing and only flashes once in the Automatic switching Automatic switching
new part selected. on off
The convenience turn signals are activated
● The turn signal only works when the igni-
and deactivated in the Easy Connect system The photo sensor detects When adequate lighting is
via the  button and the SETTINGS function tion is switched on. The hazard warning darkness, for example, detected.
lights also work when the ignition is switch- when driving through a
button ››› page 114.
ed off. tunnel.

136
Lights and visibility

Automatic switching Automatic switching beam when passing through a town, for ex- ● On tight bends and steep slopes (bumps)

Technical data
on off ample. and when oncoming vehicles are partially ob-
scured.
The rain sensor detects When the windscreen wip- Switching the main beam assist on and off ● When the drivers of other oncoming vehi-
rain and activates the ers have been inactive for
cles (such as a truck) can see over a guard
windscreen wipers. a few minutes. Func- Use
rail in the centre of the road.
tion
WARNING ● If the camera is damaged or the power sup-
– Switch the ignition on and turn the light ply is cut off.
If the road is not well lit and other road users switch to position .

Advice
cannot see the vehicle well enough or at all, – From the base position, move the main ● In fog, snow and heavy rain.
Activate:
accidents may occur. beam and turn signal lever forwards ● With dust and sand turbulence.
● The automatic dipped beam control ()
 ››› page 136. When the warning lamp  is
● With loose gravel in the field of vision of
only switches on the dipped beam when displayed on the instrument panel display,
the main beam assist is switched on. the camera.
there are no changes in brightness, and not,
for example when it is foggy. ● When the field of vision of the camera is

Operation
– Switch off the ignition.
– OR: turn the light switch to a different po- misted up, dirty or covered by stickers, snow,
sition to  ››› page 135. ice, etc.
To switch – OR: with main beam on, move the main
Main beam assist* system beam and turn signal lever backwards. WARNING
off: – OR: move the main beam and turn the
Main beam assist (Light Assist) The convenience features of the main beam
signal lever forwards to manually switch
assist should not encourage the taking of

Emergencies
The main beam assist acts within the limits the main beam on. The main beam assist
will then be deactivated. risks. The system is not a replacement for
of the system and depending on environmen- driver concentration.
tal and traffic conditions. Once switched on, ● You are always in control of the main beam
the system is activated as of a speed of Malfunctions
and adapting it to the light, visibility and traf-
about 60 km/h (37 mph) and is deactivated The following conditions may prevent the fic conditions.
below about 30 km/h (18 mph) ››› . main beam headlight control from turning off ● It is possible that the main beam headlight
When the system is activated and the camera the headlights in time or from turning off al- control does not recognise all driving situa-
together:

Safety
detects other vehicles that may be dazzled, tions and is limited under certain circumstan-
the main beam is automatically switched off. ces.
● In poorly lit towns with highly reflective
Otherwise, the main beam is automatically ● When the field of vision of the camera is
signs.
switched on. dirty, covered or damaged, operation of the
● Other insufficiently lit road users (such as main beam control may be affected. This also
The main beam assist generally detects illu- pedestrians or cyclists). applies when changes are made to the »
minated areas and deactivates the main
137
Operation

vehicle lighting system, for example, if addi- Fog lights Note


tional headlights are installed.
The rear fog light can dazzle drivers behind
you. You should use the rear fog light only
CAUTION when visibility is very poor. For this reason, if
you exceed approximately 60 km/h (38 mph),
To avoid affecting the operation of the sys-
the instrument panel will display the follow-
tem, take the following points into considera-
ing warming: Switch off the fog
tion:
light!
● Clean the field of vision of the camera regu-
larly and make sure it is free of snow and ice.
● Do not cover the field of vision of the cam-
Cornering lights*1)
era.
● Check that the windscreen is not damaged Fig. 139 Dash panel: light control.
in the area of the field of vision of the camera.
When turning slowly or on very tight bends,
the cornering lights are activated automati-
The warning lamps  or  also show, on the
cally. The cornering lights may be integrated
Note light switch or instrument panel, when the
in the fog lights and are switched on only at
fog lights are on.
Main beam and headlight flasher can be speeds of less than 40 km/h (25 mph).
turned on and off manually at any time with ● Switching on front fog lights* : pull the When reverse gear is engaged, the cornering
the turn signal and main beam lever light switch to the first point ››› Fig. 139 1 , lights on both sides of the vehicle switch on,
››› page 136. from positions ,  or . in order to better illuminate the area for park-
● Switching on the rear fog light : com- ing.
pletely pull the light switch 2 from position
,  or .
● To switch off the fog lights, press the light Function “Coming home”
switch or turn it to position .
This function may be connected/disconnec-
ted through the radio menu. The “Coming
Home” and/or “Leaving Home” delay time
may also be set (default: 30 sec).

1) This function is not available on vehicles equipped

with full-LED headlights and bulb fog lights.


138
Lights and visibility

Vehicle with In the “Coming Home” function, the day- ● When the car door is opened, the “Coming Vehicle with In the “Leaving Home” function, the dip-

Technical data
halogen time running lights (DRL), the rear side Home” lighting comes on. The headlights are full-LED ped beams, the daytime running lights
headlights lights and the licence plate lights are turned off 60 seconds after the vehicle door headlights (DRL), the rear side lights and the li-
turned on. is opened. cence plate lights are switched on.

Vehicle with In the “Coming Home” function, the dip-


full-LED ped beams and the daytime running Deactivation Activation
headlights lights (DRL), the rear side lights and the ● If no door has been closed, they go out au- ● When the vehicle is unlocked using the re-
licence plate lights are switched on.
tomatically after 60 seconds. mote control.

Advice
● After the last door has been closed, the ● The “Leaving Home” function is only activa-
Automatic* activation of “Coming Home”
headlights will be switched off after the ted when the rotary light switch is in position
For vehicles with a light and rain sensor (rota- “Coming Home” delay (as established in the  and the light sensor detects darkness.
ry light switch in position ). radio menu) has elapsed.
● Switch off the engine and remove the key ● On turning the light switch to position  Deactivation
from the ignition with the rotary light switch ›››  page 27. ● When the “Leaving Home” delay period

Operation
in position  ›››  page 27. ● When the ignition is switched on (when ends (default: 30 sec).
● The automatic “Coming Home” function is starting the engine). ● When the vehicle is locked using the re-
only active when the light sensor detects mote control.
darkness. ● When the light control is switched into a
● When the car door is opened, the “Coming Function “Leaving Home” position other than .

Emergencies
Home” lighting comes on. ● With the ignition is switched on.
The “Leaving Home” function is only availa-
ble for vehicles with a light and rain sensor
Manual “Coming Home” activation
(rotary light switch in position ).
For vehicles with a light and rain sensor (rota-
ry light switch without position ). This function may be connected/disconnec-
ted through the radio menu. The “Leaving
● Switch off the engine and remove the key Home” function switch-off delay may also be
set (default: 30 sec).

Safety
from the ignition.
● Activate the headlight flashers for approxi-
Vehicle with In the “Leaving Home” function, the day-
mately 1 second.
halogen time running lights (DRL), the rear side
● Activated for any position of the rotary light headlights lights and the licence plate lights are
switch. switched on.

139
Operation

Hazard warning lights  6. Use the warning triangle to draw the atten- into contact with highly inflammable materi-
tion of other road users to your vehicle. als, for example dry grass or spilt petrol. This
7. Always take the vehicle key with you when could start a fire.
you leave the vehicle.
Note
All turn signals flash simultaneously when
● The battery will run down if the hazard
the hazard warning lights are switched on.
warning lights are left on for a long time,
The two turn signal turn signal lamps  
even if the ignition is switched off.
and the turn signal lamp in the switch  will
flash at the same time. The simultaneous ● The use of the hazard warning lights de-
hazard warning lights also work when the ig- scribed here is subject to the relevant statu-
tory requirements.
nition is switched off.
Fig. 140 Dash panel: switch for hazard warn-
ing lights. Emergency braking warning
If the vehicle brakes suddenly and continu-
Parking lights 
Read the additional information carefully
ously at a speed of more than 80 km/h (50
›››  page 28 mph), the brake light flashes several times
When the parking light is switched on, (right
or left turn signal), the front side light and
The hazard warning lights are used to draw per second to warn the vehicles driving be-
the rear light on the corresponding side of
the attention of other road users to your vehi- hind. If you continue braking, the hazard
the vehicle stay lit. The parking lights can on-
cle in emergencies. warning lights will come on automatically
ly be activated with the ignition switched off
when the vehicle comes to a standstill. They
If your vehicle breaks down: and the turn signal and main beam lever in
switch off automatically when the vehicle
the central position, before being triggered.
1. Park your vehicle at a safe distance from starts to move again.
moving traffic.
WARNING
2. Press the button to switch on the hazard Parking light on both sides
warning lights ››› . ● The risk of an accident increases if your ve-
hicle breaks down. Always use the hazard With the ignition switched off and the light
3. Switch the ignition off. warning lights and a warning triangle to draw switch in position , when locking the vehi-
4. Apply the handbrake. the attention of other road users to your sta-
cle from the outside, the parking lights on
tionary vehicle.
5. For a manual gearbox, engage 1st gear; both sides of the vehicle light up. In doing
● Due to the high temperatures that the cata-
for an automatic gearbox, move the gear so, only the side lights of both headlights
lytic converter can reach, never park in an light up, and additionally the tail lights will
lever to P. area where the catalytic converter could come
do so partially.
140
Lights and visibility

Motorway light* The light distribution that the halogen and The headlights can only be adjusted when

Technical data
full-LED headlights of the SEAT Leon range the dipped beam is switched on.
The motorway light is available on vehicles have allows the specific “tourist light” values
To reset, turn switch ››› Fig. 141:
equipped with full-LED lights. to be met without the need for stickers or
changes in the settings.
The function is connected/disconnected via Value Vehicle load statusa)
the corresponding Easy Connect system
Note Two front occupants, luggage compart-
menu. –
ment empty
“Tourist light” is only allowed temporarily. If
● Activation: when going above 110 km/h you are planning a long stay in a country that

Advice
All seats occupied, luggage compartment
(68 mph) for more than 30 seconds, the dip- drives on the other side, you should take the 1
empty
ped beam raises slightly to increase the driv- vehicle to an Authorised Technical Service to
er's visibility distance. change the headlights. All seats occupied, luggage compartment
2 full. With trailer and minimum drawbar
● Deactivation: when reducing the speed of load.
the car below 100 km/h (62 mph), the dip-
Headlight range control Driver only, luggage compartment full With

Operation
ped beam returns to its normal position. 3
trailer and maximum drawbar load.
a) If the vehicle load does not correspond to those shown in the
Driving abroad table, it is possible to select intermediary positions.

The light beam of the dipped beam lights is OR:

Emergencies
asymmetric: the side of the road on which Using the radio menu (see Easy Connect
you are driving is lit more intensely. > Adjusting Lights > Headlamp
When a car that is manufactured in a country height adjustment ›››  page 30).
that drives on the right travels to a country
that drives on the left (or vice versa), it is nor- Two front occupants, luggage compart-
Setting 0
ment empty
mally necessary to cover part of the headlight
Fig. 141 Next to the steering wheel: Head-
bulbs with stickers or to change the adjust- All seats occupied, luggage compart-
light range control Setting 1

Safety
ment of the headlights to avoid dazzling oth- ment empty
er drivers.
The lights range control adapts according to All seats occupied, luggage compart-
In such cases, the regulations specify certain the value of the headlight beam and the ve- Setting 2 ment full. With trailer and minimum
light values that must be complied with for hicle load status. This offers the driver opti- drawbar load. »
designated points of the light distribution. mum visibility and the headlights do not daz-
This is known as “Tourist light”. zle oncoming drivers ››› .
141
Operation

Driver only, luggage compartment full With the ignition on and without light activa- on when the doors are opened and will de-
Setting 3 Driving with trailer and minimum draw- tion, the instrument panel lighting remains crease in intensity while driving. The intensity
bar load. activated in daytime light conditions. The of these lights can be adjusted using the ra-
lighting is reduced as the exterior light di- dio menu (see Easy Connect > Light
Dynamic headlight range control minishes. In some cases, e.g. when driving Settings > Interior lighting
through a tunnel without the  function ›››  page 30).
The control is not mounted in vehicles with
active, the instrument panel lighting may
dynamic headlight range control. The head-
even switch off. The objective of this function Ambient light*
light range is automatically adjusted accord-
is to provide the driver with a visual indica-
ing to the vehicle load status when they are The ambient lighting in the door panels may
tion that he or she should activate the dip-
switched on. change colour. The intensity of these lights
ped beam.
can be adjusted using the radio menu (see
WARNING Easy Connect > Light Settings >
Interior lighting ›››  page 30).
Heavy objects in the vehicle may mean that Interior and reading lights1)
the headlights dazzle and distract other driv-
ers. This could result in a serious accident. Note
Read the additional information carefully
● Adjust the light beam to the vehicle load ›››  page 29 The reading lights switch off when the vehi-
status so that it does not blind other drivers. cle is locked using a key or after several mi-
nutes if the key is removed from the ignition.
Glove compartment and luggage compart- This prevents the battery from discharging.
ment lighting*
Lighting of the instrument panel, When opening and closing the glove com-
screens and controls partment on the front passenger side and the
rear lid, the respective light will automatically
Depending on the model, the lighting of the switch on and off.
instrument panel and controls can be adjus-
ted in the Easy Connect system, using the  Footwell lighting*
button and the SETTINGS function button
›››  page 30. The lights in the footwell area below the dash
(driver and front passenger sides) will switch

1) Depending on the level of equipment fitted in the

vehicle, LEDs can be used for the following interior


lights: front courtesy light, rear courtesy light, foot-
well light, sun blind and glove compartment light.
142
Lights and visibility

Visibility The lamp goes out when the vanity mirror Rear window sun blind*

Technical data
cover is closed or the sun visor is pushed – Pull out the visor and hook it into the hooks
back up.
Sun visors in the centre of the top of the door frame
››› Fig. 143.
WARNING
Folded sun blinds can reduce visibility.
● Always store sun blinds and visors in their
housing when not in use.
Windscreen wiper and window
wiper systems

Advice
Note
Window wiper lever
The light above the sun visor automatically
switches off after a few minutes in certain Read the additional information carefully
conditions. This prevents the battery from
discharging.
›››  page 29

Operation
Fig. 142 Sun visor
CAUTION
Options for adjusting driver and front pas- If the ignition is switched off with the wind-
senger sun visors: Sun blind* screen wipers active, they complete their
● Lower the sun visor towards the wind- 3 Applies to the model: LEON ST wipe before returning to the rest position.
screen. Ice, snow and other obstacles on the wind-

Emergencies
screen may damage the wiper and the wind-
● The sun visor can be pulled out of its screen wiper motor.
mounting and turned towards the door ● If necessary, remove snow and ice from the
››› Fig. 142
1 .
windscreen wipers before starting your jour-
● Swing the sun visor towards the door, lon- ney.
gitudinally backwards. ● Carefully lift the frozen windscreen wipers
from the glass. SEAT recommends a de-icer
Vanity mirror light spray for this operation.

Safety
There may be a vanity mirror, with a cover, on ● Do not switch on the windscreen wipers if
the rear of the sun visor. When the cover is the windscreen is dry. Cleaning with the
opened 2 a light comes on. Fig. 143 Rear window: sun blind. windscreen wipers while dry can cause dam-
age. »

143
Operation

● In icy conditions, always check that the Windscreen wiper performance in different sit- Note
wiper blades are not frozen to the glass be- uations The wiper will try to wipe away any obstacles
fore using the wipers. In cold weather, it may
Intervals between wipes depend
that are on the windscreen. The wiper will
help to leave the vehicle parked with the wip-
stop moving if the obstacle blocks its path.
ers in service position ›››  page 67. For the interval wipe
on the vehicle's speed. The high-
er the vehicle speed the shorter Remove the obstacle and switch the wiper
the intervals. back on again.
Note
● The windscreen and window wipers only Heated windscreen washer jets
function when the ignition is switched on and
The heating only thaws the frozen jets, it
the bonnet or rear lid, respectively, are
closed. does not thaw the water in the washer hoses.
When the ignition is switched on the heated
● The interval wipe speed varies according to
windscreen washer jets automatically adjust
the vehicle speed. The faster the vehicle is
the heat depending on the ambient tempera-
moving, the more often the windscreen is
cleaned. ture.
● The rear wiper is automatically switched on
Headlight wash/wipe system
when the windscreen wiper is on and the car
is in reverse gear. The headlight washers/wipers clean the
headlight lenses.
After the ignition is switched on, the first and
Windscreen wiper functions every fifth time the windscreen washer is
switched on, the headlights are also washed.
Windscreen wiper performance in different sit- Therefore, the windscreen wiper lever should
uations be pulled towards the steering wheel when
the dipped beam or main beam are on. Any
The activated position provision- incrusted dirt (such as insects) should be
If the vehicle is at a
ally changes to the previous posi-
standstill cleaned regularly (e.g. when refuelling).
tion.
To ensure the headlight washers work cor-
The air conditioner comes on for
approximately 30 seconds in air
rectly in winter, any snow which has got into
During automatic recirculation mode to prevent the the bumper jet supports should be cleaned
wipe smell of the windscreen washer away. If necessary, remove snow with an anti-
fluid entering the inside the vehi- icing spray.
cle.
144
Lights and visibility

Rain sensor* Move the lever to the required position reduce the effectiveness of the rain sensor or

Technical data
››› Fig. 144: make it react more slowly, later or not at all.
● Cracked windscreen: the impact of a stone
0 Rain sensor off.
will trigger a single wipe cycle with the rain
1 Rain sensor on; automatic wipe if neces- sensor on. Next the rain sensor detects the
sary. reduction in the sensitive surface area and
A Setting sensitivity level of rain sensor adapts accordingly. The behaviour of the sen-
– Set control to the right: highly sensi- sor will vary with the size of the damage
caused by the stone.

Advice
tive.
– Set control to the left: less sensitive.
WARNING
When the ignition is switched off and then The rain sensor may not detect enough rain
Fig. 144 Windscreen wiper lever: adjusting back on, the rain sensor stays on and starts to switch on the wipers.
the rain sensor A operating again when the windscreen wipers ● If necessary, switch on the wipers manually

Operation
are in position 1 and the vehicle is travel- when water on the windscreen obstructs visi-
ling at more than 16 km/h (10 mph). bility.

Rain sensor modified behaviour Note


Possible causes of faults and mistaken read- ● Clean the sensitive surface of the rain sen-
ings on the sensitive surface ››› Fig. 145 of

Emergencies
sor regularly and check the blades for dam-
the rain sensor include: age ››› Fig. 145 (arrow).
● Damaged blades: a film of water on the ● To remove wax and coatings, we recom-
damaged blades may lengthen the activation mend a window cleaner containing alcohol.
time, reduce the washing intervals or result
Fig. 145 Rain sensor sensitive surface in a fast and continuous wipe.

The rain sensor controls the frequency of the


● Insects: insects on the sensor may trigger Mirror

Safety
the windscreen wiper.
windscreen wiper intervals, depending on
the amount of rain ››› . The sensitivity of the ● Salt on roads: in winter, salt spread in the Anti-dazzle rear view mirror
rain sensor can be adjusted manually. Man- roads may cause an extra long wipe when the
ual wipe ››› page 143. windscreen is almost dry. Your vehicle is fitted with an interior rear vi-
● Dirt: dry dust, wax, coating on glass (Lotus sion mirror with a manual or automatic* con-
effect) or traces of detergent (car wash) may trol for anti-dazzle position. »
145
Operation

Interior rear vision mirror with manual set- automatic adjustment for anti-dazzle posi- ● Adjust the left-hand exterior mirror. The
ting for anti-dazzle position tion. right exterior mirror will be adjusted at the
● Position the small lever of the lower edge same time (synchronised).
of the mirror to face towards the rear. ● If necessary the right exterior mirror adjust-
Adjusting the exterior rear view mir- ment may need correcting. turn the control to
WARNING position R1).
rors
In the event that an automatic anti-dazzle ● In the Easy Connect system the exterior mir-
rear vision mirror breaks, an electrolyte fluid rors can be adjusted using the  button
may leak. This could cause irritation to the and the SETTINGS function button.
skin, eyes and respiratory organs. If you
come into contact with this liquid, it must be Tilt function for front passenger exterior mir-
rinsed with large quantities of water. If neces- ror*
sary, get medial help.
When parking backwards, and in order to be
able to see the kerb, the passenger side mir-
CAUTION ror can be automatically tilted towards the
In the event that an automatic anti-dazzle passenger to provide a better view of the
rear vision mirror breaks, an electrolyte fluid kerb. The control must be in the position R1)
may leak. This liquid attacks plastic surfaces. Fig. 146 Driver door: control for the exterior for this feature to be operational.
Clean it with a wet sponge as soon as possi- mirror.
ble. The mirror returns to its original position as
Read the additional information carefully soon as you drive forward at over 15 km/h
›››  page 18 (9 mph) or switch off the ignition. It also re-
Note
turns to its original position if the position of
● If the light incident in the interior rear vi- Synchronized regulation of the exterior mir- the control is adjusted.
sion mirror is obstructed (e.g. with the sun rors
blind*), the anti-dazzle rear vision mirror with Storing the rear view mirror settings for the
● In the Settings - Convenience menu,
automatic setting will not operate perfectly. tilt function
select whether or not the exterior mirrors
● When the interior lights are on or reverse
should move in synchronisation. ● Switch the ignition on.
gear engaged, the mirrors do not darken with
● Turn the knob to position L1).

1) Regulation in right-hand drive vehicles is symmet-

rical.
146
Seats and head restraints

● Access the Easy Connect system, Menu WARNING Seats and head restraints

Technical data
CAR , function “Rear view mirrors and wind-
screen wipers” and select “lower while re- Convex or wide-angle* exterior mirrors give a
versing” ››› page 114.
larger field of vision. However, they make ob- Adjusting the seats and headr-
jects look smaller and further away than they
● Select the R1) position on the control. really are. If you use these mirrors to esti- ests
● Select reverse gear. mate the distance to vehicles behind you
● Adjust the front passenger exterior mirror
when changing lane, you could misjudge the Manual adjustment of seats
distance. Risk of accident!
so that you can see, for example, the kerb
Read the additional information carefully

Advice
area well.
CAUTION ›››  page 17
● Release the reverse gear.
● If one of the mirror housings is knocked out
● The adjusted position for the rear view mir- WARNING
of position (e.g. when parking), the mirrors
ror is stored. must first be fully retracted with the electric The safe driving chapter contains important
control. Do not readjust the mirror housing by information, tips, suggestions and warnings

Operation
Fold in the exterior mirrors after parking hand, as this will interfere with the mirror ad- that you should read and observe for your
(convenience function)* juster function. own safety and the safety of your passengers
● Before washing the vehicle in an automatic
››› page 69.
The Easy Connect system, Menu CAR , func-
tion “Rear view mirrors and windscreen wip- car wash, please make sure to retract the ex-
ers” can be used to have the exterior mirrors terior mirrors to prevent them from being WARNING
fold in when the vehicle is parked damaged. Electrically retractable exterior
● Adjust the front seats only when the vehi-

Emergencies
mirrors must not be folded in or out by hand.
››› page 114. cle is stationary. Failure to follow this instruc-
Always use the electrical power control.
tion could result in an accident.
When the vehicle is locked with the remote
control, by pressing for more than approxi- ● Be careful when adjusting the seat height.
Note Careless or uncontrolled adjustment can
mately 1 second the exterior mirrors are fol-
ded in automatically. When the vehicle is If the electrical adjustment should fail to op- cause injuries.
opened with the remote control, the exterior erate, both of the mirrors can be adjusted by ● The front seat backrests must not be re-
mirrors are deployed automatically. hand by lightly pressing the edge of the mir- clined for driving. Otherwise, seat belts and

Safety
ror glass. the airbag system might not protect as they
should, with the subsequent danger of injury.

1) Regulation in right-hand drive vehicles is symmet-

rical.
147
Operation

Electric driver's seat adjustment* Adjusting the front head restraints Adjusting the head restraints
– To set the head restraint higher, grasp the
Read the additional information carefully Read the additional information carefully sides with both hands and move it up-
›››  page 17 ›››  page 17 wards, until you see it engage.
Adjust the head restraint ›››  page 17 so – To set the head restraint lower down, press
WARNING
that as far as possible the top of the head re- the 1 ››› Fig. 147 button and move it
● If the electric front seats are used negli- straint is level with the top of your head. downwards.
gently or without paying due attention, it can When this is not possible, try to get as close
cause serious injury. as possible to this position.
Removing the head restraint
● The front seats can also be electrically ad-
justed when the ignition is switched off. Nev- To remove the head restraint, the correspond-
er leave a child or any other person who may ing backrest must be partially folded forward.
Adjusting the rear head restraints
need help in the vehicle.
– Unlock the backrest ››› page 151.
● In the event of an emergency, electrical ad-
justment can be stopped by pressing any – Move the head restraint upwards until it ar-
control. rives to the top.
– Press button 1 ››› Fig. 147, while simulta-
CAUTION neously pressing on the security hole 2
To avoid damaging the electrical components ››› Fig. 147 with a flat screwdriver a maxi-
of the front seats, please refrain from kneel- mum of 5 mm wide, and remove the head
ing on the seat or applying sharp pressure at restraint.
a single point to the seat cushion and back- – Move the backrest until it engages properly
rest.
››› .
Fig. 147 Rear centre head restraint: release
Note point. Fitting the head restraint
● It may not be possible to electrically adjust To mount the external head restraints, the
When transporting people in the back seat,
the seat if the vehicle battery is very low. corresponding backrest must be partially fol-
place the head restraints of the occupied
● If the engine is started while the seats are seats at a minimum of the next socket up ded forward.
being electrically adjusted, the adjustment ››› . – Unlock the backrest ››› page 151.
will stop.
– Insert the head restraint bars into the
guides until they perceptibly engage. It

148
Seats and head restraints

should not be possible to remove the head Seat heating Adjusting the heating output

Technical data
restraint from the backrest. Press the button  or  repeatedly until the
– Move the backrest until it engages properly desired intensity level is reached.
››› .
Deactivating
WARNING Press the button  or  until all warning
● Please observe the general notes lamps switch off.
››› page 73.

Advice
● Remove the rear head restraints only when WARNING
it is necessary for the placement of a child People who, because of medications, paraly-
seat ››› page 86. After removing a child seat, sis or chronic diseases (e.g. diabetes) cannot
remount the head restraint immediately. perceive pain or temperature, or have a limi-
Fig. 148 In the centre console: front seats
Travelling with the head restraints removed ted perception thereof, may suffer burns to
or improperly adjusted increases the risk of heating switch
the back, buttocks or legs when using seat

Operation
severe injuries. heating, an occurrence that may entail a very
The seat cushions can be heated electrically
lengthy recovery period or from which it may
when the ignition is switched on. The back-
not be possible to recover fully. Seek medical
rest is also heated in some versions. advice if you have doubts regarding your
Seat functions The seat heating should not be engaged in health.
any of the following conditions: ● People with limited pain and temperature

Emergencies
Introduction thresholds must never use seat heating.
● The seat is unoccupied.
WARNING ● The seat has a covering.
WARNING
Inappropriate use of the seat functions can ● There is a child seat installed in the seat.
If the fabric of the cushion is wet, this can ad-
cause severe injuries. ● The seat cushion is wet or damp. versely affect the operation of the seat heat-
● Assume the proper sitting position before ● The indoor or outdoor temperature is great- ing, increasing the risk of burns.
your trip and remain in it throughout. This al- ● Make sure the seat cushion is dry prior to
er than 25°C (77°F).

Safety
so applies to the other occupants. using the seat heater.
● Always keep hands, fingers, feet and other
Activate ● Do not sit on the seat with clothing that is
parts of the body away from the operating ra- wet or damp.
dius and the adjustment of seats. Press the button  or . Seat heating is
switched on fully. ● Do not leave clothing that is wet or damp
on the seat. »
149
Operation

● Do not spill liquid on the seat. The armrest can be moved backwards and Folding down and raising the rear seat
forwards. backrest
CAUTION 3 Applies to the model: LEON/LEON SC
● To avoid damaging the heating elements of Folding down the passenger seat
the seat heaters, please do not kneel on the
backrest*
seat or apply sharp pressure to a single point
on the seat cushion or backrest. 3 Applies to the model: LEON / LEON ST
● Liquids, sharps objects and insulating ma-
terials (e.g. covers or child seats) can damage
the seat heating.
● In the event of smells, switch off the seat
heating immediately and have it inspected by
a specialised workshop.

Fig. 150 Clip to support the seat belt.


For the sake of the environment
The seat heating should remain on only when
needed. Otherwise, it is an unnecessary fuel
waste. Fig. 149 Front passenger seat: lever for fold-
ing down the backrest.

Front centre armrest The front passenger seat can be folded down
to increase the storage space.
The centre armrest can be adjusted to various
levels.
● Pull lever 1 ››› Fig. 149 and push the seat
backrest 2 until the backrest is horizontal.
Adjusting the centre armrest Fig. 151 Backrest release lever.
WARNING
– To adjust the tilt, lift the armrest from the
When the front passenger seat is folded The backrests can be folded forward individu-
starting position so that it is engaged. down it cannot be occupied. ally or together.
– To return the armrest to the starting posi-
tion, remove the armrest from the upper
fixed position and lower it.

150
Seats and head restraints

Folding the backrest forwards compartment will not fly forward through the

Technical data
– Place the side seat belts in the trim clip interior during sudden braking.
››› Fig. 150.
– Slide the head restraint(s) downwards CAUTION
››› page 148. ● With the backrest inclined there is a danger
of damaging the rear head restraints when
– Press the release lever ››› Fig. 151 1 in the
adjusting the front seats backwards.
direction of the arrow.
● When folding the backrest forwards, make

Advice
– Fold the backrest forwards. sure to place the side seat belts in the trim
clip to prevent them from being damaged by
Fig. 153 In the luggage compartment: levers
Converting the table to a seat becoming trapped in the backrest lock.
for remote release of the left part 1 and right
– Raise the backrest until it engages in its part 2 of the rear seat backrest.
upright position ››› . The red marking on
the tab ››› Fig. 151 2 should no longer be Folding down and lifting the rear seat The rear seat backrest is split and each part

Operation
visible when the backrest is properly se- backrest be lowered separately to extend the luggage
cured. compartment.
3 Applies to the model: LEON ST
When the rear seat backrest is lowered no-
WARNING
body else can travel in the corresponding
The safe driving chapter contains important seats (not even a child).

Emergencies
information, tips, suggestions and warnings
that you should read and observe for your Lowering the rear seat backrest with the un-
own safety and the safety of your passengers lock button
››› page 69.
● Lower the head restraint properly.

WARNING ● Push the unlock button ››› Fig. 152 1 for-


wards and at the same time lift the backrest.
● Make sure that the rear backrest is securely
● The rear seat backrest is not engaged when

Safety
locked in position so that the seat belt can
provide proper protection on the centre rear Fig. 152 On the rear seat backrest: release the red marking of the button 2 is visible.
seat. catch 1 ; red mark 2 .
● The rear backrest must always be securely Lowering the rear seat backrest with the re-
latched so that objects stored in the luggage mote release lever
● Lower the head restraint properly. »
151
Operation

● Open the rear lid. must be properly engaged. This is particular- Transport and practical
● Pull the remote release lever of the left part ly important in the case of the centre rear
››› Fig. 153 1 or right part 2 of the backrest seat. If someone is seated in a seat whose equipment
in the direction of the arrow. The released backrest is not properly engaged they will fly
forward, along with the backrest, during an
part of the rear seat backrest is folded auto-
accident or a sudden driving or braking ma-
Storage compartments
matically down and forwards.
noeuvre.
● If this occurs, close the rear lid.
● A red signal on the button 2 warns that
Storage areas under the front seats*
The rear seat backrest is not engaged when the backrest is not engaged. Always check
the red marking of the button ››› Fig. 152 2 that the red marking is not visible when the
backrest is in the upright position.
is visible.
● When the rear seat backrest is lowered or is
Folding up the rear seat backrest not properly engaged nobody else can travel
in the corresponding seats (not even a child).
● Lift the backrest and press it firmly into the
lock until it engages ››› .
CAUTION
● It should not be possible to see the red
mark of the unlock button 2 . Serious damage can be caused to the vehicle
and other objects if the rear seat backrest is
● The backrest must be properly engaged. lowered or lifted without due care and atten- Fig. 154 Storage compartment under the
tion. front seats.
WARNING ● Before lowering the rear seat backrest, al-
Serious injuries can be caused if the rear seat ways adjust the front seats so that neither There is a storage compartment with a cover
backrest is lowered or lifted without due care the head restraints nor the cushions of the under each front seat.
and attention. rear backrest can hit them.
The drawer* is opened by pulling on the han-
● Never lower or lift the rear seat backrest
dle of the cover ››› Fig. 154.
while driving.
● Do no trap or damage the seat belt when To close the drawer, press the cover until it
raising the rear seat backrest. locks into position.
● When lowering or lifting the rear seat back-
rest, keep your hands, fingers, feet and other WARNING
body parts out of its path. ● The drawers will hold a maximum weight of
● For the rear seat belts to offer the necessa- 1.5 kg.
ry protection all the parts of the rear backrest
152
Transport and practical equipment

● Do not drive with the drawer cover open. ● Do not put hot drinks in the drink holders. WARNING

Technical data
There is an injury risk for passengers if the During normal or sudden driving manoeuvres, ● Do not place any hot drinks in the drink
cargo is released in case of sudden braking or sudden braking or an accident, the hot drink
holder while the vehicle is moving. Hot drinks
an accident. could be spilled. Danger of scalding.
could spill and cause burns, which may cause
an accident.
CAUTION ● Do not use hard china cups or glasses.
Folding table* When driving, do not leave open cans in the These could cause injury in the event of an
3 Applies to the model: LEON ST cup holders. The drink might be spilt on brak- accident.

Advice
ing, for example, and could damage the vehi-
cle. CAUTION
You should avoid putting open drinks con-
tainers in the drink holders. The drinks could
Drink holders otherwise spill over and cause damage to e.g.
the electrical equipment or the seat covers.

Operation
Glove compartment

Fig. 155 Left-hand front seat: folding table.

Emergencies
– To open the tray, open it up in the direction
of the arrow ››› Fig. 155.

WARNING
Fig. 156 Centre console: front drink holders.
● The folding trays may not be folded down
whilst the vehicle is in motion and anyone is Front drink holders

Safety
seated on the second row of seats. There is a
– Place drinks in the holder ››› Fig. 156.
risk of injury during a sudden braking ma-
noeuvre! The tray must therefore be closed Placement of two drinks is possible. There Fig. 157 Glove compartment »
and properly secured whilst the vehicle is in is also the possibility of placing larger plas-
motion. tic bottles in the trims of the doors.

153
Operation

Opening/closing load of the compartment should not exceed Power sockets


– To open the glove compartment, pull the 0.2 kg.
handle in the direction of the arrow. ● Coat hooks in the door frames ››› .
– To close the glove compartment, move the ● Other storage compartments are found in
cover upwards until it engages. the rear seat, to the left and the right of the
seats.
Depending on the vehicle equipment, the CD
player is located in the glove compartment. WARNING
Separate operating instructions are enclosed ● Please make sure that any items of clothing
for this equipment in the corresponding In- hanging from the coat hooks do not obstruct
struction Manual. your view to the rear.
● The coat hooks should only be used for
WARNING Fig. 158 Centre console: front/rear 12-volt
lightweight clothing. Do not leave any heavy power socket.
The cover of the glove compartment should or sharp objects in the pockets.
always be closed while driving. Failure to fol- ● Do not use clothes hangers to hang up the
low this instruction could result in an acci- clothing, as this could interfere with the func-
dent. tion of the head-protection airbags.

Other storage compartments


You will find more object holders, compart-
ments and supports in other parts of the ve-
hicle:
● In the top of the glove compartment in ve- Fig. 159 Detailed view of the side trim in the
hicles that do not have a CD reader. The load luggage compartment: 12-volt power socket
of the compartment should not exceed (applies only to the LEON ST model).
1.2 kg.
In the centre console
● In the centre console under the centre arm-
rest*. – Remove the connector located in the centre
console of the power socket ››› Fig. 158.
● In the driver side panel there is a remova-
ble box for access to fuses and relays. The
154
Transport and practical equipment

– Insert the plug of the electrical appliance Storing objects if a loose object is struck by an inflating air-

Technical data
into the power socket. bag. If this happens, objects may shoot out-
Loading the luggage compartment ward like a missile. Risk of fatal injury.
In the luggage compartment (applies only to ● Please note that the centre of gravity may
the LEON ST model) All luggage and other loose objects must be shift when transporting heavy objects; this
– Lift the power socket cover ››› Fig. 159. safely secured in the luggage compartment. may affect vehicle handling and lead to an ac-
Unsecured objects which shift back and forth cident. Therefore, it is essential to adjust
– Insert the plug of the electrical appliance your speed and driving style accordingly, to
could impair the driving safety or driving
into the power socket. avoid accidents.
characteristics of the vehicle by shifting the

Advice
centre of gravity. ● Never exceed the allowed axle weights or
Electrical equipment can be connected to the
allowed maximum weight. If said weights are
12 volt power socket. The appliances connec- – Distribute the load evenly in the luggage exceeded, the driving characteristics of the
ted to each power socket must not exceed a compartment. vehicle may change, leading to accidents, in-
power rating of 120 Watt. juries and damage to the vehicle.
– Place heavy objects as far forward as possi-
ble in the luggage compartment. ● Never leave your vehicle unattended, espe-

Operation
WARNING
cially when the rear lid is open. Children
The power socket works only when the igni- – Place the heavy objects first. could climb into the luggage compartment,
tion is on. Improper use may cause serious – Secure heavy objects to the fitted fastening closing the door behind them; they will be
injury or even fire. Children should therefore trapped and run the risk of death.
rings ››› page 161.
not be left in the vehicle unattended if the ● Never allow children to play in or around
button is also left behind. Otherwise there is the vehicle. Close and lock all the doors and
WARNING

Emergencies
a possibility that they may be injured. rear lid when you leave the vehicle. Before
● Loose luggage and other objects in the lug- you lock the vehicle, make sure that there are
gage compartment could cause serious inju- no adults or children in the vehicle.
CAUTION
ries.
Always use the correct type of plugs to avoid ● Always stow objects in the luggage com-
damaging the sockets. Note
partment and secure them on the fastening
rings. ● Air circulation in the vehicle helps reduce
Note ● Use suitable straps to secure heavy ob- fogging of the windows. Used air escapes

Safety
jects. through ventilation slits in the side trim of
The use of electrical appliances with the en- the luggage compartment. Ensure that the
gine switched off will cause a battery dis- ● During sudden manoeuvres or accidents,
ventilation slots are never covered.
charge. loose objects can be thrown forward, injuring
● Straps for securing the load to the fasten-
vehicle occupants or passers-by. This in-
creased risk of injury will be further increased ing rings are commercially available.

155
Operation

Luggage compartment cover Removing Retractable rear shelf


3 Applies to the model: LEON/LEON SC ● Detach the cord loops ››› Fig. 160 B from 3 Applies to the model: LEON ST
their hooks A .
● Remove the rear shelf from the side sup-
ports ››› Fig. 161 by pulling it upwards and
then take it out.
● If necessary, the rear shelf can be stored
under the luggage compartment variable
floor ››› page 157

Fitting
● Insert the cover horizontally so that the “re-
Fig. 160 In the luggage compartment: remov- cess” fits onto the axis of the supports
ing and installing the rear shelf. ››› Fig. 161 and press down until it engages.
● Hook the loops ››› Fig. 160 B to the rear lid
››› .
WARNING
● The luggage compartment cover must al-
ways be fixed properly (risk of accident).
● The luggage compartment cover should not
be used as a storage shelf. Articles placed on
Fig. 162 In the luggage compartment: open-
this cover could cause injury to vehicle occu-
ing and retracting the rear shelf.
pants in an accident or if the brakes are ap-
plied suddenly.
Fig. 161 In the luggage compartment: remov-
ing and installing the rear shelf.

The luggage compartment cover blocks the


view into the luggage compartment.

156
Transport and practical equipment

● The rear shelf can be stored under the lug- Storing the rear shelf

Technical data
gage compartment variable floor when the 3 Applies to the model: LEON/LEON SC
latter is in the top position (except for vehi-
cles equipped with natural gas engine CNG)
››› page 158.

Fitting the rear shelf


● Place the rear shelf in the housing provided
in the left side cover.

Advice
● Engage the support of the rear shelf
Fig. 163 In the luggage compartment: remov- ››› Fig. 163 1 in the right housing.
ing the rear shelf.
● Check that the support ››› Fig. 163 1 is
Opening the rear shelf properly engaged.
Fig. 164 In the luggage compartment: covers

Operation
● Pull evenly on the rear shelf using its han- for storing the rear shelf.
WARNING
dle ››› Fig. 162 1  in a backwards direction
until it audibly clicks into place. Animals, loose or unsecured or objects car-
ried on the rear shelf can cause serious injury
in case of sudden manoeuvring or braking or
Retracting the rear shelf
in case of an accident.
● Press on the handle of the rear shelf in the

Emergencies
● Do not leave hard, sharp or heavy objects
direction of the arrow to release it ››› Fig. 162 or in bags on the rear shelf.
. ● Never carry animals on the rear shelf.
The shelf will automatically move towards the
end and will retract completely. CAUTION
To retract the rear shelf, press on its handle
Removing the rear shelf in a downwards only direction; if you press it
Fig. 165 In the luggage compartment: fitting
the storage compartment shelf.

Safety
● Press the rear shelf support ››› Fig. 163 1 upwards it may lead to its axles breaking.
in the direction of the arrow.
The rear shelf can be stored under the lug-
● Remove the rear shelf through the support gage compartment variable floor.
and upwards.
● Remove the left and right covers
››› Fig. 164. »
157
Operation

● Press the rear shelf until it engages in its Use of the net partition behind the
housing ››› Fig. 165. front seat*
● Put the left and right covers in their original 3 Applies to the model: LEON ST
position.

Storing the rear shelf


3 Applies to the model: LEON ST

Fig. 167 In the luggage compartment: hous-


ing for storing the rear shelf.

The rear shelf can be stored under the lug-


gage compartment variable floor. Fig. 168 In the luggage compartment: pulling
● Remove covers ››› Fig. 166 A left and right. out and securing the net partition.

● Press the head of the rear shelf in the direc-


tion of the arrow until it engages in its hous-
ing ››› Fig. 167.
Fig. 166 In the luggage compartment: hous-
ing for storing the rear shelf. ● Put the left and right covers in their original
position.

Fig. 169 In the luggage compartment: remov-


ing the net partition.

Pulling out and securing the net partition


● Pull up handle ››› Fig. 168 2 to remove the
net from the casing 4 .
158
Transport and practical equipment

● Hook in the net partition on the right side WARNING

Technical data
3 (magnified image).
● Always secure objects, even when the net
● Hook in the net partition in the left side partition is properly assembled.
housing 1 pulling the rod.
● There should be nobody behind the assem-
The net partition is properly assembled when bled partition when the vehicle is moving.
the T-shaped ends are firmly secured in the
corresponding housings 3 and 1 . CAUTION

Advice
Incorrect handling of the net partition could
Retracting the net partition cause damage.
● Unhook the rod from the housings 3 and ● Do not “release” the net partition when
1 . lowering it, as the net and other vehicle parts
Fig. 171 In the luggage compartment: net
● Roll up the net into the casing 4 lowering could be damaged. Roll down the net parti-
partition hooked into the rear seat backrests.
it with your hand. tion by hand.

Operation
Fitting the net partition
Removing the net partition ● Fold the rear seat backrests forward.
● Fold the rear seat backrests forward. Use of the net partition with the rear
● Remove the net partition from the side sup-
seat backrests lowered
● Press the left or right release catch ports.
››› Fig. 169 in the direction of the arrow 1 . 3 Applies to the model: LEON ST
● Place the net casing in the rail slots in the

Emergencies
● Remove the casing from the support in the direction of the arrows ››› Fig. 170 1 .
direction of the arrow ››› Fig. 169 2 . ● Push the casing towards the left side of the
vehicle in the direction of arrow ››› Fig. 170
Fitting the net partition 2 and as far as it will go.
● Fold the rear seat backrests forward. ● Check that the net is secure.
● Fit the casing in the right and left supports.
● Press the casing into the left and right sup- Pulling out and securing the net partition

Safety
ports in the opposite direction to the arrow ● Pull up handle ››› Fig. 171 2 to remove the
››› Fig. 169 2 until it engages. net from the casing ››› Fig. 171 4 .
Fig. 170 Assembling the net partition in the ● Hook in the net partition on the right side
The red markings on the release buttons
should no longer be visible. rear seat backrests. ››› Fig. 171 3 (magnified image). »
159
Operation

● Hook in the net partition in the left side WARNING


housing ››› Fig. 171 1 pulling the rod.
The rear seat backrests should only be lifted
The net partition is properly assembled when again once the net partition has been disas-
the T-shaped ends are firmly secured in the sembled.
corresponding housings ››› Fig. 171 3 and
1 . CAUTION
Incorrect handling of the net partition could
Retracting the net partition cause damage.
● Remove the rod from the housings in the ● Do not “release” the net partition when
trims of the roof side members. lowering it, as the net and other vehicle parts Fig. 173 In the luggage compartment: open-
● Roll up the net into the casing ››› Fig. 171 could be damaged. Roll down the net parti- ing the tailboard.
4 lowering it with your hand. tion by hand.
On the rear seat, behind the central armrest,
Removing the net partition there is a tailboard for transporting long
Tailboard for transporting long items* items in the interior, such as skis.
● Pull the net casing out approximately 5 cm
in the opposite direction to the arrow To avoid soiling the interior, dirty objects
››› Fig. 170 2 . should be wrapped (e.g. in a blanket) before
● Remove the casing from the rails by pulling they are inserted through the tailboard.
in the opposite direction to the arrows When the armrest is down, nobody may trav-
››› Fig. 1701 . el in the centre rear seat.
● Lift the rear seat backrests.
Opening the tailboard
WARNING ● Lower the centre armrest.
During a sudden driving or braking manoeu- ● Pull the release lever in the direction of the
vre, or in the event of an accident, objects arrow and push the tailboard cover
could be flung though the interior and cause Fig. 172 On the rear seat backrest: opening ››› Fig. 172
1 down and forwards.
serious or fatal injuries. the tailboard.
● Open the rear lid.
● Always secure objects, even when the net
partition is properly assembled. ● Insert the long objects through the gap
● There should be nobody behind the assem-
from the luggage compartment.
bled partition when the vehicle is moving. ● Secure the objects with the seatbelt.

160
Transport and practical equipment

● Close the rear lid. Fastening rings* In the front and rear part of the luggage com-

Technical data
partment there are fastening rings to secure
Closing the tailboard the luggage ››› Fig. 175.
● Lift the tailboard cover until it engages. The In order to use the fastening rings, they must
red mark on the luggage compartment side be lifted beforehand1).
should never be visible.
● Close the rear lid. WARNING
● Lift the centre armrest if necessary. If unsuitable or damaged belts or retaining

Advice
straps are used, they could break in the event
Note of braking or an accident. Objects could then
be launched across the passenger compart-
The tailboard can also be opened from the ment and cause serious or fatal injuries.
luggage compartment. To do so, press the re- Fig. 174 In the luggage compartment: fasten- ● Always use belts or retaining straps that
lease lever down, in the direction of the ar- ing rings (LEON/LEON SC model except ver-
are suitable and in a good condition.
row, and the cover upwards ››› Fig. 173. sions with spare wheel and CNG).

Operation
● Belts and retaining straps should be se-
curely fastened to the fastening rings.
● Objects in the luggage compartment that
are unsecured could move suddenly and mod-
ify the handling of the vehicle.
● Secure all objects, little and large.

Emergencies
● Never exceed the maximum tensile load of
the fastening ring when securing objects.
● Never secure a child seat to the fastening
rings.

Fig. 175 In the luggage compartment: fasten- Note


ing rings (LEON ST model).

Safety
● The maximum tensile load that the fasten-
ing rings can support is 3.5 kN. »

1) Valid only for the LEON ST model.


161
Operation

● Belts and securing systems for the appro- Net bag*


priate load can be obtained from specialised
dealerships. SEAT recommends visiting a
SEAT dealership for this.
● The fastening rings are rendered unusable
for versions with spare wheel and CNG.

Retaining hooks
Fig. 177 In the luggage compartment: retain-
ing hooks (LEON ST model).
Fig. 178 In the luggage compartment: net
At the rear of the luggage compartment, on bag hooked up at floor level (LEON ST model).
the left and right, there are fixed retaining
hooks ››› Fig. 177.
The retaining hooks have been designed to
secure light shopping bags.
In the front and rear part of the luggage com-
partment there are fastening rings to secure
Fig. 176 In the luggage compartment: retain- the luggage ››› Fig. 174 and ››› Fig. 175.
ing hooks (LEON/LEON SC model).
WARNING
Never use the retaining hooks as fastening
rings. In case of sudden braking or an acci- Fig. 179 In the luggage compartment: rings
dent, the hooks could break. 1 and hooks 2 for securing the net bag
(LEON ST model).
CAUTION
The luggage compartment prevents light lug-
Each hook is designed for a maximum load of gage from moving. The net bag has a zip and
2.5 kg. can be used to store small objects.

162
Transport and practical equipment

The net bag can be hooked up to the luggage up it is taut. If the net bag is hooked up or un-

Technical data
compartment in different ways. hooked incorrectly the hooks could cause in-
juries.
Hooking the net bag into the luggage com- ● Always secure the net hooks properly so
partment floor that they do not suddenly release from the
● As applicable, lift the front fastening rings fastening rings when hooking or unhooking
››› Fig. 178 2 . them.
● On hooking or unhooking them, protect
● Secure the net hooks to the fastening rings
your eyes and face in case the hooks are re-

Advice
2 ››› . The bag zip should be facing up- leased suddenly.
wards.
● Always hook up the net bag hooks in the Fig. 181 Luggage compartment: variable
● Secure the net hooks to the fastening rings
described order. If a hook is unexpectedly re- floor
1 . leased the risk of injury is increased.
Variable floor in the tilted position
Hook the net bag next to the load threshold

Operation
When the variable floor is tilted you can ac-
● Secure the short net hooks to the fastening Luggage compartment variable floor cess the spare wheel/anti-puncture kit area.
rings ››› Fig. 179 1 ››› . The bag zip should
3 Applies to the model: LEON/LEON SC ● Lift the variable floor using handle
be facing upwards.
● Secure the straps in the bag hooks 2 . ››› Fig. 180 1 , pull it back and push the
backrest of the rear seat until the movable

Emergencies
part of the floor is resting on it.
Removing the net bag
● Rest the floor on its housings ››› Fig. 181
The hooked up net bag is taut ››› .
(arrows).
● Remove the hooks and the net bag straps
from the fastening rings and from the bag
hooks.
● Store the net bag in the luggage compart-

Safety
ment.
Fig. 180 Luggage compartment: variable
WARNING floor
To secure the elastic net bag on the fastening
rings it must be stretched out. Once hooked

163
Operation

Luggage compartment variable floor ● Move the floor forward over the supports as ● Always secure objects, even when the lug-
3 Applies to the model: LEON ST
far as the rear seat backrest and then lower gage compartment floor is properly lifted.
the floor with the handle 1 . ● Only objects that do not protrude more
than 2/3 the height of the floor may be car-
Variable floor in the low position ried between the rear seat and the raised lug-
● Lift the floor using handle ››› Fig. 182 1 gage compartment floor.
and pull it back until the front of the floor has ● Only objects that do not weigh than ap-
fully passed the supports 2 . proximately 7.5 kg may be carried between
● Now match the front part with the lower the rear seat and the raised luggage compart-
ment floor.
grooves of the supports and slide the floor
forwards as far as the rear seat backrest and
lower the floor at the same time with the han- CAUTION
dle 1 . ● The maximum weight that can be loaded on
Fig. 182 Luggage compartment variable
the luggage compartment variable floor in
floor: positions.
Variable floor in the tilted position the top position is 150 kg.
When the variable floor is tilted you can ac- ● Do not let the luggage compartment floor
cess the spare wheel/anti-puncture kit area. fall when closing it. Always carefully guide it
downwards in a controlled manner. Other-
● Lift the variable floor using handle wise, the lining and the floor of the luggage
››› Fig. 182 1 and pull it back until the front compartment could be damaged.
of the floor has fully passed the tilted
grooves ››› Fig. 183 3 . Note
● Run the floor through these grooves with
SEAT recommends the use of straps to secure
the help of handle 1 as the rear seat back- objects to retaining rings.
rest and until the floor is resting in the
grooves.
Fig. 183 Luggage compartment variable
floor: grooves tilted.
WARNING Roof carrier
Variable floor in the high position During a sudden driving or braking manoeu-
● Lift the floor using handle ››› Fig. 182 1
vre, or in the event of an accident, objects Introduction
could be flung though the interior and cause
and pull it back until the front of the floor has serious or fatal injuries. The vehicle roof has been designed to opti-
fully passed the supports 2 . mise aerodynamics. For this reason, cross
164
Transport and practical equipment

bars or conventional roof carrier systems can- CAUTION Attach the cross bars and the roof car-

Technical data
not be secured to the roof water drains. rier system
● Remove the cross bars and the roof carrier
As the roof water drains are integrated in the system before entering a car wash.
roof to reduce air resistance, only SEAT-ap- ● Vehicle height is increased by the installa-
proved cross bars and roof carrier systems tion of cross bars or a roof carrier system and
can be used. the load secured on them. For this purpose,
check that your vehicle's height does not sur-
Cases in which cross bars and the roof carri- pass the headspace limit, for example, for un-

Advice
er system should be disassembled. derpasses or for entering garage doors.
● When they are not used. ● Cross bars, a roof carrier system and the
load secured on them should not interfere
● When the vehicle is washed in a car wash.
with the roof aerial or hamper the path of the
● When the vehicle height exceeds the maxi- panoramic sun roof ››› page 133 and the rear
mum height, for example, in some garages. lid.

Operation
● On opening the rear lid make sure that it
WARNING does not knock into the roof load.
When heavy or bulky loads are transported
on the roof carrier system, car driving per- For the sake of the environment
formance is affected, as the centre of gravity
shifts and there is greater wind resistance. When cross bars and a roof carrier system are
installed, the increased air resistance means

Emergencies
● Always secure the load properly using belts that the vehicle uses more fuel.
or retaining straps that are suitable and in a
good condition.
● Bulky, heavy, long or flat loads have a neg- Fig. 184 Leon/Leon SC: attachment points for
ative effect on aerodynamics, the centre of the roof railings for the roof carrier system. »
gravity and driving performance.
● Avoid sudden braking and manoeuvres.

Safety
● Adapt your speed and driving style at all
times to suit visibility, weather, road and traf-
fic conditions.

165
Operation

rear attachment points 3 are marked on the Note


top edge of the glass with arrow heads
››› Fig. 184 B. Always read the assembly instructions that
come with the crossbars and the roof carrier
system carefully and keep them in the vehi-
LEON ST model cle.
The crossbars are assembled on the roof rail-
ings. The attachment points can be seen on
bottom of the roof railing ››› Fig. 185. Loading the roof carrier system
WARNING The load can only be secured if the crossbars
Fig. 185 Leon ST: attachment points for the and the roof carrier system are properly in-
Incorrect attachment and use of the cross-
roof railings for the roof carrier system. stalled ››› .
bars and the roof carrier system may cause
the whole system to detach from the roof and
The crossbars are the basis of a series of spe- cause an accident and injuries. Maximum authorised roof load
cial roof carrier systems. For safety reasons,
● Always take the manufacturer assembly in-
special fixtures must be used to safely trans- The maximum permissible roof load is 75 kg.
structions into account.
port luggage, bicycles, skis, surf boards or This figure comes from the combined weight
● Use only crossbars and the roof carrier sys- of the roof carrier, the cross bars and the load
boats on the roof. Suitable accessories can
be acquired at SEAT dealerships. tem when they are in perfect condition and itself on the roof ››› .
are properly secured.
Always secure the crossbars and the roof car- ● Secure the crossbars and the roof carrier
Always check the weight of the roof carrier
rier system properly. Always take the assem- system properly. system, the cross bars and the weight of the
bly instructions that come with the crossbars load to be transported and weigh them if
● Check threaded joints and attachments
and the roof carrier system in question into necessary. Never exceed the maximum au-
travelling and if necessary tighten them after
account. thorised roof load.
you have travelled a short distance. When
making long trips, check the threaded joints If you are using cross bars and a roof carrier
LEON model whenever you stop for a rest. with a lower weight rating, you will not be
The front and rear attachment points 1 and ● Always fit the special roof carrier systems able to carry the maximum authorised roof
2 are only visible when the doors are open correctly for wheels, skis and surfboards, etc. load. In this case, do not exceed the maxi-
››› Fig. 184 A. ● Do not modify or repair the crossbars or mum weight limit for the roof carrier which is
roof carrier system. listed in the fitting instructions.
Leon SC model
The front and rear attachment points 1 are
only visible when the doors are open. The
166
Air conditioning

Distributing a load
Air conditioning WARNING

Technical data
Distribute loads uniformly and secure them Reduced visibility through the windows in-
correctly ››› .
Heating, ventilation and cool- creases the risk of serious accidents.
● Always ensure that all windows are free of
Check attachments ing ice and snow, and that they are not fogged,
Once the cross bars and roof carrier system so as to maintain good visibility of everything
have been installed, check the bolted con- Introduction outside.
nections and attachments after a short jour- ● The maximum heat output required to de-
Read the additional information carefully

Advice
ney and subsequently with a certain frequen- frost windows as quickly as possible is only
cy.
›››  page 48 available when the engine has reached its
normal running temperature. Only drive when
WARNING
Viewing Climatronic information you have good visibility.

Exceeding the maximum authorised roof load


On the screen of Climatronic control unit and ● Always ensure that you use the heating
on the screen of the factory-fitted Easy Con- system, fresh air system, air conditioner and
can result in accidents and considerable vehi-

Operation
nect system, the theoretical values of the the heated rear window to maintain good visi-
cle damage.
temperature zones are shown. bility to the outside.
● Never exceed the maximum authorised
● Never leave the air recirculation on for a
load on the roof and on the axles or the vehi- The unit of temperature measurement can be
long period of time. If the cooling system is
cle's maximum authorised weight. changed in the Easy Connect system. switched off and air recirculation mode
● Never exceed the load capacity of the cross switched on, the windows can mist over very
bars and the roof carrier system, even if the Dust and pollen filter

Emergencies
quickly, considerably limiting visibility.
maximum authorised roof load has not been
The dust and pollen filter with its activated ● Switch air recirculation mode off when it is
reached.
charcoal cartridge serves as a barrier against not required.
● Secure heavy items as far forward as possi-
impurities in the air taken into the vehicle in-
ble and distribute the vehicle load uniformly.
terior. WARNING
The dust and pollen filter must be changed Stuffy or used air will increase fatigue and re-
WARNING
regularly so that air conditioner performance duce driver concentration possibly resulting

Safety
If the load is loose or not secured, it could fall is not adversely affected. in a serious accident.
from the roof carrier system or cause acci-
If the filter loses efficiency prematurely due ● Never leave the fresh air fan turned off or
dents and injuries.
to use in areas with very high levels of air use the air recirculation for long periods of
● Always use belts or retaining straps that time; the air in the vehicle interior will not be
pollution, the filter must be changed more
are suitable and in a good condition.
frequently than stated in the Service Sched- refreshed. »
● Secure the load properly.
ule.
167
Operation

CAUTION Adjust using the Easy Connect sys- Function


tem* Function
● Switch the air conditioner off if you think it button
may be broken. This will avoid additional 3 Applies to vehicles with a Media System
Switch off and switch on the Climatron-
damage. Have the air conditioner checked by Touch/Colour. OFF
ic.
a specialised workshop.
In the Easy Connect system it is also possible The air conditioning settings submenu
● Repairs to the air conditioner require spe-
to perform various adjustments to the Clima- is opened. It is possible to make the fol-
cialist knowledge and special tools. SEAT rec-
ommends visiting a SEAT Official Service.
tronic. lowing adjustments:
Function button Air conditioning profile. : to
adjust the level of the fan in AUTO
Open the air conditioner menu
Note mode. You can choose between low,
SETUP
● Press the  button on the Climatronic medium and high.
● When the cooling system is turned off, air Function button Automatic air recirculation
control panel.
coming from the outside will not be dried. To to switch on and off automatic air recir-
prevent fogging of the windows, SEAT recom- ● OR: press the MENU button in Easy Con- culation ››› page 170.
mends leaving the cooling system (compres- nect. With the rotating switch select the air BACK  function button to close the
sor) turned on. To do this, press the button conditioner menu and open it. submenu.
 . The button lamp should light up.
On the touch screen you can see and change
● The maximum heat output required to de-
the current settings, for example, the temper-
frost windows as quickly as possible is only Adjust using the Easy Connect sys-
available when the engine has reached its
ature set for the driver and passenger sides,
the air distribution and the fan speed. With tem*
normal running temperature.
button  the driver and passenger side 3 Applies to vehicles with a Media System Plus/Navi
● Keep the air intake slots in front of the
temperatures are synchronised ››› Book- System.
windscreen free of snow, ice and leaves to en-
let Media System Touch/Colour, chapter Air
sure heating and cooling are not impaired, In the Easy Connect system it is also possible
and to prevent the windows from misting conditioning.
to perform various adjustments to the Clima-
over. To switch a function on or off, or to select a tronic.
submenu, you must press the corresponding
function button. Open the air conditioner menu
For more information about functions ● Press the  button on the Climatronic
››› page 114. control panel.

On the top of the screen you can see and


change the current settings, such as, for ex-
ample, the temperature set for the driver side
168
Air conditioning

and for that of passenger. Temperatures up Function The cooling system cannot be activated

Technical data
to +22°C (+72°F) are shown with blue arrows, Function
button If the air conditioning system cannot be
and temperatures over +22°C (+72°F) with switched on, this may be caused by the fol-
red arrows. Activate/deactivate the automatic acti-
lowing:
vation of the supplementary heating for
To switch a function on or off, or to select a colder countries (only for engines with
Automatic ● The engine is not running.
submenu, you must press the corresponding supplementary heating). With the option
supplemen-
function button. deactivated, depending on the outside ● The fan is switched off.
tary heating
temperature the heating may need more
● The air conditioner fuse has blown.
time than normal to reach a comfortable

Advice
Function ● The outside temperature is lower than ap-
Function temperature.
button
proximately +3°C (+38°F).
Air condi- Adjust the fan level in AUTO mode. You ● The air conditioner compressor has been
tioning pro- can choose between low, medium and
file high.
Air conditioning user instructions temporarily switched off because the engine
coolant temperature is too high.
The interior cooling system only works when

Operation
OFF Climatronic is switched off. ● Another fault in the vehicle. Have the air
the engine is running and fan is switched on. conditioner checked by a specialised work-
ON Climatronic is switched on.
The air conditioner operates most effectively shop.
The air conditioning settings submenu with the windows and the panoramic sliding
is opened. It is possible to make the fol- Special Characteristics
sunroof closed. However, if the vehicle has
lowing adjustments:
Function button Air conditioning profile. : to heated up after standing in the sun for some If the humidity and temperature outside the

Emergencies
adjust the level of the fan in AUTO time, the air inside can be cooled more quick- vehicle are high, condensation can drip off
mode. You can choose between low, me- ly by opening the windows and the panoram- the evaporator in the cooling system and
SETUP
dium and high. ic sliding sunroof briefly. form a pool underneath the vehicle. This is
Function button Automatic air recirculation
to switch on and off automatic air recir- normal and does not indicate a leak!
culation ››› page 170.
Climatronic: change the temperature unit on
BACK  function button to close the the screen of the radio or on the factory-fit- Note
submenu. ted navigation system
After starting the engine, any residual humid-

Safety
Changing the temperature display from Cel- ity in the air conditioner could mist over the
sius to Fahrenheit on radio or on the factory- windscreen. Switch on the defrost function as
fitted navigation system is done using the soon as possible to clear the windscreen of
menu on the instrument panel condensation.
›››  page 33.

169
Operation

Air outlets

Fig. 186 On the dash panel: air vents

Air vents Note When the outside temperature is very high,


To ensure proper heating, cooling and venti- selecting manual air recirculation mode for a
Food, medicine and other heat or cold sensi- short period refreshes the vehicle interior
lation in the vehicle interior, air vents tive objects should never be placed in front of
››› Fig. 186 1 should remain open. more quickly.
the air outlets as they may be damaged or
made unsuitable for use by the air coming For safety reasons, air recirculation mode is
● Turn the corresponding thumbwheel (de- from the air vents. switched off when the button  is press-
tail) in the required direction to open and ed or the air distributor turned to .
close the air vents. When the thumbwheel is
in the  position, the corresponding air vent
Air recirculation mode Switching the manual air recirculation mode
is closed.
on and off 
● Change the air direction using the ventila- Basic points To switch system on: press the  button un-
tion grille lever.
Air recirculation: til the warning lamp lights up.
There are other additional, non-adjustable air To switch system off: press the  button un-
vents in the dash panel 2 , in the footwell  Manual recirculation
til the warning lamp goes off.
and in the rear area of the interior.
Air recirculation mode prevents the ambient
air from entering the interior.
170
Driving

Functioning mode of automatic air recircula- ● If the cooling system is switched off and air Driving

Technical data
tion (air conditioning menu) recirculation mode switched on, the windows
With the automatic air recirculation mode ac- can mist over very quickly, considerably limit-
tivated, the entry of fresh air into the cabin ing visibility. Ignition lock
interior is enabled. If the system detects a ● Switch air recirculation mode off when it is
high concentration of hazardous substances not required. Switching the ignition on and starting
in the ambient air, air recirculation mode is the engine with the key
switched on automatically. When the level of CAUTION
impurities drops to within a normal range, re-

Advice
Do not smoke when air recirculation is
circulation mode is switched off.
switched on in vehicles with an air condition-
The system is unable to detect unpleasant er. The smoke taken in could lie on the cool-
smells. ing system vaporiser and on the activated
charcoal cartridge of the dust and pollen fil-
The air recirculation will not connect auto- ter, leading to a permanently unpleasant
matically in versions without humidity sensor

Operation
smell.
and in the following external conditions:
● The outside temperature is lower than +3°C Note
(+38°F). Climatronic: air recirculation mode is activa- Fig. 187 Ignition key positions.
● The cooling system is switched off and the ted to prevent exhaust gas or unpleasant
outside temperature is below +10°C (+50°F). odours from entering the vehicle interior Read the additional information carefully

Emergencies
when it is in reverse and while the automatic ›››  page 27
● The cooling system is switched off, the out-
windscreen wiper is working.
side temperature is below +15°C (+59°F) and
Diesel engines can take a few seconds longer
the windscreen wipers are switched on.
than usual to start on cold days. Therefore
Activation/deactivation of automatic air recir- the clutch pedal (manual gearbox) or the
culation is done in the air conditioner menu, brake pedal (automatic gearbox) must re-
under Configuration. main pressed until the engine starts up. Dur-

Safety
ing preheating, the warning lamp  remains
WARNING lit.
Observe the safety warnings ››› in Intro- The preheating time depends on the coolant
duction on page 167. and exterior temperatures. With the engine at
operating temperature, or at outside temper-
atures above +8°C, the warning lamp  will »
171
Operation

light up for about one second. This means Select N or P WARNING


that the engine starts immediately. This message appears if you try to start or ● Never run the engine in confined spaces, as
If the engine does not immediately start up, stop the engine when the selector lever of the exhaust gases are poisonous.
interrupt the starting process and try again the automatic gearbox is not in position P or
after 30 seconds. To start the engine again, N. The engine can only start or stop in certain
CAUTION
return the key to position 1 . positions.
Avoid high engine speeds, full throttle and
Start-Stop System* Engage position P; the vehicle extreme load conditions until the engine has
can move; doors can only close in reached its normal operating temperature,
If the vehicle is stopped and the Start-Stop otherwise this can damage the engine.
position P.
system* switches off the engine, the ignition
remains switched on. For safety reasons, this driver message ap-
pears and an audible warning sounds if the For the sake of the environment
Automatic gearbox: before leaving the vehi- selector lever of the automatic gearbox is not Do not warm up the engine by idling it. You
cle, make sure that the ignition is switched in position P after you switch off the ignition. should drive off as soon as you start the en-
off and the selector lever is in position P. Put the selector lever in position P, otherwise gine. This will help avoid unnecessary ex-
the vehicle could roll away. haust emissions.
Driver messages on the instrument panel
display Gear change: selector lever in Note
the drive position!
Press the clutch ● If it is difficult to turn the ignition key to
This driver message is displayed when the the position 1 , turn the steering wheel to
This message appears on vehicles with a selector lever is not in the position P when both sides to release the steering lock.
manual gearbox if the driver tries to start the the driver door is opened. Additionally, a ● When starting from cold, the engine may be
engine without having the clutch pedal buzzer will sound. Put the selector lever in a little noisy for the first few seconds until oil
pressed. The engine will only start if you position P, otherwise the vehicle could roll pressure has built up in the hydraulic valve
press the clutch pedal. away. lifters. This is quite normal, and no cause for
concern.
Press the brake Ignition is switched on ● If the vehicle battery is disconnected and
This message appears on vehicles with an This driver message is displayed and a buz- reconnected, the key must remain in the posi-
automatic gearbox if the driver tries to start tion 1 for around 5 seconds before starting
zer is sounded when the driver door is
the engine without having the brake pedal up.
opened with the ignition switched on.
pressed.

172
Driving

● Depending on the country, vehicles with an As you cannot steer and brake in the normal ● If the vehicle is stopped and the Start-Stop

Technical data
automatic gearbox: after switching off the ig- manner, there is a greater risk of accidents system* switches off the engine, the ignition
nition, you can only remove the ignition key if and serious injury. remains switched on. Make sure that the igni-
the selector lever is in position “P” (parking ● Never remove the key from the ignition if tion is switched off before leaving the vehi-
lock). Next, the selector lever is locked. the vehicle is in motion. Otherwise, the steer- cle, otherwise the battery could discharge.
ing could suddenly lock, making it impossible
to steer the vehicle: risk of accident!
Switching off the engine with the key ● Always take the key with you when you
leave the vehicle. This is particularly impor-

Advice
Switching off the engine tant if there are children in the vehicle, as
they might otherwise be able to start the en-
– Stop the vehicle.
gine or use power-operated equipment (e.g.
– Turn the ignition key to position 1 the electric windows), which could cause in-
››› Fig. 187. juries.

Operation
Engaging the steering wheel lock CAUTION
In vehicles with automatic gearbox, the igni- If the engine has been running under high
tion key can only be removed when the selec- load for a long time, there is a risk of heat
tor lever is in position P. building up in the engine compartment after
it has been switched off; this could cause en-
– Remove the key from the ignition in posi-

Emergencies
gine damage. For this reason, you should idle
tion 1 ››› Fig. 187 ››› . the engine for approximately 2 minutes be-
– Turn the steering wheel until you hear it en- fore you switch it off.
gage.
Possible vehicle theft is prevented with the Note
steering lock engaged. ● After the engine is switched off the radiator
fan may run on for up to 10 minutes, even if
the ignition is switched off. It is also possible

Safety
WARNING
that the fan turns itself on once more if the
● Never switch the engine off until the vehi-
coolant temperature increases due to the
cle is stationary. The brake servo and power
heat accumulated in the engine compartment
steering functions will not be completely cov-
or due to its prolonged exposure to solar ra-
ered under warranty. More force may also be
diation.
needed to turn the steering wheel or to brake.
173
Operation

Starter button* Opening the driver's door when exiting the trim of the steering column ››› Fig. 189, as
vehicle activates the electronic lock on the close as possible to the Kessy logo.
steering column if the ignition is disabled. ● The ignition connects and the engine starts
automatically.
Switching the ignition on/off manually
Briefly push the starter button without touch- Emergency disconnection
ing the brake or clutch pedal ››› . If the engine does not switch off after briefly
For vehicles with both manual and automatic pressing the starter button, an emergency
transmission, the starter button text disconnect will be required:
START ENGINE STOP flashes like a heartbeat
● Press the starter button twice within 3 sec-
when the system is preset for switching the
onds or press it once for more than 1 sec-
ignition on and off.
Fig. 188 In the lower part of the centre con- ond ››› .
sole: starter button. ● The engine turns off automatically.
Automatic ignition switch-off
If the driver leaves the vehicle, taking the ve-
Engine restart feature
hicle key with them but leaving the ignition
on, the ignition is switched off automatically If no valid key is detected inside the vehicle
after a certain time. If at that time the dipped after the engine stops, you will only have 5
beam is on, the parking lights will stay on for seconds to restart it. A warning will display
approx. 30 minutes. The side light can be on the dash panel screen.
turned off by blocking the vehicle After this interval, it will not be possible to
››› page 120 or manually ››› page 135. start the engine without a valid key inside
the vehicle.
Emergency starting function
Fig. 189 On the right of the steering column: If no valid key is detected inside the vehicle, Automatic deactivation of the ignition on ve-
emergency start. an emergency start-up will be required. The hicles with the Start-Stop system
relevant message will appear in the dash The ignition is switched off automatically
The vehicle engine can be started with a panel display. This may happen when, for ex- when the vehicle is stopped and the auto-
starter button (Press & Drive). To do so, there ample, the battery of the vehicle key button matic engine shutdown is active, if:
must be a valid key inside the vehicle in the is very low or flat:
area of the front or rear seats. ● The driver's seat belt is not fastened,
● Immediately after pushing the starter but-
● the driver does not step on any pedal,
ton, keep the vehicle key next to the right
174
Driving

● the driver door is opened. ● If the vehicle is stationary for a long time Starting the engine with the starter

Technical data
Step
After automatically turning off the ignition, if
with the ignition on, the vehicle battery button ››› page 174.
might be discharged and it might not be pos-
the dipped beam  is on, the side light re- sible to start the engine. Briefly press the starter button ››› Fig. 188
mains on for approx. 30 minutes (if the bat- without pressing the accelerator. For the en-
● In diesel vehicles, there may be a delay in
tery is sufficiently charged). If the driver locks gine to start there must be a valid key in the
the engine starting if it requires preheating. 3. vehicle.
the vehicle or manually turns off the light, the
● If during the STOP phase you press the After starting the engine, the light of the
side light goes out.
START ENGINE STOP button, the ignition is START ENGINE STOP button changes to a fixed
switched off and the button flashes. light indicating that the engine has started.

Advice
WARNING
● If the indication “Start-Stop system deacti- If the engine does not start, stop and wait for
Any accidental movement of the vehicle could vated: Start the engine manually” is dis- approx. 1 minute before trying again. If nec-
result in serious injury. 4.
played on the dash panel display, the essary, perform an emergency start
● When switching on the ignition, do not START ENGINE STOP button will blink. ››› page 174.
press the brake or clutch pedal, otherwise
the engine could start immediately. Disconnect the parking brake when you are
5.

Operation
about to start driving ››› page 177.
Starting the engine
WARNING WARNING
3 Valid for vehicles: with starter button
If vehicle keys are used negligently or with- Never leave the vehicle with the engine run-
out due care, this may cause accidents and Starting the engine with the starter ning, especially if a gear or gear range is en-
serious injury. Step
button ››› page 174. gaged. The vehicle could then suddenly move

Emergencies
● Never leave any key inside the vehicle or something strange could happen that
when exiting. Otherwise, a child or unauthor- Press and hold the brake pedal until step 5 would cause damage, fire or serious injury.
1.
ised person could lock the vehicle, start the is performed.
engine or connect the ignition and, in this In vehicles with a manual gearbox: press
way, operate electronic equipment (e.g. the WARNING
1a. and hold the clutch down until the engine
windows). starts. Cold start sprays could explode or cause a
sudden increase in the engine speed.
Put the gearbox lever in neutral or the selec-
Note 2. ● Never use sprays to cold start the engine.

Safety
tor lever in position P or N.
● Before leaving the vehicle, always discon-
nect the ignition manually and, if appropri- CAUTION
ate, take into account the instructions on the ● The starter motor or the engine may be
screen of the dash panel. damaged if you try to start the engine while »
175
Operation

driving or if you restart it immediately after Stopping the engine ● Power steering does not work when the en-
switching it off. 3 Valid for vehicles: with starter button gine is not running. You need more strength
● If the engine is cold, avoid high engine to steer when the engine is switched off.
speeds, pushing the engine too hard and rap- Switch off the engine with the starter ● If the ignition is switched off, the steering
Step
id acceleration. button ››› page 174. column could be locked, making it impossible
● Do not start the engine by pushing the ve- to control the vehicle.
1. Stop the vehicle completely ››› .
hicle or towing it. Unburnt fuel could enter
the catalytic converter and damage it. Press and hold the brake pedal until the step CAUTION
2.
4 is performed.
If the engine is made to work hard for a long
Note If you are driving an automatic vehicle, place time, it may overheat after being switched
3.
● Do not wait until the engine warms up with the selector lever in position P. off. To prevent damage to the engine before
the vehicle stationary; if you have good visi- switching it off, leave it idle for approx. 2 mi-
Connect the electronic parking brake nutes in neutral.
bility through the windows, start driving im- 4.
››› page 177.
mediately. This helps the engine reach oper-
ating temperature faster and reduces emis- Briefly press the start-up button ››› Fig. 188. Note
sions. The START ENGINE STOP button blinks again. If
5. After switching off the engine, the cooling fan
the engine fails to switch off, perform an
● Electrical components with a high power
emergency disconnect ››› page 174. may continue to operate in the engine com-
consumption are switched off temporarily partment for a few more minutes, even with
when the engine starts. If the vehicle is equipped with a manual the ignition off. The radiator fan is automati-
6.
● When starting with a cold engine, noise gearbox, put it into 1st or reverse. cally switched off.
levels may briefly increase. This is quite nor-
mal, and no cause for concern. WARNING
● When the outside temperature is below Never switch off the engine while the vehicle “My Beat” Function
+5°C (+41°F), if the engine is diesel, some is moving. This could cause loss of control of
smoke may appear under the vehicle when the vehicle, accidents and serious injury.
the fuel-operated auxiliary heater is on.
● The airbags and belt tensioners do not
work when the ignition is switched off.
● The brake servo does not work with the en-
gine off. Therefore, you need to press the
break pedal harder to brake the vehicle.
Fig. 190 Related video

176
Driving

For vehicles with a convenience key there is ● When the engine cannot be stated again ● Pull and hold the  ››› Fig. 191 button.

Technical data
the “My Beat” function. This feature provides with the Start-Stop system, ››› page 196, and ● The parking brake is activated when the
an additional indication of the vehicle igni- needs to be started manually, the control light of the ››› Fig. 191 button (arrow)
tion system. START ENGINE STOP button flashes to indicate
and the red  control light of the display in
this fact. the dash panel are on.
When accessing the vehicle, e.g. by opening
the doors with the remote control, the ● Release the button.
START ENGINE STOP button flashes, calling at-
tention to the relevant starter system button. Braking and parking Releasing the electronic parking brake

Advice
Upon switching the ignition on/off, the light ● Switch the ignition on.
of the START ENGINE STOP button flashes. With Electronic parking brake* ● Press the button  ››› Fig. 191. At the same
the engine switched off, after a few seconds, time step hard on the brake pedal or, if the
the STOP ENGINE START button stops flashing engine is running, press the accelerator ped-
and goes out. al slightly.

Operation
With the engine running, the ● The control light of the ››› Fig. 191 button
START ENGINE STOP button light stays on, indi- (arrow) and the red  control light of the dis-
cating that the engine is running. The time play in the dash panel go out.
that lapses between the moment the user
starts the engine with the START ENGINE STOP Automatic release of the electronic parking
button and the lighting changes from flash- brake on starting the engine

Emergencies
ing to fixed will depend on specific engine
size characteristics. Upon switching the igni- The electronic parking brake is automatically
tion off with the START ENGINE STOP button, it Fig. 191 In the lower part of the centre con- switched off when starting if, after the driv-
starts flashing again. sole: electronic parking brake button. er's door is closed and the driver's seat belt
fastened, any of the following situations take
In vehicles with the Start-Stop system, the The electronic parking brake replaces the place:
“My Beat” function also offers additional in- handbrake.
formation: ● On vehicles with an automatic gearbox: A
gear range is engaged or the vehicle is

Safety
Activating the electronic parking brake
● When the engine stops during the Stop switched to another one and the accelerator
phase, the light of the START ENGINE STOP but- The electronic parking brake can be activated pedal is lightly pressed.
ton stays on, since, even though the engine whenever the vehicle is at a standstill, even
● In vehicles with a manual gearbox: The
is off, the Start-Stop system is active. when the ignition is switched off. Activate it
whenever you leave or park the vehicle. clutch pedal is pressed fully before starting »

177
Operation

off and the accelerator is pedal lightly ● Pull and hold the  ››› Fig. 191 button in ● If the vehicle battery is flat, it will not be
pressed. this position to forcefully stop the vehicle. At possible to disconnect the electronic parking
● To facilitate certain manoeuvres there are the same time, an acoustic warning can be brake. Use the jump-start ›››  page 65.
exceptions that allow the automatic parking heard. ● When the electronic parking brake is ap-
brake to be released without the driver's seat ● To stop the braking process, release the plied or released, noises may be heard.
belt being fastened. button or press the accelerator. ● The system performs automatic and audi-
ble tests sporadically in the parked vehicle if
The parking brake can be prevented from be- WARNING some time elapses without the electronic
ing automatically released by continuously parking brake being used.
pulling up the  ››› Fig. 191 switch when The improper use of the electronic parking
brake can cause accidents and serious injury.
starting off.
● Never use the electronic parking brake to
The electronic parking brake is not discon- stop the vehicle, unless it is an emergency. Using the handbrake
nected until the  button is released. This The braking distance may be considerably
can facilitate starting off when a heavy load longer. Always use the foot brake.
is towed ››› page 241. ● Never accelerate from the engine when a
gear range or a gear is engaged and the en-
Automatic activation of the electronic park- gine is running. The vehicle could move, even
ing brake when exiting the vehicle incorrect- if the electronic parking brake is activated.
ly
In vehicles with automatic transmission, the CAUTION
electronic parking brake is activated auto- To prevent the vehicle from unintentionally
matically when exiting the vehicle incorrectly moving when parking it, first apply the elec-
if: tronic parking brake and then remove your
foot from the brake pedal. Fig. 192 Handbrake between the front seats.
● The selector lever is in the D/S or R posi-
tion or in the Tiptronic selection track. The handbrake should be applied firmly to
Note
● AND: the vehicle is stationary. prevent the vehicle from accidentally rolling
● AND: the driver door is open.
● In vehicles with a manual gearbox, releas- away.
ing the clutch and accelerating at the same
time automatically disconnects the electronic Always apply the handbrake when you leave
Emergency braking function parking brake. your vehicle and when you park.
Only use the emergency brake function if you
are unable to stop the vehicle with the foot
brake ››› .
178
Driving

Applying the handbrake system and could lead to an accident. This al- ● If the vehicle is parked facing uphill, turn

Technical data
– Pull the handbrake lever up firmly so causes premature wear on the rear brake the front wheels so that they point away from
››› Fig. 192. pads. the kerb.
● Secure the vehicle as usual by applying the
Releasing the handbrake CAUTION handbrake firmly and putting it in 1st gear.
– Pull the lever up slightly and press the re- Always apply the handbrake before you leave
WARNING
lease knob in the direction of the arrow the vehicle. Put it in 1st gear as well.
››› Fig. 192 and guide the handbrake lever ● Take measures to reduce the risk of injury

Advice
down fully ››› . when you leave your vehicle unattended.
● Never park where the hot exhaust system
Always pull the handbrake all the way up, so Parking
could ignite inflammable materials, such as
there is less risk of driving off with it still en- dry grass, low bushes, spilt fuel etc.
The handbrake should always be firmly ap-
gaged ››› . ● Never allow vehicle occupants to remain in
plied when the vehicle is parked.
The handbrake warning lamp  lights up the vehicle when it is locked. They would be

Operation
Always note the following points when park- unable to open the vehicle from the inside,
when the handbrake is applied and the igni-
ing the vehicle: and could become trapped in the vehicle in
tion switched on. The warning lamp turns off
when the handbrake is released. – Use the brake pedal to stop the vehicle.
an emergency. In the event of an emergency,
locked doors will delay assistance to vehicle
If you drive faster than 6 km/h (4 mph) with – Apply the handbrake. occupants.
the handbrake on, the following message* ● Never leave children alone in the vehicle.
– Put it in 1st gear.

Emergencies
will appear on the instrument panel: HAND- They could set the vehicle in motion, for ex-
BRAKE ON. You will also hear an audible – Switch the engine off and remove the key ample, by releasing the handbrake or the
warning. from the ignition. Turn the steering wheel gearbox lever.
slightly to engage the steering lock. ● Depending on weather conditions, it may
WARNING become extremely hot or cold inside the vehi-
– Never leave a vehicle key in the vehicle.
● Never use the handbrake to stop the vehi- cle. This can be fatal.
cle when it is in motion. The braking distance Additional notes on parking the vehicle on
is considerably longer, because braking is gradients:

Safety
only applied to the rear wheels. Risk of acci- Brakes
Turn the steering wheel so that the vehicle
dent!
rolls against the kerb if it started to roll.
● If the handbrake is only partially released, New brake pads
this will cause the rear brakes to overheat, ● If the vehicle is parked facing downhill,
For the first 400 km (250 miles), new brake
which can impair the function of the brake turn the front wheels so that they point to-
wards the kerb.
pads have not yet reached their maximum »
179
Operation

braking capacity, and need to be “run in” The effectiveness of the brakes can also be Low brake fluid level
first. However, you can compensate for the temporarily reduced if the vehicle is driven Malfunctions can occur in the brake system if
slightly reduced braking effect by applying for some distance without using the brakes the brake fluid level is too low. The brake flu-
more pressure on the brake pedal. Avoid when there is a lot of salt on the road in win- id level is monitored electronically.
overloading the brakes while running them ter. The layer of salt that accumulates on the
in. discs and pads can be removed by gently ap- Brake servo
plying the brakes a few times.
Wear The brake servo increases the pressure you
Corrosion apply to the brake pedal. It works only when
The rate of wear on the brake pads depends the engine is running.
a great deal on how you drive and the condi- There may be a tendency for corrosion to
tions in which the vehicle is operated. This is form on the discs and dirt to build up on the WARNING
a particular problem in urban traffic and brake pads if the vehicle is used infrequently
● Apply the brakes heavily to clean the brake
short stretches, or with very sporty driving. or the brakes are not used very often.
system only in a suitable traffic situation. Do
Depending on the speed, the braking force If the brakes are not used frequently, or if not put other road users in danger: there is
and the environmental conditions (for exam- rust has formed on the disks, it is advisable risk of causing an accident.
ple, the temperature, air humidity, etc.) to clean off the pads and disks by braking ● Ensure the vehicle does not move while in
noises may be produced on braking. firmly a few times at a moderately high speed neutral, when the engine is stopped. Failure
››› . to follow this instruction could result in an
Wet roads or road salt accident.
In certain situations (for example, on driving Fault in the brake system ● If the brake fluid loses its viscosity and is
through flooded areas, in severe downpours If the brake pedal travel should ever increase subjected to heavy use, vapour bubbles can
or after washing the vehicle) the braking ac- suddenly, this may mean that one of the two form in the brake system. This reduces the ef-
ficiency of the brakes.
tion could be delayed if the discs and pads brake circuits has failed. Drive immediately
are damp, or frozen in winter. In this case the to the nearest specialised workshop and
brakes should be “dried” by pressing the have the fault repaired. Drive there slowly CAUTION
brake pedal several times. and remember that you will have to apply ● Never let the brakes “drag” by leaving your
more pressure on the brake pedal and allow foot on the pedal when it is not necessary to
At high speed and with the windscreen wip-
for longer stopping distances. brake. This overheats the brakes, resulting in
ers activated, the brake pads will briefly
touch the brake discs. This takes place, al- longer stopping distances and greater wear.
though unnoticeable to the driver, at regular ● Before driving down a long, steep gradient,
intervals to improve the response time of the it is advisable to reduce speed and select a
brakes when they are wet. lower gear. This makes use of engine braking

180
Driving

and relieves the brakes. If you still have to ESC includes the Anti-lock brake system Electronic differential lock (EDL)

Technical data
use the brakes, it is better to brake firmly at (ABS), the brake assist system, the traction When the EDL detects wheelspin, it brakes
intervals than to apply the brakes continu- control system (ASR), electronic differential the spinning wheel and directs the power to
ously. lock (EDL), electronic self-locking*, selective the other driven wheel. This function is active
torque control* and tractor-trailer sway miti- up to approximately 100 km/h (62 mph).
Note
gation*. ESC also helps stabilise the vehicle
by changing the torque. To prevent the disc brake of the braked wheel
● If the brake servo is out of action, for exam- from overheating, the EDL cuts out automati-
ple when the car is being towed, you will Anti-lock brake system (ABS) cally if subjected to excessive loads. The ve-

Advice
have to press the brake pedal considerably hicle can still be driven. The EDL will switch
harder than normal to make up for the lack of ABS prevents the wheels from locking up un- on again automatically when the brake has
servo assistance. der braking until the vehicle has reached a cooled down.
● If you wish to equip the vehicle with acces- virtual standstill. You can continue to steer
sories such as a front spoiler or wheel covers, the vehicle even when the brakes are on full.
Tractor-trailer sway mitigation*
it is important that the flow of air to the front Keep your foot on the brake pedal and do not
If the vehicle is pulling a trailer, it will control

Operation
wheels is not obstructed, otherwise the pump the brakes. You will feel the brake ped-
brakes can overheat. al pulsate while the ABS is working. the following: Tractor-trailers tend to sway.
When the swaying of the trailer is felt by the
Brake assist system vehicle and detected by the ESC, it will auto-
matically brake the towing vehicle within the
Braking and stability systems The brake assist system can reduce the re- limits of the system and mitigate the sway.
quired braking distance. The braking force is Tractor-trailer sway mitigation is not available

Emergencies
automatically boosted if you press the brake in all countries.
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) pedal quickly in an emergency. You must
keep pressing the brake pedal until the dan-
The ESC helps to improve safety. It reduces Electronic torque management (XDS)
ger has passed.
the tendency to skid and improves the stabil- When taking a curve, the driveshaft differen-
ity and roadholding of the vehicle. The ESC tial mechanism allows the outer wheel to turn
detects critical handling situations, such as Traction control system (ASR)
at a higher speed than the inner wheel. In
vehicle understeer or oversteer, or wheelspin In the event of wheelspin, the traction control this way, the wheel that is turning faster (out-

Safety
on the driving wheels. It stabilises the vehi- system reduces the engine torque to match er wheel) receives less drive torque than the
cle by braking individual wheels or by reduc- the amount of grip available. This helps the inner wheel. This may mean that in certain
ing the engine torque. The warning lamp will car to start moving, accelerate or climb a gra- situations the torque delivered to the inner
flash on the instrument panel when the ESC dient. wheel is too high, causing the wheels to
is intervening . spin. On the other hand, the outer wheel is
receiving a lower drive torque than it could »
181
Operation

transmit. This causes an overall loss of lateral ● When the braking pressure through press- Note
grip on the front axle, resulting in understeer ing the brake pedal is greater than the sys-
● The ABS and ASR will only operate correctly
or “lengthening” of the trajectory. tem’s braking pressure the vehicle will brake
if the four wheels have identical tyres. Any
automatically.
The XDS system can detect and correct this differences in the rolling radius of the tyres
effect via the sensors and signals of the ESC. ● Multi-collision braking will not be available can cause the system to reduce engine power
if ESC is malfunctioning. when this is not desired.
Via the ESC, the XDS will brake the inside
● The regulating processes of the systems
wheel and counter the excess driving torque WARNING can make noises when they intervene.
of that wheel. This means that the driver's
● The ESC, ABS, ASR, EDL, electronic self- ● If the warning lamp  lights up, or  alter-
desired trajectory is much more precise.
locking differential or selective torque control natively, there could be a fault ››› page 113.
The XDS system works in combination with systems cannot exceed the limits imposed by
the ESC and is always active, even when ASR the laws of physics. Always bear this in mind,
traction control is disconnected, or the ESC in especially on wet or slippery roads. If you no-
Sport mode or disconnected. tice the systems cutting in, you should re- Switching on/off the ESC and ASR
duce your speed immediately to suit the road
Multi-collision brake and traffic conditions. Do not be encouraged
to take risks by the presence of more safety
In an accident, the multi-collision brake can systems. If you do, an accident may occur.
help the driver by braking to avoid the risk of ● Please remember that the accident risk al-
skidding during the accident, which could ways increases if you drive fast, especially in
lead to further collisions. corners or on a slippery road, or if you follow
The multi-collision brake works for front, side too close behind the vehicle in front of you.
The ESC, ABS, brake assist, EDL, electronic
or rear accidents, when the airbag control
self-locking and selective torque control sys-
unit records its activation level and the acci-
tems cannot prevent accidents: risk of acci-
dent takes place at a speed of over 10 km/h dents!
(6 mph). The ESC automatically brakes the Fig. 193 Centre console: Button for switching
● Accelerate with caution on slippery surfa-
vehicle, as long as the accident has not dam- on/off the ESC and ASR
ces (for example, icy or snow-covered). De-
aged the ESC, the brake hydraulics or the on-
spite the control systems, the driven wheels
board network The ESC is switched on automatically when
could spin, affecting the stability of the vehi-
the engine is started, and only works when
The following actions control automatic brak- cle: risk of accident!
the engine is running and includes the ABS,
ing during the accident:
EDS and ASR systems.
● When the driver presses the accelerator,
the automatic braking does not take place.
182
Driving

The ASR and ESC function should only be Disable ASR ● OR: activate or deactivate the ASR or ESC

Technical data
switched off in situations in which traction is The Easy Connect system menu is used to function in the Easy Connect system using
insufficient, among others: switch off the ASR ››› page 114. The traction the  button and the SETTINGS and
ESC System function buttons.
● When driving in deep snow or on surfaces control system will be disabled.
that are not very firm. The control lamp  lights up. For vehicles WARNING
● To “free” the vehicle if it gets stuck. with a driver information system* the driver
You should switch on the ESC Sport mode on-
will be informed that ASR is disabled.
ly if the traffic conditions and your driving
Then switch the ASR and ESC function back
ability allow you to do so safely: risk of skid-

Advice
on. Activate ASR ding!
Depending on finishes and versions, it is The Easy Connect system menu ››› page 114 ● With ESC in Sport mode, the stabilising
possible either to disconnect only the ASR or is used to switch on the ASR. The traction function will be limited to allow for a sportier
else activate ESC Sport mode. control system will be enabled. drive. The driving wheels could spin and the
vehicle could “skid”.
The control lamp  switches off. For vehicles
ESC in “Sport” mode

Operation
● If the ESC/ASR is deactivated, the vehicle
with a driver information system* the driver
Sport mode can be connected via the Easy stabilisation function is not available.
will be informed that ASR is enabled.
Connect ››› page 114 system menu. The ac-
tion of the ESC and the ASR is limited ››› . Disconnection of the ESC Note
The control lamp  lights up. For vehicles In some versions of the model, besides the If the ASR is disconnected or the ESC’s Sport
with a driver information system*, the driver traction control system (ASR), the electronic mode is selected, cruise control* will be

Emergencies
will be shown the electronic stability stability programme (ESC) can also be switched off.
control (ESC) option: sport. switched off.
Warning! Limited stability.
● Press the button  ››› Fig. 193 for approxi-
Hill driving assistant
Disable ESC “Sport” mode mately 1 second to switch off the ASR func-
tion. The hill driving assistant helps the driver to
Through the Easy Connect system menu
● Press the button  ››› Fig. 193 for approxi- move off and upward on a hill when the vehi-
››› page 114. The warning lamp  will switch

Safety
off. For vehicles with a driver information sys- mately 3 seconds to switch off the Electronic cle is stationary.
tem*, the driver will be shown the elec- Stability programme (ESC), including the ASR
The system maintains brake pressure for ap-
tronic stability control (ESC) function.
proximately two seconds after the driver
option: on. ● The ASR and ESC function are reconnected takes his foot off the brake pedal to prevent
by pressing the button  ››› Fig. 193. the vehicle from lurching backward when it is
started. During these 2 seconds, the driver »
183
Operation

has enough time to release the clutch pedal Note WARNING


and accelerate without the vehicle moving
and without having to use the handbrake, The Official Service or a specialist workshop When the engine is running, the vehicle will
can tell you if your vehicle is equipped with start to move as soon as a gear is engaged
making start-up easier, more comfortable
this system. and the clutch released. This is also the case
and safer.
with the electronic parking brake switched
These are the basic operation conditions: on.
● Never engage reverse gear when the vehi-
● being on a ramp or hill/slope, Manual gearbox cle is moving.
● doors closed,
● vehicle completely stationary, Changing gear WARNING
● engine running and foot on the brake, Read the additional information carefully If the gear is changed down inappropriately
● besides having a gear engaged or being in ›››  page 46 by selecting a gear that is too low, you may
neutral for manual gear change and with the lose control of the vehicle, causing an acci-
In some countries the clutch pedal must be dent and serious injuries.
selector lever at position S, D or R for an au-
fully pressed down for the engine to start.
tomatic gearbox.
CAUTION
This system is also active when reversing up- Selecting reverse gear
hill. When travelling at high speeds or at high en-
● Engage reverse gear only when the vehicle
gine speeds, selecting a gear that is too low
is stopped. can cause considerable damage to the clutch
WARNING
and the gearbox. This can also occur if the
● If you do not start the vehicle immediately Changing down gears clutch pedal is pressed and held and it does
after taking your foot off the brake pedal, the While driving, changing down a gear must al- not engage.
vehicle may start to roll back under certain
ways be done gradually, i.e. to the gear di-
conditions. Depress the brake pedal or use
rectly below and when the engine speed is CAUTION
the hand brake immediately.
not too high ››› . Changing down while by- To prevent damage and avoid premature
● If the engine stalls, depress the brake ped-
passing one or various gears at high speeds wear, please observe the following:
al or use the hand brake immediately.
or at high engine speeds can damage the
● When following a line of traffic uphill, if you ● Do not rest your hand on the gear lever
clutch and the gearbox, even if the clutch
want to prevent the vehicle from rolling back while driving. The pressure applied by your
pedal remains depressed ››› .
accidentally when starting off, hold the brake hand is transmitted to the gearbox selector
pedal down for a few seconds before starting forks.
off. ● Always ensure that the vehicle is complete-
ly stopped before engaging the reverse gear.
184
Driving

● Always press the clutch to the floor when gearbox positions G, D, E and S, the engaged or Sport (S) mode. To select Sport mode (S),

Technical data
changing gears. gear is also indicated on the display. move the selector lever backwards. Moving
● Never hold the vehicle “on the clutch” on
the lever again will select normal mode (D).
hills with the engine on. P – Parking lock The selected driving mode is shown on the
instrument panel display.
When the selector lever is in this position,
the driven wheels are locked mechanically. In normal mode (D), the gearbox automatical-
The parking lock must be engaged only when ly selects the best gear ratio. This depends
Automatic gearbox/DSG auto- the vehicle is stationary ››› . on the engine load, the road speed and the
matic gearbox*

Advice
dynamic gear control programme (DCP).
The interlock button (the button on the selec-
tor lever handle) must be pressed in and si- Sport mode (S) must be selected for a sporty
Introduction multaneously the brake pedal must be de- driving style. This setting makes use of the
pressed before moving the selector lever ei- engine's maximum power output. When ac-
Your vehicle is equipped with an electronical- ther in or out of position P. celerating the gear shifts will be noticeable.
ly controlled manual gearbox. Torque be-

Operation
tween the engine and the gearbox is trans- Press the brake pedal to move the selector
R – Reverse gear
mitted via two independent clutches. They re- lever from N to D/S when the vehicle is sta-
place the torque converter found on conven- Reverse gear must be engaged only when the tionary or at speeds below 3 km/h (2 mph)
tional automatic gearboxes and allow for vehicle is stationary and the engine is idling ››› .
smooth, uninterrupted acceleration of the ve- ››› .
Under certain circumstances (e.g. when driv-
hicle. To move the selector lever to position R, the ing in mountains) it can be advantageous to

Emergencies
The tiptronic system allows the driver to interlock button must be pressed in and at switch temporarily to tiptronic mode
change gears manually if desired the same time the brake pedal must be de- ››› page 187, in order to manually select gear
››› page 187, Changing gears in tiptronic pressed. The reverse lights come on when ratios to suit the driving conditions.
mode*. the selector lever is in the R position with the
ignition on. WARNING
● Take care not to accidentally press the ac-
N – Neutral (idling) celerator pedal when the vehicle is stopped.
Selector lever positions

Safety
With the selector lever in this position, the The vehicle could otherwise start moving im-
Read the additional information carefully gear is in neutral. mediately (in some cases even if the parking
›››  page 46 brake is engaged) resulting in the risk of an
D/S – Permanent drive (forward) position accident. »
The selector lever position engaged is high-
lighted on the display in the instrument clus- The selector lever in the D/S position enables
ter. With the selector lever in the manual the gears to be controlled in normal mode (D)
185
Operation

● Never move the selector lever to R or P Note Automatic selector lever lock
when driving. Failure to follow this ● If the selector lever is moved accidentally With the ignition switched on, the selector
instruction could result in an accident. lever is locked in the positions P and N. The
to N when driving, release the accelerator and
● With selector lever in any position (except let the engine speed drop to idling before se- brake pedal must be pressed to release the
P) the vehicle must always be held with the lecting gear range D or S again. lever while pressing the release button if the
foot brake when the engine is running. This is ● Should the power supply to the selector selector lever is in the position P. As a re-
because an automatic gearbox still transmits minder for the driver, with the lever in posi-
lever be interrupted in position P, the selector
power even at idling speed, and the vehicle tions P or N the following message will be
lever will be locked. If this should happen the
tends to “creep”. The accelerator pedal must
manual release can be used ›››  page 47. shown on the display:
on no account be pressed inadvertently when
a gear is engaged with the vehicle stationary. When stationary, apply footbrake
The vehicle could otherwise start moving im- while selecting a gear.
mediately (in some cases even if the parking Selector lever lock
brake is engaged) resulting in the risk of an Level lock only engages with the vehicle sta-
accident. tionary and at speeds of up to 5 km/h
● While you are selecting a gear and the vehi-
(3 mph). At speeds of over 5 km/h (3 mph)
cle is stopped with the engine running, do
the lever lock is automatically deactivated in
not accelerate. Failure to follow this instruc- position N.
tion could result in an accident. The selector lever lock is not engaged if the
● As a driver you should never leave your ve- selector lever is moved quickly through posi-
hicle if the engine is running and a gear is en- tion N (e.g. when shifting from R to D). This
gaged. If you have to leave your vehicle while makes it possible, for instance, to rock the
the engine is running, you must apply the vehicle “backwards and forwards” if it is
handbrake and engage the parking lock (P). stuck. The selector lever lock engages auto-
● To avoid accidents, apply the handbrake matically if the brake pedal is not depressed
Fig. 194 Selector lever lock.
and put the selector lever in position P before and the lever is in position N for more than
opening the bonnet and working on the vehi- about two seconds.
The selector lever lock prevents gears from
cle with the engine running. Please always
being engaged inadvertently, so that the ve-
observe the important safety warnings Interlock button
››› page 268, Work in the engine compart- hicle is not set in motion unintentionally.
ment. The selector lever lock is released as follows: The interlock button on the selector lever
handle prevents the driver from inadvertently
– Switch the ignition on. engaging certain gears. Press the button in
– Press the brake pedal and at the same time to disengage the selector lever lock. The se-
press in the interlock button. lector lever positions in which the interlock
186
Driving

button has to be pressed are shown in the il- function. Seek specialist assistance and The tiptronic gives the driver the option to

Technical data
lustration, highlighted in colour ››› Fig. 194. have the system checked. change gears manually.

Safety interlock for ignition key Changing gear manually with the selector
Once the ignition has been turned off, the lever
Changing gears in tiptronic mode*
key may be removed only if the gear selector It is possible to change to tiptronic mode,
is in position P. While the key is not in the ig- both when the vehicle is stopped and while
nition, the selector lever is locked in position driving.
P.

Advice
– To switch to tiptronic mode, move the se-
lector lever from position D/S to the right.
Note
As soon as the change is made the selector
● If the selector lever lock does not engage, level will be shown in the position M on the
there is a fault. The transmission is interrup- instrument panel display (for example M4
ted to prevent the vehicle from accidentally means that the fourth gear is engaged).

Operation
moving. Follow the procedure below in order
for the selector lever lock to engage again: – Move the selector lever forwards + to se-
– With a 6-speed gearbox: press the brake lect a higher gear ››› Fig. 195.
Fig. 195 Centre console: changing gear with
pedal and release it again. tiptronic – Move the selector lever backwards – to
– With a 7-speed gearbox: press the brake select a lower gear.
pedal. Move the selector lever to posi-

Emergencies
tion P or N and subsequently engage a Changing gear manually with the gearshift
gear. paddles*
● Despite a gear being engaged, the vehicle
The gearshift paddles can be used when the
does not move forwards or back. Proceed to
selector lever is in the position D/S or M.
the next mode:
– When the vehicle does not move in the – Press the gearshift paddle + to select a
required direction, the system may not higher gear ››› Fig. 196.
have the gear range correctly engaged.

Safety
– Press the gearshift paddle – to select a
Press the brake pedal and engage the
lower gear.
gear range again.
Fig. 196 Steering wheel: automatic gearbox
– If the vehicle still does not move in the levers – With the selector lever in position D/S, if no
required direction, there is a system mal- paddle is operated during a short period of
time, the gearbox control system switches »
187
Operation

back to automatic mode. To switch to per- for instance D ››› page 185, and release the Moving off uphill in vehicles without Hill
manent manual gear change using the interlock button. start assistant*
gearshift paddles, move the selector lever – Apply the handbrake.
– Wait for the gearbox to engage the gear (a
from position D/S to the right.
slight movement can be felt). – Once you have engaged a gear press the
When accelerating, the gearbox automatical- – Release the brake and press the accelerator accelerator carefully and disengage the
ly shifts up into the next gear shortly before ››› . handbrake.
the maximum engine speed is reached.
If you select a lower gear, the automatic gear- Stopping briefly Moving off uphill in vehicles with Hill start
box will not shift down until there is no risk of assistant*
– Apply the foot brake to hold the vehicle
over-revving the engine. briefly when stationary (for instance at traf- – Once you have engaged a gear, release the
When the kick-down feature is used, the fic lights). Do not press the accelerator. footbrake and press the accelerator
gearbox shifts down to a lower gear, depend- ››› page 183, Hill driving assistant.
ing on road speed and engine speed. Stopping/Parking
Driving down hills: in some situations (on
If the driver door is opened and the selector mountain roads or when towing a trailer or
lever is not in position P, the vehicle could caravan) it can be advantageous to switch
Driving tips move. The driver message will be:  Gear temporarily to the manual gearbox pro-
change: selector lever in the gramme so that the gear ratios can be selec-
The gearbox changes gear ratios automatical- drive position!. Additionally, a buzzer ted manually to suit the driving conditions
ly as the vehicle moves. will sound. ››› .
The engine can only start with the selector – Press and hold the brake pedal ››› . On level ground it is sufficient to move the
lever in the position P or N. At low tempera- selector lever to position P. On slopes, first
– Apply the handbrake.
tures, below -10°C (50°F), the engine can on- engage the parking brake and then put the
ly start with the selector lever in the position – Move the selector lever to position P. selection lever into the P position. This
P. avoids overloading the locking mechanism
Holding the car on a hill and it will be easier to move the selector lev-
Starting the vehicle – Always apply the brake pedal firmly to pre- er from position P.
– Press and hold the brake pedal. vent the vehicle from “moving backwards;
if necessary, apply the handbrake” ››› . WARNING
– Press and hold the interlock button (the
Do not try to stop the vehicle “rolling back” Observe the safety warnings ››› in Selector
button on the selector lever handle), move
by increasing the engine speed when a lever positions on page 185.
the selector lever to the desired position,
gear is engaged (pressing the accelerator)
››› .
188
Driving

● Never allow the brake to rub and do not use Kick-down feature The engine speed for launch-control is differ-

Technical data
the brake pedal too often or for long periods. ent on petrol and diesel engines. To use the
Constant braking causes overheating in the The kick-down feature allows maximum ac- launch-control you must disconnect the anti-
brakes. This could significantly reduce brak- celeration to be reached. slip regulation (ASR) through the Easy Con-
ing power, increase braking distance or even nect system menu ››› page 114. The warning
When the accelerator pedal is pressed right
result in the total failure of the brake system. lamp  will stay switched on or will flash
down past the point of resistance at full throt-
● To avoid rolling back on gradients always slowly depending on whether or not the vehi-
tle, the gearbox will shift down to a lower
hold the vehicle with the footbrake or hand- cle has a driver information system*.
gear, depending on road speed and engine
brake if you have to stop.
speed. The upshift to the next higher gear is

Advice
On vehicles with the driver information sys-
delayed until the engine reaches maximum tem, the ESC lamp lights up permanently and
CAUTION rpm. the corresponding text message Stability
● If you stop the vehicle on a gradient, do not control deactivated (temporary) ap-
attempt to stop it from rolling by depressing WARNING pears on the instrument panel to indicate the
the accelerator when a gear has been selec- Please note that if the road surface is slip- deactivation status.

Operation
ted. This could cause overheating and dam- pery or wet, the kick-down feature could – When the engine is running, switch off the
age the automatic gearbox. Apply the hand- cause the driving wheels to spin, which could
brake firmly or press the brake pedal in order
traction control (ASR)1).
result in skidding.
to prevent the vehicle from rolling back. – Turn the selector lever to the position “S”
● If you allow the car to roll with the selector or tiptronic, or else select the sport driv-
lever in position N with the engine switched ing mode from the SEAT Drive Profile*
Launch control programme ››› page 224.

Emergencies
off, the automatic gearbox will be damaged
as it will not be lubricated. 3 Valid for vehicles: with Launch-Control/6-Speed
DSG with diesel engines superior to 125 kW and pet- – Press the brake pedal firmly with your left
● In certain driving situations or traffic condi-
rol engines superior to 140 kW. foot and hold it down for at least one sec-
tions, such as frequently starting, prolonged
ond.
“creeping” of the vehicle or traffic jams with The Launch control programme enables maxi-
continuous stoppages, the gearbox could mum acceleration. – With your right foot, press the accelerator
overheat causing damage! If the warning down to the full throttle or kick-down posi-
lamp  lights up, stop the vehicle as soon as Important: the engine must have reached op- tion. The engine speed will stabilise at

Safety
possible and wait for the gearbox to cool erating temperature and the steering wheel about 3,200 rpm (petrol engine) or about
››› page 191. must not be turned. 2,000 rpm (diesel engine). »

1) Vehicles without driver information system: the

warning lamp flashes slowly/Vehicles with driver in-


formation system: the warning lamp stays on.
189
Operation

– Take your left foot off the brake pedal. Downhill speed control* maintained constant in all situations. Always
be prepared to use the brakes!
WARNING The downhill speed control function helps
● Always adapt your driving style to the traf- the driver when driving down steep gradi-
fic conditions. ents.
Inertia mode
● Only use the launch control programme Downhill speed control is activated when the
when road and traffic conditions permit, and selector lever is in D/S and the driver applies The inertia mode enables the kinetic energy
make sure your manner of driving and accel- the foot brake. The automatic gearbox auto- of the vehicle to be harnessed enabling cer-
erating the vehicle does not inconvenience or matically engages a lower gear that is suita- tain stretches to be driven without using the
endanger other road users. ble for the slope. The downhill speed control accelerator. This enables fuel to be saved.
● Make sure that the ESC remains switched function attempts to maintain the speed at Use the inertia mode to “let the vehicle roll”
on. Please note that when the ASR and ESC which the vehicle was travelling when the before, for example, arriving in a town.
are deactivated, the wheels may start to spin, foot brake was applied (subject to the laws of
causing the vehicle to lose grip. Risk of acci- physics and technical drive limitations). It Switching on inertia mode
dent! may be necessary to adjust the speed again
Important: selector lever must be in position
● After putting the vehicle into gear, the using the foot brake in certain situations. Giv-
D, gradients below 12 %.
“sport” mode of the ESC should be deactiva- en that the downhill speed control can only
ted again by briefly pressing the OFF but- change down to 3rd gear, on very steep de- – Select, in SEAT Drive Profile*, Eco mode
ton. scents the tiptronic mode may be required. In ››› page 224.
this case, manually reduce the tiptronic to – Take your foot off the accelerator.
Note 2nd or 1st gear to use the engine brake and
reduce the charge on the brakes. The driver message Inertia will be dis-
● After using the Launch control programme,
played. At speeds higher than 20 km/h (12
the temperature in the gearbox may have in- Downhill speed control is deactivated as mph), the gearbox will automatically disen-
creased considerably. In this case, the pro- soon as the road levels out again or you
gramme could be disabled for several mi- gage and the vehicle will roll freely, without
press the accelerator pedal. the effect of the engine brake. While the vehi-
nutes. The programme can be used again af-
ter the cooling phase. On vehicles with cruise control system* cle rolls, the engine runs at idling speed.
● Accelerating with the Launch control pro- ››› page 200, downhill speed control is acti-
gramme places a heavy load on all parts of vated when you set a cruising speed. Stopping inertia mode
the vehicle. This can result in increased wear – Press the brake or the accelerator pedal.
and tear. WARNING
To make use of the braking force and switch
The downhill speed control cannot defy the
off the engine again, simply press the brake
laws of physics. Therefore, speed cannot be
pedal briefly.
190
Driving

Applying both the inertia mode (= prolonged Backup programme and the driver message do not switch off, do

Technical data
section with less energy) and the switching not continue driving. Seek specialist assis-
off using inertia (= shorter section without A backup programme is in place if a fault tance.
the need for fuel) facilitates improved fuel should occur in the control system.
consumption and emission balance.
If all the positions of the selector lever are
shown over a light background on the instru- Gearbox malfunctions
WARNING
ment panel display, there is a system fault
● If the inertia mode has been switched on, and the automatic gearbox will operate in  Gearbox: Fault! Stop the ve-
take into account, when approaching an ob- with the backup programme. When the back- hicle and place the lever in the

Advice
stacle and releasing the accelerator pedal, up programme is activated, it is possible to position P.
that the vehicle will not decelerate in the usu- drive the vehicle, however, at low speeds and There is a fault in the gearbox. Stop the vehi-
al manner: risk of accident!
within a selected range of gears. In some ca- cle in a safe place and do not continue driv-
● When using inertia mode while travelling ses driving in reverse gear may not be possi- ing. Seek specialist assistance.
down hills, the vehicle can increase speed: ble.
risk of accident!  Gearbox: System fault! You

Operation
● If other users drive your vehicle, warn them CAUTION may continue driving.
about inertia mode. Have the fault corrected by a specialised
If the gearbox operates with the backup pro-
gramme, take the vehicle to a specialised workshop without delay.
Note workshop and have the fault repaired without  Gearbox: System fault! You
delay.
● Inertia mode is only available in eco (SEAT can continue driving with re-

Emergencies
Drive Profile*) driving mode. strictions. Reverse gear disa‐
● The driver message Inertia is only dis- bled
played with the current consumption. In iner- Clutch
Take the vehicle to a specialised workshop
tia mode the gear will no longer be displayed
 Clutch overheating! Please and have the fault repaired without delay.
(for example “E” will appear instead of “E7”).
● On downhill sections with gradients above stop!  Gearbox: System fault! You
15 %, the inertia mode will automatically be The clutch has overheated and could be dam- can continue driving in D until

Safety
switched off temporarily. aged. Stop the vehicle and wait for the gear- switching off the engine
box to cool with the engine at idling speed Stop the vehicle in a safe place well away
and the selector lever in position P. When the from moving traffic. Seek specialist assis-
warning lamp and the driver message switch tance. »
off, have the fault corrected by a specialised
workshop without delay. If the warning lamp
191
Operation

 Gearbox: too hot. Adapt your How the vehicle is driven for the first 1,500 ● Use of compatible plastics in the same part
driving accordingly km influences the future engine perform- if its components are not easily separated.
ance. Subsequently, also drive at a moderate ● Use of recycled materials and/or materials
Continue driving at moderate speeds. When
rate, especially when the engine is still cold: originating from renewable sources.
the warning lamp switches off, you can con-
this will lead to less engine wear and tear
tinue driving in a normal manner. ● Reduction of volatile components, includ-
and will prolong its useful life.
 Gearbox: press the brake and ing odour, in plastic materials.
You should also avoid driving with the engine ● Use of CFC-free coolants.
engage a gear again.
speed too low. Change down to a lower gear
If the fault was caused by a gearbox with a when the engine no longer runs “smoothly”. Ban on heavy metals, with the exceptions
high temperature, this driver message will be If the engine revs too much, cut fuel injection dictated by law (Annex II of ELV Directive
displayed when the gearbox has cooled to protect the engine. 2000/53/EC): cadmium, lead, mercury, hexa-
again. valent chromium.

Environmental compatibility Manufacturing methods


Run-in and economical driving Environmental protection is a top priority in
● Reduction of the quantity of thinner in the
protective wax for cavities.
the design, choice of materials and manufac-
Running-in the engine ture of your new SEAT. ● Use of plastic film as protection during ve-
hicle transport.
A new vehicle should be run in over a dis- ● Use of solvent-free adhesives.
Constructive measures to encourage recy-
tance of 1500 km (1000 miles). For the first
cling ● Use of CFC-free coolants in cooling sys-
1,000 km the engine speed should not ex-
ceed 2/3 of the maximum permissible engine ● Joints and connections designed for easy tems.
speed. In doing so, do not accelerate at full dismantling. ● Recycling and energy recovery from resi-
throttle and do not drive with a trailer! From ● Modular construction to facilitate disman- dues (RDF).
1000 to 1500 km (600 to 1000 miles) you tling. ● Improvement in the quality of waste water.
can gradually increase the engine rpm and ● Increased use of single-grade materials. ● Use of systems for the recovery of residual
road speed.
● Plastic parts and elastomers are marked in heat (thermal recovery, enthalpy wheels,
During its first few hours of running, the in- accordance with ISO 1043, ISO 11469 and etc.).
ternal friction in the engine is greater than ISO 1629. ● The use of water-soluble paints.
later on when all the moving parts have bed-
ded down. Choice of materials
● Use of recycled materials.
192
Driving

Economical and environmentally- brakes and tyres. Emissions and fuel con- and at traffic lights that remain red for long

Technical data
friendly driving sumption will drop to zero due to the overrun periods of time. When an engine has reached
fuel cut-off. operating temperature, and depending on
Fuel consumption, environmental pollution the cylinder capacity, keeping it switched off
and wear to the engine, brakes and tyres de- Changing gear to save energy for a minimum of about 5 seconds already
pends largely on driving style. Fuel consump- saves more than the amount of fuel necessa-
An effective way of saving is to change in ad-
tion can be reduced by 10-15% with an eco- ry for restarting.
vance to a higher gear. Running the engine at
nomical driving style and proper anticipation high rpm in the lower gears uses an unneces- The engine takes a long time to warm up
of traffic conditions. The following section sary amount of fuel.

Advice
when it is idling. Mechanical wear and pollu-
gives you some tips on lessening the impact tant emissions are also especially high dur-
on the environment and reducing your oper- Manual gearbox: shift up from first to second
ing this initial warm-up phase. It is therefore
ating costs at the same time. gear as soon as possible. In any case, we rec-
best to drive off immediately after starting
ommend that you change to a higher gear
the engine. Avoid running the engine at high
Active cylinder management (ACT®)* upon reaching 2,000 rpm. Choosing the right
speed.
gear enables fuel savings. Select the highest

Operation
Depending on vehicle equipment, the active possible gear appropriate for the driving sit-
cylinder management (ACT®) may automati- uation (the engine should continue function- Regular maintenance
cally deactivate some of the engine cylinders ing with cyclical regularity). Regular servicing helps in saving fuel even
if the driving situation does not require too before the engine is started. A well-serviced
much power. When it is switched off, no fuel Automatic gearbox: accelerate gradually and
engine gives you the benefit of improved fuel
is injected into these cylinders, hence total without reaching the “kick-down” position.
efficiency as well as maximum reliability and

Emergencies
fuel consumption may be reduced. The num- an enhanced resale value. A badly serviced
ber of active cylinders can be seen on the in- Avoid driving at high speed
engine can consume up to 10% more fuel
strument panel display ›››  page 34. Avoid travelling at top speed, whenever pos- than necessary.
sible. Fuel consumption, emission of harmful
Foresight when driving gases and noise pollution multiply dispropor- Avoid short journeys
Acceleration causes the vehicle to consume tionately as speed is increased. Driving at
The engine and catalytic converter need to
more fuel. If you think ahead when driving, moderate speeds will help to save fuel.
reach their optimal operating temperature in

Safety
you will need to brake less and thus acceler- order to minimise fuel consumption and
ate less. Wherever possible, let the car roll Reduce idling time
emissions.
slowly to a stop, with a gear engaged (for in- In vehicles with the Start-Stop system idling
stance when you can see that the next traffic A cold engine consumes a disproportionate
is automatically reduced. In vehicles without
lights are red). This takes advantage of the amount of fuel. The engine reaches its work-
the Start-Stop system it is worth switching off
engine braking effect, reducing wear on the the engine, for example, at level crossings
ing temperature after about four kilometres »
193
Operation

(2.5 miles), when fuel consumption will re- a high setting, the rear window heating or Catalytic converter
turn to a normal level. the seat heating*. 3 Applies to vehicles with petrol engine

Check tyre pressure The vehicle must only be used with unleaded
petrol, otherwise the catalytic converter will
Always make sure the tyres are inflated to the Engine management and ex- be irreparably damaged.
correct pressures ››› page 278 to save fuel. If
the pressure is below half bar, fuel consump- haust gas purification system Never drive until the tank is empty; an irregu-
tion may increase by 5%. Due to the greater lar supply of fuel can cause faulty combus-
rolling resistance, under-inflation also increa- Introduction tion. In these cases, unburned fuel reaches
ses tyre wear and impairs handling. the exhaust system, which can overheat and
WARNING damage the catalytic converter.
Do not use winter tyres all year round as they
increase fuel consumption by up to 10%. ● Because of the high temperatures which
can occur in the exhaust purification system
Avoid carrying unnecessary loads (catalytic converter or diesel particulate fil- Diesel particulate filter
ter), do not park the vehicle where the ex-
Given that every kilo of extra weight will in- 3 Applies to vehicles with diesel engine
haust can come into contact with flammable
crease the fuel consumption, it is advisable materials under the car (e.g. on grass or at The diesel engine particulate filter eliminates
to always check the luggage compartment to the forest edge). Fire hazard!
most of the soot from the exhaust gas sys-
make sure that no unnecessary loads are be- ● Do not apply wax underneath the vehicle tem. Under normal driving conditions, the fil-
ing transported. around the area of the exhaust system: Fire ter cleans itself. The diesel particulate filter is
Since the luggage rack increases the aerody- hazard! cleaned automatically without need for indi-
namic drag of the vehicle, you should remove cation by the warning lamp . This may be
it when not needed. At speeds of 100-120 Note noticed because the engine idle speed in-
km/h (62-75 mph), this will save 12% of fuel. While the control lamps , ,  or  re-
creases and an odour may be detected.
main lit, there may be engine problems, fuel If automatic filter purification cannot be car-
Save electrical energy consumption may increase and the engine ried out (because only short trips are taken,
The engine drives the alternator, thereby gen- may lose power. for example), soot will accumulate on the fil-
erating electricity. This implies that any in- ter and the Diesel particulate filter warning
crease in power consumption also increases lamp will  switch on.
fuel consumption! For this reason, switch off
Facilitate the automatic filter cleaning proc-
any unneeded electrical devices. Devices that
ess by driving in the following manner: drive
use a lot of electricity includes the blower at
for approximately 15 minutes at a minimum
speed of 60 km/h (37 mph) in 4th or 5th gear
194
Driving

(automatic gearbox: gear S). Maintain the en- The control lamp  lights up: Driving tips

Technical data
gine speed at approximately 2,000 rpm. The If a fault has developed during driving which
rise in temperature causes the soot on the fil- has reduced the quality of the exhaust gas Driving through flooded roads
ter to burn. On completion of the cleaning (e.g. lambda probe fault). Reduce speed and
the warning lamp will switch off. If the warn- drive carefully to the nearest specialised To prevent damage to the vehicle when driv-
ing lamp does not switch off, go immediately workshop to have the engine checked. ing through water, for example, along a floo-
to a specialised workshop to rectify the prob- ded road, please observe the following:
lem.
● The water should never come above the

Advice
Engine pre-heating/fault system* 
lower edge of the bodywork.
Engine management*  The warning lamp lights up to show that the ● Drive at pedestrian speed.
glow plugs are preheating the diesel engine.
This warning lamp monitors the engine man- WARNING
agement system for petrol engines. The control lamp  lights up After driving through water, mud, sludge,

Operation
The warning lamp  (Electronic Power Con- If the control lamp  lights up when the en- etc., the braking effect can be delayed slight-
trol) lights up when the ignition is switched gine is started it means that the glow plugs ly due to moisture build-up on the discs and
on while system operation is being verified. It brake pads. Applying the brakes carefully
are preheating. The engine can be started
should go out once the engine is started. several times will remove the moisture and
straight away when the lamp switches off.
restore the full braking effect.
If there is a fault in the electronic engine
management system while you are driving, Control lamp  flashes

Emergencies
this warning lamp will light up. Take the vehi- CAUTION
If a fault develops in the engine management
cle to a specialised workshop as soon as system while you are driving, the glow plug ● Driving through flooded areas may severely
possible and have the engine checked. system lamp will flash . Take the vehicle to damage vehicle components such as the en-
a specialised workshop as soon as possible gine, transmission, running gear or electrical
system.
and have the engine checked.
Emission control system*  ● Whenever driving through water, the Start-
Stop system* must be switched off
››› page 196.

Safety
Control lamp  flashes:
When there is misfiring that can damage the
catalytic converter. Reduce speed and drive Note
carefully to the nearest specialised workshop ● Check the depth of the water before enter-
to have the engine checked. ing the flooded zone. »
195
Operation

● Do not stop in the water, drive in reverse, or Driver assistance systems ● The bonnet must be closed.
stop the engine in any situation. ● The engine must have reached a minimum
● Note that vehicles travelling in the opposite service temperature.
direction may splash water that could exceed
Start-Stop System*
● The reverse gear must not be engaged.
the maximum permitted water height for your
vehicle. Description and operation ● The vehicle must not be on a very steep
slope.
● Avoid driving through salt water (corro-
The Start-Stop system helps save fuel and re-
sion).
duce CO2 emissions. WARNING
In Start-Stop mode, the engine will automati- ● Never switch the engine off until the vehi-
cally switch off when the vehicle stops or is cle is stationary. The brake servo and power
stopping; for example when stopping at traf- steering functions will not be completely cov-
fic lights. The ignition remains switched on ered under warranty. More force may also be
needed to turn the steering wheel or to brake.
during the stopping phase. The engine auto-
As you cannot steer and brake in the normal
matically switches back on when required. In
manner, there is a greater risk of accidents
this situation, the light of the and serious injury.
START ENGINE STOP button stays on1).
● Never remove the key from the ignition if
As soon as the ignition is switched on, the the vehicle is in motion. Otherwise, the steer-
Start-Stop function is automatically activa- ing could lock making it impossible to steer
ted. the vehicle.
● To avoid injury, make sure that the Start-
Further information about the Start-Stop sys-
Stop system is switched off when working in
tem can be found in the Easy Connect sys-
the engine compartment ››› page 198.
tem: by pressing the  button in the Vehi-
cle status menu.
CAUTION
Basic requirements for the Start-Stop mode The Start-Stop system must always be
● The driver door must be closed. switched off when driving through flooded
areas ››› page 198.
● The driver must have their seat belt fas-
tened.

1) Only in vehicles with Keyless Access.


196
Driver assistance systems

Stopping/Starting the engine Additional information related to the auto- again by immediately pressing the clutch

Technical data
matic gearbox pedal.
Vehicles with a manual gearbox The engine stops when the selector lever is in
– Before stopping the vehicle or when it is the positions P, D, N and S, in addition to
stopped, put it into neutral and release the when in manual mode. With the selector lev- General notes
clutch pedal. The engine will switch off. The er in position P, the engine will also remain
warning lamp  will appear on the instru- switched off when you take your foot off the The system can interrupt the Start-Stop mode
ment panel display. The engine may stop brake pedal. In order to start the engine up frequently for different reasons.
before the vehicle comes to a halt in the again the accelerator must be pressed, or an-

Advice
deceleration phase (at 7 km/h). other gear engaged or the brake released. The engine does not switch off
– When the clutch pedal is pressed the en- If the selector lever is placed in position R Before the stopping phase, the system veri-
gine will start up again. The warning lamp during the stopping phase, the engine will fies whether certain conditions are met. The
will switch off. start up again. engine does not switch off, in the following
Change from position D to P to prevent the situations for example:

Operation
Vehicles with an automatic gearbox
engine from accidentally starting when ● The engine has not yet reached the mini-
– Use the foot brake to bring the vehicle to a changing and passing by position R. mum required temperature for the Start-Stop
stop and keep the brake pedal pressed mode.
down with your foot. The engine will switch Note
● The interior temperature selected for the air
off. The warning lamp  will appear in the ● In vehicles with an automatic gearbox, you
display. The engine may stop before the ve- conditioner has not yet been reached.

Emergencies
can control whether the engine should switch
hicle comes to a halt in the deceleration ● The interior temperature is very high/low.
off or not by reducing or increasing the brake
phase (at 7 km/h or 2 km/h, depending on force applied. While the vehicle remains stop- ● Defrost function button activated
the vehicle’s gearbox). ped, the engine will not stop if the brake ped- ›››  page 48.
al is slightly pressed, in traffic jams with fre-
– When you take your foot off the brake pedal ● The parking aid* is switched on.
quent stopping and starting for example. As
the engine will start up again. The warning ● The battery is very low.
soon as strong pressure is applied to the
lamp will switch off. In vehicles with the Au- brake pedal, the engine will stop. ● The steering wheel is overly turned or is be-
to Hold* system, when the system is active,

Safety
● In vehicles with manual gearbox, during ing turned.
the engine will not start if you remove your
the stopping phases the brake pedal must re- ● If there is a danger of misting.
foot from the brake pedal. The car starts
main depressed to prevent the vehicle from
when you press the accelerator pedal. moving. ● After engaging reverse gear.
● If the engine “stalls” in vehicles with man- ● In case of a very steep gradient. »
ual gearbox, it can be directly started up
197
Operation

The indication  is shown on the instrument Manually switching on/off the Start- Driver messages on the instrument
panel display, and in addition, the driver in- Stop system panel display
formation system* shows, .
Start-Stop system deactivated.
The engine starts by itself Start the engine manually
During a stopping phase the normal Start- This driver message is displayed when cer-
Stop mode can be interrupted in the follow- tain conditions are not met during the stop-
ing situations: The engine restarts by itself ping phase and the Start-Stop system cannot
without involvement from the driver. restart the engine. The engine must be star-
ted manually.
● The interior temperature differs from the
value selected on the air conditioner. Start-Stop system: Fault! Func-
● Defrost function button activated tion not available
›››  page 48. Fig. 197 Centre console: Start-Stop system There is a fault in the Start-Stop system. Take
● The brake has been pressed several times button. the vehicle to a workshop to have the fault
consecutively. repaired.
If you do not wish to use the system, you can
● The battery is too low.
switch it off manually.
● High power consumption.
– To manually switch on/off the Start-Stop
Note system, press the button  . The button
symbol remains lit up yellow when the sys-
In vehicles with an automatic gearbox, if the tem is switched off.
selector lever is placed in position D, N or S
after engaging reverse gear, the vehicle must Note
be driven at a speed faster than 10 km/h (6
mph) for the system to return to conditions in The system is automatically switched on each
which the engine can be stopped. time the engine is deliberately stopped dur-
ing a stopping phase. The engine will start
automatically.

198
Driver assistance systems

Auto Hold Function* After detecting that the vehicle is stationary Automatically engaging and disengaging the

Technical data
and the brake pedal has been released, the Auto Hold function
Auto Hold function holds the vehicle. The
Description and operation If the Auto Hold function was switched on
driver can lift their foot off the brake pedal. with the  button before disengaging the ig-
When the driver touches the accelerator ped- nition, the function will remain on after the
al or accelerates slightly to continue driving, ignition is re-engaged.
the Auto Hold function releases the brake. If the Auto Hold function was not switched
The vehicle moves according to the slope of on, it will automatically remain off next time

Advice
the road. the ignition is engaged.
If the vehicle is stationary and one of the con-
ditions required by the Auto Hold function is The Auto Hold function is automatically
impaired, it disconnects itself and the but- switched on if the following conditions are
ton's control light goes out ››› Fig. 198. The met:
electronic parking brake connects automati-

Operation
Fig. 198 In the lower part of the centre con- cally, if necessary, to park the vehicle safe- All conditions must be met at the same time
sole: Auto Hold function button. ly ››› . ››› :

The control light of the  ››› Fig. 198 button Manual gearbox Automatic gearbox
Conditions for keeping the vehicle stationary
remains on when the Auto Hold function is with the Auto Hold function 1. The vehicle is kept stationary with the brake ped-
connected. al on a flat surface or on a slope.

Emergencies
● The driver door must be closed.
Once connected, the Auto Hold function as- 2. The engine rotates “correctly”.
● The driver's seat belt must be fastened.
sists the driver in keeping the vehicle station-
ary at repeated intervals or for a certain peri- ● The engine is running. Upon pressing the Upon accelerating, the
clutch and accelerating brake releases gradu-
od of time with the engine running, for exam- »
at the same time, the ally.
ple, when going up a slope, when stopped at Switching the Auto Hold function on and off brake releases gradu-
traffic lights or in heavy traffic with intermit- Press the button  ››› . The control lamp on ally.
tent stops. the button goes out when the Auto Hold func-

Safety
When connected, the Auto Hold function au- tion is switched off.
tomatically prevents the vehicle from rolling
when stationary without pressing the brake
pedal.

199
Operation

The Auto Hold function is automatically ● The Auto Hold function cannot always keep Read the additional information carefully
turned off if the following conditions are the vehicle stationary uphill or downhill or ›››  page 42
met: stop it sufficiently, for example, on slippery The cruise control system (CCS) is able to
or frozen surfaces.
Manual gearbox Automatic gearbox maintain the set speed from 20 km/h (15
mph).
If any of the conditions mentioned on Note
››› page 199, Conditions for keeping the vehicle The CSS only reduces vehicle speed by ceas-
1. Before entering a car wash, always switch off
stationary with the Auto Hold function are no lon- ing to accelerate, not by actively braking the
ger met. the Auto Hold function, because if the elec- vehicle ››› .
tronic parking brake is automatically connec-
If the engine is running irregularly or an anomaly ted, it may cause damage.
2. Control lamp
is detected.
When the warning lamp  is lit, cruise con-
If the engine is turned If the engine is switch-
3. trol is active.
off or stalls. ed off.
Cruise control system (CCS)* Several warning and control lamps light up
The clutch and the ac-
If the accelerator is for a few seconds when the ignition is switch-
4. celerator are pressed at
the same time.
pressed. Operation ed on, signalling that the function is being
verified. They will switch off after a few sec-
If any of the tyres has
onds.
only minimal contact
5. with the ground, e.g. in
the case of axle articu- Displayed on the CCS screen
lation.
Status Fig. 199:

WARNING A CCS temporarily switched off. The set


speed is displayed in small figures.
The smart technology incorporated into the
Auto Hold function cannot defy the laws of B System error. Contact a specialised work-
physics; it only works within the limits of the shop.
system. The greater convenience provided by C CCS switched on. The speed memory is
the Auto Hold function should never tempt
empty.
you to take any risk that may compromise
safety. D The CCS is switched on. The set speed is
● Never leave the vehicle running and with Fig. 199 Instrument panel display: CCS status displayed in large figures.
the Auto Hold function switched on. indications.

200
Driver assistance systems

WARNING Operating the cruise control system* Adaptive Cruise Control ACC*

Technical data
Use of the cruise control could cause acci- Read the additional information carefully
dents and severe injuries if it is not possible Related video
›››  page 42
to drive at a constant speed maintaining the
safety distance. The value indicated in the table in brackets
● Do not use the cruise control in heavy traf- (in mph, miles per hour) only refers to instru-
fic, if the distance from the vehicle in front is ment panels with indications in miles.
insufficient, on steep roads, with several

Advice
bends or in slippery circumstances (snow, Changing gear in CCS mode
ice, rain or loose gravel), or on flooded roads.
The CCS decelerates as soon as the clutch Fig. 200 Safety
● Never use the CCS when driving off-road or
pedal is pressed, intervening again automati-
on unpaved roads. cally after a gear is engaged.
● Always adapt your speed and the distance
to the vehicles ahead in line with visibility, Introduction
Travelling down hills with the CCS

Operation
weather conditions, the condition of the road
and the traffic situation. When travelling down hills the CCS cannot
● To avoid unexpected operation of the cruise
maintain a constant speed. Slow the vehicle
control system, turn it off every time you fin- down using the brake pedal and reduce
ish using it. gears if required.
● It is dangerous to use a set speed which is

Emergencies
too high for the prevailing road, traffic or
Automatic off
weather conditions. The cruise control system (CCS) is switched
● When travelling down hills, the CCS cannot off automatically or temporarily:
maintain a constant speed. The vehicle tends
● If the system detects a fault that could af-
to accelerate under its own weight. Select a
lower gear or use the foot brake to slow the fect the working order of the CCS. Fig. 201 Detection area.
vehicle. ● If you press and maintain the accelerator
pedal for a certain time, driving faster than The adaptive cruise control (ACC) is an exten-

Safety
WARNING the stored speed. sion of the normal cruise control system
● If the dynamic driving control systems in-
(CCS) ››› .
Observe the safety warnings ››› in Warning
and control lamps on page 113. tervene (e.g. ASR or ESC). The ACC function allows the driver to estab-
● If the airbag is triggered. lish a cruise speed of between 30 and 210
km/h (18 and 150 mph), as well as the »
201
Operation

temporary distance required with regard to ● Adapt your speed and safe distance to the CAUTION
the vehicle in front. The ACC function will vehicle in front of you at all times to suit visi-
adapt the vehicle's cruise speed at all times, If you have the sensation that the radar sen-
bility, weather, road and traffic conditions.
sor is damaged, disconnect the ACC. This will
maintaining a safe distance with the vehicle ● Do not use the ACC when visibility is bad, avoid possible damage. If this occurs have it
in front. on steep roads, with several bends or in slip- adjusted.
The ACC function is based on a radar sensor pery circumstances such as snow, ice, rain or ● Repairs to the radar sensor require special-
that can measure the distance to the vehicles loose gravel, or on flooded roads.
ist knowledge and special tools. SEAT recom-
in front. ● Never use the ACC when driving off-road or mends visiting a SEAT dealership for this pur-
on unpaved roads. The ACC has been de- pose.
If the vehicle is equipped with automatic signed for use on paved roads only.
gearbox, the ACC can brake the vehicle until
● The ACC does not react on approaching a
it stops completely if a vehicle in front of it Note
fixed obstacle, such as the tail of a traffic
stops. jam, a damaged vehicle or a vehicle stopped ● If the ACC system does not work as descri-
at the traffic lights. bed in this chapter, do not use it until it has
Driver intervention prompt ● The ACC only reacts to people if a pedes-
been checked by a specialised workshop.
SEAT recommends visiting a SEAT dealership
During driving, the ACC is subject to certain trian monitoring system is available. In addi-
for this purpose.
limitations inherent in the system. In other tion, the system does not react to animals or
vehicles crossing your path or approaching ● Maximum speed with the ACC activated is
words, in certain circumstances the driver will
have to adjust speed him or herself, as well head-on down the same lane. limited to 210 km/h (150 mph).
as the distance from other vehicles. ● If the ACC does not reduce speed sufficient- ● When the ACC is switched on, strange
ly, brake the vehicle immediately by applying noises may be heard during automatic brak-
In this case, the instrument panel screen will the pedal. ing cause by the braking system.
warn you to intervene by applying the brake
● If you are driving using the spare wheel,
and a warning tone will be heard
the ACC system could automatically switch
››› page 203. off during the journey. Switch off the system
when starting off.
WARNING
● If the vehicle continues to move involuntar-
The intelligent technology in the ACC cannot ily after a driver intervention prompt, brake
overcome the system's inherent limitations the vehicle by applying the pedal.
or change the laws of physics. If used negli-
● If the dash panel displays a driver interven-
gently or involuntarily, it may cause serious
tion prompt, adjust the distance yourself.
accidents and injuries. The system is not a re-
placement for driver awareness. ● The driver should be ready to accelerate or
brake by him/herself at all times.

202
Driver assistance systems

Indications on the display, warning 2 Distance margin selected, the ACC is in-
 The ACC is active.

Technical data
and control lamps active.
No vehicle is detected in front. The programmed speed
3 Vehicle detected in front. The ACC is ac-
remains constant.
tive.
4 Adjustment of the temporary distance
If the symbol is white: the ACC is ac-
from the vehicle in front with a program-  tive.
med speed.
5 Temporary distance adjustment from the A vehicle in front has been detected. The ACC adjusts

Advice
speed and distance from the vehicle in front.
vehicle in front with a programmed
speed.
If the symbol is grey: the ACC is not
 active.
Warning and control lamps
The system is switched on, but is not adjusting.
››› in Warning and control lamps on

Operation
page 113.
 It lights up green
The speed reduction by the ACC to The ACC is active.
 maintain the distance from the vehi-
cle in front is not sufficient. Some warning and control lamps will light up
briefly when the ignition is switched on to

Emergencies
Brake! apply the foot brake! Driver intervention prompt.
check certain functions. They will switch off
after a few seconds.
 The ACC is not currently available. a)
Fig. 202 On the instrument panel display: (A)
With the vehicle stationary, switch off the engine and WARNING
ACC temporarily inactive, vehicle detected in
front, temporary distance adjusted. (B) ACC start it up again. Check the radar sensor visually for dirt, Observe the safety warnings ››› in Warning
active, vehicle detected in front, temporary ice or knocks. If it is still unavailable, refer to a special- and control lamps on page 113.
ised workshop to have the system inspected.
distance adjusted.

Safety
a) The symbol on the instrument panels with colour display is in Note
Status display colour.
When the ACC is connected, the indications
Indications on the display ››› Fig. 202: on the instrument panel screen may be con-
1 Vehicle in front, the ACC is inactive. cealed by warnings from other functions,
such as an incoming call.

203
Operation

Radar sensor presence of metallic objects (e.g. rails on the mends visiting a SEAT dealership for this pur-
road or sheets used in road works). pose.
The area in front of and around the radar sen- ● Clean away the snow with a brush and the
sor should not be covered with adhesives, ice preferably with a solvent-free de-icer
additional or similar headlights, as this may spray.
negatively affect ACC operation.
If structural modifications are made to the ve-
hicle, for example, if the suspension is low-
ered or the front spoiler is modified, ACC op-
eration may be affected. So structural modifi-
cations should only be made by specialised
workshops. SEAT recommends visiting a SEAT
Fig. 203 On the front bumper: radar sensor.
dealership for this purpose.
A radar sensor is installed on the front bump- If work is done incorrectly on the front of the
er to determine the traffic situation vehicle, the radar sensor could be damaged
››› Fig. 203 1 . or lose its settings, and ACC operation may
The radar sensor's visibility may be impaired be affected. So repair work should only be
by dirt, mud or snow, or by environmental in- made by specialised workshops. SEAT recom-
fluences such as rain or mist. In this case the mends visiting a SEAT dealership for this pur-
adaptive cruise control (ACC) does not work. pose.
The instrument panel displays the following
CAUTION
message: ACC: No sensor vision! If
necessary clean the radar sensor ››› . If you have the sensation that the radar sen-
sor is damaged or has lost its settings, dis-
When the radar sensor begins to operate connect the ACC. This will avoid possible
properly again, the ACC will automatically be damage. If this occurs have it adjusted.
available again. The message on the instru- ● The sensor may become damaged or lose
ment panel screen will switch off and the ACC its settings when knocked, for example, dur-
will be reactivated again. ing a parking manoeuvre. This may compro-
ACC operation may be affected by a strong ra- mise the system's efficacy or disconnect it.
dar reverse reflection. This may occur, for ex- ● Repairs to the radar sensor require special-
ample, in a closed car park or due to the ist knowledge and special tools. SEAT recom-

204
Driver assistance systems

Operating the Adaptive Cruise Control When the Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) is The following settings can also be adjusted:

Technical data
ACC connected, the green control lamp  will
light up on the instrument panel, and the ● Distance.
programmed speed and ACC status will be ● Driving Programme.
displayed ››› Fig. 202. ● Driving style.

Conditions for the adaptive cruise control to Activating/Deactivating


be activated
Any speed1) between 30 and 210 km/h (19
● The selector lever must be at the D or S po-

Advice
and 150 mph) can be adjusted.
sition or in the tiptronic selection track. In
manual gearbox any forward gear must be Activating the ACC
engaged, except the 1st gear.
● In vehicles with manual gearbox, if there is
››› Fig. 204.
● Pull the lever to position 1
Fig. 204 On the left of the steering column: ACC standby will be shown on the instrument
no programmed speed, drive at least at
panel display.

Operation
third lever for operating the Adaptive Cruise 30 km/h (18 mph).
Control.
Programme speed and activate control
Speed control
● Press the SET ››› Fig. 205 button to pro-
When the ACC is connected, speed can be
gramme current speed.
programmed and adjusted. The programmed
speed must be different from the speed at ● Automatic gearbox: apply the brake pedal

Emergencies
which the vehicle travels if the distance is be- to activate control with the vehicle stationary.
ing adjusted at the time.
Deactivating the ACC
What functions can be operated? ● Move the lever to position 0 until it en-
If you activate the ACC the current speed can gages. The text ACC: off appears.
be programmed as the “control speed”.
Fig. 205 On the left of the steering column: Altering speed

Safety
During driving, control can be operated at
third lever for operating the Adaptive Cruise ● To increase or reduce speed step by step,
any time and the speed also modified.
Control. press the lever up/down briefly ››› Fig. 205. »

1) Different speed limits apply in each country and

depend on the unit indicated on the speedometer.


205
Operation

Any modification to the programmed speed The following driving programmes items can tion by the ACC will not suffice. In this case
is shown on the bottom left part of the instru- be selected: the brake pedal should be applied immedi-
ment panel display. ately.
● Normal
● The ACC may not be able to detect all situa-
Adjusting distance level ● Sport tions properly.
The distance according to speed with regard ● Eco ● “Stepping” on the accelerator may cause
to the vehicle in front can be controlled on the ACC not to intervene in braking. Driver
the Easy Connect system on 5 levels In vehicles without the driving profile selec- braking will have priority over intervention by
›››  page 30. tion function, acceleration behaviour can be the speed control or adaptive cruise control.
influenced by selecting a driving programme
● Always be ready to use the brakes!
In wet road conditions, you should always set on the Easy Connect system using the 
a larger distance with regard to the vehicle in ● Observe country-specific provisions gov-
button and the SETTINGS and Driver assistance
front than when driving in dry conditions. function buttons ›››  page 30. erning obligatory minimum distances be-
tween vehicles.
The following distances can be preselected:
The following conditions may lead the ACC
● Very short not to react: Note
● Short ● If the accelerator is pressed. ● The programmed speed is erased once the
● Media ignition or the ACC are switched off.
● If there is no gear engaged.
● When the traction control system (ASR) is
● Long ● If the ESC is controlling.
deactivated during acceleration or else the
● Very long ● If the driver is not wearing his/her seat ESC is activated in Sport* Mode
belt. (››› page 114), the ACC switches off automati-
In the Easy Connect system you can adjust cally.
● If several brake lights of the vehicle or elec-
the distance level that will be applied when ● In vehicles with the Start-Stop system, the
the ACC is connected using the  button trically connected trailer are damaged.
engine switches off automatically during the
and the SETTINGS and Driver assistance function ● If the vehicle is reversing.
ACC stopping phase and restarts automatical-
buttons ›››  page 30. ● Driving faster than 210 km/h (150 mph). ly to begin driving.

Adjusting the driving programme WARNING


In vehicles with driving profile selection There is a danger of rear collision when the Vehicles with an automatic gearbox
(SEAT Drive Profile), the profile selected can minimum distance to the vehicle in front is
influence acceleration behaviour exceeded and the speed difference between If the vehicle is equipped with automatic
››› page 224. both vehicles is so great that a speed reduc- gearbox, the ACC can brake the vehicle until

206
Driver assistance systems

it stops completely if a vehicle in front of it Interrupting control ● To resume control, apply the brake and turn

Technical data
stops. the lever to position 2 .
The ACC will still be available for a few sec-
WARNING
onds. The vehicle will restart by itself if the
vehicle in front moves (traffic jam assistant). It is dangerous to activate control and resume
the programmed speed if the road, traffic or
Disconnection criteria weather conditions do not permit this. Risk of
accident!
The ACC will switch off if the driver applies

Advice
the brake pedal or the driver's door is
opened.
Setting the distance
Restarting the vehicle with the ACC manually Fig. 206 On the left of the steering column:
The ACC can be activated again by moving third lever for operating the Adaptive Cruise
the lever to position 2 ››› Fig. 206. Control.

Operation
CAUTION Important: the ACC is active.
● If your vehicle with ACC does not start up
Interrupting control during driving
as expected, you can drive off by briefly step-
ping on the accelerator. ● Move the lever to the position 3 . The ACC

Emergencies
● The Start-Stop system usually acts if you standby message is displayed to the driver.
are driving with ACC. or
● Brake. Fig. 207 Control lever: setting the distance.
● To resume the programmed speed, turn the
● To display the distance currently program-
lever to position 2 .
med, briefly press the rocking button
Interrupt speed control with the vehicle sta-
››› Fig. 207.

Safety
tionary ● To increase/reduce the distance one level,
press the rocking button again towards the
Applies to vehicles with automatic gearbox:
left/right. The instrument panel display
● Move the lever to the position 3 . The ACC modifies the distance between both vehicles.
standby message is displayed to the driver.
If the vehicle approaches another vehicle de-
tected in front of it, the ACC reduces the »
207
Operation

speed accordingly and then controls the ad- example, to leaves, snow, heavy fog or dirt.  ACC: speed limit
justed distance. If the vehicle detected in Clean the sensor. The message for the driver is displayed if, in
front accelerates, the adaptive cruise control vehicles with manual gearbox, the current
will also accelerate up to the target speed  ACC: currently not available. Gradient too speed is too low for the ACC mode.
programmed at most. steep
The speed to be stored must be at least
The greater the speed, the greater the dis- The maximum road slope has been excee- 30 km/h (18 mph). The speed limiter
tance in metres should be ››› . We recom- ded, hence safe ACC operation cannot be switches off if the speed falls below 20 km/h
mend the setting Distance 3. guaranteed. The ACC cannot be switched on. (12 mph).
WARNING  ACC: only available in D, S or M  ACC: available as of the 2nd gear
With regard to distance setting, the driver is Select the D/S or M position on the selector The ACC is operational as of the 2nd gear
responsible for observing country-specific lever. (manual gearbox).
legislation.
 ACC: parking brake applied  ACC: engine speed
The ACC is deactivated if the parking brake is The message for the driver is displayed if,
Driver messages applied. The ACC is available once again after when the ACC accelerates or brakes, the driv-
the parking brake is released. er does not shift up or down a gear in time,
 ACC not available
which means exceeding or not reaching the
The system can no longer continue to guar-  ACC: currently not available. Intervention permissible engine speed. The ACC switches
antee safe vehicle detection and will be de- of stability control itself off. A buzzer warning is heard.
activated. The sensor has lost its setting or is The message for the driver is displayed when
damaged. Take the vehicle to a specialised the electronic stability control (ESC) inter-  ACC: clutch pressed
workshop and have the fault repaired. venes. In this case, the ACC is automatically Vehicles with a manual gearbox: pressing the
switched off. clutch pedal for longer abandons control
 ACC: currently not available. No sensor vi-
sion mode.
 ACC: Take action!
 ACC and Front Assist: currently not availa- The message for the driver is displayed if, Door open
ble. No sensor vision when the vehicle starts up on a hill with a Vehicles with automatic gearbox: the ACC
mild slope, the vehicle rolls back even al- cannot be activated with the vehicle station-
This message will be displayed to the driver if though the ACC is activated. Apply the brake
the radar sensor's vision is impaired due, for ary and the door open.
to stop the vehicle from moving/colliding
with another vehicle.
208
Driver assistance systems

Function for preventing overtaking in Deactivating the Adaptive Cruise Con- Note

Technical data
an inside lane trol ACC temporarily in certain situa- If you do not switch off the ACC in the afore-
tions mentioned situations, you may commit a le-
gal offence.
In the following situations the Adaptive
Cruise Control (ACC) should be deactivated
due to the system's limitations ››› :
● When changing lanes, on tight bends and

Advice
roundabouts, in acceleration and decelera-
tion lanes on motorways or in sections with
road works to prevent involuntary accelera-
tion to reach the programmed speed.
Fig. 208 On the instrument panel display: ● When going through a tunnel, as operation
could be affected.

Operation
ACC active, vehicle detected in an outer lane.
● On roads with several lanes, when other ve-
The adaptive cruise control (ACC) has a func- hicles are driving more slowly in the overtak-
tion that helps avoid overtaking while driving ing lane. In this case, slower vehicles will be
in inside lanes at certain speeds. overtaken on the right.
If another vehicle is detected travelling at a ● In case of heavy rain, snow or spray, as the

Emergencies
slower speed in an outer lane, it is displayed vehicle in front might not be detected proper-
on the multifunction display ››› Fig. 208. ly or, in certain circumstances, might not be
detected at all.
To avoid overtaking while driving in an inside
lane the system will gently brake, and in ac-
WARNING
cordance with the speed will prevent the car
from overtaking. The driver can override this If the ACC does not switch off in the situa-
function at any time. tions described, serious accidents and inju-

Safety
ries may occur.
● Always switch off the ACC in critical situa-
tions.

209
Operation

Special driving situations Overtaking


When the turn signal lights up before the ve-
hicle begins an overtaking manoeuvre, the
ACC accelerates the vehicle automatically
and thus reduces the distance from the vehi-
cle in front.
When the vehicle enters the overtaking lane,
if the ACC does not detect another vehicle in
front, it accelerates until it reaches the pro-
grammed speed and maintains it.
System acceleration can be interrupted at
any time by pressing the brake or moving the
third lever backwards ››› page 205.

Fig. 210 (C) Vehicle changing lanes. (D) One Driving through a bend
vehicle turning and another stationary.
On entering or exiting bends, the radar sen-
Fig. 209 (A) Vehicle on a bend. (B) Motorcy-
sor may no longer determine the vehicle in
clist ahead out of range of the radar sensor. The adaptive cruise control (ACC) has certain
front or react to a vehicle in the adjacent lane
physical limitations inherent in the system.
››› Fig. 209 A. In these situations the vehicle
For example, certain reactions of the ACC, in
may brake unnecessarily or fail to react to re-
certain circumstances, may be unexpected or
act to the vehicle in front. In this case, the
come late from the driver's point of view. So
driver has to intervene by accelerating or in-
pay attention in order to intervene if necessa-
terrupting the braking process by applying
ry.
the brake or pushing the third lever back-
For example, the following traffic situations wards ››› page 205.
call for the utmost attention:
Driving in tunnels
Starting driving after a stopping phase (only When driving through tunnels the radar sen-
vehicles with automatic gearbox) sor may be limited. Switch off the ACC in tun-
After a stopping phase the ACC may begin nels.
driving automatically when the vehicle in
front drives off.
210
Driver assistance systems

Narrow or misaligned vehicles ››› Fig. 210 D. In these cases, you should Trailer mode

Technical data
The radar sensor can only detect narrow or brake as necessary. When driving with trailer the ACC controls
misaligned vehicles when they are within less dynamically.
range ››› Fig. 209 B. This applies particularly Vehicles driving in the opposite direction
to narrow vehicles such as motorbikes. In and vehicles crossing your path Overheated brakes
these cases, you should brake as necessary. The ACC does not react to vehicles approach- If the brakes overheat, for example after
ing from the opposite direction or vehicles abrupt braking or in long and steep slopes,
Vehicles with special loads and accessories crossing your path. the ACC may be deactivated temporarily. The

Advice
Special loads and accessories of other vehi- relevant text message will appear in the dash
cles that jut out over the sides, backwards or Metal objects panel display. In this case, adaptive cruise
over the top may be out of the ACC's range. Metal objects, e.g. rails on the road or sheets control cannot be activated.
Switch off the ACC when driving behind vehi- used in road works, can confuse the radar Adaptive cruise control can be reactivated
cles with special loads and accessories or sensor and cause the ACC to react wrongly. once brake temperature has cooled suffi-
when overtaking them. In these cases, you ciently. The message will disappear from the

Operation
should brake as necessary. Factors that may affect how the radar sensor instrument panel display. If the message ACC
operates not available remains on for quite a long
Other vehicles changing lanes If laser sensor operation is impaired, due to time it means that there is a fault. Contact a
heavy rain, spray, snow or mud, the ACC is specialised workshop. SEAT recommends vis-
Vehicles changing lanes a short distance
deactivated temporarily. The relevant text iting a SEAT dealership.
away from your own can only be detected
message will appear in the dash panel dis-

Emergencies
when they are within range of the sensors.
play. If necessary, clean the radar sensor. WARNING
Consequently, the ACC will take longer to re-
act ››› Fig. 210 C. In these cases, you should When the radar sensor begins to operate If the message ACC ready to start ap-
brake as necessary. properly again, the ACC will automatically be pears on the instrument panel display and
available again. The message on the instru- the vehicle in front starts up, the vehicle will
Stationary vehicles ment panel screen will switch off and the ACC start up automatically. In this case the radar
sensor may not detect obstacles on the road.
The ACC does not detect stationary objects will be reactivated again.
This could cause an accident and serious in-

Safety
while driving, such as traffic tails or damaged ACC operation may be affected by a strong ra- juries.
vehicles. dar reverse reflection, for example in a closed ● Before driving off, check that the road is
If a vehicle detected by the ACC turns or car park. clear. If necessary, apply the brake.
moves over and there is a stationary vehicle
in front of it, the ACC will not react to it

211
Operation

Area monitoring system (Front The warning moment varies depending on contribute to reducing the consequences of
the traffic situation and driver behaviour. an accident.
Assist) including City emergen-
cy braking and pedestrian Advance warning Front assist
monitoring* If the system detects a possible collision with If the Front Assist notices that the driver is
the vehicle in front, it may warn the driver by not braking sufficiently in case of a collision
Introduction means of an audible warning and an indica- hazard, the system can increase braking ef-
tion on the instrument panel when driving at fect and thus avert the collision when driving
The Front Assist system including City emer- a speed of between approximately 30 km/h at a speed of between approximately 4 km/h
gency braking and pedestrian monitoring can (18 mph) and 250 km/h (156 mph) (2.5 mph) and 250 km/h (156 mph). Front
help avoid collisions. ››› Fig. 211. assist only acts while the brake pedal is
pressed down hard.
The Front Assist system may warn the driver, The warning moment varies depending on
within the constraints of the system, of im- the traffic situation and driver behaviour. At
WARNING
pending collisions, prepare the vehicle for the same time, the vehicle will prepare for a
emergency braking in case of danger, provide possible emergency braking ››› . The intelligent technology in the Front Assist
cannot change the laws of physics. The driver
support during braking and apply automatic
Critical warning is always responsible for braking in time. If
braking.
the Front Assist issues a warning, then, de-
The City emergency braking and pedestrian If the driver fails to react to the advance pending on the traffic circumstances, you
monitoring functions are an integral part of warning, the system may actively intervene in must brake immediately or dodge the obsta-
the Front Assist system. the brakes when driving at a speed of be- cle.
tween approximately 30 km/h (18 mph) and ● Adapt your speed and safe distance to the
The Front Assist is not a replacement for 250 km/h (156 mph), generating a brief jolt vehicle in front of you at all times to suit visi-
driver awareness. to warn of the imminent collision. bility, weather, road and traffic conditions.
● The Front Assist alone cannot avoid acci-
Distance warning Automatic braking dents and serious injuries.
If the system detects that safety is endan- If the driver also fails to react to the advance ● In complex driving situations, the Front As-
gered by the proximity of the vehicle in front, warning, the system may brake the vehicle sist may issue unnecessary warnings and in-
it may warn the driver by means of a message automatically, by progressively increasing tervene unnecessarily in braking, such as in
on the instrument panel when driving at a braking effect driving at a speed of between traffic islands.
speed of between approximately 60 km/h approximately 4 km/h (2.5 mph) and ● If the operation of the Front Assist is im-
(37 mph) and 250 km/h (156 mph) 250 km/h (156 mph). By reducing speed in paired, for example, by dirt or because the ra-
››› Fig. 211. case of a possible collision, the system may dar sensor has lost its settings, the system

212
Driver assistance systems

may issue unnecessary warnings and On-screen warning lamps and mes- Radar sensor

Technical data
intervene inopportunely in the braking. sages
● During driving, the Front Assist does not re-
act to people or animals or vehicles crossing
your path or which approach you head-on in
the same lane.
● The driver must always be ready to take
over the control of the vehicle.

Advice
Note
● When the Front Assist causes a braking,
the brake pedal is “harder”.
Fig. 212 On the front bumper: radar sensor.
● Automatic interventions by the Front Assist Fig. 211 On the instrument panel display:
on the brakes may be interrupted by pressing

Operation
Warning indications. A radar sensor is installed on the front bump-
the clutch, accelerator or moving the wheel. er to determine the traffic situation
● If the Front Assist does not work as descri- Distance warning ››› Fig. 212 1 .
bed in this chapter (e.g. in intervenes several
If the safe distance with regard to the vehicle The radar sensor's visibility may be impaired
times unnecessarily), switch it off. Have the
system checked by a specialised workshop.
in front is exceeded, the relevant warning will by dirt, mud or snow, or by environmental in-
SEAT recommends visiting a SEAT dealership. appear on the instrument panel display fluences such as rain or mist. In this case the

Emergencies
. Front Assist monitoring system does not
work. The instrument panel displays the fol-
WARNING lowing message: Front Assist: No
Observe the safety warnings ››› in Warning sensor vision! If necessary clean the ra-
and control lamps on page 113. dar sensor ››› .
When the radar sensor begins to operate
Note properly again, the Front Assist will automati-

Safety
cally be available again. The message will
When the Front Assist is connected, the indi-
cations on the instrument panel screen may disappear from the instrument panel display.
be concealed by warnings from other func- Front Assist operation may be affected by a
tions, such as an incoming call. strong radar reverse reflection. This may oc-
cur, for example, in a closed car park or due »
213
Operation

to the presence of metallic objects (e.g. rails mends visiting a SEAT dealership for this pur- Switching the Front Assist on and off
on the road or sheets used in road works). pose. With the ignition switched on, the Front As-
The area in front of and around the radar sen- ● Clean away the snow with a brush and the sist can be switched on and off as follows:
sor should not be covered with adhesives, ice preferably with a solvent-free de-icer ● Select the corresponding menu option us-
additional or similar headlights, as this may spray.
ing the button for the driver assistance sys-
negatively affect Front Assist operation. tems ›››  page 34.
If structural modifications are made to the ve- ● OR: switch the system on and off in Easy
hicle, for example, if the suspension is low- Operating the Front Assist monitoring Connect using the  button and the
ered or the front spoiler is modified, Front As- system SETTINGS and Driver assistance function but-
sist operation may be affected. So structural tons ›››  page 30.
modifications should only be made by speci-
alised workshops. SEAT recommends visiting When Front Assist is switched off, the instru-
a SEAT dealership for this purpose. ment panel will inform that it has been
switched off with the following indicator 
If work is done incorrectly on the front of the ››› Fig. 213.
vehicle, the radar sensor could be damaged
or lose its settings, and Front Assist opera- Switching the advance warning function on
tion may be affected. So repair work should or off
only be made by specialised workshops.
SEAT recommends visiting a SEAT dealership The pre-warning function (advance warning)
for this purpose. can be switched on or off in the Easy Connect
Fig. 213 On the instrument panel display: system with the  button and the SETTINGS
Front Assist switched off message. and Driver assistance function buttons
CAUTION
›››  page 30.
If you have the sensation that the radar sen- The Front Assist is active whenever the igni-
sor is damaged or has lost its settings, dis- tion is switched on. The system will store the setting for the next
connect the Front Assist. This will avoid pos- time the ignition is switched on.
sible damage. If this occurs have it adjusted. When the Front Assist is switched off, so too
are the advance warning function (pre warn- SEAT recommends keeping the advance
● The sensor may become damaged or lose
ing) and the distance warning. warning function switched on at all times.
its settings when knocked, for example, dur-
ing a parking manoeuvre. This may compro- SEAT recommends leaving the Front Assist al- Depending on the infotainment system in-
mise the system's efficacy or disconnect it. ways switched on. Exceptions ››› page 215, stalled in the vehicle, the advance warning
● Repairs to the radar sensor require special- Switching the Front Assist off temporarily in function may be adjusted as follows:
ist knowledge and special tools. SEAT recom- the following situations. ● Ready
214
Driver assistance systems

● Medium ● If the vehicle is on a test bed. ● Pressing the accelerator all the way down.

Technical data
● Delayed ● When the radar sensor is damaged. ● If the Front Assist is switched off or dam-
● Deactivated ● If the radar sensor takes a heavy knock, for aged.
example in a rear collision. ● If the ASR has been manually disconnec-
SEAT recommends driving with the function ted.
● If it intervenes several times unnecessarily.
in “Medium” mode.
● If the radar sensor is covered temporarily ● If the ESC is controlling.

Switching distance warning on and off with some kind of accessory, such as an ad- ● If several brake lights of the vehicle or elec-
ditional headlight or the like. trically connected trailer are damaged.

Advice
If the safe distance with regard to the vehicle
in front is exceeded, the relevant warning will ● When the vehicle is to be loaded on a lorry, ● If the radar sensor is dirty or covered.
appear on the instrument panel display ferry or train. ● If there are metal objects, e.g. rails on the
. In this case, increase the safe dis- road or sheets used in road works.
tance. WARNING
● If the vehicle is reversing.
The distance warning can be switched on and If the Front Assist is not switched off in the

Operation
● If the vehicle over-accelerates.
situations described, serious accidents and
off in the Easy Connect system using the ● In case of snow or heavy rain.
injuries may occur.
 button and the SETTINGS and
Driver assistance function buttons ● Switch off the Front Assist in critical situa- ● In case of narrow vehicles, such as motor-
›››  page 30. tions. bikes.
● Misaligned vehicles.
The system will store the setting for the next

Emergencies
time the ignition is switched on. ● Vehicles crossing the other's path.
System limitations
SEAT recommends keeping the distance ● Vehicles approaching in the opposite direc-
warning switched on at all times. The Front Assist has certain physical limita- tion.
tions inherent to the system. Thus, in certain ● Special loads and accessories of other ve-
circumstances some of the system's reac- hicles that jut out over the sides, backwards
Switching the Front Assist off tempo- tions may be inopportune or be delayed from or over the top.
the driver's standpoint. So pay attention in
rarily in the following situations

Safety
order to intervene if necessary.
In the following situations the Front Assist
Monitoring System should be deactivated The following conditions may cause the Front
due to the system's limitations ››› : Assist not to react or to do so too late:
● On taking tight bends.
● When the vehicle is to be towed.
215
Operation

City Emergency braking function If the system detects a possible collision with in braking, such as in work areas or if there
a vehicle in front of it, the vehicle prepares are metal rails.
for a possible emergency braking ››› . ● If the operation of the City Emergency brak-
If the driver fails to react to a possible colli- ing function is impaired, for example, by dirt
sion, the system may brake the vehicle auto- or because the radar sensor has lost its set-
matically, by progressively increasing braking tings, the system may issue unnecessary
effect driving to reduce speed in the event of warnings and intervene inopportunely in the
braking.
a collision. The system can thus help to re-
duce the consequences of an accident. ● During driving, the City Emergency braking
function does not react to people or animals
Status display or vehicles crossing your path or which ap-
proach you head-on in the same lane.
Automatic deceleration by means of the City
Fig. 214 On the instrument panel display: ad-
vance warning message.
Emergency braking function is displayed on
Note
the instrument panel by means of the ad-
The City Emergency braking function is part vance warning ››› Fig. 2141). ● When the City Emergency braking function
causes a braking, the brake pedal is “hard-
of Front Assist and is active whenever this
WARNING er”.
system is switched on.
● Automatic interventions on the brakes by
The smart technology included in the City
Depending on the equipment, the City emer- the City Emergency braking function may be
Emergency braking function cannot defy the
gency braking function can be switched on laws of physics. The driver is always respon- interrupted by pressing the clutch, accelera-
and off in the Easy Connect system using the sible for braking in time. tor or moving the wheel.
 button and the SETTINGS and ● The City Emergency braking function can
● Adapt your speed and safe distance to the
Driver assistance function buttons brake the vehicle until it stops completely.
vehicle in front of you at all times to suit visi-
›››  page 30. bility, weather, road and traffic conditions. However, the brake system does not halt the
vehicle permanently. Use the foot brake!
The City Emergency braking function picks up ● The City Emergency braking function alone
the traffic situation in front of the vehicle at ● If several inopportune intervenes occur,
cannot prevent accidents or serious injury.
speeds approximately between 4 km/h switch off the Front Assist and with it the City
● In complex driving situations, the City Emergency braking function. Take it to a spe-
(2.5 mph) and 30 km/h (19 mph). Emergency braking function may issue unnec- cialised workshop, SEAT recommends visiting
essary warnings and intervene inopportunely a SEAT dealership.

1) The symbol on the instrument panels with colour

display is in colour.
216
Driver assistance systems

● If numerous unnecessary interventions oc- acoustic signal and a message on the dash WARNING

Technical data
cur, the City Emergency braking function may panel display ››› Fig. 215.
The technology in the pedestrian monitoring
switch off automatically. The pedestrian monitoring system, including system cannot defy the laws of physics and
the advance warning, is automatically con- only works within the system's limits. The
nected when the ignition is switched on driver is always responsible for braking in
Pedestrian Monitoring*1) ››› page 171. time. If the pedestrian monitoring system is-
sues a warning, brake the vehicle immediate-
SEAT recommends always having the pedes- ly with the brake pedal or swerve to avoid the
trian monitoring system connected. The ex- pedestrian, depending on traffic conditions.

Advice
ceptions set out for the Front Assist system ● The pedestrian monitoring system alone
are equally valid for the pedestrian monitor- cannot avoid accidents or serious injury.
ing system ››› page 215.
● In complex driving situations, the pedes-
trian monitoring system may issue unneces-
Switching the pedestrian monitoring system sary warnings and intervene unnecessarily in
on and off braking, such as in main roads with turnings.

Operation
With the ignition on, the pedestrian monitor- ● If the operation of the system is impaired,
ing system can be switched on and off as fol- for example, because the radar sensor and
lows: camera are covered or have lost their set-
Fig. 215 On the instrument panel display: 
tings, the system may issue unnecessary
Advance warning message.  Pedestrian ● Switch the system on and off in the info- warnings and intervene inopportunely in the
Monitoring deactivated.
tainment system using the  button and braking.

Emergencies
the SETUP and Driver assistance function but- ● The driver must always be ready to take
The pedestrian monitoring system can help
tons ›››  page 30. over the control of the vehicle.
prevent accidents involving pedestrians or
reduce the consequences of an accident. When the pedestrian protection system is
switched off, the dash panel display shows a Note
The system warns of danger of collision, pre-
pares the vehicle for emergency braking, as- message indicating this ››› Fig. 215 . The ● When the vehicle is braked via the pedes-
sists in the braking and brakes automatically. pedestrian monitoring system is switched off trian monitoring system, the brake pedal be-
with the Front Assist function. comes stiffer. »

Safety
If the system detects a possible collision with
a pedestrian, it warns the driver with an

1) Depending on the vehicle equipment, pedestrian

monitoring is not available in all countries.


217
Operation

● Automatic interventions by the pedestrian tures or objects in poor condition can be in- ● If there is a fault in the system, have it
monitoring system on the brakes may be in- correctly detected as road markings under checked by a specialised workshop.
terrupted by pressing the accelerator or mov- certain circumstances by the Lane Assist sys-
ing the wheel. tem. In such situations, switch the Lane As-
● If the pedestrian monitoring system does sist system off immediately.
not work as described in this chapter (e.g. if ● Please observe the indications on the in-
it intervening unnecessarily several times), strument panel and act as is necessary.
switch if off, contact a specialist workshop ● Always pay attention to the vehicle's sur-
immediately and request to have the system roundings.
checked. SEAT recommends visiting a SEAT
● When the area of vision of the camera be-
dealership for this.
comes dirty, covered or is damaged, the Lane
Assist system function can be affected.

Lane Assist system* CAUTION


In order to avoid influencing the operation of
Introduction the system, the following points must be tak-
en into account:
WARNING ● Regularly clean the area of vision of the
The intelligent technology in the Lane Assist camera and keep it in a clean state, without
system cannot change the limits imposed by snow or ice.
the laws of physics and by the very nature of ● Do not cover the area of vision of the cam-
the system. Careless or uncontrolled use of era.
the Lane Assist system may cause accidents ● Check that the area of vision of the wind-
and injury. The system is not a replacement screen camera is not damaged.
for driver awareness.
● Always adapt your speed and the distance
to the vehicles ahead in line with visibility, Note
weather conditions, the condition of the road ● The Lane Assist system has been exclusive-
and the traffic situation. ly developed for driving on paved roads only.
● Always keep your hands on the steering ● If the Lane Assist system does not work as
wheel so it can be turned at any time. described in this chapter, do not use it and
● The Lane Assist system does not detect all contact a specialised workshop.
road markings. The road surfaces, road struc-
218
Driver assistance systems

Indications on the display and lamps – The system is operational, the highligh-

Technical data
ted line A indicates that there was a
risk of involuntarily crossing the lane
line and that the steering is being adjus-
ted to correct the angle ››› Fig. 217 C.
– The two lines A light up simultaneously
when both lane lines are recognised and
the Lane Assist function is active
››› Fig. 217 D.

Advice
Control lamps

Blinks or lights up yellow: Lane Assist


 active but not available.

Operation
The system can not accurately recognise the lane.
Please see page 220, the Lane Assist system is not
available (the control lamp is lit up yellow).

 Blinks or lights up green:


Lane Assist system active and available.

Emergencies
Fig. 217 On the instrument panel display: In-
dication on the Lane Assist system display
Fig. 216 On the instrument panel display: In- (example 2). WARNING
dication on the Lane Assist system display Observe the safety warnings ››› in Warning
(example 1). Status display and control lamps on page 113.
– The system is active, but not available,
either because the minimum speed has
not been reached or because the lane

Safety
lines are not recognised ››› Fig. 216 A.
– The system is active and available, both
lane lines are recognised. The steering
angle is not being corrected at this mo-
ment ››› Fig. 216 B.
219
Operation

Operation ● When the maximum rotational torque dur- motion through the brakes and, if the vehicle
ing the corrective steering movement is not has it, activates the Emergency Assist func-
enough to keep the vehicle inside the lane. tion ››› page 222.
● When no lane is detected during the correc- ● In vehicles without Emergency Assist, the
tive steering movement. adaptive lane guidance function will be disa-
bled after the corresponding warnings to the
Switching the Lane Assist system on or off driver.
Through the Easy Connect system
The lane assist system is active but it is not
● Press the Easy Connect button  available (the control lamp is lit up yellow)
● Press the SETTINGS function button ● When driving at speeds below 65 km/h (38
● Press the function button Driver assistance to mph).
Fig. 218 In the windscreen: field of vision of open the menu.
the Lane Assist system camera. ● When the Lane Assist system does not de-
OR: through the driving assist button tect the dividing lines of the road. For exam-
Using the camera located in the windscreen, on the turn signal level*. ple, in the event warnings indicating road
the Lane Assist system detects the possible works, and snow, dirt, moisture or reflec-
lines dividing the lanes. When the vehicle in- The Lane centring guide function is ac- tions.
voluntarily approaches a dividing line it has tivated/deactivated in the Easy Connect sys- ● When the radius of a curve is too small.
detected, the system notifies the driver with tem using the  button and the SETTINGS
function button ››› page 114. ● When no road markings can be seen.
a corrective steering movement. This move-
● When the distance to the next marking to
ment can be over-regulated at any time. Self-deactivation: the Lane Assist system can
too great.
No warning is produced with the turn signals be automatically deactivated if there is a sys-
tem malfunction. The control lamp disap- ● When the system does not detect any clear
activated, given that the Lane Assist system
pears. and active steering movement during a long
understands that a lane change is required.
period of time.
Steering wheel vibration Hands-Off Function ● Temporarily, in the event of very dynamic
● In the absence of steering wheel activity driving styles.
The following situations can cause vibration
in the steering wheel and require the driver the system alerts the driver with acoustic sig- ● If a turn signal is activated.
to take active control of driving: nals and a text message on the dash panel ● With the stability control system (ESC) in
asking to actively take over the steering. Sport mode or switched off.
● When the limits of the very nature of the ● If the driver does not react to this, the sys-
system are reached. tem also alerts the driver with a little shaking
220
Driver assistance systems

Note Traffic Jam Assist To do this, the system automatically controls

Technical data
the accelerator, brakes and steering, and
● Before starting a journey, verify that the
slows the vehicle, stopping it fully if neces-
field of vision of the camera is not covered Related video
sary, when faced with a vehicle in front that
››› Fig. 218.
has stopped. It automatically moves off again
● Always keep the field of vision of the cam-
when the vehicle ahead moves.
era clean.
Traffic Jam Assist is designed only for use on
motorways and wide roads. Therefore, never

Advice
use it in city traffic.
Switching off the Lane Assist system
in the following situations Fig. 219 Safety
Switching Traffic Jam Assist on and off
Due to the limits of the Lane Assist system, If Lane Assist ››› page 218 is on, Traffic Jam
switch it off in the following situations: Assist can be switched on or off in the info-
Description and operation
tainment system using the  button and

Operation
● When more attention is required of the the SETTINGS and Driver Assistance function
Traffic Jam Assist helps the driver keep the
driver
car within its lane and to move in convoy in buttons ›››  page 30.
● When driving in a sporty style case of traffic congestion or slow traffic. It is activated by switching on Lane Assist
● In unfavourable weather conditions and the lane centring guide in the infotain-
Traffic Jam Assist is an additional function of
● On roads in poor condition Lane Assist ››› page 218 and combines Lane ment system. If the lane centring guide is not

Emergencies
Assist functions with Adaptive Cruise Control active, the Traffic Jam Assist system is not ac-
● In areas of road works
(ACC) ››› page 201. Therefore, it is essential tive
Note that you read these two chapters carefully Traffic Jam Assist may be disconnected using
and note the limitations of the systems and the button for driver assistance systems to-
The Lane Assist system deactivates when
driving below 60 km/h (37 mph).
the information about them. gether with Lane Assist ›››  page 34.

Operation of Traffic Jam Assist Technical requirements for using Traffic Jam
Assist

Safety
At speeds of below 60 km/h (40 mph), Traffic
Jam Assist can maintain a (temporary) dis- ● Lane Assist must be activated ››› page 218,
tance preset by the driver with respect to the Lane Assist system*.
vehicle ahead and help stay within the lane ● Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) must be con-
››› . nected and active ››› page 201. »
221
Operation

● The selector lever must be in the D/S posi- ● In sections with roadworks. ● If the vehicle continues to move when you
tion or in the Tiptronic selection track. ● In city journeys. wish it to stop after a driver intervention
● The speed must be below 60 km/h prompt, brake the vehicle by applying the
(38 mph). WARNING pedal.
● The lane centring guide must be active ● If driver intervention is requested on the
The smart technology incorporated into Traf-
››› page 220. fic Jam Assist cannot defy the laws of phys- dash panel display, immediately resume con-
ics; it only works within the limits of the sys- trol of the vehicle.
tem. Accidents and severe injury may occur if ● Keep your hands on the wheel at all times
Traffic Jam Assist is not active (the Lane As-
sist control light turns yellow) Traffic Jam Assist is used negligently or invol- to be ready to intervene in the steering at any
untarily. The system is not a replacement for time. The driver is always responsible for
● If any of the conditions mentioned on driver awareness. keeping the vehicle in its own lane.
page 221, Technical requirements for using ● Adapt your speed and safe distance to the ● Always be prepared to take charge of driv-
Traffic Jam Assist are no longer met. vehicle in front of you at all times to suit the ing (accelerating or braking) yourself.
● If any of the conditions required for opera- visibility, weather, road and traffic condi-
tion of the Lane Assist are not met tions.
Note
››› page 218. ● Do not use Traffic Jam Assist in city jour-
● If Traffic Jam Assist does not work as de-
● If any of the conditions necessary for the neys.
scribed in this chapter, stop using it and con-
adaptive cruise control (ACC) to work are no ● Do not use Traffic Jam Assist if there is poor
tact a specialised workshop.
longer fulfilled ››› page 201. visibility, for example, in case of snow, ice,
● If the system is faulty, take it to a special-
rain or loose gravel, or on steep or slippery
sections or flooded roads. ised workshop and have it checked.
Situations in which Traffic Jam Assist must
be switched off ● Do not use Traffic Jam Assist offroad or on
roads where the surface is not firm. Traffic
Due to the limitations of the system, Traffic
Jam Assist must always be switched off in the
Jam Assist has been designed for use on
paved roads only.
Emergency Assist
following situations:
● Traffic Jam Assist does not react to people
Description and operation
● When more attention is required by the or animals or vehicles crossing your path or
driver. that approach you head-on down the same
Emergency Assist detects whether there is in-
lane.
● When driving in a very sporty style. activity by the driver and can automatically
● If Traffic Jam Assist does not reduce speed
● In adverse weather conditions, e.g. in case keep the car within the lane and stop it alto-
sufficiently, brake the vehicle immediately by gether if necessary. This way the system can
of snow or heavy rain. applying the pedal.
actively help avoid an accident.
● When driving on roads in poor condition.

222
Driver assistance systems

Emergency Assist is an additional function of Switching the Emergency Assist on and off WARNING

Technical data
Lane Assist ››› page 218 and combines Lane The Emergency Assist is switched on auto-
Assist functions with Adaptive Cruise Control The smart technology incorporated into the
matically when the Lane Assist is switched on Emergency Assist cannot overcome the limits
(ACC) ››› page 201. Therefore, it is essential ››› page 218. imposed by the laws of physics; it only works
that you read these two chapters carefully
within the limits of the system. The driver is
and note the limitations of the systems and Technical requirements for using the Emer- responsible for driving the vehicle.
the information about them. gency Assist ● Adapt your speed and safe distance to the
● The adaptive cruise control (ACC) must be vehicle in front of you at all times to suit the
Operation of Emergency Assist

Advice
switched on ››› page 201. visibility, weather, road and traffic condi-
Emergency Assist detects when the driver tions.
● The Lane Assist must be switched on
ceases to perform any activity and repeatedly ● Keep your hands on the wheel at all times
requests that he/she regain active control of ››› page 218. to be ready to intervene in the steering at any
the vehicle, through the use of optical and ● The selector lever must be at the D/S posi- time.
acoustic warnings and by applying the tion or in the Tiptronic selection track. ● The Emergency Assist alone cannot always

Operation
brakes. ● The system must have detected a lane sep- avoid accidents or serious injuries.
If the driver continues to do nothing, the sys- aration line on both sides of the vehicle ● If the operation of the Emergency Assist is
tem automatically takes over the accelerator, ››› Fig. 217. impaired, for example if the radar sensor of
brakes and steering in order to brake the ve- the adaptive cruise control (ACC) or the Lane
hicle and keep it in its lane ››› . If the re- The following conditions may cause the Assist camera are covered or have lost their
maining braking distance is sufficient, if nec- Emergency Assist not to react or to switch off settings, the system may intervene inoppor-

Emergencies
automatically: tunely in braking or in steering.
essary the system slows down the vehicle un-
til it stops completely and automatically ● The Emergency Assist does not react to
● If the driver accelerates, brakes or moves
switches on the electronic parking brake people or animal or vehicles crossing your
the steering wheel.
››› page 177. path or which approach you head-on in the
● If any of the conditions mentioned in same lane.
When the Emergency Assist is actively adjust- ››› page 223, Technical requirements for us-
ing, the hazard warning lights come on ing the Emergency Assist are not fulfilled.
WARNING
››› page 140 and the vehicle makes slight zig- ● If any of the conditions required for opera-

Safety
zag movements in the lane in order to warn If the Emergency Assist Intervenes inoppor-
tion of the Lane Assist are not met
other drivers. tunely, serious accidents and injuries may oc-
››› page 218. cur.
● If any of the conditions necessary for the ● If the Emergency Assist does not operate
adaptive cruise control (ACC) to work are no properly, switch off the Lane Assist »
longer fulfilled ››› page 201.
223
Operation

››› page 218. Doing so will also switch off the SEAT Drive Profile* in harmony with the movements of the accel-
Emergency Assist. erator. Additionally, when Eco mode is selec-
ted, the Start-stop function is automatically
● Have the system checked by a specialised Introduction
workshop. SEAT recommends visiting a SEAT activated.
dealership for this. SEAT Drive Profile enables the driver to In vehicles with automatic transmission, the
choose between four profiles or modes, Nor- gear change points are modified to position
Note mal, Sport, Eco and Individual, that them in lower or higher engine speed ranges.
modify the behaviour of various vehicle func- Additionally, the Eco1) mode activates the In-
● Automatic interventions by the Emergency
tions, providing different driving experiences. ertia function, enabling consumption to be
Assist on the brakes may be interrupted by
pressing the accelerator or brake or by mov- In the FR and X-PERIENCE models equipped further reduced.
ing the wheel. with dynamic chassis control, the Comfort In manual gearbox vehicles, Eco1) mode cau-
● Hazard warning lights that come on auto- profile is also available. ses the gear change recommendation indica-
matically can be switched off by pressing the In the Leon Cupra model the four profiles are tions that appear on the instrument panel to
accelerator or the break, moving the steering vary, facilitating more efficient driving.
Comfort, Sport, Cupra and Individual.
wheel or pressing the hazard warning light
switch. The Individual profile can be configured Dynamic chassis control (DCC)
● If this occurs, the Emergency Assist may according to personal preferences. The other
profiles are fixed. DCC continuously adapts the shock absorb-
decelerate the vehicle until it comes to a com-
ers to the condition of the road and current
plete stop.
driving conditions, according to the pre-set
● When the Emergency Assist is activated, it
programme.
is only available again after the ignition has Description
been switched off and back on again. In the event of a fault in the DCC, the follow-
Depending on the equipment fitted in the ve- ing message is displayed on the instrument
hicle, SEAT Drive Profile can operate on the screen Fault: damping setting.
following functions:
Address
Engine Power steering becomes more robust in
Depending on the profile selected, the en- Sport mode to enable a sportier driving
gine responds more spontaneously or more style. In the Leon Cupra the power steering
becomes more robust in Cupra mode.

1) In the Leon Cupra model, Eco mode is selected

through the Individual profile.


224
Driver assistance systems

Air conditioning Setting driving mode Driving

Technical data
Characteristics
In vehicles with Climatronic, this can operate profile
in eco1) mode, especially restricting fuel con-
Offers a balanced driving experience, suit-
sumption. Normal
able for everyday use.

Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)2) Provides a complete dynamic performance


Sport in the vehicle, enabling the user a more
According to the active driving profile, the ac- sporty driving style.
celeration gradient of the adaptive cruise

Advice
control varies. Places the vehicle in a particularly low
state of consumption, facilitating a fuel-
Eco
saving driving style that is respectful to
Electronic self-locking differential2) the environment.
The self-locking differential adapts its behav- Fig. 220 Centre console: MODE button. Enables some configurations to be modi-
iour depending on the driving profile chosen. fied by pressing the Profile settings
Normal mode or Cupra mode can be selected Individ-

Operation
You can select from Normal, Sport, Eco button. The functions that can be adjusted
ual
to prioritise improved traction in sport driv- and Individual. depend on the equipment fitted in the ve-
ing. hicle.
You can select the required mode either by
repeatedly pressing the button MODE It permits more relaxed and comfortable
››› Fig. 220, or on the touch screen, in the Conven- driving, for example for long motorway
iencea) journeys. Its main characteristic is the soft
menu that opens when the above button is

Emergencies
suspension setting (DCC).
pressed.
a)Only for FR and X-PERIENCE models equipped with dynamic
An icon on the Easy Connect system display chassis control.
informs about the active mode.
The MODE button light remains lit up yellow WARNING
when the active mode is different to Normal. When operating SEAT Drive Profile, pay atten-
tion to all traffic: doing otherwise could cause
an accident. »

Safety
1) In the Leon Cupra model, Eco mode is selected

through the Individual profile.


2) Applies to the Leon Cupra model.
225
Operation

Note You can select from Convenience, Sport, WARNING


Cupra and Individual.
● When the vehicle is switched off it will al- When operating SEAT Drive Profile, pay atten-
ways store the driving profile that was selec- tion to all traffic: doing otherwise could cause
Cupra Drive Profile button
ted when the ignition key was removed. Nev- an accident.
ertheless, when the engine is restarted, the You can select the required mode either by
engine and the gear will not restart in the set- repeatedly pressing the button with the Cu-
Note
ting selected. For engine and gear to revert to pra logotype ››› Fig. 221, or on the touch
the desired position, select the correspond- screen, in the menu that opens when the ● When the vehicle is switched off it will al-
ing drive profile again or press the Easy Con- above button is pressed. ways store the driving profile that was selec-
nect system button repeatedly. ted when the ignition key was removed. Nev-
● Your speed and driving style must always An icon on the Easy Connect system display ertheless, when the engine is restarted the
be adjusted to visibility, weather, and traffic informs about the active mode. engine and the gear will not restart in its
conditions. sportier mode in order to save fuel. For en-
The light of the button with the Cupra logo- gine and gear to revert to a sportier mode,
● The Eco profile is not recommended when type remains lit up only when the Cupra pro- select the corresponding driving profile again
towing a vehicle. file is active. on the Easy Connect system screen.
● Your speed and driving style must always
Driving Characteristics be adjusted to visibility, weather, and traffic
Setting driving mode profile conditions.
3 Applies to the model: Leon Cupra It permits more relaxed and comfortable
Conven- driving, for example for long motorway
ience journeys. Its main characteristic is the
Kick-down
soft suspension setting (DCC).

It represents the vehicle's default behav- The kick-down feature allows maximum ac-
Sport
iour, suitable for dynamic driving. celeration to be reached.
It gives the vehicle a decidedly sportier If the eco* ››› page 225 mode has been se-
Cupra nature, and makes for maximum perform- lected in SEAT Drive Profile*, and the acceler-
ance. ator is pressed beyond a hard point, the en-
Enables some configurations to be modi- gine power is automatically controlled to give
fied by pressing the Profile settings your vehicle maximum acceleration.
Individ-
button. The functions that can be adjus-
ual
Fig. 221 Centre console: Cupra Drive Profile ted depend on the equipment fitted in the
vehicle.
button.

226
Driver assistance systems

WARNING

Technical data
Please note that if the road surface is slip-
pery or wet, the kick-down feature could
cause the driving wheels to spin, which could
result in skidding.

Advice
Operation
Emergencies
Safety
227
Operation

Traffic sign detection system* kia, Slovenia, Spain, Sweden, Switzerland, Note
Turkey, the United Kingdom and the Vatican
City. In order not to compromise the system's op-
Introduction eration, please take the following points into
account:
The traffic sign detection system records the WARNING
● Regularly clean the area of vision of the
standard traffic signs in front of the vehicle The technology in the traffic sign detection camera and keep it in a clean state, without
with a camera located on the base of the in- system cannot change the limits imposed by snow or ice.
terior mirror and provides information about the laws of physics and only works within the
● Do not cover the field of vision of the cam-
speed limits and overtaking prohibitions. system's limits. Do not let the extra conven-
ience afforded by the traffic sign detection era.
Within its limitations, the system also dis-
system tempt you into taking any risks when ● Always replace damaged or worn blades
plays additional signals, such as time-specif-
driving. The system is not a replacement for when required to avoid lines on the camera's
ic prohibitions, signs for vehicles towing trail-
driver awareness. field of vision.
ers ››› page 241 or limitations that only apply
● Adapt your speed and driving style to suit ● Check that the windscreen is not damaged
in the event of rain. Even on journeys without
visibility, weather, road and traffic condi- in the area of the camera's field of vision.
signs, the system may display any applicable
tions.
speed limits.
● Poor visibility, darkness, snow, rain and fog Note
In Germany, on motorways and vehicle roads, may lead to the system failing to display traf-
besides speed limits and overtaking provi- ● The use of outdated maps on the naviga-
fic signs or not displaying them correctly.
sions the system also displays the end of tion system may cause the system to show
● If the camera's field of vision is dirty, cov-
prohibition signs. The valid speed limit at the traffic signs incorrectly.
ered or damaged, system operation may be
time in other countries is always shown. ● In the waypoints mode of the navigation
impaired.
system, the traffic sign detection system is
Countries in which it works only partly available.
WARNING
When this instruction manual went to print,
The driving recommendations and traffic indi-
the traffic sign detection system was operat-
cations shown on the traffic sign detection
ing in the following countries: system may differ from the actual current
Andorra, Austria, Belgium, Bulgaria, Croatia, traffic situation.
Cyprus, Czech Republic, Denmark, Estonia, ● The system may not detect or correctly
Finland, France, Germany, Greece, Hungary, show all the traffic signs.
Iceland, Ireland, Italy, Latvia, Liechtenstein, ● Traffic signs and traffic regulations have
Lithuania, Luxembourg, Malta, Monaco, the priority over the recommendations and dis-
Netherlands, Northern Ireland, Norway, Po- plays provided by the system.
land, Portugal, Romania, San Marino, Slova-
228
Driver assistance systems

Indication on display Traffic sign detec- Cause and solution WARNING

Technical data
tion system mes- If messages are ignored, the vehicle may stall
sages in traffic and cause accidents and severe inju-
ries.
There are no The system is booting up.
traffic signs OR ELSE: the camera has not ● Never ignore the messages displayed.
available recognised any obligation or ● Stop the vehicle at the next opportunity
prohibition signs.
and in a safe place.
Error: Detection There is a fault in the system.

Advice
of traffic signs Have the system checked by a Note
specialised workshop.
Failure to heed the control lamps and corre-
Speed warning The speed warning function of sponding text messages when they light up
currently un- the traffic sign detection sys- may result in damage to the vehicle.
available. tem is faulty.
Have the system checked by a

Operation
specialised workshop.

Detection of The windscreen is dirty in the


Operation
traffic signs: camera area.
Clean the wind- Clean the windscreen. The traffic sign detection system does not
screen! work in all countries ››› page 228, Countries
in which it works. Keep this in mind when

Emergencies
Detection of The navigation system is not travelling abroad.
traffic signs: transmitting any data.
Limited at the Check that the navigation sys-
Fig. 222 On the instrument panel display: ex- Activating and deactivating traffic sign dis-
moment tem's maps are up-to-date.
amples of speed limits or overtaking prohibi- play on the instrument panel
OR ELSE: the vehicle is cur-
tions with their respective additional signs. rently in a region that is not
included in the navigation
The permanent display of traffic signs on the
The traffic signs detected by the system are system's map. instrument panel can be activated or deacti-
displayed on the dash panel display vated in the infotainment system using the

Safety
››› Fig. 222 and, depending on the navigation No data available The traffic sign detection sys-  button and the SETTINGS and
tem does not work in the cur- Driver Assistance function buttons.
system fitted in the vehicle, on the infotain- rent country.
ment system as well ›››  page 30.
Display of traffic signs
When the traffic sign detection system is con-
nected, a camera located on the base of the »
229
Operation

interior rear-view mirror records the traffic using the button and the SETTINGS and
 Limited operation
signs in front of the vehicle. After checking function buttons
Driver Assistance
The traffic sign detection system has certain
and evaluating the information from the cam- ›››  page 30. The speed is adjusted in limitations. The following cases may lead the
era, the navigation system and the current steps of 5 km/h (3 mph) within a range of be- system to operate with limitations or not at
vehicle data, up to three valid traffic signs tween 0 km/h (mph) and 20 km/h (12 mph) all:
are displayed ››› Fig. 222 B in conjunction above the maximum speed permitted.
with their corresponding additional signs. ● In the case of poor visibility, e.g. in snow,
Trailer mode rain, fog or intense mist.
First: The sign that is currently valid for the
In vehicles equipped with a towing bracket ● In cases of dazzling, e.g. caused by head-
driver is shown in the left side of the
screen For example, a maximum speed device from the factory and a trailer that is on traffic or by the sun.
limit of 130 km/h (100 mph) electrically connected to the vehicle, it is pos- ● When driving at high speeds.
››› Fig. 222 A. sible to activate or deactivate the display of
● If the camera is covered or dirty.
specific traffic signs for vehicles with trailer,
Second: A sign valid only in certain circum- ● If the traffic signs are out of the camera's
such as speed limits or overtaking prohibi-
stances, e.g. 100 km/h (60 mph) is tions. Activation or deactivation is performed field of vision.
shown second, together with the addi- on the infotainment system using the ● If the traffic signs are partially or totally
tional rain sign.  button and the SETTINGS and covered, e.g. by trees, snow, dirt or other ve-
Additional sign: If the windscreen wiper is Driver Assistance function buttons hicles.
working while you are driving, the signal ›››  page 30. ● In the case of traffic signs that do not fulfil
with the additional rain sign will be
For trailer mode, the display of speed limits the regulations.
shown first, on the left, as it is the one
that is applicable at the time. applicable to the type of trailer or to the legal ● In the case of damaged or bent traffic
provisions can be adjusted. The speed is ad- signs.
Third: A sign valid only with restrictions, e.g. justed in steps of 10 km/h (5 mph) within a
No overtaking at certain times, will be ● In the case of variable messages on over-
range of between 60 km/h (40 mph) and
displayed third ››› Fig. 222 C. 130 km/h (80 mph). If it is adjusted to a
head or gantry signs (LED-based variable traf-
fic signs or other lighting units).
speed greater than that which is permitted in
Speed warning the country in question for driving with a ● If the maps on the navigation system are
If the system detects that the permitted trailer, the system automatically displays the not up-to-date.
speed is exceeded, it may warn the driver usual speed limits, e.g. in Germany 80 km/h ● In the case of adhesives affixed to vehicles
with a “gong” and visually with a message (50 mph). that depict traffic signs, e.g. speed limits on
on the dash panel display. If the speed warning for the trailer is deacti- lorries.
The speed warning can be adjusted or deacti- vated, the system displays the speed limits
vated completely in the infotainment system as if there were no trailer hitched.
230
Driver assistance systems

Fatigue detection (break rec- Note shown for approximately 5 seconds, and de-

Technical data
pending on the case, is repeated. The system
ommendation)* ● Fatigue detection has been developed for
stores the last message displayed.
driving on motorways and well paved roads
only. The message on the instrument panel display
Introduction
● If there is a fault in the system, have it can be switched off by pressing the 
The Fatigue detection informs the driver checked by a specialised workshop. button on the windscreen wiper lever or the
when their driving behaviour shows signs of button  on the multi function steering
fatigue. wheel ›››  page 33.

Advice
Function and operation The message can be recalled to the instru-
WARNING ment panel display using the multifunction
Do not let the comfort afforded by the Fatigue display ›››  page 33.
detection system tempt you into taking any
risks when driving. Take regular breaks, suffi- Conditions of operation
cient in length when making long journeys.

Operation
Driving behaviour is only calculated on
● The driver always assumes the responsibil- speeds above about 65 km/h (40 mph) up to
ity of driving to their full capacity. around 200 km/h (125 mph).
● Never drive if you are tired.
● The system does not detect the tiredness of Switching on and off
the driver in all circumstances. Consult the in- Fatigue detection can be activated or deacti-
formation in the section ››› page 231, System

Emergencies
vated in the Easy Connect system with the
limitations. Fig. 223 On the instrument panel display: fa-
 button and the SETTINGS function button
● In some situations, the system may incor- tigue detection symbol.
››› page 114. A mark indicates that the ad-
rectly interpret an intended driving manoeu- justment has been activated.
vre as driver tiredness. Fatigue detection determines the driving be-
● No warning is given in the event of the ef-
haviour of the driver when starting a journey,
making a calculation of tiredness. This is System limitations
fect called microsleep!
constantly compared with the current driving The Fatigue detection has certain limitations
● Please observe the indications on the in-

Safety
behaviour. If the system detects that the driv- inherent to the system. The following condi-
strument panel and act as is necessary.
er is tired, an audible warning is given with a tions can limit the Fatigue detection or pre-
sound and an optic warning is shown with a vent it from functioning.
symbol and complementary message on the
instrument panel display ››› Fig. 223. The ● At speeds below 65 km/h (40 mph)
message on the instrument panel display is ● At speeds above 200 km/h (125 mph) »
231
Operation

● When cornering General information CAUTION


● On roads in poor condition
Assorted assistance systems – which vary Parking Aid functions may be negatively af-
● In unfavourable weather conditions fected by different factors that may lead to
depending on the equipment fitted in the car
● When a sporty driving style is employed damage to the vehicle or its immediate sur-
– will help you when parking or manoeu-
rounds:
● In the event of a serious distraction to the vring.
● Under certain circumstances, the system
driver The rear parking aid is an audible assistant does not detect or display certain objects:
that warns about obstacles located behind – Objects such as chains, trailer draw bars,
Fatigue detection will be restored when the
the vehicle ››› page 233. fences, posts and thin trees.
vehicle is stopped for more than 15 minutes,
when the ignition is switched off or when the During parking, Parking System Plus assists – Objects that are located above the sen-
driver has unbuckled their seat belt and the driver by visually and audibly warning sors, such as protrusions in a wall.
opened the door. them about obstacles detected in front and – Objects with certain surfaces or struc-
behind the vehicle ››› page 234. tures, such as wire mesh fences or pow-
In the event of slow driving during a long pe-
der snow.
riod of time (below 65 km/h, 40 mph) the
WARNING ● Certain surfaces of objects and garments
system automatically re-establishes the tired-
ness calculation. When driving at a faster ● Always pay attention, also when looking do not reflect the ultrasound sensors' sig-
speed the driving behaviour will be recalcula- straight ahead, to traffic and the vehicle sur- nals. The system cannot detect, at least cor-
roundings. The assistance systems are not a rectly, these objects or people wearing such
ted.
replacement for driver awareness. When in- clothes.
serting or removing the vehicle from a park- ● Ultrasound sensor signals may be affected
ing space, or when performing similar ma- by external sound sources. In certain circum-
Parking aid noeuvres the driver always assumes the re- stances this may prevent them from detect-
sponsibility. ing people or objects.
Related video ● Adapt your speed and driving style at all ● Please note that low obstacles detected by
times to suit visibility, weather, road and traf- the system may no longer be registered by
fic conditions. the sensors as the car moves closer, so the
● The ultrasound sensors have blind spots in system will not give any further warning. In
which obstacles and people are not regis- certain circumstances, objects such as high
tered. Pay special attention to children and kerbs that could damage the bottom of the
animals. vehicle are not detected either.
● Always keep visual control of the vehicle ● If the first warning from the ParkPilot is ig-
Fig. 224 Safety surroundings: use the mirrors for additional nored, the vehicle could suffer considerable
help. damage.

232
Driver assistance systems

● The knocks or damage on the radiator ● In order to familiarise yourself with the sys- The approximate measurement range of the

Technical data
grille, bumper, wheel arch and vehicle under- tem, it is advised that you practice parking in rear sensors is:
body can adjust the orientation of the sen- an area or car park that is free from traffic.
sors. This can affect the parking aid function. There must be good weather and light condi- side area 0.60 m
Have the function checked by a specialised tions.
central area 1.60 m
workshop. ● The volume and tone of the warnings can
be modified, in addition to the indications As you approach the obstacle, the time inter-
Note ››› page 236. val between the audible warnings will be re-
● In vehicles without a driver information duced. When you reach around 0.30 m the

Advice
● In certain situations, the system can give a
warning even though there is no obstacle in system, these parameters can be modified in warning will be constant: Do not continue to
the detected area, e.g: a SEAT Official Service or in a specialised move forward (or backward) ››› in General
workshop. information on page 232, ››› in General in-
– with rough or cobbled floors or ground
● Please observe information on towing a formation on page 232 !
with long grass;
trailer ››› page 237.
– with external ultrasound sources, such as If you maintain separation from the obstacle,

Operation
● The display on the Easy Connect screen
cleaning vehicles or other vehicles; the volume of the warning begins to reduce
shows a slight time delay.
– In downpours, intense snow or dense ex- after four seconds (does not affect the tone
haust gases; of the constant warning).
– if the registration plate (front or rear) is
not properly affixed to the bumper sur- Rear parking aid* Activating/Deactivating
face; When engaging reverse gear, the parking aid

Emergencies
The rear Parking Aid assists the driver in
– or in locations such as the brow of a hill. is automatically switched on. This is con-
parking by means of audible warning
● In order to guarantee good system opera- sounds. firmed with a short warning.
tion, keep the ultrasound sensors clean, free On disengaging reverse gear, the Parking Aid
of snow or ice, and do not cover them with Description system is disconnected immediately.
adhesives or other objects.
● If you use high-pressure or vapour equip-
There are sensors integrated in the rear
ment to clean the ultrasound sensors, apply bumper. When the sensors detect an obsta-

Safety
it directly only very briefly and always from a cle, you are alerted by audible warnings.
distance of more than 10 cm. Make particularly sure that the sensors are
● Retrofitting of accessories to the vehicle, not covered by adhesives, residues and the
such as a bicycle rack, may interfere with the like, as this could affect the system's opera-
operation of the Parking Aid. tion. Cleaning instructions ››› page 254.

233
Operation

Parking system plus* like, as this could affect the system's opera- Parking Aid operation
tion. Cleaning instructions ››› page 254.
The approximate measurement range of the
sensors is:
A 1.20 m
B 0.60 m
C 1.60 m
D 0.60 m

As you approach the obstacle, the time inter-


val between the audible warnings will be re-
Fig. 225 Represented area. Fig. 226 Centre console: parking aid button.
duced. When you reach around 0.30 m the
warning will be constant: do not continue to
Parking system plus assists you audibly and Manual connection of Parking Aid
move forward (or backward)!
visually when parking. ● Press the  button once.
If you maintain separation from the obstacle,
There are sensors integrated in the front and
the volume of the warning begins to reduce
rear bumpers. When they detect an obstacle, Manual disconnection of Parking Aid
after four seconds (does not affect the tone
you are alerted by audible warnings and visu- ● Press the  button again.
of the constant warning).
ally on the Easy Connect system.
In the event of danger of a frontal collision, Manual disconnection of Parking Aid display
the audible warnings come from the front of (the audible sounds remain active)
the vehicle, and in the event of the danger of ● Press a button on the main menu of the fac-
a rear-end collision they come from the rear. tory-assembled infotainment system.
Make particularly sure that the sensors are ● OR: press the BACK function button.
not covered by adhesives, residues and the

234
Driver assistance systems

Automatic connection of Parking Aid ● OR: depending on the equipment, if the ve- Automatic activation

Technical data
● Engage reverse gear or turn the selector hicle rolls back1).
lever to position R. ● OR: press the car icon in reduced view.
● OR: depending on the equipment, if the ve-
hicle rolls back1). If necessary, switch to the rear-assist image
(Rear View Camera “RVC”)
● OR: If the vehicle approaches an obstacle
that is in its forwards path at a speed below ● Engage reverse gear or turn the selector
10 km/h (6 mph) ››› page 235, Automatic ac- lever to position R.

Advice
tivation. The obstacle is detected as of a dis- ● OR: Press the RVC function button.
tance of approx. 95 cm if the automatic con-
nection is activated in the infotainment sys- A short confirmation signal will be heard and
tem. A reduced display is shown. the button symbol will light up yellow when
Fig. 227 Miniature indication of automatic ac-
the system is switched on.
tivation.
Automatic disconnection of Parking Aid

Operation
● Move the selector lever to position P. When the Parking System Plus is switched on
● OR: accelerate to more than approx.
automatically, a miniature of the vehicle will
be displayed and the segments will be
10 km/h (6 mph) forward.
shown on the left side of the screen
››› Fig. 227.
Temporary suppression of sound in Parking

Emergencies
Aid Automatic activation occurs when slowly ap-
● Press the  function button. proaching an obstacle located in front of the
vehicle. It only operates every time the speed
is reduced below approximately 10 km/h (6
Change from reduced view to full view
mph) for the first time. »
● Engage reverse gear or turn the selector
lever to position R.

Safety
1) With certain equipment, the system will be activa-

ted automatically when the vehicle reverses for a cer-


tain distance (about 10 cm if an obstacle is detected
in the rear area and about 20 cm if no obstacle is de-
tected in the rear area).
235
Operation

If the parking aid is switched off using the  CAUTION Yellow segments: obstacles located in the
button, the following actions must be carried vehicle's trajectory and which are more
out in order for it to automatically switch on: The automatic connection of the Parking Aid than 30 cm away from the vehicle are
only works when you are driving slowly. If
displayed in yellow.
● Switch off the ignition and switch it on driving style is not adapted to the circum-
stances, an accident and serious injury or Red segments: obstacles that are less than
again.
damage may be caused. 30 cm away from the vehicle are dis-
● OR: accelerate above 10 km/h (6 mph) be- played in red.
fore reducing speed below this number
again. Moreover, with the SEAT Media System
Segments of the visual indication Plus/Navi System radios, a yellow trail indi-
● OR: place the selector lever in position P
and then move it from this position. cates the vehicle's expected journey based
on the steering wheel angle.
● OR: switch on and off the automatic activa-
tion in the Easy Connect system menu. Whenever the obstacle is located in the vehi-
cle’s direction of travel, the corresponding
The automatic activation with parking aid audible warning will sound.
miniature indication can be switched on and
off from the Easy Connect system menu As the vehicle approaches an obstacle, the
›››  page 30: segments are displayed closer to the vehicle.
When the penultimate segment is displayed,
● Switch the ignition on. this means that the vehicle has reached the
● Select: CAR button > Settings > Parking collision zone. In the collision zone, the ob-
Fig. 228 Parking Aid display on the Easy Con-
and manoeuvring. stacles are represented in red, including
nect system screen.
those out of the path. Do not continue to
● Select the Automatic activation op-
move forward (or backward) ››› in General
tion. When the function button check box is The distance of separation from the obstacle
information on page 232, ››› in General in-
activated , the function is on. can be estimated using the segments around
formation on page 232 !
the vehicle.
If the system has been activated automatical-
ly, an audible sound warning will only be giv- The optical indication of the segments works
en when obstacles in front are at a distance as follows: Adjusting the display and audible
of less than 50 cm. White segments: a white segment is dis- warnings
played when the obstacle is not within
the vehicle's trajectory or the direction The settings for the display and audible
of travel is in the opposite direction to warnings are controlled via the Easy Con-
its location. nect*.
236
Driver assistance systems

Automatic activation ing aid error is displayed on the instrument Parking System Plus

Technical data
 on – activates the Automatic activa- panel, there is a fault in the system. The distance to possible obstacles at the rear
tion option ››› page 235. If the fault doesn't disappear before discon- of the vehicle will not be displayed on the
necting the ignition, next time that parking screen and nor will it be indicated by means
 off – deactivates the Automatic ac-
aid is engaged in reverse, it will not be indi- of audible sound signals.
tivation option ››› page 235.
cated. The Easy Connect system screen will only dis-
Front volume* play objects detected at the front, and the ve-
Parking System Plus* hicle's trajectory will be hidden.
Volume in the front and rear area.

Advice
If there is a fault in the parking aid system a
Front sound settings/sharpness* message will appear on the instrument panel
indicating the error. In addition the  key Braking while manoeuvring function*
Frequency (tone) of the sound in the front LED will blink.
area. 3 Only valid with Parking System Plus
If there is a fault in a sensor, the symbol  is
As soon as an obstacle is detected while re-

Operation
Rear volume* displayed on the Easy Connect display in
front of/behind the vehicle. If a rear sensor is versing, the braking while manoeuvring func-
Volume in the rear area. faulty, only the obstacles in the areas A and tion activates the emergency braking. De-
B are displayed ››› Fig. 225. If a front sensor pending on the equipment, the braking while
Rear sound settings/sharpness* is faulty, only the obstacles in the areas C manoeuvring function can also activate
and D are displayed. emergency braking while moving forwards.
Frequency (tone) of the sound in the rear

Emergencies
area. Have the fault corrected by a specialised The emergency braking function is used to
workshop without delay. minimise collisions. Vehicle speed must not
Adjust volume be higher than 10 km/h.
With the parking aid switched on, the active The braked manoeuvre function is active or
audio/video source volume will be reduced Towing bracket inactive when the parking light is lit or off, re-
to the intensity of the selected setting. spectively. If an emergency braking is activa-
In vehicles equipped with a towing bracket ted, the function will remain inactive until the

Safety
device from the factory, when the trailer is gear is changed.
Error messages connected electrically, the Parking Aid rear
The Parking System’s limitations apply.
sensors will not be activated when reverse
When the Parking Aid is activated or when it gear is engaged, when the selector lever is The braking while manoeuvring function is
is switched on, if a message reporting a Park- turned to position R or when the button  is controlled in the Easy Connect system with »
pressed.
237
Operation

the  button and the SETTINGS and Operating and safety warnings at all times to suit visibility, weather, road
Park and manoeuvre function buttons. and traffic conditions.
WARNING ● Do not be distracted from the traffic by
●  on – permits the use of the braking
while manoeuvring function. ● The Rear Assist does not make it possible looking at the screen.
to precisely calculate the distance from ob- ● The images on the rear assist screen are
●  off – does not permit the use of the
stacles (people, vehicles, etc.) and nor can it only two-dimensional. Due to a lack of spatial
braking while manoeuvring function. overcome the system's own limits, hence us- depth, protruding parts or holes in the road,
ing it may cause serious accidents and inju- for example, are more difficult to detect or
Temporary suppression of emergency brak- ries if used negligently or without due care. may not be seen at all.
ing The driver should be aware of his/her sur- ● Vehicle load modifies the representation of
● When the function is deactivated with the roundings at all times to ensure safe driving. the orientation lines displayed. The width
button that appears
Braking while manoeuvring ● The camera lens expands and distorts the represented by the lines diminishes with ve-
on the Parking System screen of the Easy field of vision and displays the objects on the hicle load. Pay special attention to the vehi-
Connect system. screen in a different, vague manner. The per- cle's surroundings when the inside of the ve-
ception of distances is also distorted by this hicle of the luggage compartment is carrying
● Whenever any of the car doors, rear lid or
effect. a heavy load.
bonnet are opened.
● Due to the screen resolution or insufficient ● In the following situations, the objects or
light conditions, some items may be dis- other vehicles shown in the navigation sys-
played in an unsatisfactory manner or not at tem display appear to be further away or
Rear Assist “Rear View Cam- all. Take special care with thin posts, fences,
railings or trees that might not be displayed
closer than they really are: Pay special atten-
tion:
era”* on screen and could damage the vehicle. – On moving from a horizontal plane to a
● The rear assist has blind spots where it is slope.
Related video not possible to represent people or objects – On moving from a slope to a horizontal
(small children, animals and certain objects plane.
cannot be detected in its field of vision). Mon-
itor the vehicle's surrounding area at all – If the vehicle is heavily loaded at the
times. rear.
● Keep the camera lens clean, free of ice and – When the vehicle approaches objects
snow, and do not cover it. that are not on the ground surface or are
jutting out from it. These objects may al-
● The system is not a replacement for driver
Fig. 229 Safety so be outside the camera's angle of vi-
awareness. Supervise the parking operation sion when reversing.
at all times, as well as the vehicle's surround-
ing area. Adapt your speed and driving style
238
Driver assistance systems

Note Rear assist settings ● If the position and installation angle of the

Technical data
Rear assist offers the user the possibility to camera have been changed, e.g. after a rear-
● It is important to take great care and pay
change the image's brightness, contrast and end collision. Have the system checked by a
special attention if you are not yet familiar
colour settings. specialised workshop.
with the system.
● Rear assist will not be available if the vehi- To change these settings: Familiarising yourself with the system
cle's rear lid is open.
● Park the vehicle in a safe place. To familiarise yourself with the system, the
● Apply the parking brake. orientation lines and their function, SEAT rec-
ommends practising parking and manoeu-

Advice
Instructions for use ● Switch the ignition on. vring with the rear assist in a place without
● If necessary, switch on the Easy Connect too much traffic or in a car park when there
system. are good weather and visibility conditions.
● Engage reverse gear or turn the selector
lever to position R. Cleaning the camera lens

Operation
● Press the  function button displayed on Keep the camera lens clean and clear of snow
the right of the image. and ice:
● Make the desired adjustments on the menu ● Moisten the lens using a normal alcohol-
by pressing the –/+ function buttons or by based glass cleaning product and clean the
moving the corresponding scroll button. lens with a dry cloth.

Emergencies
● Remove snow using a small brush.
Fig. 230 On the rear bumper: location of the Necessary conditions for parking and ma-
rear assist camera. noeuvring with the rear assist ● Use de-icing spray to remove any ice.

A camera on the rear bumper aids the driver The system should not be used in the follow- CAUTION
during reverse parking or manoeuvring ing cases:
● Never use abrasive cleaning products to
››› Fig. 230. The camera image is viewed to- ● If the image displayed is not very reliable or clean the camera lens.
gether with orientation lines projected by the is distorted, for example low visibility or dirty ● Do not use hot or warm water to remove ice

Safety
system on the Easy Connect system screen. lens. or snow from the camera lens. Doing so could
The bottom of the screen displays part of the damage the camera.
● If the area behind the vehicle is not dis-
bumper corresponding to the number plate
area that will be used as reference by the played very clearly or is incomplete.
driver. ● If the vehicle is heavily loaded at the rear.

239
Operation

Parking and manoeuvring with the ● The camera will stop transmitting images Meaning of the orientation lines
rear assist above the speed of 15 km/h (9 mph) with re- ››› Fig. 231
verse engaged.
1 Side lines: extension of the vehicle (the
In combination with the Parking System Plus approximate width of the vehicle plus the
››› page 232, the camera image will cease to rear view mirrors) on the road surface.
be transmitted immediately when reverse 2 End of the side lines: the area marked in
gear is disengaged or when the selector lever green ends approximately 2 m behind
is moved from the R position, and the optical the vehicle on the road surface.
information provided by the Parking Aid sys-
3 Intermediate line: indicates a distance of
tem will be displayed.
approximately 1 m behind the vehicle on
Also in combination with the system, the rear the road surface.
assist image can also be concealed: 4 Red horizontal line: indicates a safe dis-
Fig. 231 Display on the Easy Connect system ● By pressing one of the Infotainment system tance of approximately 40 cm at the rear
screen: orientation lines. of the vehicle on the road surface.
buttons on the display.
Switching the system on and off ● OR: By pressing the miniature vehicle that
Parking manoeuvre
appears on the left of the screen (which
● The rear assist will switch on when the igni- ● Place the vehicle in front of the parking
switches to the full-screen mode of the Park-
tion is on or the engine running, on engaging space and engage reverse gear (manual
ing System Plus's optical system).
reverse gear (manual gearbox) or on chang- gearbox) or move the selector to the R posi-
ing the selector lever to the R position (auto- If you wish to display the rear assist image tion (automatic gearbox).
matic gearbox). again: ● Reverse slowly, and turn the steering wheel
● The system switches off 8 seconds after so that the side orientation lines lead to-
● Disengage reverse, or change the selector
disengaging reverse gear (manual gearbox) wards the parking space.
or removing the selector lever from the R po- lever's position, engage reverse again or
move the selector lever to position R. ● Guide the vehicle into the parking space so
sition (automatic gearbox). The system will
● OR: Press the RVC function button1) that the side orientation lines run parallel to
also disconnect immediately after the igni-
it.
tion is switched off.

1) WARNING: the RVC function button will only be ac-


tivated and available when the reverse gear is en-
gaged or the selector lever is set to position R.
240
Towing bracket device

Towing bracket device CAUTION Depending on the country or version, the

Technical data
towing bracket device's detachable ball joint
Handle the detachable ball joint with care in is located:
Towing bracket device* order to avoid damaging the bumper paint-
work. ● underneath the floor panel of the luggage
Introduction compartment.
Note ● or else on the surface of the floor panel of
The towing bracket device fitted to your vehi- Towing the vehicle with the detachable ball the luggage compartment in a bag secured
cle, be it factory-fitted or a genuine SEAT ac- joint ››› page 95. to the fastening rings.

Advice
cessory, meets all the national technical and
legal requirements for towing. The ball joint is fitted and removed by hand.
Your vehicle is fitted with a 13-pin connector Description The towing device bracket is supplied with a
for the electrical connection between the key.
trailer and the vehicle. If the trailer is equip-
Key to ››› Fig. 232

Operation
ped with a 7-pin connector you can use the
corresponding adaptor, which is available as 1 13-pin connector
a genuine SEAT accessory. 2 Safety lug
The maximum authorised towing load is 3 Hook housing
80 kg. 4 Hook housing cap

Emergencies
WARNING
5 Ball protective cover
6 Detachable ball
● Before each journey, make sure that the de-
tachable ball joint is properly fitted and se- 7 Locking lever
cured in its housing. 8 Lock cover
● If the detachable ball joint is not properly 9 Release bolt
fitted and secured, do not use it.
10 Lock
● Do not use the towing bracket device for

Safety
towing if it is damaged or has missing parts. 11 Locking balls
● Do not modify or adapt the towing device 12 Key »
connection.
● Never unhook the detachable ball joint
when the trailer is hitched. Fig. 232 Towing bracket device support / de-
tachable ball joint / key.
241
Operation

Note Before assembling it, place the detachable Standby position


ball in the standby position with the follow-
Contact an Authorised Service Partner if you ing two steps.
lose your key.
Step 1.
● Turn the key in the direction of arrow 1 un-
Placing in standby position
til the part of the key with the holes reaches
the top position ››› Fig. 233.

Step 2.
● Grip the detachable ball below the protec-
tive cover.
● Press the release bolt B in the direction of
arrow 2 , and at the same time press lever
C in the direction of arrow 3 as far as it will
go ››› Fig. 234.

Fig. 233 Step 1. The lever will remain blocked in this position.

Fig. 235 Standby position: Position of the lev-


er and the release bolt.

Standby position adjusted properly


● Key A ››› Fig. 235 is in the released posi-
tion (the part of the key with the holes is fac-
ing upwards).
● Lever B ››› Fig. 235 is in the bottom posi-
tion.
Fig. 234 Step 2. ● The release bolt C ››› Fig. 235 can be
moved.

242
Towing bracket device

Thus adjusted, the detachable ball is ready ing following the direction of arrow 1 until it Assembling the detachable ball - Step

Technical data
for installation. engages audibly ››› . 2
CAUTION Lever A turns automatically in the direction
of arrow 2 upwards, and the release bolt B
The key cannot be removed or turned in the moves outwards (the red and green part will
standby position.
be visible) ››› .
If lever A does not turn automatically or the
release bolt B does not come out, the de-

Advice
Assembling the detachable ball - Step
tachable ball should be removed by turning
1 the lever as far as possible downwards from
the housing cavity, and the detachable ball's
support surfaces and the cavity should then
be cleaned. Fig. 237 Locking the lock.

Operation
WARNING
● When attaching the detachable ball, keep
your hands well away from the reach of the
lever's rotation. There is a risk of injuring
your fingers!

Emergencies
● Never try to pull the lever upwards by force
to turn the key. The detachable ball would not
Fig. 236 Fitting the detachable ball / Release be secured properly!
bolt in the deployed position.

Fitting the detachable ball


● Remove the hook housing cap 4 Fig. 238 Placing the cover over the lock.
››› Fig. 232 downwards.
Do not omit this first step ››› page 243, As-

Safety
● Set the detachable ball to its standby posi- sembling the detachable ball - Step 1!
tion ››› page 242.
● Grip the detachable ball from below ● Turn key A in the direction of arrow 1 un-
››› Fig. 236 and insert it into the hook hous- til the part of the key with the holes reaches
the bottom position ››› Fig. 237. »
243
Operation

● Remove the key in the direction of arrow Checking proper attachment Removing the detachable ball - Step 1
2 .
● Place cover B in the lock in the direction
of arrow 3 ››› Fig. 238 ››› .
● Check that the detachable ball is secure
››› page 244.
CAUTION
● After removing the key, always place the
cover over the lever's lock. If the lock be-
comes soiled it will be impossible to insert
the key.
Fig. 239 Detachable ball properly attached. Fig. 240 Removing the lock cover.
● Keep the towing bracket device's housing
cavity clean at all times. Dirtiness can pre-
Whenever you go to use the detachable ball,
vent the detachable ball from being properly
make sure that it is properly attached first.
secured!
● If the detachable ball is removed, always
Detachable ball properly attached.
place the cap on the hook's housing.
● The detachable ball will not fall out of the
housing cavity after a major “knock or jerk”.
● Lever A ››› Fig. 239 is fully raised.
● The release bolt B ››› Fig. 239 is sticking
fully out (the red and green part is visible).
● The key has been removed. Fig. 241 Releasing the lock.
● Cover C ››› Fig. 239 is placed over the lock.
● Remove cover A from the lock in the direc-
WARNING tion of arrow 1 ››› Fig. 240.
● Insert key B into the lock in the direction
The towing bracket device should only be
used if the detachable ball has been properly of arrow 2 ››› Fig. 241.
locked! ● Turn the key in the direction of arrow 3 un-
til the part of the key with the holes is facing
upwards.
244
Towing bracket device

WARNING time press lever B in the direction of arrow ● When operating the lever, do not apply too

Technical data
2 as far as it will go. much pressure (for example, do not stand on
Never remove the detachable ball joint when
it)!
the trailer is hitched. In this position, the detachable ball is loose
and will fall/drop freely downwards. If this
does not occur when you release it, press it Note
Note
with the other hand from above. Remove any dirt from the detachable ball be-
Before you remove the detachable ball, you
fore you put it away with the vehicle tools.
are advised to place the protective cover on The detachable ball locks into the standby
the ball coupling. position at the same time and is therefore

Advice
ready to be reinserted into the hook housing
››› . Operation and care
Removing the detachable ball - Step 2 ● Fit the cap 4 ››› Fig. 232 onto its housing. Put the cover on the housing cavity so that
dirt cannot get in.
WARNING

Operation
Before hooking up a trailer, always check the
Never leave the detachable ball loose in the ball coupling and apply suitable grease if
luggage compartment. It could cause damage necessary.
in the luggage compartment in the case of
abrupt braking, and even jeopardise passen- Use the protective cover when putting the de-
ger safety! tachable ball away to keep the luggage com-
partment clean.

Emergencies
CAUTION Remove any dirt from the housing cavity sur-
● If you hold the lever and do not press down faces and use a suitable cleaning product.
Fig. 242 Releasing the detachable ball. on it as far as you can, after you remove the
detachable ball, the latter will continue up- CAUTION
Do not omit this first step ››› page 244, Re- wards and will not lock into the standby posi- The top part of the hook housing is greased.
moving the detachable ball - Step 1! tion. The detachable ball should be placed in Make sure that the grease has not been re-
this position before the next assembly. moved.

Safety
Releasing the detachable ball ● Keep the detachable ball in the standby po-
sition, with the key inserted into the box
● Grip the detachable ball from below. while you place it facing downwards with the
● Press the release bolt A in the direction of side opposite to the one where the key is in-
arrow 1 as far as it will go, and at the same serted. The key could get damaged!

245
Operation

Trailer towing duced by 10% for every further 1000 m (or Exterior mirrors
part thereof). The gross combination weight Check whether you can see enough of the
is the actual weight of the laden vehicle plus
What do you need to bear in mind road behind the trailer with the standard rear
the actual weight of the laden trailer. When vision mirrors. If this is not the case, you
when towing a trailer? possible, operate the trailer with the maxi- should have additional exterior mirrors fitted.
mum permitted drawbar load on the ball joint Both exterior mirrors should be mounted on
Your vehicle may be used to tow a trailer
of the towing bracket, but do not exceed the hinged extension brackets. Adjust the mirrors
when fitted with the correct equipment.
specified limit. to give sufficient vision to the rear.
If you wish to retrofit a towing bracket, con-
The figures for trailer weights and drawbar
sult ››› page 249.
loads that are given on the data plate of the Tow rope
towing bracket are for certification purposes Always use a cable between the vehicle and
Connectors
only. The correct figures for your specific the trailer ››› page 247.
Your vehicle is fitted with a 13-pin connector model, which may be lower than these fig-
for the electrical connection between the ures for the towing bracket, are given in the Trailer rear lights
trailer and the vehicle. vehicle documentation or in ››› chapter Tech-
nical Data. The trailer's rear lights should comply with
If the trailer has a 7-pin plug you will need to the statutory safety regulations ››› page 247.
use an adapter cable. It is available at any
Technical Service. Distributing the load
WARNING
Distribute loads in the trailer so that heavy
Trailer weight/drawbar load objects are as near to the axle as possible. Never transport people in a trailer. This could
result in fatal accidents.
Never exceed the authorised trailer weight. If Loads carried in the trailer must be secured
you do not load the trailer up to the maxi- to prevent them moving.
Note
mum permitted trailer weight, you can then
climb correspondingly steeper slopes. Tyre pressure ● Towing a trailer places additional demands
Set tyre pressure to the maximum permissi- on the vehicle. We recommend additional
The maximum trailer weights listed are only services between the normal inspection inter-
ble pressure shown on the sticker on the in-
applicable for altitudes up to 1000 m above vals if the vehicle is used frequently for tow-
side of the fuel tank flap. Set the tyre pres-
sea level. With increasing altitude the engine ing a trailer.
sure of the trailer tyres in accordance with the
power and therefore the vehicle climbing ● Find out whether special regulations apply
trailer manufacturer's recommendations.
ability are impaired because of the reduced to towing a trailer in your country.
air density. The maximum trailer weight has
to be reduced accordingly. The weight of the
vehicle and trailer combination must be re-
246
Towing bracket device

Hitching and connecting the trailer Key of the Schematic diagram ››› Fig. 243: Trailer maximum electricity consumption

Technical data
Pin Meaning Brake lights (total) 84 Watts

Turn signal, on each side 42 Watts


12 Unassigned
Side lights (total) 100 Watts
13 Earth, pin 9
Rear lights (total) 42 Watts
Electrical socket for trailer
Rear fog light 42 Watts

Advice
The vehicle is fitted with a 13-pole power
socket for the electrical connection between Never exceed the values indicated!
the trailer and the vehicle. If the system de-
Fig. 243 Schematic diagram: assignment of tects that a trailer has been connected elec- Note
the pins of the trailer's electrical socket. trically, the electrical equipment on the trailer ● If the rear lights of the trailer are not cor-
will receive voltage through this connection. rectly connected, the vehicle electronics may

Operation
Key of the Schematic diagram ››› Fig. 243: Pin 9 has a permanent live. This powers, for be damaged.
example, the trailer's interior lighting. Pin 10 ● If the trailer absorbs excessive electric cur-
Pin Meaning
is only powered when the engine is running. rent, the vehicle electronics may be dam-
1 Left turn signal The charge wire (pin 10) charges, for exam- aged.
ple, a caravan battery. ● Never connect the trailer's electric system
2 Rear fog light
directly to the electrical connections of the

Emergencies
Pin 9 and 10 should not be connected to tail lights or any other power sources. Only
3 Earth, pins 1, 2, 4 to 8
each other to avoid discharging or damaging use the connections intended for providing
4 Right turn signal the vehicle's battery. electric current to the trailer.
5 Rear light, right The earth wires, pin 3, pin 11 and pin 13,
should never be connected to each other to
6 Brake lights
avoid overloading the electrical system. Ball coupling of towing bracket de-
7 Rear light, left If the trailer has a 7-contact connector, you vice*

Safety
8 Reverse lights will need to use an adapter cable. In this case
the function corresponding to pin 10 will not The ball coupling is provided with instruc-
9 Permanent live be available. tions on fitting and removing the ball cou-
pling of the towing bracket. »
10 Cable without positive charge

11 Earth, pin 10
247
Operation

WARNING Before driving WARNING


The towing bracket ball coupling must be ● Grip the 13-pin connector at area A and ● Never use the safety lug to tow!
stored securely in the luggage compartment remove it in the direction of the arrow
● Adjust your speed to suit the road and traf-
to prevent them being flung through the vehi- ››› Fig. 244. fic conditions.
cle and causing injury. ● Remove the protective cover 5 ››› Fig. 232 ● All work on the electrical system must be
upwards. carried out only by specialised workshops.
Note ● Never connect the trailer's electric system
● By law, the ball coupling must be removed
After driving to the electrical connections of the rear lights
if a trailer is not being towed if it obscures ● Grip the 13-pin connector at area A and or any other power sources.
the number plate. insert it in the opposite direction to the arrow ● After hooking up the trailer and connecting
››› Fig. 244. the socket, check that all the trailer's rear
● Fit the protective cover 5 ››› Fig. 232 on lights are working properly.
Driving with a trailer the ball coupling.
Note
Safety lug ● If there is any fault in the trailer's lighting,
The safety lug B ››› Fig. 244 is used to hook check the fuses in the instrument panel fuse
up the trailer's retainer cable. box ›››  page 58.
● The contact between the retainer cable and
On hooking it up to the safety lug, the retain-
the safety lug may give rise to mechanical
er cable should have slack in all the trailer
wear in the lug's surface protection. This
positions with respect to the vehicle (sharp
wear will not prevent the safety lug from op-
bends, reverse gear, etc.). erating properly or cause any fault and is ex-
cluded from the warranty.
Headlights ● When connecting and disconnecting the
Fig. 244 Turn the 13-pin connector. The front part of the vehicle may be raised trailer, the towing vehicle's handbrake
when the trailer is connected and the light should be applied.
may dazzle the rest of the traffic. ● When the tow hitch ball has not been fitted,
Adapt the height of the headlights using the the socket should remain concealed in its
housing on the bumper.
headlight range rotary adjuster1).

1) This does not apply for vehicles with bi-xenon

headlights.
248
Towing bracket device

Anti-theft alarm system Weight distribution Electronic stability control*

Technical data
The weight distribution of a loaded trailer The ESC* system helps to stabilise the trailer
When the vehicle is locked, the alarm is trig- with an unladen vehicle is very unfavourable. in case of skidding or rocking.
gered when the electrical connection be- However, if this cannot be avoided, drive ex-
tween vehicle and trailer is interrupted. tra slowly to allow for the unbalanced weight
Always turn off the anti-theft alarm system distribution. Retrofitting a towing bracket*
before connecting or disconnecting a trailer
››› page 128. Speed

Advice
The stability of the vehicle and trailer is re-
Conditions for the integration of a trailer in duced with increasing speed. For this reason,
the anti-theft alarm system. it is advisable not to drive at the maximum
● The vehicle is factory-equipped with an an- permissible speed in an unfavourable road,
ti-theft alarm system and a towing bracket weather or wind conditions. This applies es-
device. pecially when driving downhill.

Operation
● The trailer is connected electrically to the You should always reduce speed immediately
towing vehicle by the trailer connector. if the trailer shows the slightest sign of snak-
● The electrical system of the vehicle and the ing. Never try to stop the “snaking” by in-
trailer are prepared for operation. creasing speed.
● The vehicle is locked with the ignition key Always brake in due course. If the trailer has

Emergencies
and the anti-theft alarm system is activated. an overrun brake, apply the brakes gently at
first and then, firmly. This will prevent the
CAUTION jerking that can be caused by locking of trail-
For technical reasons, trailers fitted with rear
er wheels. Select a low gear in due course
LED lights are not integrated in the anti-theft before going down a steep downhill. This en-
alarm system. ables you to use the engine braking to slow
down the vehicle.

Safety
Reheating
Driving tips
At very high temperatures and during pro-
Driving with a trailer always requires extra longed slopes, driving in a low gear and high
care. engine speed, always monitor the coolant Fig. 245 Attachment points for towing brack-
temperature gauge ››› page 113. et. »
249
Operation

If a towing bracket is to be fitted after the ve- ● The legal requirements in your country your SEAT dealer in case additional modifica-
hicle is purchased, this must be completed must be observed (e.g. the fitting of a sepa- tions to your vehicle are necessary.
according to the instructions of the towing rate control lamp). ● Due to the specific design of the exhaust,
bracket manufacturer. ● Certain vehicle components, e.g. the rear the fitting of a conventional towing hook is
The attachment points for the towing bracket bumper, must be removed and reinstalled. not recommended for some sportier versions.
A are on the lower part of the vehicle. The towing bracket securing bolts must be Please consult your Technical Service.
tightened using a torque wrench, and a pow-
The distance between the centre of the ball er socket must be connected to the vehicle
coupling and the ground should never be electrical system. This requires specialised
lower than the indicated value, even with a knowledge and tools.
fully loaded vehicle and including the maxi-
● Figures in the illustration show the eleva-
mum drawbar load.
tion value and the attachment points which
Elevation values for securing the towing must be considered if you are retrofitting a
bracket: towing bracket.

B 65 mm (minimum) WARNING
C 350 mm to 420 mm (fully laden vehicle) The towing brackets should be fitted at a spe-
cialised workshop.
D 1040 mm
● If the towing bracket is incorrectly instal-
E 317 mm led, there is a serious danger of accident.
● For your own safety, please observe the tow
LEON/LEON SC LEON ST
F bracket manufacturer's instructions.
319 mm 596 mm
CAUTION
Fitting a towing bracket
● If the power socket is incorrectly installed,
● Driving with a trailer involves an extra effort this could cause damage to the vehicle elec-
for the vehicle. Therefore, before fitting a trical system.
towing bracket, please contact a Technical
Service to check whether your cooling system Note
needs modification.
● SEAT recommends that the towing hooks
be fitted at a specialised workshop. Consult

250
Care and maintenance

Advice Any retro-fitted equipment which has a direct wear of components, and also invalidate your

Technical data
effect on the vehicle and/or the way it is driv- vehicle registration documents.
en, such as a cruise control system or elec-
You will appreciate that your SEAT dealership
Care and maintenance tronically-controlled suspension, must be
cannot be held liable for any damage caused
approved for use in your vehicle and bear the
by modifications and/or work performed in-
e mark (the European Union's authorisation
Accessories and modifications symbol).
correctly.
to the vehicle If any additional electrical devices are fitted
We therefore recommend that all work should
be performed by a SEAT Official Service using

Advice
which do not serve to control the vehicle it-
Accessories, replacement parts and genuine SEAT parts®.
self (for instance a refrigerator box, laptop or
repair work ventilator fan, etc.), they must bear the 
WARNING
sign (manufacturer conformity declaration in
Always ask your dealer or specialist retailer the European Union). Incorrectly performed modifications or other
for advice before purchasing accessories and work on your vehicle can lead to malfunctions
replacement parts. and cause accidents.

Operation
WARNING
Your vehicle is designed to offer a high Accessories, for example telephone holders
standard of active and passive safety. For this or cup holders, should never be fitted on the
reason, we recommend that you ask a SEAT covers, or within the working range of the air- Radio transmitters and office equip-
Official Service for advice before fitting ac- bags. Otherwise, there is a danger of injury if ment
cessories or replacement parts. Your SEAT Of- the airbag is triggered in an accident.

Emergencies
ficial Service has the latest information from Radio transmitters (fixed installation)
the manufacturer and can recommend acces- Any retrofit installations of radio transmitters
sories and replacement parts which are suita- Modifications in the vehicle require prior approval. SEAT
ble for your requirements. They can also an- generally authorises in-vehicle installations
swer any questions you might have regarding Modifications must always be carried out ac- of approved types of radio transmitters provi-
official regulations. cording to our specifications. ded that:
We recommend you to use only SEAT acces- Unauthorised modifications to the electronic ● The aerial is installed correctly.

Safety
sories and Genuine SEAT parts®. SEAT has components, software, wiring or data transfer
tested these parts and accessories for suita- ● The aerial is installed on the exterior of the
in the vehicle may cause malfunctioning. Due
bility, reliability and safety. SEAT Official to the way the electronic components are vehicle (and shielded cables are used togeth-
Services have the necessary experience and linked together in networks, other indirect er with non-reflective aerial trimming).
facilities to ensure that the parts are installed systems may be affected by the faults. This ● The effective transmitting power does not
correctly and professionally. can seriously impair safety, lead to excessive exceed 10 Watts at the aerial base. »
251
Advice

A SEAT Official Service and specialised work- WARNING WARNING


shop will be able to inform you about options
for installing and operating radio transmitters Mobile telephones or radio equipment which ● Cleaning products and other materials used
is operated inside the vehicle without a prop- for car care can be damaging to your health if
with a higher transmitting power.
erly installed external aerial can create exces- misused.
sive magnetic fields that could cause a health ● Always keep care products in a safe place,
Mobile radio transmitters hazard. out of the reach of children. Failure to comply
Commercial mobile telephones or radio could result in poisoning.
equipment might interfere with the electron- Note
ics of your vehicle and cause malfunctions.
● The posterior fitting of electric and elec- For the sake of the environment
This may be due to:
tronic equipment in this vehicle affects its li- ● If possible, use environmentally friendly
● No external aerial. cence and could lead to the withdrawal of the products.
vehicle registration document under certain
● External aerial incorrectly installed. ● The remains of car care products should not
circumstances.
● Transmitting power more than 10 W. be disposed of with ordinary household
● Please use the mobile telephone/radio op-
waste.
erating instructions.
You must, therefore, do not operate portable
mobile telephones or radio equipment inside
the vehicle without a properly installed exter-
nal aerial ››› . Vehicle exterior care
Care and cleaning
Please note also that the maximum range of Washing the vehicle
the equipment can only be achieved with an General information
external aerial. The longer substances such as insects, bird
Regular and careful care helps to maintain droppings, resinous tree sap, road dirt, in-
Business equipment the value of the vehicle. This may also be one dustrial deposits, tar, soot or road salt and
of the requirements for upholding any war- other aggressive materials remain on the ve-
Retrofit installation of business or private
ranty claims in the event of corrosion or paint hicle, the more damage they do to the paint-
equipment in the vehicle is permitted, provi-
defects. work. High temperatures (for instance due to
ded the equipment cannot interfere with the
driver's immediate control of the vehicle and SEAT Official Services and specialist retailers strong sunlight) further intensify the corro-
that any such equipment carries the  mark. carry stocks of suitable car care materials. sive effect.
Any retrofit equipment that could influence Please follow the instructions for use on the After the period when salt is put on the roads
the driver's control of the vehicle must have a packaging. it is important to have the underside of the
type approval for your vehicle and must carry vehicle washed thoroughly.
the e mark.
252
Care and maintenance

Automatic car washes ● Do not use scrapers to remove ice or snow ● When washing the car during the winter

Technical data
Before going through a car wash, be sure to from the sheets. season: water and ice in the brake system
take the usual precautions such as closing ● Do not polish the adhesive sheets. can reduce braking effectiveness: risk of acci-
the windows and roof. If the vehicle has spe- dent!
● Do not use dirty cloths or sponges.
cial accessories such as spoilers or a roof
● It is preferable to wash them with a soft
rack or two-way radio aerial, etc., it is advisa- CAUTION
sponge and gentle neutral soap.
ble to consult the car wash tunnel operator. ● Do not wash the vehicle in direct sunlight –
It is best to use a car wash without revolving Washing the car by hand otherwise the paint can be damaged.

Advice
bristles if possible. ● Do not use sponges, abrasive household
When washing the car by hand, use plenty of
sponges or similar to clean insect remains.
water to soften the dirt first, and rinse off as
Washing the vehicle with a high pressure This could damage the surface.
well as possible.
cleaner ● Clean off stubborn dirt (insects, etc.) from
Then clean the vehicle with a soft sponge, the headlights at regular intervals, for in-
When washing the vehicle with a high-pres-
glove or brush using only slight pressure. stance when filling the fuel tank. The head-
sure cleaner, always follow the operating in-

Operation
You should start on the roof and work down. lights should only be washed with water, do
structions for the equipment. This applies
Special car soap should only be used for very not wipe them with a dry cloth or sponge. It
particularly to the operating pressure and the is best to use soapy water.
persistent dirt.
spraying distance. Do not hold the nozzle too
● Never wash tyres with a jet that sprays the
close to soft materials such as rubber hoses Rinse the sponge or glove thoroughly and of-
water out in a direct stream. This could dam-
or seals. The same applies to the parking aid ten.
age the tyres even if the spray is kept at a
sensors*, which are located in the rear bump-

Emergencies
Wheels, sills and similar should be cleaned distance and only used for a very short time.
er.
last. Use a second sponge for this. ● Before washing the vehicle in an automatic
Do not use a nozzle that sprays the water out car wash, please make sure to retract the ex-
in a direct stream or one that has a rotating WARNING terior mirrors to prevent them from being
jet for forcing off dirt. ● The vehicle should only be washed with the damaged. Electrically retractable exterior
mirrors must not be folded in or out by hand,
ignition switched off. Failure to follow this in-
Factory-fitted adhesive sheets always use the electrical power control.
struction could result in an accident.

Safety
The following indications should be taken in- ● Do not clean the underside of chassis, the
to account to avoid damaging adhesive inside of wheel arches or wheel trims without CAUTION
sheets: protecting your hands and arms. You may cut ● Before washing the vehicle in an automatic
yourself on sharp-edged metal parts. Other- car wash, please proceed as follows to lock
● Do not use high pressure cleaners. wise, there is a risk of sustaining cuts. the wiper arms so that they are not moved to-
wards the top of the windscreen: »
253
Advice

– the bonnet must be closed. – Stay a suitable distance from the sensors If the polish does not contain wax, a wax
on the front and rear bumpers. product should be applied after polishing.
– switch the ignition on and off.
– press the windscreen wiper lever forward – Do not clean the camera lenses or sur-
rounding area with the pressure washer. CAUTION
briefly (windscreen washer function).
This will lock the wiper arms. ● Never use warm or hot water to remove ● Do not use polishes and hard wax on pain-
snow and ice from the reverse camera lens, ted parts with a matt finish or on plastic
as it could crack the lens. parts.
For the sake of the environment
● Never use abrasive cleaning agents on the ● Do not apply paint polishes to the side trim
The car should only be washed in special lens. that runs around the panoramic roof and ends
wash bays. These areas are prepared to pre- on the windscreen. However, it can be treated
vent oily water from getting into the public with hard wax.
drains. In some places, washing vehicles out-
side the areas intended for this purpose is Waxing and polishing
prohibited.
Care Trims
Waxing protects the paintwork. It is time to In respect for the environment, the silver-
Camera sensors and lenses apply a coat of good wax when water no lon- plated trims on the body are made of pure
ger forms droplets and rolls off the clean aluminium (they do not contain chrome).
● Use a small brush to remove snow and a paintwork.
de-icer spray to remove ice. Dirt or marks on the trim mouldings should
Even if a wax solution is used regularly in the be removed with a cleaning product with a
● Clean the sensors with a solvent-free prod- vehicle washing tunnel, it is advisable to pro- neutral PH (do not use a chrome cleaner).
uct and a soft, dry cloth. tect the paint with a hard wax coating at least Body polish is also unsuitable for use on trim
● Moisten the camera lens using a standard twice a year. mouldings. The intensive cleaning fluids of-
alcohol-based glass cleaning agent and In the summer, you will find it is much easier ten used before the car goes into a car wash
clean the lens with a dry cloth. In the active to remove dead insects (which accumulate may contain alkaline substances, which can
lane assist*, the area in front of the lens is on the bumper and the front of the bonnet) if cause dull or milky patches when they dry
normally cleaned with the windscreen wash- the car has been treated with care products out.
er. recently. SEAT Official Services carry stocks of cleaning
CAUTION products which have been tested for use on
Polishing your vehicle and are not harmful to the envi-
● When you clean the vehicle with a pressure ronment.
Polishing is only necessary if the paint has
washer:
lost its shine, and the gloss cannot be
brought back by putting on wax.
254
Care and maintenance

Plastic parts Windows avoid scratches caused by dirt on the glass,

Technical data
the scraper should only be pushed in one di-
Plastic parts are cleaned with a power wash- Clear vision is an essential safety factor. rection and not moved to and fro.
er. If this is not sufficient, plastic parts ● The heating element for the rear window is
The windscreen must not be cleaned with in-
should only be treated with a special solvent- located on the inner side of the window. To
sect remover or wax, otherwise the wind-
free plastic cleaning agent. Do not use paint- avoid damaging them, do not apply stickers
screen wipers will not function properly (jud-
work cleaners, polishes or wax on plastic to these heating elements.
dering).
parts. ● Never use warm or hot water to remove
Traces of rubber, oil, grease or silicone can snow and ice from windows and mirrors. This

Advice
be removed with a window cleaning solution could cause the glass to crack!
Carbon parts or a silicone remover. Wax residue can only
be removed with a special cleaner. Your SEAT
The carbon parts on your vehicle have a pain- Official Service will be able to provide you
with more detailed information. Wheels
ted surface. They do not need any special
care and are cleaned just like any other pain-

Operation
The windows should also be cleaned on the The wheels require regular attention to pre-
ted part ››› page 252. inside at regular intervals. serve their appearance. It is important to re-
Use a separate cloth or chamois to dry the move road salt and brake dust by washing
windows. Cloths used for waxing and polish- the wheels at regular intervals, otherwise the
Paint damage finish will be impaired.
ing contain residues that will cause smears
Minor damage to the paint, such as scratches on the glass. After washing, the wheels should only be

Emergencies
or stone chips, should be touched up without cleaned with an "acid-free" cleaning agent
delay before the metal starts to corrode. Suit- WARNING for alloy wheels. This is available from SEAT
able touch-up brushes or sprays for your car Do not use water-repellent coatings on the Official Services and specialist retailers. Nev-
can be obtained from a SEAT Official Service. windscreen. In bad visibility conditions (e.g. er leave the cleaning agent on the rims for
in the rain, dark or with a low sun), these any longer than specified in the instructions
The number of the original paint finish on the coatings may cause dazzle: risk of accident! before rinsing it off. If the wheel cleaner fluid
vehicle is given on the data sticker Such coatings can also cause the windscreen contains acid it can attack the surfaces of the
››› page 287. wiper blades to make noise.

Safety
wheel bolts.
If corrosion is already visible it must be thor- Car polish or other abrasive agents should
oughly removed by a specialised workshop. CAUTION not be used for maintaining the rims. If the
● Remove snow and ice from windows and ex- protective coating is damaged, e.g. by flying
terior mirrors with a plastic scraper only. To stones, the damaged area should be re-
paired immediately. »
255
Advice

WARNING The Easy Connect control panel* should first Normal cleaning
be cleaned with a brush so that no dirt goes We recommend that you use a soft sponge or
Please note when cleaning the wheels that into the device or between the keys and
water, ice and road salt can impair the effec- a commercially available lint-free, micro-fibre
housing. Next, we recommend cleaning the cloth for normal cleaning. Only use brushes
tiveness of the brakes; this can cause an acci-
Easy Connect control panel* using a cloth on floor coverings and mats, as other textile
dent.
dampened with water and washing-up liquid. surfaces could become damaged.
CAUTION In the case of normal surface dirt you can use
Exhaust tail pipe a foam cleaner. Use a sponge to spread the
● To avoid scratching the screen, do not wipe
foam on the textile surface and to work it into
the display with a dry cloth.
It is important to remove road salt and brake the material lightly. However, make sure that
dust by washing the wheels at regular inter- ● To avoid damage, ensure that no liquid
the textile material does not become soaking
vals, otherwise the exhaust tail pipe material goes into the Easy Connect control panel*.
wet. Then dab off the foam with a dry and ab-
could be damaged. To remove impurities, do sorbent cloth (e.g. a micro-fibre cloth) and
not use rim, paint or chrome cleaners or oth- vacuum off any residue once the surface is
er abrasive products. Clean the exhaust tail Plastic and leatherette parts completely dry.
pipes with cleaning products that are suita-
ble for stainless steel. Plastic parts and leatherette can be cleaned Cleaning stains
with a damp cloth. If this is not sufficient,
SEAT Official Services carry stocks of cleaning Treat drink stains (such as coffee or fruit
plastic parts and leatherette should only be
products that have been tested and ap- juice, etc.) with a cleaning solution for deli-
treated with a special solvent-free plastic
proved for use on your vehicle. cate fabrics. This solution should be applied
cleaner.
with a sponge. If the stains are difficult to re-
move, a washing paste can be applied direct-
ly onto the stain and worked into the fabric.
Caring for the vehicle interior Textile covers and trim parts The surface will then have to be wiped with
clear water to remove any residue left by the
Radio display/Easy Connect* and con- Textile covers and trim parts (e.g. seats, door
paste. To do so, use a damp cloth or sponge
trol panel* trim) should be cleaned regularly with a vac-
and then dab the stain with an absorbent
uum cleaner. This will remove surface dirt
cloth.
The display can be cleaned with a soft cloth which could otherwise be rubbed into the
and a professionally available “LCD cleaner”. textile material during use. Do not use steam Remove chocolate or make-up stains with a
Moisten the cloth with a small amount of the cleaners, as the steam could carry the dirt cleaning paste (for e.g., soft soap). Then re-
cleaning fluid. deeper into the textile material. move the soap with water (wet sponge).

256
Care and maintenance

A spirit-based cleaner can be used to remove ing remain visible; these are the characteris- To maintain the value of natural leather you

Technical data
grease, oil, lipstick or ball point pen. Then tic features of genuine natural leather. should note the following points:
dab the dissolved grease or colour particles
Natural napped leather does not have a pro-
off with an absorbent cloth or similar. You CAUTION
tective surface coating of dye. It is therefore
may also have to treat the stain once more ● Avoid exposing leather to direct sunlight
somewhat more prone to damage. This
using washing paste and water. for long periods, otherwise it may tend to
should be borne in mind if children or pets
If the covers or textile trim panels are badly often travel in the car, or if there are other lose some of its colour. If the car is left for a
soiled we recommend that you have them factors that could lead to damage. prolonged period in the bright sun, it is best
to cover the leather.

Advice
cleaned by a professional cleaning company
Types of leather with a coloured surface coat- ● Sharp-edged objects on clothing, such as
with a shampoo and spray.
ing are likely to be more resistant to damage. belts, zip fasteners, rivets or similar, can also
This has a great advantage for day-to-day leave permanent scratches and rough marks
Note
use. However, this means that the typical on the surface of the leather.
Open Velcro fasteners on clothes can damage natural characteristics of the surface are less
the seat upholstery. Make sure they are apparent, though this does not affect quality.

Operation
closed. Note

Cleaning and care ● Use a suitable impregnating cream with ul-


tra-violet protection at regular intervals and
Due to the natural properties of the specially after cleaning. The cream nourishes and
Natural leather selected hides employed, the finished leath- moisturises the leather, keeps it supple and
er has a certain sensitivity to grease and dirt, able to breathe. A protective film will also
General information

Emergencies
etc. so a degree of care is required in every- form.
Our range of leathers is large. The main type day use and when looking after the leather. ● Clean the leather every 2 to 3 months and
used is particularly nappa in various forms, Dark clothing (especially if damp or incorrect- remove fresh dirt as soon as possible.
that is, leather with a smooth surface in dif- ly dyed) may stain leather upholstery on the ● Remove stains from fresh ball-pen and oth-
ferent colours. seats. Dust and grit in the pores and seams er inks, lipstick, shoe cream and similar
The amount of dye used determines the ap- can scratch and damage the surface. There- stains as soon as possible.
pearance and properties of leather. If the fore leather should be cleaned at regular in-
● Preserve the colour of the leather. A special
leather is left in a more natural state, it re- tervals, depending on the actual amount of
coloured cream will renew the colour of the

Safety
tains its typical natural napped appearance use. When they have been in use for a certain leather when required and will eliminate dif-
and confers excellent all-weather properties time, your car seats will acquire a typical and ferences in colour.
to the seats. Fine veins, healed scars, insect unmistakable patina. This is characteristic for
bites, wrinkles and a subtle variation in shad- leather as a natural product and is a sign of
genuine quality.

257
Advice

Cleaning and care of leather uphols- – Treat fat-based, dried-in stains with grease- CAUTION
tery dissolving spray.
On no account use solvents (such as petrol,
– Treat less common stains on leather, such turpentine), wax polish, shoe cream or simi-
Natural leather requires an extra degree of at- as ball-pen and other inks, felt-tip pens, lar materials.
tention and care. nail polish, dispersion paint, shoe cream
etc. with a special leather stain remover.
Normal cleaning
Cleaning Alcantara upholstery
– Moisten a cotton or woollen cloth with wa- Leather maintenance
ter and wipe over the leather surfaces. – The leather should be treated regularly Removing dust and dirt
(about twice a year) with a special leather- – Moisten a cloth just a little and wipe down
More stubborn dirt care product. the seat covers.
– More stubborn dirt can be removed using a
– Apply these products very sparingly.
mild soap solution (pure liquid soap: two Removing stains
tablespoons dissolved in one litre of wa- – Then wipe off with a soft cloth.
– Moisten a cloth with lukewarm water or di-
ter).
Should you have questions regarding the luted white spirits.
– Do not let the water soak through the leath- care and cleaning of the leather upholstery in
– Dab at the stain. Start at the outside and
er or penetrate into the seams. your vehicle, we recommend that you contact
work inwards.
– Then wipe off with a soft, dry cloth. your SEAT Official Service. Our representa-
tives will be happy to advise you and tell you – Dry the clean area with a soft cloth.
about the product range for leather conserva-
Removal of stains Do not use leather cleaning products on Al-
tion, for example:
– Remove fresh water-based stains such as cantara seat covers.
coffee, tea, juices, blood etc. with an ab- ● Cleaning and care set.
You may use a suitable soap on dust and dirt.
sorbent cloth or kitchen roll, or use the ● Coloured leather-care cream.
cleaning agent from the care set for dried- Dust and grit in the pores and seams can
● Stain remover for ball-pen inks, shoe cream scratch and damage the surface. If the car is
on stains.
etc. left standing in the sun for long periods, Al-
– Remove fresh grease-based stains that ● Grease dissolving spray. cantara leather should be protected against
have not penetrated the surface such as direct sunlight to prevent it from fading. How-
● New products and further developments
butter, mayonnaise, chocolate, etc. with an ever, slight colour variations will arise in nor-
absorbent cloth or kitchen roll or with the mal use.
cleaning agent from the care set.

258
Intelligent technology

CAUTION the belt in question must be replaced by a Intelligent technology

Technical data
● Do not use solvents, wax polish, shoe
specialised workshop.
cream, stain removers, leather cleaning prod- Electromechanical steering
ucts or any similar products on Alcantara.
● To avoid damage, stubborn stains should Electro-mechanical power steering assists
be removed by a specialised workshop. the driver when steering.
● On no account use brushes, hard sponges Electro-mechanical power steering adapts
or similar utensils. electronically to the speed of the car, torque

Advice
and turning angle.
If the power steering should fail at any time
Seat belts or the engine is switched off (for instance
when being towed), the car can still be
– Keep the seat belts clean.
steered. However, more effort than normal

Operation
– For cleaning, use a mild solution of soap will be required to turn the steering wheel.
and water.
Driver warning lamps and messages
– Check the condition of the seat belts at reg-
ular intervals.  (in red) Faulty steering! To
park the vehicle
The retract function may not operate properly

Emergencies
in very dirty belts. Make sure that the inertia If the warning lamp remains on and the driver
reel seat belts are completely dry before al- indication appears, the power steering could
lowing them to retract. be faulty.
Do not continue driving. Seek specialist as-
CAUTION sistance.
● Do not remove the seat belts from the vehi-  (in yellow) Steering: System
cle to clean them. fault! You may continue driving.

Safety
● Do not use chemical cleaning agents on the
seat belts, as this can damage the webbing. If the warning lamp comes on, the steering
Ensure that the seat belts do not come into could react with more difficultly or more sen-
contact with corrosive fluids. sitivity than normal. In addition, when driving
● If you find any damage to the belt webbing,
in a straight line the steering wheel may be
belt fittings, the belt retractor or the buckle,
off-centre. »
259
Advice

Drive slowly to a specialised workshop and sportier, more direct and noticeably more dy- Snow chains
have the fault repaired. namic driving sensation. On roads where snow chains are mandatory,
 (in yellow) Steering lock: this also applies to cars with four-wheel drive
fault! Go to an Official Service ›››  page 64.
Four-wheel drive
The electronic steering lock is malfunction-
3 Valid for vehicles: with four-wheel drive Changing tyres
ing.
On vehicles with four-wheel drive, all four
Go to a specialised workshop as soon as On four-wheel drive models, the engine pow-
tyres must have the same rolling circumfer-
possible and have the fault repaired. er is distributed to all four wheels
ence. Also avoid using tyres with varying
tread depths ››› page 279.
WARNING General notes
Take it immediately to a specialised work- On four-wheel drive vehicles, the engine Off-roader?
shop and have the fault repaired: risk of acci- power is distributed to all four wheels. The
Your SEAT is not an off-road vehicle: it does
dent! distribution of power is controlled automati-
not have enough ground clearance to be
cally according to your driving style and the
used as such. It is therefore best to avoid
Note road conditions. Also see ››› page 181, Brak-
rough tracks and uneven terrain as much as
ing and stability systems.
If the lamp  (in red) or else  (in yellow) possible.
lights up briefly, you may continue driving. The four-wheel drive is specially designed to
complement the superior engine power. This WARNING
combination gives the vehicle exceptional ● Even with four-wheel drive, you should al-
handling and performance capabilities, both ways adjust your speed to suit the condi-
Progressive steering on normal roads and in more difficult condi- tions. Do not let the extra safety features
tions, such as snow and ice. Even so (or per- tempt you into taking any risks when driving.
Depending on the vehicle equipment, the
haps especially for this reason), it is impor- Risk of accident!
progressive steering can adapt steering hard-
tant to observe certain safety points ››› . ● The braking capability of your vehicle is
ness to the current driving situation. The
power steering only works when the engine limited by the tyres' grip. It is therefore no
is running. Winter tyres different from a car without four-wheel drive.
Thanks to four-wheel drive, your vehicle will So do not be tempted to drive too fast on firm
In city traffic you do not need to turn so much or slippery roads just because the vehicle
have plenty of traction in winter conditions,
on parking, manoeuvring or in very tight still has good acceleration in these condi-
even with the standard tyres. Nevertheless,
turns. tions. Risk of accident!
we still recommend that winter tyres or all-
On the road or on the motorway, progressive season tyres be fitted on all four wheels to ● On wet roads bear in mind that the front
steering transmits, for example, in bends, a give even better braking response. wheels may start to “aquaplane” and lose
260
Intelligent technology

contact with the road if the car is driven too The main functions incorporated in the power sume more electrical power than the alterna-

Technical data
fast. If this should happen, there will be no management system are battery diagnosis, tor can supply, and thus maintains the maxi-
sudden increase in engine speed to warn the residual current management and dynamic mum possible battery power level.
driver, as occurs with a front-wheel drive car. power management.
For this reason you should always choose a Note
driving speed suitable for the road condi- Battery diagnosis ● Neither is the power management system
tions. Risk of accident!
The battery diagnosis function constantly able to overcome the given physical limits.
registers the condition of the battery. Sen- Please remember that the power and useful
sors detect the battery voltage, battery cur- life of the battery are limited.

Advice
Power Management rent and battery temperature. This enables ● When there is a risk that the vehicle will
the system to calculate the current power lev- not start, the alternator power failure or low
el and charge condition of the battery. battery charge level warning lamp will be
This system helps to ensure reliable shown  ››› page 113.
starting
Residual current management

Operation
The power management controls the distribu- The residual current management reduces
tion of electrical energy and thus helps to en- power consumption while the vehicle is Flat battery
sure that there is always enough power avail- parked. It controls the supply of power to the
Starting ability has first priority.
able to start the engine. various electrical devices while the ignition is
switched off. The system takes the battery di- Short trips, city traffic and low temperatures
If a vehicle with a conventional electrical sys-
agnosis data into consideration. all place a heavy load on the battery. In these

Emergencies
tem is left parked for a long time, the battery
conditions a large amount of power is con-
will gradually lose its charge because certain Depending on the power level of the battery,
sumed, but only a small amount is supplied.
electrical devices, such as the electronic switch off the individual electrical devices
The situation is also critical if electrical devi-
gearbox lock continues to draw current even one after the other to prevent the battery
ces are in use when the engine is not run-
when the ignition is off. In some cases there from losing too much charge and to ensure
ning. In this case power is consumed when
may not be enough power available to start that the engine can be started reliably.
none is being generated.
the engine.
Dynamic power management In these situations you will be aware that the
Your vehicle is equipped with an intelligent

Safety
While the vehicle is moving, this function dis- power management system is intervening to
power management system to control the
distribution of electrical energy. This signifi- tributes the available power to the various control the distribution of electrical power. »
cantly improves reliability when starting the electrical devices and systems according to
engine, and also prolongs the useful life of their requirements. The power management
the battery. ensures that on-board systems do not con-

261
Advice

When the vehicle is parked for long periods especially if the battery is not fully charged
initially.
Checking and refilling levels
If you do not drive your vehicle for a period of
several days or weeks, the power manage-
ment will gradually shut off the electrical de-
To restore the necessary energy balance, the Filling the tank
system will then temporarily shut off the elec-
vices one by one or reduce the amount of cur- trical devices that are using a lot of power, or
rent they are using. This limits the amount of Filling up
reduce the current they are consuming. Heat-
power consumed and helps to ensure relia- ing systems in particular use a large amount Read the additional information carefully
ble starting even after a long period. Some of electrical power. If you notice, for instance,
convenience functions, such as remote vehi-
›››  page 53
that the seat heating* or the rear window
cle opening, may not be available under cer- heater is not working, they may have been If the automatic filler nozzle is operated cor-
tain circumstances. These functions will be temporarily switched off or regulated to a rectly, it will switch itself off as soon as the
restored when you switch on the ignition and lower heat output. These systems will be fuel tank is “full”. Do not try to put in more
start the engine. available again as soon as sufficient electri- fuel after the nozzle cuts out, as this will fill
cal power is available. the expansion chamber in the fuel tank.
With the engine switched off
You may also notice that the engine runs at a The correct fuel grade for your vehicle is giv-
For example, if you listen to the sound sys- slightly faster idling speed when necessary. en on a sticker on the inside of the fuel tank
tem with the engine switched off the battery This is quite normal, and no cause for con- flap. Further notes on fuel can be found at
will run down. cern. The increased idling speed allows the ››› page 264.
If the energy consumption means there is a alternator to meet the greater power require- The capacity of your vehicle's fuel tank is giv-
risk that the engine will not start, a text will ment and charge the battery at the same en in ›››  page 53.
appear in vehicles with a driver information time.
system*. Vehicles with natural gas engines and hy-
This driver indicator tells you that you must brids
start the engine so that the battery can re- Every 6 months it is necessary to run on pet-
charge. rol until the control lamp switches off  and
then the tank must be refilled. This is neces-
When the engine is running sary to ensure that the system works proper-
ly, as well as the fuel quality required for driv-
Although the alternator generates electrical
ing with petrol.
power, the battery can still become dis-
charged while the vehicle is being driven.
This can occur when a lot of power is being
consumed but only a small amount supplied,
262
Checking and refilling levels

WARNING – Never spill fuel in the vehicle or in the Note

Technical data
luggage compartment. Fuel vapour is ex-
Fuel is highly flammable and can cause seri- Diesel vehicles are fitted with a protective de-
plosive. Risk of fatal accident!
ous burns and other injuries. vice that prevents the insertion of the wrong
● Do not smoke when filling the fuel tank or a fuel hose1). It is only possible to refuel with
canister. Naked flames are forbidden in the CAUTION Diesel nozzles.
vicinity due to the risk of explosion. ● If any fuel is spilt onto the vehicle, it ● If the pump nozzle is worn, damaged, or if
● Observe legislation governing the use, should be removed immediately. It could oth- it is very small, it is possible that it will not
storage and carrying of a spare fuel canister erwise damage the paintwork. be able to open the protective device. Before

Advice
in the vehicle. trying to insert the pump nozzle by turning it,
● Never run the tank completely dry. An irreg-
try a different pump or request specialist
● For safety reasons we do not recommend ular fuel supply could cause misfiring. As a
help.
carrying a spare fuel canister in the vehicle. result, unburnt fuel could enter the exhaust
system and damage the catalytic converter. ● If you fill the tank from a reserve fuel canis-
In an accident the canister could be damaged
and could leak. ter, the protective device will not open. One
● When filling the fuel tank after having run it
way to resolve this is to pour the fuel in very
● If, in exceptional circumstances, you have completely dry on a vehicle with a diesel en-
slowly.

Operation
to carry a spare fuel canister, please observe gine, the ignition must be switched on for at
the following points: least 30 seconds before starting the engine.
– Never fill fuel into the spare fuel canister
When you then start the engine it may take
if it is inside or on top of the vehicle. An longer than normal (up to one minute) to Refuelling with natural gas
electrostatic charge could build up during start firing. This is because air needs to be
filling, causing the fuel vapour to ignite. bled from the fuel system while starting.

Emergencies
Danger of explosion. Always place the
canister on the ground to fill it. For the sake of the environment
– Insert the filling nozzle as far as possible Do not overfill the fuel tank, it may cause the
into the spare fuel canister. fuel to overflow if it becomes warm.
– If the spare fuel canister is made of met-
al, the filling nozzle must be in contact
Note
with the canister during filling. This
helps prevent an electrostatic charge There is no emergency mechanism for the

Safety
building up. manual release of the fuel tank flap. If neces-
sary, request assistance from specialised per- Fig. 246 Tank flap open: gas filler mouth 1 ,
sonnel. filler mouth retainer 2 »

1) Depending on country
263
Advice

Before refuelling, the engine and the igni- ● If you wish to finish refuelling in advance, do not know, ask a qualified employee at the
tion, mobile telephone and heating must be press the button on the pump to stop the petrol station to do the refuelling.
switched off separately ››› . flow. ● Noises heard when refuelling are normal
Read the instructions on how to use the natu- and do not indicate the presence of a fault in
Closing the fuel tank cap the system.
ral gas pump carefully.
● Check that the gas filler mouth retainer 2 ● The vehicle natural gas system is prepared
The vehicle is not prepared for refuelling with
is not trapped with the filler nozzle. If neces- both for refuelling with a small compressor
liquefied natural gas (LNG) ››› . Before refu- (slow refuel) and a large compressor (fast re-
sary, place it in the filler mouth again.
elling with natural gas, make sure you add fuel) in natural gas service stations.
the appropriate type of fuel ››› page 264. ● Insert the plug in the filler mouth.
● Close the tank flap. Make sure you hear it
Opening the fuel tank cap click into place.
The natural gas filler mouth is behind the fuel Fuel
tank cap, next to the petrol filler mouth. WARNING
Natural gas is a highly explosive, easily flam- Types of petrol
● Unlock the vehicle with the key or with the mable substance. Incorrect handling of the
central locking button  situated on the driv- natural gas can cause accidents serious The correct grade of petrol is listed inside the
er door ››› page 120. burns and other injuries. fuel tank flap.
● Press on the rear area of the flap and open ● Before refuelling with natural gas, engage The vehicle is equipped with a catalytic con-
it. the filling mouth correctly. If you can smell verter and must only be run on unleaded pet-
gas, stop refuelling immediately.
rol. The petrol must comply with European
Refuelling Standard EN 228 or German standard DIN
Special feature: if the ambient temperature is WARNING 51626-1 and must be unleaded. You can re-
very high, the natural gas pump protection The vehicle is not prepared to use liquefied fuel with a maximum ethanol proportion of
against overheating disconnects this auto- natural gas (LNG), and this fuel must not be 10 % (E10). The types of petrol are differenti-
matically. added under any circumstances. Liquefied ated by their octane rating (RON).
natural gas can cause the natural gas tank to The following titles appear on the corre-
● Remove the plug from the gas filler mouth explode, resulting in serious injury.
››› Fig. 246 1 . sponding adhesive on the fuel tank flap:
● Connect the pump filling nozzle to the gas Note
filler mouth.
● The filling nozzles of natural gas pumps
● The fuel tank will be full when the pump can differ in the way they are operated. If you
compressor automatically cuts the supply.
264
Checking and refilling levels

Super unleaded 95 octane or normal 91 oc- petrol industry, free of metals. These addi- ● Just filling one full tank of leaded fuel or

Technical data
tane unleaded petrol tives will help to prevent corrosion, keep the fuel containing other metal additives would
We recommend you use super 95 octane pet- fuel system clean and prevent deposits from seriously impair the efficiency of the catalytic
rol. If this is not available: normal 91 octane building up in the engine. converter.
petrol, with a slight decrease in power. If good-quality petrol with metal-free addi- ● Only use fuel additives that have been ap-
tives is not available or engine problems proved by SEAT. Octane boosting or anti-
Super unleaded petrol with a minimum of 95 arise, the necessary additives must be added knock additives may contain metal additives
that could seriously damage the engine or
octanes when refuelling ››› .
the catalytic converter. These additives must

Advice
You should use super petrol with a minimum Not all petrol additives have been shown to not be used.
of 95 octanes. be effective. The use of unsuitable petrol ad- ● High engine speed and full throttle can
If super is not available, in an emergency you ditives may cause significant damage to the damage the engine when using petrol with an
may refuel with normal 91 octane petrol. In engine and the catalytic converter. Metal ad- octane rating lower than the correct grade for
this case only use moderate engine speeds ditives should never be used. Metal additives the engine.
and a light throttle. Refuel with super as soon may also be contained in petrol additives for

Operation
as possible. improving anti-detonation ratings or octane Note
ratings ››› .
● You may use petrol with a high octane num-
Super unleaded 98 octane or super 95 oc- SEAT recommends “genuine Volkswagen ber than the one recommended for your en-
tane unleaded petrol Group Fuel Additives for petrol engines”. gine.
We recommend you use super plus 98 octane These additives can be bought at SEAT deal- ● In those countries where unleaded petrol is

Emergencies
petrol. If this is not available: super 95 oc- ers, where information on how to use them not available, you may refuel with a fuel with
tane petrol, with a slight decrease in power. can also be obtained. a low lead content.

If super is not available, in an emergency you CAUTION


may refuel with normal 91 octane petrol. In
● Do not refuel if the filler indicates that the Diesel fuel
this case only use moderate engine speeds
fuel contains metal. LRP (lead replacement
and a light throttle. Refuel with super as soon
petrol) fuels contain high concentrations of Please note the information on the inside of
as possible. metal additives. Using them may damage the the fuel tank flap.

Safety
engine!
Petrol additives We recommend the use of diesel fuel which
● Never refuel with fuels containing a large
The quality of the fuel influences the behav- proportion of ethanol (for example, E50, E85). complies to European standard EN 590. If
iour, power and service life of the engine. This could damage the fuel system. diesel fuel which meets European standard
This is why the petrol you use should carry EN 590 is not available, the Cetane number
suitable additives already included by the (CZ) must, at minimum, be 51. If the engine »
265
Advice

is equipped with a particulate filter, the sul- Programme. We recommend having this done the natural gas, the lower the consumption
phur content of the fuel must be below 50 by a specialised workshop. If water is allowed will be.
parts per million. to collect in the filter, this can cause engine However, the heating power and the propor-
performance problems.
tion of nitrogen and carbon dioxide can fluc-
Winter-grade diesel
tuate within the quality groups. Therefore, ve-
Summer fuel becomes thicker in winter and it hicle consumption can also vary when using
is more difficult to start the engine. For this Natural gas a single type of gas only.
reason, petrol stations in some countries al-
Natural gas can be compressed or in liquid The engine management automatically
so offer winter diesel with improved fluidity
form, addition to others. adapts to the natural gas used according to
when cold (winter-grade diesel).
its quality. Therefore, different quality gases
Liquefied natural gas (LNG) is the result of can be mixed in the tank, without the need
Water in the fuel filter1) heavy cooling of natural gas. Therefore its for comprehensive draining before applying a
If your vehicle has a diesel engine and is volume is considerably reduced compared different quality gas.
equipped with a fuel filter with a water sepa- with compressed natural gas (CNG). In vehi-
cles with a natural gas engine, liquefied nat- Updated information relating to natural gas
rator, the instrument panel may display the
ural gas cannot be directly refilled, as the gas quality is displayed on the instrument panel
following warning:  Water in the ›››  page 33.
would expand excessively in the vehicle gas
fuel filter. If this is the case, take the
tank.
vehicle to a specialised workshop so that Natural gas and safety
they can drain the fuel filter. Therefore, vehicles with a natural gas engine
If you can smell gas or suspect that there is a
must only be refuelled using compressed
leak ››› :
CAUTION natural gas ››› .
● The vehicle is not designed for the use of ● Stop the vehicle immediately.
FAME fuel (biodiesel). The fuel system would Natural gas quality and consumption
● Switch the ignition off.
be damaged if you used biodiesel. Natural gas is divided into the groups H and ● Open the doors to appropriately ventilate
● Do not mix fuel additives, the so-called L depending on its quality.
the vehicle.
“thinners”, petrol or similar additives with
diesel fuel. Gas type H has a superior heating power and ● Extinguish cigarettes immediately.
inferior nitrogen and carbon dioxide content
● If poor-quality diesel fuel is used, it may be ● Move away from the vehicle or switch off
than type L. The higher the heating power of
necessary to drain the fuel filter more fre- objects that may cause sparks or a fire.
quently than is specified in the Maintenance

1) Valid for the market: Algeria.


266
Checking and refilling levels

● If you continue to smell gas, do not contin- added under any circumstances. Liquefied

Technical data
ue driving! natural gas can cause the natural gas tank to
● Seek specialist assistance. Have the fault explode, resulting in serious injury.
repaired.
WARNING
Regular checks of the natural gas system
Damaged, corroded or rusted tanks can result
The natural gas tanks may be damaged or in serious injury or even death.
corroded by external factors. The walls of the ● Have the natural gas deposits checked at

Advice
gas tanks are weakened by deformations, least every 4 years (visual check).
damage or corrosion. As a result, the tanks ● Natural gas tanks have a limited service
could burst and result in serious injuries or life. Have the natural gas tanks replaced
even death. For this reason, the vehicle own- when required. You can obtain further infor-
er must have a specialised workshop check mation about this at SEAT dealers or special-
(visual check) the gas system every 4 years at ised workshops.

Operation
least. The vehicle owner must have a special-
ised workshop replace the natural gas tanks
WARNING
before they reach the end of their service life.
For further information about the service life If the vehicle underbody touches the ground
of gas tanks, go to a SEAT dealer service or a or in the event of a rear collision, there could
specialised workshop be damage to the natural gas tanks.

Emergencies
● Check whether there is a smell of gas.
WARNING ● If you do not notice the smell of gas, take
Failure to act when you can smell gas in the the vehicle to a specialised workshop imme-
vehicle or when refuelling can cause serious diately and have the natural gas system
injuries. checked.
● Carry out the necessary operations.
● Leave the danger zone. Note

Safety
● If necessary, warn the emergency services. Have the natural gas system checked regular-
ly by a specialised workshop, according to
the Maintenance Programme.
WARNING
The vehicle is not prepared to use liquefied
natural gas (LNG) and this fuel must not be
267
Advice

Engine compartment
Checking levels

Fig. 247 Diagram for the location of the various elements.

From time to time, the levels of the different Overview gine compartment of the vehicle is a poten-
fluids in the vehicle must be checked. Never You will find further explanations, instruc- tially hazardous area ››› .
fill with incorrect fluids, otherwise serious tions and restrictions on the technical speci-
damage to the engine may be caused. fications as of ››› page 287. WARNING
● Switch the engine off, remove the key from
1 Coolant expansion tank
the ignition and apply the hand brake. If the
2 Engine oil dipstick vehicle has a manual gearbox, place the lever
Work in the engine compartment
3 Engine oil filler cap in neutral; if it has an automatic gearbox,
place the selector lever in position P. Wait for
4 Brake fluid reservoir Read the additional information carefully
the engine to cool down.
5 Vehicle battery (underneath the cover)
›››  page 15
● Keep children away from the engine com-
6 Windscreen washer reservoir Always be aware of the danger of injury and partment.
scalding as well as the risk of accident or fire ● Never spill liquids used for vehicle opera-
The checking and refilling of service fluids when working in the engine compartment tion on the engine compartment, as these
are carried out on the components men- (e.g. when checking and refilling fluids). Al- may catch fire (e.g. the antifreeze in coolant).
tioned above. These operations are descri- ways observe the warnings listed below and
bed in ››› page 268. follow all general safety precautions. The en-
268
Checking and refilling levels

● Take care not to cause short circuits in the CAUTION WARNING

Technical data
electrical system, especially when working
When topping up fluids make sure the correct Never open the bonnet if you see steam or
on the battery.
fluid is put into the correct filler opening, oth- drips of coolant being released from the en-
● If working inside the engine compartment, erwise this can cause serious malfunctions or gine compartment. Failure to comply could
remember that, even when the ignition is engine damage. result in burns. Wait until no steam or coolant
switched off, the radiator fan may start up au- can be seen before opening the bonnet.
tomatically, and therefore there is a risk of in-
jury. For the sake of the environment
● Never cover the engine with additional in- Inspect the ground underneath your vehicle

Advice
regularly so that any leaks are detected at an Closing the bonnet
sulating materials such as a blanket. Risk of
fire! early stage. If you find spots of oil or other
fluids in the area where it was parked, have – Slightly lift the bonnet.
● Do not unscrew the cap on the coolant ex-
your vehicle inspected at the workshop. – Release the bonnet stay before pressing it
pansion tank when the engine is hot. The
cooling system is under pressure. back into its support.
Note

Operation
● Protect face, hands and arms by covering – Carefully close the bonnet.
the cap with a large, thick rag to protect In right-hand drive vehicles* some brake flu-
against escaping coolant and steam. – Press the bonnet down until it locks into
id reservoirs are on the other side of the en-
gine compartment ››› Fig. 247.
place.
● If it is necessary to work in the engine com-
partment while the engine is running, the ro- – Make sure that the bonnet catches onto its
tating components (for example, poly-V belt, clasp. Do not press down too hard ››› .

Emergencies
alternator, radiator fan) and the high voltage
ignition system are an additional hazard.
Opening the bonnet
WARNING
● Observe the following additional warnings Read the additional information carefully ● For safety reasons the bonnet must always
if work on the fuel system or the electrical ›››  page 15 be completely closed when the vehicle is
system is necessary:
moving. Therefore, after closing the bonnet,
– Always disconnect the battery from the The bonnet is released from inside the vehi-
always check that the locking element is
on-board network. cle. properly engaged. This is the case if the bon-
– Do not smoke. Check that the windscreen wiper arms are net is flush with the adjacent body panels.

Safety
– Never work near naked flames. not unfolded. Otherwise the paint may be ● Should you notice that the bonnet is not
damaged. safely secured when the vehicle is moving,
– Always keep an approved fire extinguish-
stop the vehicle immediately and close the
er immediately available. The bonnet can only be unlocked when the bonnet. Failure to follow this instruction
driver door is open. could result in an accident.

269
Advice

Engine oil this means that your vehicle has the LongLife miles)(whatever comes first) ››› Booklet
service programmed. If it lists the codes QI1, Maintenance Programme.
QI2, QI3, QI4 or QI7, the interval service is
General notes ● In exceptional circumstances, if the engine
dependent on time/distance travelled.
oil level is too low ››› page 271 and you can-
The engine comes with a special, multi-grade not obtain the oil specified for your vehicle,
oil that can be used all year round. Flexible service intervals (LongLife service
intervals*) you can add a small quantity of oil conform-
Because the use of high-quality oil is essen- ing to the specification ACEA A2 or ACEA A3
tial for the correct operation of the engine Special oils and processes have been devel- (petrol engines) or ACEA B3 or ACEA B4 (die-
and its long useful life, when topping up or oped which, depending on the characteris- sel engines) (up to 0.5 l).
changing oil, use only those oils that comply tics and individual driving profiles, enable
with VW standards. the extension of the oil change service (Long- Vehicles with diesel particulate filter*
Life service intervals).
The specifications (VW standards) set out in The Maintenance Programme states whether
the following page should appear on the con- Because this oil is essential for extending the your vehicle is fitted with a diesel particulate
tainer of the service oil; when the container service intervals, it must only be used ob- filter.
displays the specific standards for petrol and serving the following indications:
Only VW 507 00 engine oil, with reduced ash
diesel engines together, it means that the oil ● Avoid mixing it with oil for fixed service in- formation, may be used in diesel engines
can be used for both types of engines. tervals. equipped with particulate filter. Using other
We recommend that the oil change indicated ● Only in exceptional circumstances, if the types of oil will cause a higher soot concen-
in the Maintenance Programme, be per- engine oil level is too low ››› page 271 and tration and reduce the life of the DPF. There-
formed by a technical service or specialised LongLife oil is not available, it is permitted to fore:
workshop. top up (once) with oil for fixed service inter- ● Avoid mixing this oil with other engine oils.
The correct oil specifications for your engine vals ›››  page 55 (up to a maximum of 0.5
litres). ● Only in exceptional circumstances, if the
are listed in the ›››  page 55, Engine oil engine oil level is too low ››› page 271 and
specifications. you cannot obtain the oil specified for your
Fixed service intervals*
vehicle, you can use a small quantity of oil
Service intervals If your vehicle does not have the “LongLife (once) conforming to the VW 506 00,
Service intervals can be flexible (LongLife service interval” or it has been disabled (by VW 506 01, VW 505 00, VW 505 01 or
service) or fixed (dependent on time/dis- request), you may use oils for fixed service ACEA B3/ACEA B4 specification. (up to 0.5 l).
tance travelled). intervals, which also appear in
›››  page 55, Engine oil specifications. In
If the PR code that appears on the back of the this case, your vehicle must be serviced after
Maintenance Programme booklet is PR QI6, a fixed interval of 1 year/15,000 km (10,000
270
Checking and refilling levels

Checking engine oil level Depending on how you drive and the condi- Topping up engine oil 

Technical data
tions in which the vehicle is used, oil con-
sumption can be up to 0.5 l/1000 km. Oil
consumption is likely to be higher for the first
5,000 km. For this reason the engine oil level
must be checked at regular intervals, prefera-
bly when filling the tank and before a jour-
ney.

Advice
WARNING
Any work carried out in the engine compart-
ment or on the engine must be carried out
Fig. 248 Engine oil dipstick. cautiously. Fig. 249 In the engine compartment: Engine
● When working in the engine compartment, oil filler cap.
Read the additional information carefully

Operation
always observe the safety warnings
›››  page 54 ››› page 268. Read the additional information carefully
›››  page 54
The engine oil dipstick indicates the level of
the oil. CAUTION Before opening the bonnet, read and observe
If the oil level is above the area A do not the warnings ››› in Work in the engine
Checking oil level start the engine. This could result in damage compartment on page 268.

Emergencies
– Park the vehicle in a horizontal position. to the engine and catalytic converter. Contact
a Technical Service.
The position of the oil filler opening is shown
– Briefly run the engine at idle speed until in the corresponding engine compartment il-
the operating temperature is reached and lustration ››› page 268.
then stop. Engine oil specification ›››  page 55.
– Wait for about two minutes.
WARNING
– Pull out the dipstick. Wipe the dipstick with

Safety
Oil is highly inflammable! Ensure that no oil
a clean cloth and insert it again, pushing it
comes into contact with hot engine compo-
in as far as it will go. »
nents when topping up.
– Then pull it out once more and check the oil
level ››› Fig. 248. Top up with engine oil if
necessary.
271
Advice

CAUTION WARNING ● Use a suitable container when draining the


used oil. It must be large enough to hold all
If the oil level is above the area A do not Only change the engine oil yourself if you
the engine oil.
start the engine. This could result in damage have the specialist knowledge required!
to the engine and catalytic converter. Contact ● Before opening the bonnet, read and ob-
a specialised workshop. serve the warnings ››› page 268.
● Wait for the engine to cool down. Hot oil Cooling system
For the sake of the environment may cause burn injuries.
The oil level must never be above area A . ● Wear eye protection to avoid injuries, such Topping up coolant
Otherwise oil can be drawn in through the as acid burns, caused by splashes of oil.
crankcase breather and escape into the at- ● When removing the oil drain plug with your Read the additional information carefully
mosphere via the exhaust system. fingers, keep your arm horizontal to help pre- ›››  page 55
vent oil from running down your arm. Top up coolant when the level is below the
Note ● Wash your skin thoroughly if it comes into MIN (minimum) mark.
contact with engine oil.
Before a long trip, we recommend finding an
engine oil that conforms to the correspond- ● Engine oil is poisonous! Used oil must be Checking coolant level
ing VW specifications and recommend keep- stored in a safe place out of the reach of chil-
– Park the vehicle in a horizontal position.
ing it in the vehicle. This way, the correct en- dren.
gine oil will always be available for a top-up if – Switch the ignition off.
needed.
CAUTION – Read off the coolant level on coolant ex-
No additives should be used with engine oil. pansion tank. When the engine is cold, the
This could result in engine damage. Any dam- coolant level should be between the marks.
Changing engine oil age caused by the use of such additives When the engine is hot, it may be slightly
would not be covered by the factory warranty. above the upper mark.
Read the additional information carefully
›››  page 54. Topping up coolant
For the sake of the environment
The engine oil must be changed at the inter- – Wait for the engine to cool down.
● Because of disposal problems and the spe-
vals given in the service schedule.
cial tools and specialist knowledge required, – Cover the coolant expansion tank cap with
We recommend that you have the engine oil we recommend that you have the engine oil a cloth and carefully unscrew it to the left
changed by a Technical Service. and filter changed by a Technical Service.
››› .
● Never pour oil down drains or into the
The oil change intervals are shown in the – Top up the coolant only if there is still cool-
ground.
Maintenance Programme. ant in the expansion tank, otherwise you
272
Checking and refilling levels

could damage the engine. If there is no tomatically, and therefore there is a risk of in- that the G13 additive has been mixed with an

Technical data
coolant in the expansion tank, do not con- jury. inadequate coolant. The coolant must be
tinue driving. You should obtain professio- changed as soon as possible if this is the
nal assistance ››› . case! This could result in serious faults and
WARNING
engine damage.
– If there is still some coolant in the expan-
If there is not enough anti-freeze in the cool-
sion tank, top up to the upper mark. ant system, the engine may fail leading to se-
For the sake of the environment
– Top up with coolant until the level becomes rious damage.
stable. ● Please make sure that the percentage of Coolants and additives can contaminate the

Advice
additive is correct with respect to the lowest environment. If any fluids are spilled, they
– Screw the cap back on correctly. should be collected and correctly disposed
expected ambient temperature in the zone in
which the vehicle is to be used. of, with respect to the environment.
Any loss of coolant fluid normally indicates a
leak in the cooling system. Take the vehicle ● When the outside temperature is very low,
straight to a specialised workshop to have the coolant could freeze and the vehicle
would be immobilised. In this case, the heat-
the cooling system examined. If there are no Brake fluid

Operation
leaks in the engine cooling system, a loss of ing would not work either and inadequately
dressed passengers could die of cold.
coolant can only occur if the coolant boils Topping up brake fluid
and is forced out of the system as a result of
overheating. CAUTION Read the additional information carefully
Do not top up the expansion tank with cool- ›››  page 56
WARNING

Emergencies
ant fluid if it is empty! Air could enter the
● The cooling system is under pressure. Do cooling system. In this case, stop driving. Checking the brake fluid level
not unscrew the cap on the coolant expan- Seek specialist assistance. Otherwise, there
is a risk of engine damage. The brake fluid level must be between the
sion tank when the engine is hot: risk of
MIN and MAX markings.
burns!
● The antifreeze and coolant fluid can be a CAUTION However, if the brake fluid level goes down
health hazard. Therefore, the antifreeze noticeably in a short time, or drops below the
The original additives should never be mixed MIN mark, there may be a leak in the brake
should be stored in the original container in a
with coolants which are not approved by

Safety
safe place out of reach of children. Failure to system. Seek specialist assistance. A warn-
SEAT. Otherwise, you run the risk of causing
comply could result in poisoning. ing light on the instrument panel display
severe damage to the engine and the engine
● If working inside the engine compartment, cooling system. monitors the brake fluid level ››› page 113. »
remember that, even when the ignition is
● If the fluid in the expansion tank is not pur-
switched off, the radiator fan may start up au-
ple but is, for example, brown, this indicates

273
Advice

In right-hand drive vehicles the brake fluid Windscreen washer reservoir proportion of mixture in the washer fluid
reservoir is on the other side of the engine tank.
compartment.
Checking and topping up the wind-
Capacity
Changing brake fluid
screen washer reservoir
The reservoir holds approximately 3 litres in
The regular intervals at which the brake fluid Read the additional information carefully versions without headlight washer and 5 li-
should be replaced are listed in the Mainte- ›››  page 56 tres in versions with headlight washer.
nance Programme. We recommend you have
Check the water level in the windscreen
it replaced at a SEAT Official Service, during WARNING
washer reservoir regularly and top up as re-
an Inspection Service. If the water from the windscreen washer does
quired.
not contain enough anti-freeze, it may freeze
WARNING The container for the windscreen washer con- on the windscreen and rear window, reducing
● Brake fluid should be stored in the closed tains the cleaning fluid for the windscreen, forward and rear visibility.
original container in a safe place out of reach the rear window and the headlight washer ● In winter, ensure the windscreen washer
of children. Risk of poisoning! system*. contains enough anti-freeze.
● If the brake fluid is left in the system for ● Open the bonnet  ››› page 268. ● In cold conditions, you should not use the
too long and the brakes are subjected to windscreen wiper system unless you have
heavy use, vapour bubbles may form in the ● The windscreen washer reservoir is marked
warmed the windscreen with the ventilation
brake system. This would seriously affect the with the symbol  on the cap. system. The antifreeze could freeze on the
efficiency of the brakes and the safety of the ● Check there is enough windscreen water in windscreen and reduce visibility.
vehicle. This may cause an accident. the reservoir.
WARNING
CAUTION Recommended windscreen wipers
Never mix an unsuitable antifreeze or other
Brake fluid should not come into contact with ● For the hottest seasons we recommend similar additives with the windscreen washer
the vehicle paintwork, as it is abrasive. summer G 052 184 A1 for clear glass. Propor- water. A greasy layer may be formed on the
tions of the mixture in the washer fluid tank: windscreen which will impair visibility.
1:100 (1 part concentrate per 100 parts wa- ● Use clean water with a window cleaner rec-
ter). ommended by SEAT.
● All year round, G 052 164 A2 for clear ● If necessary, add a suitable antifreeze to
glass. Approximate proportion of the winter the water in the reservoir.
mixture, up to -18°C (0°F): 1:2 (1 part con-
centrate per 2 parts water); otherwise, a 1:4

274
Checking and refilling levels

CAUTION connected, some of the vehicle's functions Winter conditions

Technical data
are “lost” (››› table on page 275). These During the winter, the starting power may be
● Do not mix cleaning products recommen-
functions will require resetting after the bat- reduced, and if necessary, the battery should
ded by SEAT with other products. This could
tery is reconnected. be charged ››› in Important safety warn-
lead to flocculation and may block the wind-
screen washer jets. Deactivate the anti-theft alarm* before you ings for handling a vehicle battery on
● When topping up service fluids, make abso- disconnect the battery Otherwise the alarm page 276
lutely certain that you fill the fluids into the will be triggered.
correct reservoirs. Using the wrong fluids

Advice
could cause serious malfunctions and engine Function Reprogramming Important safety warnings for han-
damage! dling a vehicle battery
● Not having windscreen wiper fluid reduces
One-touch function of ››› page 133, One-touch
the electric windows opening and closing*.
visibility through the windscreen, and leads All work on batteries requires specialist
to loss of visibility in headlights in models If the vehicle does not re- knowledge. Please refer to a SEAT Official
with headlight washer. spond to the key, they Service or a workshop specialising in batter-
Remote control key
should be synchronised

Operation
ies: risk of burns or exploding battery!
››› page 127.
The battery must not be opened. Never try to
Digital clock ››› page 109.
Battery change the fluid level of the battery. Other-
After driving for a few me- wise explosive gas is released from the bat-
General information ESC warning lamp tres, the warning lamp goes tery that could cause an explosion.
out again.

Emergencies
Read the additional information carefully  Wear eye protection.
›››  page 56. If the vehicle is not used for long periods
 Battery acid is very corrosive and caustic. Wear
The battery is located in the engine compart- The vehicle has a system for monitoring the protective gloves and eye protection. In the event
ment and is almost maintenance-free. It is current consumption when the engine is left of electrolyte splashes, rinse off with plenty of
checked as part of the Inspection Service. unused for long periods of time ››› page 261. water.

Nevertheless, check the terminals are clean Some functions, such as the interior lights, or
the remote door opening, may be temporarily
 Fires, sparks, open flames and smoking are pro-
and have the correct tightening torque, espe- hibited.

Safety
cially in summer and winter. disabled to prevent the battery from running
flat. These functions will come back on as  The battery should only be charged in a well-ven-
tilated zone. Risk of explosion!
Disconnecting the battery soon as the ignition is switched on and the
The battery should only be disconnected in
engine started.  Keep children away from acid and batteries! »
exceptional cases. When the battery is dis-
275
Advice

WARNING – Note the warnings ››› in Important safety WARNING


warnings for handling a vehicle battery on
● When repairing or working on the electrical Never charge a battery that has frozen: re-
page 276 and ››› .
system, proceed as follows: place battery! Failure to do so may lead to an
– 1. Remove the key from the ignition. The – Switch off all electrical devices. Remove the explosion.
negative cable on the battery must be ignition key.
disconnected. – Raise the bonnet ››› page 269. Note
– 2. When the repair is finished, reconnect
– Open the battery cover. Use only the terminals in the engine compart-
the negative pole of the battery. ment to charge the battery.
● Switch off all electrical devices before re- – Connect the charger clamps as described
connecting the battery. Reconnect first the to the positive pole of the battery (+) and
positive cable and then the negative cable. exclusively to an earth on the bodywork
Never reverse the polarity of the connections. (–). Replacing the battery
This could cause an electrical fire.
– Only use a charger which is compatible for The new battery should have the same speci-
● Ensure that the vent hose is always connec-
use with 12 V nominal voltage batteries. fications (amperage, load and voltage) as the
ted to the battery.
The charge must not exceed a voltage of 15 used battery.
● Never use damaged batteries. This could
V.
cause an explosion! Replace a damaged bat- Your vehicle is equipped with an intelligent
tery immediately. – Now connect the battery charger to the power management system to control the
power socket and switch on. distribution of electrical energy ››› page 261.
CAUTION – After charging the battery: switch off the
The power management function ensures
that the battery is charged much more effi-
● Never disconnect the battery if the ignition battery charger and disconnect the power
ciently than on vehicles without a power
is switched on or if the engine is running. socket cable.
management system. To maintain this func-
This could damage the electrical system or – Finally disconnect the charger cables from tion after replacing the battery, we recom-
electronic components. the battery. mend that the replacement battery used is of
– Replace the battery cover correctly. the same make and type as the original fitted
battery. To make proper use of the power
Charging the battery – Close the bonnet ››› page 269. management function after the battery has
been changed, have the battery coded to the
Terminals for charging the battery are fitted Important: Before you charge the battery
power management mode at a specialised
in the engine compartment. make sure you read the manufacturer's in-
workshop.
structions for using the battery charger.

276
Wheels

CAUTION Wheels driving carefully and at moderate speeds for

Technical data
about the first 500 km (300 miles). This will
● Some vehicles, for example those with the
also increase the useful life of the tyres.
Start-Stop system* are fitted with a special Wheels and tyres
battery (AGM-type or EFB-type battery). If any The tread depth of new tyres may vary, ac-
other type of battery is fitted, the Start-Stop cording to the type and make of tyre and the
function may be considerably reduced and General notes
tread pattern.
the vehicle may not stop on repeated occa-
sions. – When driving with new tyres, be especially
careful during the first 500 km (300 miles). Concealed damage

Advice
● Make sure that the vent hose is always at-
Damage to tyres and rims is often not readily
tached to the original opening on the side of – If you have to drive over a kerb or similar
the battery. Gases or battery acid can other- visible. If you notice unusual vibration or the
obstacle, drive very slowly and as near as
wise escape and possibly cause damage. car pulling to one side, this may indicate that
possible at a right angle to the obstacle.
one of the tyres is damaged. Reduce speed
● The battery holder and clamps must always
– Check from time to time if the tyres are immediately if there is any reason to suspect
be correctly secured.
damaged (punctures, cuts, cracks or that damage may have occurred. Inspect the

Operation
● Before starting any work on the battery, al- dents). Remove any foreign objects embed- tyres for damage. If no external damage is
ways observe the warnings listed under ded in the treads. visible, drive slowly and carefully to the near-
››› page 275, Important safety warnings for est specialised workshop and have the car
handling a vehicle battery. – Damaged wheels and tyres must be re-
placed immediately. inspected.
● Do not forget to replace the battery cover-
ings, where applicable. It is a protection for – Keep grease, oil and fuel off the tyres. Tyres with directional tread pattern

Emergencies
high temperatures. This in turn extends the
vehicle service life. – Replace any missing valve caps as soon as An arrow on the tyre sidewall indicates the di-
possible. rection of rotation on single drive tyres. Al-
– Mark the wheels before taking them off so
ways note the direction of rotation indicated
For the sake of the environment
that they rotate in the same direction when when mounting the wheel. This guarantees
 Batteries contain toxic substances includ- optimum grip and helps to avoid aquaplan-
ing sulphuric acid and lead. They must be put back.
ing, excessive noise and wear.
disposed of appropriately and must not be – When removed, the wheels or tyres should
disposed of with ordinary household waste.

Safety
be stored in a cool, dry and preferably dark Retrofitting accessories
Make sure disconnected batteries cannot tip place.
over. Sulphuric acid could be spilt! If you wish to change or fit wheels, rims or
New tyres wheel trims, we recommend that you consult
with a SEAT Official Service centre for advice
New tyres do not give maximum grip straight
regarding current techniques.
away and should therefore be “run in” by
277
Advice

Tyre useful life – In vehicles with a tyre pressure indicator, Do not forget the spare wheel when checking
save the modified tyre pressure the tyre pressures: Keep this spare wheel in-
››› page 281. flated to the highest pressure required for the
road wheels.
– Avoid fast cornering and hard acceleration.
In the case of a minimised temporary spare
– Inspect the tyres for irregular wear from
wheel (125/70 R16 or 125/70 R18) inflate to
time to time.
a pressure of 4.2 bar as indicated on the tyre
The useful life of your tyres depends on the pressure label on the fuel tank flap.
following factors:
Driving style
Tyre pressure Fast cornering, heavy acceleration and hard
Tyre pressure values are indicated on the braking (squealing tyres) all increase tyre
sticker on the inside of the fuel tank flap wear.
››› Fig. 250.
Wheel balance
Insufficient or excessive pressure greatly re-
duces the useful life of the tyres and adverse- The wheels on new vehicles are balanced.
ly affects vehicle performance and ride. Cor- However, certain circumstances may lead to
rect inflation pressures are very important, imbalance (run-out), which is detected as vi-
Fig. 250 Location of the tyre pressure sticker. brations in the steering wheel.
especially at high speeds.
Correct inflation pressures and sensible driv- Depending on the vehicle, tyre pressure can Unbalanced wheels should be rebalanced, as
ing habits will increase the useful life of your be adjusted to medium load to improve driv- they otherwise cause excessive wear on
tyres. ing comfort (tyre pressure ). When driving steering, suspension and tyres. A wheel must
with comfort tyre pressure fuel consumption also be rebalanced when a new tyre is fitted
– Check tyre pressure at least once a month,
may increase slightly. or if a tyre is repaired.
and also prior to any long trip.
– The tyre pressure should only be checked The tyre pressure must be adjusted according Incorrect wheel alignment
when the tyres are cold. Do not reduce the to the load the vehicle is carrying. If the vehi-
cle is going to carry the maximum load, the Incorrect running gear alignment causes ex-
pressure of warm tyres. cessive tyre wear, impairing the safety of the
tyre pressure should be increased to maxi-
– Adjust tyre pressure to the load being car- mum value indicated on the sticker on the in- vehicle. If you notice excessive tyre wear, you
ried by the vehicle. side of the fuel tank flap. should check wheel alignment at a SEAT Offi-
cial Service.

278
Wheels

WARNING The original tyres on your vehicle have Changing wheels

Technical data
1.6 mm high “tread wear indicators” running
● Always adapt the tyre pressure accordingly
across the tread. Depending on the manufac-
when the vehicle load changes.
turer, there will be 6 to 8 of them spaced at
● A tyre with low air pressure has to flex a lot equal distances around the tyre. Markings on
more when the vehicle is heavily loaded or at the tyre sidewall (for instance the letters
high speeds, therefore causing overheating “TWI” or a triangle) indicate the positions of
to occur. Under these conditions, the tyre
the tread wear indicators.
bead may be released or the tyre may burst.
Risk of accident!

Advice
The minimum tread depth required by law is
1.6 mm (measured in the tread grooves next
For the sake of the environment to the tread wear indicators). (Different fig-
ures may apply in other countries.)
Under-inflated tyres will increase fuel con- Fig. 252 Interchanging tyres.
sumption.
WARNING
To ensure that the wear is equal on all tyres

Operation
The tyres must be replaced at the latest when
the wheels should be changed round from
the tread is worn down to the tread wear indi-
Wear indicators cators. Failure to follow this instruction could
time to time according to the system
result in an accident. ››› Fig. 252. The useful life of all the tyres will
then be about the same time.
● Especially in difficult driving conditions
such as wet or icy roads. It is important that

Emergencies
the tyre tread be as deep as possible and be
approximately the same on the tyres of both New tyres or new wheels
the front and the rear axles.
● The scant driving safety due to insufficient – All four wheels must be fitted with tyres of
tread depth is particularly evident in vehicle the same type, size (rolling circumference)
handling, when there is a risk of “aquaplan- and preferably the same tread pattern.
ing” in deep puddles of water and when driv- – Tyres should be replaced at least in pairs
ing through corners, and braking is also ad- and not individually (i.e. both front tyres or

Safety
Fig. 251 Tyre tread: tread wear indicators versely affected.
both rear tyres together).
● The speed has to be adapted accordingly,
Tread wear indicators indicate if a tyre is otherwise there is a risk of losing control over – Do not use tyres whose effective size ex-
worn. the vehicle. ceeds the dimensions of the factory-ap-
proved makes of tyre. »
279
Advice

– If you wish to fit the vehicle with rims or 91 Load rating code sions will be correct for your vehicle. If you
tyres different to those installed in manu- decide to fit a different type of tyre, you must
facture, it is advisable to consult a SEAT Of- V Speed index obtain the appropriate manufacturer's certif-
ficial Service before purchasing them. icate from the tyre retailer to confirm that
The manufacturing date is also indicated on the tyres are suitable for your vehicle. Keep
The tyres and wheel rims are an essential the tyre sidewall (possibly only on the inner this certificate in a safe place.
part of the vehicle's design. The tyres and part):
rims approved by SEAT are specially matched Your SEAT Official Service will be able to ad-
DOT ... 2212 ... vise you on which tyres may be fitted to your
to the characteristics of the vehicle and make
a major contribution to good roadholding it means, for example, that the tyre was man- vehicle.
and safe handling ››› . ufactured in the 22nd week of 2012. It is best to have all servicing of wheels and
The sizes of the rims and tyres approved for But note that with some types of tyre, the ac- tyres performed by a specialised workshop.
your vehicle are listed in the vehicle docu- tual tyre size can differ from the nominal size They are familiar with the procedure and
mentation (e.g. EC Certificate of Conformity or marked on the tyre (for instance 205/55 R 16 have the necessary special tools and spare
COC document1)). The vehicle documentation 91 W), and there may be significant differen- parts as well as the proper facilities for dis-
varies depending on the country of resi- ces in the contours of the tyres, even though posing of the old tyres respecting the envi-
dence. the tyres are marked with the same nominal ronment.
size designation. When replacing the tyres,
A knowledge of tyre designations makes it WARNING
it is therefore important to make sure that
easier to choose the correct tyres. The follow-
the actual size of the new tyres does not ex- ● It is very important to ensure that the tyres
ing wording can be read on the sides of the
ceed the dimensions of the factory-approved you have chosen have adequate clearance.
tyre:
makes of tyre. When selecting replacement tyres, do not re-
205/55 R16 91V ly entirely on the nominal tyre size marked on
Failure to observe this requirement can af- the tyre, since the effective tyre size can dif-
This contains the following information: fect the clearance needed for the tyres. If the fer significantly depending on the manufac-
tyres rub against the bodywork, in certain turer. Inadequate tyre clearance can result in
205 Tyre width in mm circumstances the tyres, running gear or damage to the tyres or the vehicle, causing a
bodywork and pipes may be damaged, and serious safety risk. Risk of accident! It may
55 Height/width ratio in %
vehicle safety could be severely impaired also invalidate the vehicle's registration for
R Tyre construction: Radial ››› . use on public roads.

16 Rim diameter in inches If you use tyres that are approved by SEAT
you can be sure that the actual tyre dimen-

1) COC = certificate of conformity.


280
Wheels

● Avoid running the vehicle on tyres that are the right length and correctly shaped bolt ● Regularly check your tyres for damage and

Technical data
more than 6 years old. If you have no heads. This ensures that wheels are fitted se- wear.
alternative, you should drive slowly and with curely and that the brake system functions ● Never exceed the maximum permitted
extra care at all times. correctly. speed or loads specified for the type of tyre
● If wheel trims are fitted after the car is pur- The wheel bolts must be clean and turn easi- fitted on your vehicle.
chased, ensure that there is an adequate flow ly.
of air for cooling the brake system.
A special adapter is required to turn the anti- For the sake of the environment
theft wheel bolts* ›››  page 62. Under-inflated tyres lead to increased fuel

Advice
For the sake of the environment
consumption and tyre wear.
Old tyres must be disposed of according to
the laws in the country concerned.
Tyre monitoring systems Note
● Driving for the first time with new tyres at a
Note
Introduction high speed can cause them to slightly ex-

Operation
● A SEAT Service Centre should be consulted pand, which could then produce an air pres-
to find out whether wheels or tyres of differ- sure warning.
WARNING
ent sizes to those originally fitted by SEAT ● Only replace used tyres with those author-
can be fitted, and to find out about the com- Unsuitable handling of the wheels and tyres ised by SEAT for the corresponding type vehi-
binations allowed between the front axle may lead to sudden tyre pressure losses, to cle.
(axle 1) and the rear axle (axle 2). tread separation or even to a blow-out.
● Do not only rely on the tyre monitoring sys-

Emergencies
● Never mount used tyres if you are not sure ● Check tyre pressures regularly and ensure tem. Regularly check your tyres to ensure
of their “previous history”. they are maintained at the pressures indica- that the tyre pressure is correct and that the
● For technical reasons, it is not generally ted. Tyre pressure that is too low could cause tyres are not damaged due to puncture, cuts,
possible to use the wheels from other vehi- overheating, resulting in tread detachment or tears and impacts/dents. Remove objects
cles. In some cases, this may also be true for even burst tyres. from the tyres only when they have not
the same model of wheel. ● Tyre pressure should be that indicated on pierced the tyres.
the label when the tyres are cold at all times
››› page 289.

Safety
Wheel bolts ● Regularly check the cold inflation pressure
of the tyres. If necessary, change the tyre
The wheel bolts are matched to the rims. pressure of the vehicle tyres while they are
When installing different wheels (for instance cold.
alloy wheels or wheels with winter tyres) it is
important to use the correct wheel bolts with
281
Advice

Tyre monitoring control lamp control of the vehicle and a serious or fatal ● Tyre pressures which are too high or too
accident. low reduce the useful life of the tyre, affect-
If a light appears ● If the warning lamp  lights up, stop im- ing vehicle performance.
The pressure in one or more tyres has mediately and check the tyres. ● If a tyre has not been punctured and it does
clearly reduced in comparison to the ● If the tyres are inflated at different pres- not have to be changed immediately, drive to
 tyre pressure set by the driver or the sures or if a tyre pressure is too low, this will the nearest specialised workshop at a moder-
increase tyre wear, negatively affecting vehi- ate speed and have the tyre checked and in-
tyre has structural damage. flated to the correct pressure.
cle stability and increasing braking distan-
Additionally, an audible warning can be heard and a text ces.
message can be seen on the instrument panel display. ● If tyres are inflated at different pressures or WARNING
Stop! Reduce speed immediately! Stop the vehicle
a tyre pressure is too low, a tyre may be dam- Observe the safety warnings ››› in Warning
safely as soon as possible. Avoid sudden manoeuvres
and braking! Check all tyres and pressures. Replace any aged and burst resulting in a loss of control and control lamps on page 113.
damaged tyres. of the vehicle.
● The driver is responsible for ensuring that
all of the vehicle tyres are correctly inflated Note
If flashing
to the right pressure. The recommended tyre ● If excessively low tyre pressure is detected
 System malfunction pressure is indicated on the label with the ignition on, an audible warning will
››› page 289. sound. In the event that there is a fault in the
The control lamp flashes for approximately one minute ● The tyre monitoring system can only oper- system, an audible warning will sound.
and then lights up permanently.
ate correctly if all of the tyres are inflated to ● Driving on dirt tracks for a long period of
If tyre pressure is correct, switch the ignition off and on
again. If the control lamp remains lit up, the tyre moni- the correct pressure when cold. time or driving in a sporty style can tempora-
toring indicator can be calibrated. Have the system ● Driving with tyres at the wrong pressure rily deactivate the TPMS. The control lamp
checked by a specialised workshop. can damage them and result in an accident. shows a fault, but disappears when road con-
Ensure that the tyre pressures of all the tyres ditions or the driving style change.
Several warning and control lamps light up correspond to the vehicle load.
for a few seconds when the ignition is switch- ● Before starting a journey, always inflate
ed on while the function is verified. They will tyres to the correct pressure.
switch off after a few seconds. ● Tyres with insufficient pressure are subjec-
ted to more flexing. Due to this, the tyre
WARNING could become excessively hot, causing tread
When the tyres are inflated at different pres- separation and also tyre blow-out.
sures or at a pressure that is too low then a ● With an overloaded vehicle at high speed,
tyre may be damaged resulting in a loss of the tyres can overheat and burst resulting in
a loss of vehicle control.
282
Wheels

Tyre monitoring indicator ● Tyre pressure is manually changed Calibrating the tyre monitoring indica-

Technical data
● Tyre pressure is insufficient tor
● Tyre structure is damaged
● The vehicle is unbalanced because of a
load
● The wheels on an axle are subject to a
heavier load (e.g. with a heavy load).

Advice
● The vehicle is fitted with snow chains
● The temporary spare wheel is fitted
● The wheel on one axle is changed
Fig. 253 Instrument panel: warning of loss of
There may be a delay in the reaction of the
tyre pressure. Fig. 254 Glove compartment: tyre control
tyre  monitoring indicator or it may not in-

Operation
dicate anything under certain circumstances switch.
The tyre monitor indicator compares wheel
(e.g. sporty driving, snow-covered or un-
revolutions and, with this information, the After changing the tyre pressure or replacing
paved roads, or when driving with snow
tread of each wheel using the ABS sensors. If one or more wheels, the tyre monitoring indi-
chains).
the rolling circumference of one or more cator must be recalibrated. Do the same, for
wheels has changed, the tyre monitoring in- example, when the front and rear wheels are
dicator will indicate this on the instrument

Emergencies
swapped.
panel through a warning lamp and a warning
to the driver ››› Fig. 253. When only one spe- ● Switch the ignition on.
cific tyre is affected, its position within the ● Store the new tyre pressure in the Easy
vehicle will be indicated. Connect system with the  button and the
 Loss of pressure: Check left function button Setup ›››  page 30 or us-
tyre pressure! ing the switch located in the glove compart-
ment1) ››› Fig. 254.

Safety
Wheel tread change ● In vehicles without radio: press and hold
down the   button with the ignition on,
The wheel tread changes when:
until an acoustic signal is heard. »

1) In vehicles without the Infotainment system:


283
Advice

When driving, the system self-calibrates the Temporary spare wheel – Turn the thumb wheel anti-clockwise.
tyre pressure provided by the driver and the
– Take out the temporary spare wheel.
wheels fitted. After a long journey with varied
General information
speeds the programmed values are collected Chains
and monitored.
For technical reasons, snow chains must not
With the wheels under very heavy loads, the be used on the temporary spare wheel.
tyre pressure must be increased to the total
If you have a puncture on one of the front
recommended tyre pressure before the cali-
wheels when using snow chains, fit the tem-
bration ››› page 289.
porary spare wheel in place of one of the rear
wheels. Fit the snow chains on the rear wheel
Note
that you have removed and replace the punc-
● The tyre monitoring indicator does not tured front wheel with this wheel.
function when there is a fault in the ESC or
ABS ››› page 181. WARNING
● An erroneous indication may be given when Fig. 255 Compact temporary spare wheel:
● After fitting the temporary spare wheel,
snow chains are in use because they increase raised floor panel.
check the tyre pressures as soon as possible.
the tread of the wheel.
The temporary spare wheel has been de- Failure to do so may cause an accident. The
tyre pressures are listed on the inside of the
signed to be used for short periods of time.
fuel tank flap.
Have the tyres checked, and if necessary, re-
● Do not drive at over 80 km/h (50 mph)
placed as soon as possible at a SEAT Official
Service or at a specialised workshop. when the temporary spare wheel is fitted on
the vehicle: risk of accident!
Please note the following restrictions when ● Avoid heavy acceleration, hard braking and
using the compact temporary spare wheel. fast cornering: risk of accident!
The compact temporary spare wheel is de- ● Never use more than one temporary spare
signed specifically for this model. For this wheel at the same time, risk of accident.
reason, do not use a temporary spare wheel
● No other type of tyre (normal summer or
from a different type of vehicle.
winter tyre) may be fitted on the compact
temporary spare wheel rim.
Removing the temporary spare wheel
● If you are driving using the spare wheel,
– Lift and hold up the floor panel to remove the ACC system could automatically switch
the temporary spare wheel ››› Fig. 255. off during the journey. Switch off the system
when starting off.
284
Wheels

Extraction of the spare wheel in vehi- – Turn the securing wheel anti-clockwise 2 . – After fitting the wheels you must always

Technical data
cles with SEAT SOUND 10 speakers check the tyre pressures. When doing so,
– Remove the subwoofer speaker and the
(with subwoofer)* take into account the correct tyre pressures
spare wheel.
listed on the rear of the front left door
– When re-mounting the spare tyre, place the frame ››› page 278.
subwoofer on the base of the wheel rim
with care. When doing so, the tip of the In winter road conditions winter tyres will
“FRONT” arrow on the subwoofer should considerably improve vehicle handling. The
point forward. design of summer tyres (width, rubber com-

Advice
pound, tread pattern) gives less grip on ice
– Reconnect the speaker cable and firmly ro- and snow. This applies particularly to vehi-
tate the securing wheel clockwise so that cles equipped with wide section tyres or with
the subwoofer system and wheel are firmly high speed tyres (code letters H, V or Y on
in place. the sidewall).
Only use winter tyres of the correct type ap-

Operation
proved for your vehicle. The sizes of these
Fig. 256 In the luggage compartment: re- Winter service tyres are specified in the vehicle's docu-
move the subwoofer. ments (e.g. EC Certificate of Conformity or
Winter tyres COC1)). The vehicle documentation varies de-
To remove the spare wheel, you must first re- pending on the country of residence. See al-
move the subwoofer. – Winter tyres must be fitted on all four so ››› page 279.

Emergencies
wheels.
– Disassemble the subwoofer's floor panel Winter tyres lose a great deal of their proper-
(carpet) as follows: – Only use winter tyres that are approved for ties when the tread is worn down to a depth
your vehicle. of 4 mm.
– LEON/LEON SC model: first, pull the carpet
in the direction of the backrest and then – Please note that the maximum permissible The performance of winter tyres is also se-
pull it upwards to remove it. LEON ST mod- speed for winter tyres may be lower than verely impaired by ageing, even if the tread is
el: lift and secure the floor storage com- for summer tyres. still much deeper than 4 mm.

Safety
partment as explained in ››› page 164. – Also note that winter tyres are no longer ef- Winter tyres are subject to the following max-
– Disconnect the subwoofer’s speaker cable fective when the tread is worn down. imum speed limits according to speed rating
››› Fig. 256 1 . code letter: ››› »

1) COC = certificate of conformity.


285
Advice

Speed rating weights for your car and on the listed weight
code letter Maximum speed limit rating of the tyres being used.
››› page 279 It is best to contact a SEAT Official Service to
check the maximum speed which is permissi-
Q 160 km/h (100 mph)
ble for the V-rated tyres fitted on your car on
S 180 km/h (112 mph) the basis of this information.
T 190 km/h (118 mph)
WARNING
H 210 km/h (130 mph) Exceeding the maximum speed permitted for
240 km/h (149 mph) (please note
the winter tyres fitted on your car can cause
V tyre failure, resulting in a loss of control of
relevant restrictions)
the vehicle – risk of accident.
W 270 km/h (168 mph)

Y 300 km/h (186 mph) For the sake of the environment


Summer tyres should be fitted again as soon
Vehicles capable of exceeding these speeds as possible after the winter period; they give
must have an appropriate sticker attached so better handling on roads which are free of
that it is visible to the driver. Suitable stickers snow and ice. Summer tyres perform with
are available from the SEAT Official Service less rolling noise, tyre wear and – most im-
and specialised workshop. Please note the portant – reduce fuel consumption.
regulations to this effect in your country.
“All-weather” tyres can also be used instead
of winter tyres.
Using winter tyres with V-rating
Please note that the generally applicable
240 km/h (150 mph) speed rating for winter
tyres with the letter V is subject to technical
restrictions; the maximum permissible
speed for your vehicle may be significantly
lower. The maximum speed limit for these
tyres depends directly on the maximum axle

286
Technical specifications

Technical data Abbreviations used in the Technical Specifi-

Technical data
cations section
kW Kilowatt, engine power measurement.
Technical specifications
Pferdestärke (horsepower), formerly used
PS
to denote engine power.
Important
rpm Revolutions per minute - engine speed.
The information in the vehicle documentation
always takes precedence over the informa- Nm Newton metres, unit of engine torque.

Advice
tion in this Instruction Manual. Cetane number, indication of the diesel
CZ Fig. 258 Chassis number.
All technical specifications provided in this combustion power.
documentation are valid for the standard Research octane number, indication of
RON VIN in the Easy Connect
model in Spain. The vehicle data card inclu- the knock resistance of petrol.
ded in the Maintenance Programme or the ● Select:  button > SETTINGS function

Operation
vehicle registration documents shows which button > Service > Chassis number.
engine is installed in the vehicle.
Vehicle identification data Chassis number
The figures may be different depending
whether additional equipment is fitted, for The VIN is located in the Easy Connect, on the
different models, for special vehicles and for vehicle data sticker and under the wind-
other countries. screen, on the driver side ››› Fig. 258. Addi-

Emergencies
tionally, the chassis number is located in the
engine compartment, on the right-hand side.
The number is engraved on the top side rail,
and is partially covered.

Type plate
The type plate is located on the right side

Safety
door pillar. Vehicles for certain export coun-
tries do not have a type plate. »

Fig. 257 Vehicle data sticker (luggage com-


partment).
287
Technical data

Vehicle data sticker Information on fuel consump- Weights


The vehicle data sticker is under the carpet tion
trim in the luggage compartment, in the Kerb weight refers to the basic model with a
spare wheel well. A sticker with the vehicle fuel tank filled to 90% capacity and without
data is attached to the inside cover of the
Fuel consumption optional extras. The figure quoted includes
Maintenance Programme. 75 kg to allow for the weight of the driver.
Approved consumption values are derived
The following information is provided on the from measurements performed or supervised Special versions, optional equipment fittings
vehicle data sticker: ››› Fig. 257 by certified EU laboratories, according to the or retro-fitting accessories will increase the
legislation in force at the time (for more infor- weight of the vehicle ››› .
1 Vehicle identification number (chassis mation, see the Publications Office of the Eu-
number) ropean Union on the EUR-Lex website: © Eu- WARNING
2 Vehicle type, model, capacity, engine ropean Union, http://eur-lex.europa.eu/) and ● Please note that the centre of gravity may
type, finish, engine power and gearbox apply to the specified vehicle characteristics. shift when transporting heavy objects; this
type may affect vehicle handling and lead to an ac-
The values relating to fuel consumption and cident. Always adjust your speed and driving
3 Engine code, gearbox code, external CO2 emissions can be found in the documen- style to suit road conditions and require-
paint code and internal equipment code tation provided to the purchaser of the vehi- ments.
4 Optional extras and PR numbers cle at the time of purchase. ● Never exceed the gross axle weight rating
Fuel consumption and CO2 emissions depend or the gross vehicle weight rating. If the per-
Identifying letters on the equipment/features of each individual missible axle load or the permissible total
vehicle, as well as on the driving style, road weight is exceeded, the driving characteris-
The identifying letters of the engine can be
conditions, traffic conditions, environmental tics of the vehicle may change, which could
viewed on the instrument panel when the en-
lead to accidents, injuries and damage to the
gine is switched off and the ignition is on. conditions, load or number of passengers.
vehicle.
● Hold down the 0.0/SET 4 ››› Fig. 120 but- Note
ton for more than 15 seconds.
In practice, and considering all the factors
mentioned here, consumption values can dif-
fer from those calculated in the current Euro-
pean regulations.

288
Technical specifications

Trailer mode WARNING 195/65 R15 Chains with links of maximum 15 mm

Technical data
● For safety reasons, you should not drive at 205/55 R16 Chains with links of maximum 15 mm
Trailer weights speeds above 80 km/h (50 mph) when towing
a trailer. This also applies in countries where 205/50 R17 Chains with links of maximum 15 mm
Trailer weight higher speeds are permitted.
225/45 R17 Chains with links of maximum 9 mm
The trailer weights and drawbar loads ap- ● Never exceed the maximum trailer weights
proved are selected in intensive trials accord- or the drawbar load. If the permissible axle 225/40 R18 Chains with links of maximum 9 mm
ing to precisely defined criteria. The ap- load or the permissible total weight is excee-
225/35 R19 Chains with links of maximum 7 mm

Advice
proved trailer weights are valid for vehicles in ded, the driving characteristics of the vehicle
the EU for maximum speeds of 80 km/h (50 may change, leading to accidents, injuries 205/55 R17 Snow chains are not permitted
and damage to the vehicle.
mph) (in certain circumstances up to 100 225/45 R18 Snow chains are not permitted
km/h (62 mph)). The figures may be different
in other countries. All data in the official vehi-
cle documentation takes precedence over Wheel bolts
Wheels

Operation
these data at all times ››› . After the wheels have been changed, the
tightening torque of the wheel bolts should
Tyre pressure, snow chains, wheel be checked as soon as possible with a torque
Drawbar loads
bolts wrench ››› . The tightening torque for steel
The maximum permitted drawbar load on the
and alloy wheels is 120 Nm.
ball joint of the towing bracket must not ex- Tyre pressures
ceed 80 kg.

Emergencies
The sticker with the tyre pressure values can WARNING
In the interest of road safety, we recommend be found on the back of the left front door ● Check the tyre pressure at least once per
that you always tow approaching the maxi- frame. The tyre pressure values given there month. Checking the tyre pressure is very im-
mum drawbar load. The response of the trail- are for cold tyres. The slightly raised pres- portant. If the tyre pressure is too high or too
er on the road will be poor, if the drawbar sures of warm tyres must not be reduced. low, there is an increased danger of accidents
load is too small. ››› - particularly at high speeds.
If the maximum permissible drawbar load The pressure for winter tyres is 0.2 bar ● If the tightening torque of the wheel bolts

Safety
cannot be met (e.g. with small, empty and (2.9 psi / 20 kPa) higher than that of summer is too low, they could loosen while the vehi-
light-weight single axle trailers or tandem tyres. cle is in motion. Risk of accident! If the tight-
axle trailers with a wheelbase of less than 1 ening torque is too high, the wheel bolts and
metre), a minimum of 4% of the actual trailer Snow chains
threads can be damaged. »
weight is legally required for the drawbar
Snow chains may be fitted only to the front
load.
wheels, and only for the following tyres:
289
Technical data

Note
We recommend that you ask your Technical
Service for information about appropriate
wheel, tyre and snow chain size.

290
Technical specifications

Engine data

Technical data
Petrol engine 1.2 63 kW (86 PS)

Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
63 (86)/4,300-5,300 160/1,400-3,500 4/1,197 Super 95 RON/Normal 91 RONa)
a) Slight power loss.

Advice
Outputs and weights LEON LEON SC LEON ST
Top speed (km/h) 178 (V) 178 (V) 178 (V)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 7.6 7.5 7.8

Operation
Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 11.9 11.8 12.1

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,700 1,700 1,800

Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,188 1,168 1,233

Maximum authorised weight on front axle (kg) 890 880 870

Emergencies
Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 860 870 980

Permitted roof load (kg) 75 75 75

Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) 590 580 610

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% (kg) 1,300 1,300 1,300

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% (kg) 1,100 1,100 1,100

Safety
291
Technical data

Petrol engine 1.2 TSI 81 kW (110 PS)

Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
81 (110)/4,600-5,600 175/1,400-4,000 4/1,197 Super 95 RON/Normal 91 RONa)
a) Slight power loss.

LEON LEON LEON LEON SC LEON SC LEON ST LEON ST LEON ST


Outputs and weights
Manual Start-Stop Automatic Manual Start-Stop Manual Start-Stop Automatic
Top speed (km/h) 194 (V) 194 (V) 194 (V) 194 (V) 194 (V) 194 (V) 194 (V) 194 (V)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 6.6 6.6 6.6 6.7 6.5 6.7 6.7 6.7

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 9.9 9.9 9.9 10.1 9.8 10.1 10.1 10.1

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,740 1,740 1,760 1,720 1,730 1,790 1,800 1,820

Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,213 1,213 1,241 1,186 1,193 1,240 1,247 1,275

Maximum authorised weight on front axle


900 900 930 890 890 880 890 910
(kg)

Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 890 890 880 880 890 960 960 960

Permitted roof load (kg) 75 75 75 75 75 75 75 75

Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) 600 600 620 590 590 620 620 630

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to


1,500 1,500 1,500 1,500 1,500 1,500 1,500 1,500
8% (kg)

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to


1,300 1,300 1,300 1,300 1,300 1,300 1,300 1,300
12% (kg)

292
Technical specifications

Petrol engine 1.6 MPI 81 kW (110 PS)

Technical data
Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
81 (110)/5,800 155/3,800-4,000 4/1,598 Super 95 RON/Normal 91 RONa)
a) Slight power loss.

LEON LEON LEON SC LEON SC LEON ST LEON ST


Outputs and weights
manual automatic manual automatic manual automatic

Advice
Top speed (km/h) 189 (IV) 185 (V) 189 (V) 185 (V) 189 (V) 185 (V)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 6.7 7.4 6.6 7.5 6.9 7.6

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 10.5 11.4 10.4 11.6 10.8 11.8

Operation
Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,740 1,770 1,710 1,730 1,790 1,830

Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,192 1,230 1,175 1,210 1,228 1,275

Maximum authorised weight on front axle (kg) 880 920 880 910 870 910

Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 910 900 880 870 970 970

Emergencies
Permitted roof load (kg) 75 75 75 75 75 75

Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) 590 610 580 600 610 630

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% (kg) 1,400 1,400 1,400 1,400 1,400 1,400

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% (kg) 1,200 1,200 1,200 1,200 1,200 1,200

Safety
293
Technical data

Petrol engine 1.0 TSI 85 kW (115 PS)

Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
85 (115)/5,000-5,500 200/2,000-3,500 3/999 Super 95 RON/Normal 91 RONa)
a) Slight power loss.

LEON LEON LEON SC LEON SC LEON ST LEON ST


Outputs and weights
manual automatic manual automatic manual automatic
Top speed (km/h) 202 202 202 202 202 202

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 6.6 6.6 6.5 6.5 6.8 6.8

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 9.6 9.6 9.5 9.5 9.8 9.8

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,720 1,740 1,710 1,740 1,770 1,800

Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,202 1,225 1,180 1,203 1,236 1,259

Maximum authorised weight on front axle (kg) 890 910 880 900 870 900

Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 880 880 880 890 950 950

Permitted roof load (kg) 75 75 75 75 75 75

Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) 600 610 590 600 610 620

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% (kg) 1,300 1,300 1,300 1,300 1,300 1,300

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% (kg) 1,000 1,000 1,000 1,000 1,000 1,000

294
Technical specifications

Petrol engine 1.4 92 kW (125 PS) Start-Stop

Technical data
Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
92 (125)/5,000-6,000 200/1,400-4,000 4/1,395 Super 95 RON/Normal 91 RONa)
a) Slight power loss.

LEON ST
Outputs and weights LEON LEON SC LEON ST
X-PERIENCE

Advice
Top speed (km/h) 203 (V&VI) 203 (V&VI) 203 (V&VI) 200 (V&VI)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 6.2 6.1 6.4 6.6

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 9.1 8.9 9.4 9.7

Operation
Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,770 1,750 1,830 1,820

Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,233 1,213 1,257 1,263

Maximum authorised weight on front axle (kg) 920 910 900 890

Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 900 890 980 980

Emergencies
Permitted roof load (kg) 75 75 75 75

Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) 610 600 620 630

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% (kg) 1,700 1,700 1,700 1,700

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% (kg) 1,400 1,400 1,400 1,400

Safety
295
Technical data

Petrol engine 1.4 TSI 110 kW (150 PS) ACT®

Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
110 (150)/5,000-6,000 250/1,500-3,500 4/1,395 Super 95 RON/Normal 91 RONa)
a) Slight power loss.

LEON LEON LEON SC LEON SC LEON ST LEON ST


Outputs and weights
manual automatic manual automatic manual automatic
Top speed (km/h) 215 (V&VI) 215 (V&VI) 215 (V&VI) 215 (V&VI) 215 (V&VI) 215 (V&VI)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 5.6 5.6 5.5 5.5 5.8 5.8

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 8 8 7.9 7.9 8.2 8.2

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,770 1,790 1,750 1,770 1,840 1,860

Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,241 1,263 1,223 1,243 1,277 1,297

Maximum authorised weight on front axle (kg) 930 950 910 930 910 930

Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 890 890 890 890 980 980

Permitted roof load (kg) 75 75 75 75 75 75

Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) 620 630 610 620 630 640

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% (kg) 1,700 1,700 1,700 1,700 1,700 1,700

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% (kg) 1,500 1,500 1,500 1,500 1,500 1,500

296
Technical specifications

Petrol engine 1.4 TSI 110 kW (150 PS)

Technical data
Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
110 (150)/5,000-6,000 250/1,500-3,500 4/1,395 Super 95 RON/Normal 91 RONa)
a) Slight power loss.

LEON LEON LEON SC LEON SC LEON ST


Outputs and weights
manual automatic manual automatic automatic

Advice
Top speed (km/h) 215 (V&VI) 215 (V&VI) 215 (V&VI) 215 (V&VI) 215 (V&VI)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 5.6 5.6 5.5 5.5 5.8

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 8 8 7.9 7.9 8.2

Operation
Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,770 1,790 1,750 1,760 1,850

Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,241 1,263 1,223 1,238 1,297

Maximum authorised weight on front axle (kg) 930 950 910 930 930

Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 890 890 890 880 970

Emergencies
Permitted roof load (kg) 75 75 75 75 75

Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) 620 630 610 610 640

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% (kg) 1,700 1,700 1,700 1,700 1,700

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% (kg) 1,500 1,500 1,500 1,500 1,500

Safety
297
Technical data

Petrol engine 1.8 132 kW (180 PS) Start-Stop

Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
132 (180)/5,100-6,200 250/1,250-5,000 4/1,798 Super 95 RON/Normal 91 RONa)
a) Slight power loss.

LEON LEON SC
LEON LEON LEON SC LEON SC LEON ST LEON ST
Outputs and weights Without Without
Manual Automatic Manual Automatic Manual Automatic
Start-Stop Start-Stop
Top speed (km/h) 226 (VI) 224 (VI) 224 (VI) 226 (VI) 224 (VI) 224 (VI) 226 (VI) 224 (VI)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 5.5 5.3 5.3 5.4 5.2 5.2 5.7 5.6

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 7.5 7.2 7.2 7.4 7.1 7.1 7.8 7.7

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,830 1,850 1,850 1,830 1,840 1,840 1,900 1,890

Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,310 1,327 1,322 1,290 1,307 1,302 1,355 1,372

Maximum authorised weight on front axle (kg) 970 990 980 960 980 970 960 980

Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 910 910 920 920 910 920 990 960

Permitted roof load (kg) 75 75 75 75 75 75 75 75

Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) 650 660 660 640 650 650 670 680

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to


1,800 1,800 1,800 1,800 1,800 1,800 1,800 1,800
8% (kg)

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to


1,500 1,500 1,500 1,500 1,500 1,500 1,500 1,500
12% (kg)

298
Technical specifications

Petrol engine 1.8 TSI 132 kW (180 PS) All-wheel drive

Technical data
Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
132 (180)/4,500-6,200 280/1,350-4,500 4/1,798 Super 95 RON/Normal 91 RONa)
a) Slight power loss.

LEON ST
Outputs and weights
X-PERIENCE 4WD

Advice
Top speed (km/h) 221 (V&VI)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 4.9

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 7.2

Operation
Maximum authorised weight (kg) 2,000

Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,486

Maximum authorised weight on front axle (kg) 1,000

Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 1,050

Emergencies
Permitted roof load (kg) 75

Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) 740

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% (kg) 1,700

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% (kg) 1,500

Safety
299
Technical data

Petrol engine 2.0 213 kW (290 PS)

Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
213 (290)/5,900-6,400 350/1,700-5,800 4/1,984 Super 98 RON/Super 95 RONa)
a) Slight power loss.

Outputs and weights LEON LEON SC LEON ST


automatic automatic automatic
Top speed (km/h) 250 (VI) 250 (VI) 250 (VI)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 4.4 4.2 4.4

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 5.7 5.6 5.9

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,910 1,890 2,010

Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,421 1,395 1,466

Maximum authorised weight on front axle (kg) 1,050 1,020 1,020

Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 910 920 1,040

Permitted roof load (kg) 75 75 75

Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) – – –

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% (kg) – – –

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% (kg) – – –

300
Technical specifications

Petrol engine 2.0 221 kW (300 PS)

Technical data
Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
221 (300)/5,500-6,200 380/1,800-5,500 4/1,984 Super 98 RON/Super 95 RONa)
a) Slight power loss.

Outputs and weights LEON LEON LEON SC LEON SC LEON ST LEON ST LEON ST
manual automatic manual automatic manual automatic Automatic

Advice
all-wheel
drive
Top speed (km/h) 250 (VI) 250 (VI) 250 (VI) 250 (VI) 250 (VI) 250 (VI) 250 (VI)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 4.7 4.4 4.5 4.2 4.7 4.4 3.5

Operation
Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 5.8 5.7 5.7 5.6 6.0 5.9 4.9

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,890 1,910 1,870 1,890 1,980 2,000 2,040

Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,395 1,421 1,375 1,395 1,440 1,466 1,545

Maximum authorised weight on front axle (kg) 1,020 1,050 1,000 1,020 990 1,020 1,040

Emergencies
Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 920 910 920 920 1,040 1,030 1,050

Permitted roof load (kg) 75 75 75 75 75 75 75

Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) – – – – – – –

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% (kg) – – – – – – –

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% (kg) – – – – – – –

Safety
301
Technical data

Petrol/CNG engine 1.4 TSI 81 kW (110 PS)

Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
Super 95 RON/Nor-
81 (110)/4,800-6,000 200/1,500-3,500 4/1,395 CNG
mal 91 RONa)
a) Slight power loss.

Outputs and weights LEON LEON LEON ST LEON ST


manual automatic manual automatic
Top speed (km/h) 194 (V) 194 (VII) 194 (VI) 194 (VII)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 7.1 7.1 7.3 7.3

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 10.9 10.9 11 11

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,840 1,870 1,870 1,900

Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,359 1,388 1,395 1,421

Maximum authorised weight on front axle (kg) 920 950 870 900

Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 970 970 1,050 1,050

Permitted roof load (kg) 75 75 75 75

Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) 670 690 690 710

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% (kg) 1,700 1,700 1,700 1,700

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% (kg) 1,400 1,400 1,400 1,400

302
Technical specifications

Diesel engine 1.6 66 kW (90 PS)

Technical data
Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
Diesel according to standard EN 590, min.
66 (90)/2,750-4,800 230/1,400-2,750 4/1,598
51 CN

Outputs and weights LEON LEON SC LEON ST

Advice
Top speed (km/h) 180 (IV) 180 (V) 180 (V)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 8.2 8.0 8.5

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 12.6 12.4 13.0

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,780 1,760 1,860

Operation
Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,260 1,240 1,305

Maximum authorised weight on front axle (kg) 960 960 950

Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 870 850 960

Permitted roof load (kg) 75 75 75

Emergencies
Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) 630 620 650

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% (kg) 1,700 1,700 1,800

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% (kg) 1,400 1,400 1,500

Safety
303
Technical data

Diesel engine 1.6 77 kW (105 PS)

Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
Diesel according to standard EN 590, min.
77 (105)/3,000-4,000 250/1,500-2,750 4/1,598
51 CN

LEON LEON LEON ST LEON ST


Outputs and weights
Manual Automatic Manual Automatic
Top speed (km/h) 191 (V) 191 (VI) 191 (V) 191 (VI)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 7.3 7.3 7.5 7.4

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 10.7 10.7 11.1 11.0

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,800 1,820 1,880 1,910

Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,281 1,306 1,326 1,351

Maximum authorised weight on front axle (kg) 980 1,000 960 990

Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 870 870 970 970

Permitted roof load (kg) 75 75 75 75

Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) 640 650 660 670

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% (kg) 1,800 1,800 1,800 1,800

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% (kg) 1,500 1,500 1,500 1,500

304
Technical specifications

Diesel engine 2.0 TDI CR 81 kW (110 PS)

Technical data
Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
Diesel according to standard EN 590, min.
81 (110)/3,250-4,500 250/1,500-3,000 4/1,968
51 CN

Outputs and weights LEON ST

Advice
Top speed (km/h) 189 (V)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 7.1

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 10.7

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,910

Operation
Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,358

Maximum authorised weight on front axle (kg) 990

Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 970

Permitted roof load (kg) 75

Emergencies
Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) 670

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% (kg) 1,800

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% (kg) 1,500

Safety
305
Technical data

Diesel engine 1.6 85 kW (115 PS)

Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
Diesel according to standard EN 590, min.
85 (115)/3,250-4,000 250/1,500-3,250 4/1,598
51 CN

LEON ST
LEON LEON LEON SC LEON SC LEON ST LEON ST
Outputs and weights X-PERIENCE
manual automatic manual automatic manual automatic
manual
Top speed (km/h) 197 (V) 197 (VII) 197 (V) 197 (VII) 197 (V) 197 (VII) 193 (V)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 6.8 6.8 6.5 6.8 6.8 6.9 6.5

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 9.8 9.8 9.5 9.9 9.9 10.0 9.5

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,810 1,830 1,750 1,770 1,870 1,890 1,890

Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,260 1,280 1,240 1,261 1,305 1,326 1,331

Maximum authorised weight on front axle (kg) 960 980 960 980 950 970 950

Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 900 900 840 840 970 970 990

Permitted roof load (kg) 75 75 75 75 75 75 75

Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) 630 640 620 630 650 660 660

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% (kg) 1,800 1,800 1,800 1,800 1,800 1,800 1,800

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% (kg) 1,500 1,500 1,500 1,500 1,500 1,500 1,500

306
Technical specifications

Diesel engine 2.0 TDI CR 105 kW (143 PS)

Technical data
Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
Diesel according to standard EN 590, min.
105 (143)/3,500-4,000 320/1,750-3,000 4/1,968
51 CN

Outputs and weights LEON LEON SC

Advice
Top speed (km/h) 211 (V) 211 (V)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 6.2 6.1

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 8.7 8.6

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,830 1,800

Operation
Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,301 1,281

Maximum authorised weight on front axle (kg) 990 990

Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 890 860

Permitted roof load (kg) 75 75

Emergencies
Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) 650 640

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% (kg) 1,800 1,800

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% (kg) 1,600 1,600

Safety
307
Technical data

Diesel engine 2.0 110 kW (150 PS)

Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
Diesel according to standard EN 590, min.
110 (150)/3,500-4,000 340/1,750-3,000 4/1,968
51 CN

LEON ST
LEON LEON LEON SC LEON SC LEON ST LEON ST LEON ST LEON ST
X-PERIENCE
Outputs and weights Start- Automat- Start- Automat- Start- Automat- All-wheel X-PERIENCE
4WD
Stop ic Stop ic Stop ic drive 4WD
automatic
Top speed (km/h) 215 (VI) 211 (VI) 215 (VI) 211 (VI) 215 (VI) 213 (VI) 211 (VI) 208 (VI) 205 (VI)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 6.1 6.0 6.0 6.0 6.2 6.2 6.3 6.3 5.8

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (sec-


8.4 8.4 8.3 8.3 8.6 8.6 8.7 8.7 8.9
onds)

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,820 1,850 1,810 1,810 1,910 1,940 2,010 2,010 2,040

Weight in running order (with driver)


1,305 1,335 1,285 1,305 1,358 1,388 1,474 1,491 1,519
(kg)

Maximum authorised weight on front


1,000 1,030 990 1,010 990 1,020 1,010 1,010 1,040
axle (kg)

Maximum authorised weight on rear


870 870 870 850 970 970 1,050 1,050 1,050
axle (kg)

Permitted roof load (kg) 75 75 75 75 75 75 75 75 75

Maximum trailer weight without brakes


650 660 640 650 670 690 730 740 750
(kg)

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients


1,800 1,800 1,800 1,800 1,800 1,800 1,900 2,000 2,000
up to 8% (kg)

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients


1,600 1,600 1,600 1,600 1,600 1,600 1,700 2,000 2,000
up to 12% (kg)
308
Technical specifications

Diesel engine 2.0 130 kW (177 PS)

Technical data
Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
Diesel according to standard EN 590, min.
130 (177)/3,600-4,000 350/1,750-3,000 4/1,968
51 CN

Outputs and weights LEON LEON SC

Advice
Top speed (km/h) 223 (VI) 223 (VI)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 5.9 5.8

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 7.8 7.6

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,880 1,860

Operation
Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,365 1,345

Maximum authorised weight on front axle (kg) 1,020 1,010

Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 910 900

Permitted roof load (kg) 75 75

Emergencies
Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) 680 670

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% (kg) 1,800 1,800

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% (kg) 1,600 1,600

Safety
309
Technical data

Diesel engine 2.0 135 kW (184 PS)

Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm3) Fuel
Diesel according to standard EN 590, min.
135 (184)/3,500-4,000 380/1,750-3,000 4/1,968
51 CN

Outputs and weights LEON LEON LEON SC LEON SC LEON ST LEON ST LEON ST
Start-Stop Automatic Start-Stop Automatic Start-Stop Automatic X-PERIENCE
4WD
Top speed (km/h) 228 (VI) 226 (VI) 228 (VI) 226 (VI) 228 (VI) 226 (VI) 224 (VI)

Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 5.7 5.7 5.6 5.6 5.9 5.9 4.9

Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 7.5 7.5 7.4 7.4 7.8 7.8 7.1

Maximum authorised weight (kg) 1,880 1,900 1,860 1,890 1,970 1,990 2,050

Weight in running order (with driver) (kg) 1,370 1,390 1,350 1,370 1,415 1,435 1,529

Maximum authorised weight on front axle (kg) 1,020 1,040 1,010 1,030 1,010 1,030 1,050

Maximum authorised weight on rear axle (kg) 910 910 900 910 1,010 1,010 1,050

Permitted roof load (kg) 75 75 75 75 75 75 75

Maximum trailer weight without brakes (kg) 680 690 670 680 700 710 750

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to


1,800 1,800 1,800 1,800 1,800 1,800 2,000
8% (kg)

Weight of trailer with brakes, gradients up to


1,600 1,600 1,600 1,600 1,600 1,600 2,000
12% (kg)

310
Technical specifications

Dimensions

Technical data
Advice
Fig. 259 Dimensions.

Operation
LEON LEON SC LEON ST LEON ST X-PERIENCE
A/B Front and rear projection (mm) 861/785 861/785 861/1,052 861/1,060

C Wheelbase (mm) 2,636 2,601 2,636 2,630

Emergencies
D Length (mm) 4,282 4,247 4,549 4,551

1,533/1,504 1,541/1,504
E/F Front/reara) track width (mm)
1,549/1,520 1,547/1,510

G Width (mm) 1,816 1,810 1,816 1,816

H Height at kerb weight (mm) 1,459 1,446 1,454b) 1,481b)

Safety
Turning radius (m) 10.9
a) This data will change depending on the type of wheel rim.
b) Dimension to the roof bars.

311
Index

Index Airbag system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19, 80


activation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Auto Hold function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
cruise control system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
deactivation of front airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84 Emergency Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
A description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 Front Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
ABS front airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19, 82 parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232, 233
see Anti-lock brake system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 functioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 pedestrian monitoring system . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
ACC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201 head-protection airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 traffic jam assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
radar sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 knee airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 traffic sign detection system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154, 251 side airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 tyre monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
Adaptive cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201 Air conditioning tyre monitoring indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
function for preventing overtaking in an inside Climatronic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48, 167 Assistance Systems
lane . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209 heating and fresh air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 fatigue detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
indications on the display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 manual air conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 tyre monitoring systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
malfunction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202 user instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 Assisted starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
radar sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 Air outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 Audible signal
special driving situations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210 Air recirculation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170 lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
warning and control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 Alcantara: cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258 Audible warning signal
Adaptive Cruise Control Anchoring seat belt not fastened . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
deactivating temporarily . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209 the front tow line. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 warning and control lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
operating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205 Anti-freeze . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 Auto Hold function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
Additional electrical appliances (efficiency pro- Anti-lock brake system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 Auto Lock (central locking) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
gramme) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 Anti-puncture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60, 90 Automatic car washes
Adjusting Anti-puncture kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60, 90 switching the Auto Hold function off . . . . . . . . 200
front head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 check after 10 minutes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92 Automatic dipped beam control . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
front seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147 Anti-theft alarm system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 Automatic gear
lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 safety interlock for ignition key . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
Adjusting the head restraints vehicle interior monitoring and anti-tow sys- Automatic gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
front head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 tem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130 backup programme . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Adjustment see also Anti-theft alarm system . . . . . . . . . . . 120 downhill speed control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
CAR menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Anti-theft security system . . . . . . . . . . 13, 120, 126 driving tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
front head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 Anti-tow protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130 kick-down feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
rear head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73, 148 Aspects to take into account before starting the launch control programme . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 manual release of selector lever . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Airbag covers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 ASR selector lever lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
Airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 see Traction control system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 selector lever positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 Assistance systems steering wheel with gearshift paddles . . . . . . 187
ACC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201 tiptronic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185, 187
adaptive cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
313
Index

AUX-IN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 Central locking Checking levels


anti-theft alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 engine compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268
B central locking switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Child-proof locking
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 electric windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 electric windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Before starting the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 Keyless Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Child seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22, 88
Belt tightening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 manual locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 categorisation in groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Bench seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 ISOFIX system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Biodiesel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 remote control key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22, 87
Bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15, 268 selective unlocking system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 securing with seat belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
opening the bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 sliding/tilting sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 Top Tether system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 26
Brake assist system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 Central locking system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 City Emergency braking function . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 Centre console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179 Cetane number (diesel fuel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 alcantara . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273 Changing carbon parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
brake servo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179 parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251 Easy Connect control panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
electronic parking brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 Changing a wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 exhaust pipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
emergency braking function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178 subsequent work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 fabrics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
new brake pads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179 Changing bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 leather . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
Braking fog light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 natural leather . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
brake assist system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 number plate light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105 plastic parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255, 256
moving off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 rear bulb in the side panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 radio display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
rear bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
C Changing gear trims . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
engaging gears (manual gearbox) . . . . . . . . . 184 washing the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
Camera
Changing main headlight wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
turn signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
cleanliness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228
Changing settings Climatronic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Lane Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
CAR menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Close . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Changing the blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92 Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
fuel tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Changing the main beam headlight bulb bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
natural gas tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263
main beam headlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 panoramic sliding sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
windscreen washer water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
Changing the main headlight bulb windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Car-care products . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
day light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 Clutch (warning lamp) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Catalytic converter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
dipped headlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 Coming Home . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
malfunction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
Changing the wiper blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 Connectivity Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
CCS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
Charging the battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
CD-ROM player (navigation) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153

314
Index

Control and warning lamps placing in standby position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242 Driver information system
diesel particulate filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194 removing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244, 245 CD/radio indication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
emission control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195 standby position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242 engine oil temperature display . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Controls and displays Diesel operation with the windscreen wiper lever . . . . 33
general instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 diesel particulate filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194 Driving
Controls on the steering wheel engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270 driving abroad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
operating the audio system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 preheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 with a trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241, 246, 248, 249
operating the telephone and audio system . . 117 refuelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 Driving abroad
Convenience closing Diesel particulate filter headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
panoramic sliding sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 malfunction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194 Driving data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Convenience opening Digital clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 data summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
panoramic sliding sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311 memories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Cooling system Direction of rotation Driving mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225, 226
checking coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272 tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 Driving profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225, 226
checking level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272 Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108, 109 Driving safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
coolant temperature gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Display of traffic signs on the instrument panel Driving through water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
topping up coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272 activate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229 DSG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Cornering deactivate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229 Duplicate keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138 Disposal Dust and pollen filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Correct position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 seat belt tensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 Dynamic lights range control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Correct sitting position Distance control
front passenger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 see Adaptive cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201 E
rear seat passengers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 Door cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 E10
Cruise control system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42, 200 Door handle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 see Ethanol (fuel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264
operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201 Door lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Easy Connect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30, 114
warning and indication lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 Door release lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 Economical
Doors driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
D childproof locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128 Efficiency programme
Dangers in not using the seat belt . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 opening and closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 additional electrical appliances . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Dash panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 Downhill speed control function . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190 saving tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Data sticker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287 Drawer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 Electrical accessories
Deactivating the front passenger front airbag 20, 84 Drink holders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 see Power socket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
Defective bulbs Driver Electrical socket
changing a bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 see Correct sitting position . . . . . . . . . 70, 71, 72 trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
Detachable ball Driver-side general instrument panel Electric windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16, 131
assembling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 left-hand drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 convenience opening and closing . . . . . . . . . 132
checking attachment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244 right-hand drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8

315
Index

Electromechanical steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259 running-in . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192 oil properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55


lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259 Start-Stop system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196 specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
Electronic differential lock (EDL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 temperature display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Electronic immobiliser . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 starting up (driver messages with the mechan- topping up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271
Electronic self-locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 ical contact) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 Environment
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 switching off (key) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 ecological driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
Electronic torque management (XDS) . . . . . . . . . 181 Engine and ignition environmental compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 automatic ignition switch-off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 Environmental tips
anti-puncture kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 My Beat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176 filling the tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263
automatic gearbox backup programme . . . . . 191 preheating the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175 refuelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175 Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154, 251
changing a wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 starting the engine with Press & Drive . . . . . . 175 ESC
emergency towing of the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 stopping the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176 electronic stability control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Engine compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15, 268 multi-collision brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
hazard warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56, 275 Sport Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
jump leads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56, 273 Ethanol (fuel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264
manual unlocking and locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92 closing the bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 Event Data Recorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
puncture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55, 272 Exhaust gas purification system
replacing a blown fuse . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54, 271 catalytic converter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
replacing the battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276 opening the bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 diesel particulate filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
vehicle tool kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 safety notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268 Exhaust pipe: Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
Emergency Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 windscreen washer reservoir . . . . . . . . . . 56, 274 Extending
see Emergency Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 Engine coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 the luggage compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223 G 12 plus-plus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 Exterior lighting
switching on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223 G 13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 changing a bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Emergency braking function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178 specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 Exterior mirrors
Emergency braking warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 Engine data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291 adjusting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Emergency operation Engine fault Exterior rear view mirrors
passenger door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195 exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
selector lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 Engine management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194 heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
Emission control system control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195 Exterior view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5, 6
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195 Engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54, 270 External aerial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251
Emissions data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287 changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270, 272
Engine checking oil level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271 F
assisted starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271 Fastening rings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
noises . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176 dipstick . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271 Fatigue detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
preheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 inspection service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270 Filling the tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
maintenance intervals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
316
Index

Floor mats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 Full-LED Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 Head-protection airbags


Fluid Level control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 Function Coming Home . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138 description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Fog light bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 Function Leaving Home . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Folding table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58, 96 Headlights
Four-wheel drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260 fuse box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 changing a bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
snow chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260 identifying blown fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 driving abroad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
winter tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260 identifying by colours . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 headlight washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Front airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19, 82 preparation before replacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Front armrest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 replacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
Front Assist monitoring system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212 front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
City Emergency braking function . . . . . . . . . . . 216 G front head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
malfunction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213 Gear-change indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 rear head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
on-screen messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213 Gearbox DSG Heated rear window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49, 51
operating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214 see Automatic gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185 Heating and fresh air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
radar sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213 Gearbox lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Hill driving assistant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
switching off temporarily . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 Gear change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
system limitations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 How to jump start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Front passenger front airbag Kick-down . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85 manual gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
deactivation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20, 85 manual gear change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 I
Front seat Gear engaged . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Identifying letters on engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
manual adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 Gear recommendation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 Ignition lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27, 171
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53, 264 Gearshift paddles (automatic gearbox) . . . . . . . 187 see Starter button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288 General instrument panel Incorrect sitting position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
diesel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 control lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 Indications on display
ethanol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 controls and displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107 traffic signs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 engine compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268 Indications on the display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
natural gas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266 warning lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 ACT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
refuelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 Glove compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 adaptive cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
saving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193 assist systems submenu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Fuel consumption H compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
switching off using inertia . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193 distance travelled . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Handbrake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
why does fuel consumption increase? . . . . . . 194 doors, bonnet and rear lid open . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
see Parking brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
Fuel tank cap driver information system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
warning lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
opening and closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 driving data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Hazard warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28, 140
Fuel tank flap ECO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
Head-on collisions and the laws of physics . . . . . 77
opening and closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
317
Index

MKB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 Keyless-Entry Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27, 135


outside temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 see Keyless Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 audible signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
recommended gear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 Keyless-Exit AUTO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
second speed display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 see Keyless Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 changing a bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
selector lever positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110, 185 Keyless Access coming home . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
service intervals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 Keyless-Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 cornering lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
speed warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 Keyless-Exit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 daytime running lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Start-Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 Press & Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 dipped beam headlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 special characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 fog light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
tyre monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283 starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175 hazard warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
warning and control lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 unlocking and locking the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . 124 interior lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
warning and information messages . . . . . . . . . 38 Keyless Access locking and ignition system leaving home . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Indications on the screen see Keyless Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 light control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
SEAT Drive Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224 Keys lighting of instruments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Inertia mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190 assign key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 lighting of the controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Infotainment system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 car key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 lights range control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Inspection service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270 driver messages (mechanical contact) . . . . . . 172 main beam lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Instrument cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 main beam lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 replacing the battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 main beams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108, 109 spare key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 motorway light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
instruments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 synchronising . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 parking lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 unlocking and locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13, 122 reading lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Kick-down side lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
service interval indication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 automatic gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
warning and control lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 manual gear change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 turn signal lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Interior lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Knee airbags Lights range control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Interior view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 safety information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Load compartment in the luggage compartment
ISOFIX system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 26 see Loading the luggage compartment . . . . . 155
L Loading the luggage compartment . . . . . . . . . . . 155
J Lane Assist system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218 Loading the vehicle
Jack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61, 90 cleaning the camera area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254 fastening rings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
mounting points . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Launch control programme (automatic gearbox) 189 luggage compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Jump leads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 Leather: care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257 roof carrier system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Leaving Home . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 tailboard for transporting long items . . . . . . . 160
K Lifting the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Locking and unlocking
Light Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 in the door cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Key-operated switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Lighting of the instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
318
Index

with Keyless Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Mobile telephones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251 Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111


with the central locking switch . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Model plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287 partial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Luggage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 Modifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251 reset button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Luggage compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Moving off total . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
automatic lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130 hill driving assistant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 Oil change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
luggage compartment lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 Multi-collision Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182 Oil properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
luggage compartment variable floor . . . 163, 164 Multimedia . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 On-screen messages
net bag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 My Beat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176 Front Assist monitoring system . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
net partition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158, 159 One-touch opening and closing
rear shelf . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 N electric windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
retractable rear shelf . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 Natural gas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266 Open and close . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
storing the rear shelf . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157, 158 fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 panoramic sliding sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
unlocking manually . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 fuel tank cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263 Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
see also Loading the luggage compartment . 155 LNG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
Luggage compartment variable floor . . . . 163, 164 refuelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263, 266 fuel tank flap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262, 263
Luggage net smell . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266 panoramic sliding sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
luggage compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 special features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Lumbar support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147 Natural leather Opening and closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258 bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
M Navigation system by remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Main beam assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 CD-ROM player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 fuel tank flap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262, 263
Main beam lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 Net bag in the door cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Main panel luggage compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 rear lid of the luggage compartment . . . . . . . . 14
turn signal and main beam lever . . . . . . . . . . . 136 Net partition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158, 159 windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Maintenance intervals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270 Noises with the central locking switch . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Malfunction adaptive cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202 Opening manually
adaptive cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202 brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 rear lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
catalytic converter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194 ESC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182 Outside temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
clutch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 parking brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
diesel particulate filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194 refuelling natural gas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 P
Front Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213 tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63, 277 Paint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
front assist monitoring system . . . . . . . . . . . . 213 Number of seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
Manual air conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 O Paintwork
Manual gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 Octane rating (petrol) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
Manual unlocking and locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
319
Index

Panoramic sliding sunroof Passenger-side instrument panel Radar sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204, 213
closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 left-hand drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Radio-operated remote control
convenience closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 right-hand drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 see Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
convenience opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 Passenger door manual locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Radio display: cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
convenience opening and closing . . . . . . . . . 132 Passenger seat backrest Radio transmitters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251
fault . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 folding down . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 Rain sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 lifting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 control of the function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
roll-back function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 Pedals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 Raising the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179, 188 Pedestrian Monitoring system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217 Rear
Parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232 Pedestrian protection headrests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
adjusting the display and audible warnings . 236 see Pedestrian Monitoring system . . . . . . . . . 217 Rear Assist system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
automatic activation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235 Petrol instructions for use . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
fault . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
parking system plus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 refuelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
rear parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 Plastic parts: cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255, 256 special characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
sensors and camera: cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254 Polishing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254 Rear bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
surroundings warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 Positioning seat belts Rear bulbs in the side panel
towing bracket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 during pregnancy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 disassembling the rear light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
visual indication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236 seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 Rear LED light bulb in the rear lid
Parking aid system Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 disassembling the bulb holder . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
see Parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232 Power Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261 Rear lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14, 15
Parking brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 Power socket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 see also Luggage compartment . . . . . . . . . . . 130
activate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 Power steering Rear light bulbs in the rear lid
automatic activation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178 see Electromechanical steering . . . . . . . . . . . . 259 disassembling the bulb holder . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
automatic release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 Pre-heating system Rear lights on the side panel
emergency braking function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178 control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195 summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 Preheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 Rear seat backrest
Parking distance warning system Preheating the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175 folding down . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
see Parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232 Press & Drive folding down and lifting the backrest . . . . . . . 151
Parking (automatic gearbox) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188 starter button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 folding down and raising the backrest . . . . . . 150
ParkPilot starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175 lifting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
see Parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232 Progressive steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260 Rear seat passengers
Particulate filter (diesel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194 Puncture see Correct sitting position . . . . . . . . . 70, 71, 72
Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251 action . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 Rear shelf
Passenger storing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157, 158
see Correct sitting position . . . . . . . . . 70, 71, 72 R Rear View Camera . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
Racks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
320
Index

Rear view mirrors


adjusting the exterior rear view mirrors . . . . . 146
S safety notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
unfastened . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
anti-dazzle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 Safe Seat belt tensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18, 79
Refuelling driving safe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 SEAT Drive Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Safelock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 Seat heating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
gas gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 see also Anti-theft security system . . . . . . . . . 120 Seats
natural gas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263 Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
opening fuel tank flap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262 child safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 rear seat backrest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
Remote control key child seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 Selective unlocking system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
unlocking and locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 deactivating the front passenger front airbag . 20 Selector lever lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
Removing and attaching head restraints . . . . . . 148 safe driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 Selector lever (automatic gearbox)
Repair work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251 Safety equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 malfunction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
Replacement parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251 Safety information manual release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Replacing the battery knee airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
of the vehicle key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 Safety instructions Service intervals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Reset the trip recorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 head-protection airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 Service notification: read . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Retaining hooks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 side airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 Side airbags
Retractable rear shelf . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 using child seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22, 87 description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Reverse gear (automatic gearbox) . . . . . . . . . . . 185 Safety interlock for ignition key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Revolution counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108, 111 Safety notes Signal lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Rims seat belt tensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 Sitting position
changing a wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 using seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Roll-back function Saving fuel Sliding panoramic sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
panoramic sliding sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 inertia mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190 Smell of gas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
sun blind . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 Saving tips (efficiency programme) . . . . . . . . . . . 40 Snow chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64, 289
windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 Seat four-wheel drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
Roof carrier system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 electric seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 Spanner symbol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Roof load . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 heating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 Special characteristics
technical data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 Seat belt position tow-starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Roof luggage rack for pregnant women . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Speed limiter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
attach the cross bars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Speed warning device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Roof rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 Seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 Sport Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Running-in adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18, 78 Start-Stop system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
new brake pads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179 cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259 driver messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198
new engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192 control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
new tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277 protective function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
purpose . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75, 80 stopping and starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . 197

321
Index

switching off and on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198 Taking care of your vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252 Traffic sign detection system . . . . . . . . . . . 228, 229
the engine does not switch off . . . . . . . . . . . . 197 exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252 indication on display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
the engine starts by itself . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197 interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256 limited operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
Starter button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 Technical data operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
Starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274 speed warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
Starting the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 roof load . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
Steering Technical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287 windscreen damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228
electromechanical steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259 Tightening torques of wheel bolts . . . . . . . . . . . 289 Traffic signs
engaging the steering lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 Timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 indication on display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
Steering wheel lap times . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 connecting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247, 248
gearshift paddles (automatic gearbox) . . . . . . 187 statistics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 driving with a trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 Tiptronic (automatic gearbox) . . . . . . . . . . 185, 187 electrical socket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
Steering wheel controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 Tire Mobility Set hitching . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
Storage area inflating a tyre . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91 mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
front seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 Top speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 parking Aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
Storage compartments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152, 154 Top Tether system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 26 rear lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
glove compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 Tow-starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 safety lug . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
glove compartment lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 Tow-starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93, 94 tow rope . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Sun blind . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134, 143 Tow-starting the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93 Trailer weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
roll-back function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 Towing a trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246 Transporting children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Sun protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 Towing bracket Transporting items
Sun visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 retrofitting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 fastening rings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
Switch Towing bracket device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 net bag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
hazard warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 ball coupling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247 retaining hooks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Switching off the engine description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 roof carrier . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
with the key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 operation and care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245 roof carrier system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164, 166
Switching off the lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 Towing the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 tailboard for transporting long items . . . . . . . 160
Switching on the lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 Towline anchorages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65, 90 Trim parts: cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
Switching the ignition on and off . . . . . . . . 27, 171 rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 Trims
System Easy Connect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Tow rope . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246 cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
Traction control system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 Turn signal convenience function . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
T Traffic Jam Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221 Turn signal lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Tailboard for transporting long items . . . . . . . . . 160 malfunctions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 Tyre mobility set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Tail lights situations in which Traffic Jam Assist must be components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
changing a bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 switched off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 sealing a tyre . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
switching on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
322
Index

Tyre Mobility System Vehicle ESC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182


see Anti-puncture kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 chassis number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287 for seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Tyre monitoring systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 data label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287 gear change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
tyre monitoring indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283 identification data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287 instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43, 45
Tyre pressure monitoring system . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 identification number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287 instrument panel display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Tyre pressures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 raising . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Lane Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
Tyre profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 unlocking and locking with Keyless Access . . 124 lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Tyre repair kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Vehicle battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56, 275 refuelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
see also Anti-puncture kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 assisted starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 Start-Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
Tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277 charge level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261 tyre monitoring system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277 charging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276 Warning symbols
changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 connecting and disconnecting . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 see Warning and control lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 disconnect and connect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Warning triangle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
new tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 power management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261 Washing the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
repair kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 replacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276 Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288
tyre pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 winter conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 Wheel
useful life . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 Vehicle care changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
wear indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 natural leather . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258 Wheel balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
with compulsory direction of rotation . . . . . . . . 63 windscreen wipers service position . . . . . . . . . 67 Wheel bolts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
with directional tread pattern . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277 Vehicle interior monitoring and anti-tow system 130 anti-theft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Tyre tread depth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 activation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129 caps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Tyre wear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 Vehicle seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 loosening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Vehicle tool kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 tightening torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
U Vehicle tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Wheel cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Unfastening the seat belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18, 78 Ventilation slits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 removing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Unlocking and locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277, 289
by remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 W chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
with Keyless Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Warning and control lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43, 113 changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61, 63
with the central locking switch . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 adaptive cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
Upholstery: cleaning airbag system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84 new wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
alcantara . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258 applying the brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203, 213 snow chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
fabrics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256 ASR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182 temporary spare wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
USB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 audible warning signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 wheel cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
USB/AUX-IN Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 cruise control system (CCS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 Wheel spanner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
electromechanical steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259 Windows
V engine management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195 electric . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16, 131
engine pre-heating/fault system . . . . . . . . . . . 195 removing ice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
Vanity mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
323
Index

Window wiper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143


Window wiper blade . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
X
Windscreen and rear window wiper blades . . . . . 92 XDS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Windscreen washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56, 143
Windscreen washer water
capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
topping up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
Windscreen wiper and rear window wiper sys-
tems
service position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Windscreen wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29, 143
functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
headlight washer system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
heated windscreen washer jets . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
lifting the wiper blade . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
rain sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
replacing the wiper blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
service position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
special characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
window wiper lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Winter conditions
battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275
defrosting the windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
diesel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265
snow chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
taking care of your vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
Winter operation
headlight washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
heated windscreen washer jets . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
salt on the roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
Winter tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
four-wheel drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
Wireless Charger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119

324
About this manual The equipment marked with an aster-
isk* is fitted as standard only in certain
For the sake of the environment

versions, and is only supplied as op- Texts preceded by this symbol contain rele-
This manual contains a description of the vant information concerning environmental
equipment supplied with the vehicle at the tional extras for some versions, or are
protection.
time this manual was published. Some of the only offered in certain countries.
units described herein will not be available ® All registered marks are indicated with
Note
until a later date or are only available in cer- ®. Although the copyright symbol does
tain markets. not appear, it is a copyrighted mark. Texts preceded by this symbol contain additio-
nal information.
Because this is a general manual for the LEON >> The section is continued on the follow-
range, some of the equipment and functions ing page.
that are described in this manual are not in- This manual is divided into six large parts,
cluded in all types or variants of the model; Important warnings on a given page which are:
they may vary or be modified depending on Detailed contents on a given page 1. The essentials
the technical requirements and on the mar- 2. Safety
ket; this is in no way deceptive advertising. General information on a given page
3. Emergencies
The illustrations are intended as a general Emergency information on a given page 4. Operation
guide and may vary from the equipment fitted
in your vehicle in some details. 5. Tips
WARNING
The steering indications (left, right, forward, 6. Technical data
Texts preceded by this symbol contain infor-
reverse) appearing in this manual refer to the mation on safety. They warn you about possi- At the end of this manual, there is a detailed SEAT S.A. is permanently concerned about continuous development of its types and models. For this reason we ask you to under-
normal driving movements of the vehicle ex- ble dangers of accident or injury. alphabetical index that will help you quickly stand, that at any given time, changes regarding shape, equipment and technique may take place on the car delivered. For this reason
cept when otherwise indicated. find the information you require. no right at all may derive based on the data, drawings and descriptions in this current handbook.
The audiovisual material only is intended to CAUTION All texts, illustrations and standards in this handbook are based on the status of information at the time of printing. Except for error
help users to understand certain car function- or omission, the information included in the current handbook is valid as of the date of closing print.
Texts with this symbol draw your attention to
alities better. It does not replace the instruc- Re-printing, copying or translating, whether total or partial is not allowed unless SEAT allows it in written form.
potential sources of damage to your vehicle.
tion manual. Please use the instruction manu-
SEAT reserves all rights in accordance with the “Copyright” Act.
al to obtain more comprehensive information
and indications. All rights on changes are reserved.

❀ This paper has been manufactured using bleached non-chlorine cellulose.


© SEAT S.A. - Reprint: 15.05.17
OWNER’S
MANUAL
Leon
5F0012720BH
Inglés 5F0012720BH (05.17)

Leon Inglés
­­ (05.17)
SEAT recommends SEAT recommends
SEAT GENUINE OIL Castrol EDGE Professional

You might also like